a3a5f3e28cc374d1b2946d84a7c1dddd41ea0d22
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1274 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1275 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1276 interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
3877 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
3878 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
3879 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
3880 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
3881 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
3882
3883 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3884 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3885 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3886 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3887 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3888 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3889
3890 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3891 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3892 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3893 classes.
3894
3895 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3896 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3897 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3904 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3905 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3906 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3907 every function in a given file:
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3911 @end smallexample
3912
3913 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3914 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3915
3916 @kindex info breakpoints
3917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3918 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3919 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3920 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3921 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3922 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3923 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3924
3925 @table @emph
3926 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3927 @item Type
3928 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3929 @item Disposition
3930 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3931 @item Enabled or Disabled
3932 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3933 that are not enabled.
3934 @item Address
3935 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3936 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3937 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3938 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3939 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3940 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3941 @item What
3942 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3943 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3944 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3945 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3950 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3951 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3952 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3953 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3954 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3955
3956 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3957 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3958 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3959 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3963 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3964 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3965 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3966 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3967
3968 @noindent
3969 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3970 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3971 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3972 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3973 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3974 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3978 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3983 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3984 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3985 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3986
3987 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3988 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3989 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3990 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item
3994 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3995
3996 @item
3997 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3998 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3999
4000 @item
4001 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4002 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4003
4004 @item
4005 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4006 several places where that function is inlined.
4007 @end itemize
4008
4009 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4010 the relevant locations.
4011
4012 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4013 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4014 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4015 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4016 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4017 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4018 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4024 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4025 stop only if i==1
4026 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4027 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4028 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4032 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4033 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4034 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4035 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4036 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4037 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4038 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4039 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4040 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4041 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4042
4043 @cindex pending breakpoints
4044 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4045 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4046 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4047 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4048 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4049 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4050 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4051 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4052 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4053 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4054 is not yet resolved.
4055
4056 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4057 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4058 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4059 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4060 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4061 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4062
4063 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4064 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4065 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4066 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4067
4068 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4069 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4070 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4071
4072 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4073 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4074 address specification to an address:
4075
4076 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4077 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4080 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4081 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4082
4083 @item set breakpoint pending on
4084 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4085 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4086
4087 @item set breakpoint pending off
4088 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4089 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4090 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4091
4092 @item show breakpoint pending
4093 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4097 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4098 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4099
4100 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4101 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4102 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4103 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4104 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4105 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4106 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4107 breakpoints.
4108
4109 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4110
4111 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4112 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4113 @table @code
4114 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4115 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4116 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4117 breakpoint must be used.
4118
4119 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4120 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4121 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4122 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4126 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4127 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4128 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4129 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4130 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4131 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4132 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4133 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4134
4135 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4136 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4137 @table @code
4138 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4139 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4140 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4141 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4142
4143 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4144 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4145 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4146 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4147 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4151 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4152 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4153
4154 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4155 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4156
4157 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4158
4159 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4160 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4161 @table @code
4162 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4163 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4164 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4165 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4166 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4167
4168 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4169 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4170 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4171 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4172 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4173 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4174 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4175 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4176 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4177 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4178 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4179 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4180 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4181
4182 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4183 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4184 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4185 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4186 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4187 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4188 @end table
4189
4190
4191 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4192 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4193 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4194 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4195 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4196 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4197 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4198 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4199
4200
4201 @node Set Watchpoints
4202 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4203
4204 @cindex setting watchpoints
4205 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4206 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4207 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4208 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4209 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item
4213 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4214
4215 @item
4216 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4217 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4218 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4219
4220 @item
4221 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4222 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4223 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4224 @end itemize
4225
4226 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4227 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4228 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4229 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4230 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4231 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4232 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4233 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4234 the expression changes.
4235
4236 @cindex software watchpoints
4237 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4238 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4239 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4240 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4241 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4242 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4243 culprit.)
4244
4245 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4246 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4247 slow down the running of your program.
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @kindex watch
4251 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4252 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4253 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4254 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4255 to watch the value of a single variable:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4259 @end smallexample
4260
4261 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4262 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4263 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4264 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4265 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4266 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4267
4268 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4269 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4270 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4271 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4272 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4273 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4274 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4275 error.
4276
4277 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4278 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4279 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4280 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4281 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4282 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4283 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4284 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4285 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4286 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4287 Examples:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4291 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 @kindex rwatch
4295 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4296 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4297 by the program.
4298
4299 @kindex awatch
4300 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4301 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4302 or written into by the program.
4303
4304 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4305 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4306 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4307 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4308 @end table
4309
4310 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4311 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4312 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4313 a never-changing value:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4317 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4318 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4319 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4323 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4324 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4325 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4326 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4327 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4328
4329 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4330 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4331 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4332 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4333 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4334 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4335 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4336 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4337
4338 @table @code
4339 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4340 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4341 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4342
4343 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4344 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4345 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4349 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4350 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4351
4352 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 @noindent
4359 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4360
4361 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4362 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4363 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4364 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4365 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4366 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4367 will print a message like this:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4374 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4375 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4376 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4377 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4378 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4379 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4380 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4381
4382 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4383 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4384 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4385 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4386 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4387 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @noindent
4394 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4395
4396 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4397 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4398 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4399 expression with separately allocated resources.
4400
4401 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4402 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4403 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4404
4405 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4406 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4407 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4408 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4409 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4410 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4411 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4412 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4413 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4414
4415 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4416 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4417 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4418 watched expression from every thread.
4419
4420 @quotation
4421 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4422 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4423 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4424 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4425 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4426 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4427 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4428 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4429 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4430 @end quotation
4431
4432 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4433
4434 @node Set Catchpoints
4435 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4436 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4437 @cindex exception handlers
4438 @cindex event handling
4439
4440 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4441 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4442 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex catch
4446 @item catch @var{event}
4447 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4451 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4452 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4453 @kindex catch throw
4454 @kindex catch rethrow
4455 @kindex catch catch
4456 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4457 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4458
4459 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4460 regular expression will be caught.
4461
4462 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4463 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4464 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4465 exception being thrown.
4466
4467 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4468 @value{GDBN}:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item
4472 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4473 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4474 supported.
4475
4476 @item
4477 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4478 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4479 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4480 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4481 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4482 built.
4483
4484 @item
4485 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4486 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4487
4488 @item
4489 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4490 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4491 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4492 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4493
4494 @item
4495 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4496 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4497 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4498 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4499 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4500 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4501 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4502 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4503 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4504
4505 @item
4506 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4507
4508 @item
4509 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4510 @end itemize
4511
4512 @item exception
4513 @kindex catch exception
4514 @cindex Ada exception catching
4515 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4516 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4517 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4518 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4519 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4520
4521 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4522 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4523 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4524 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4525 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4526 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4527 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4528 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4529
4530 @item handlers
4531 @kindex catch handlers
4532 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4533 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4534 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4535 specified at the end of the command
4536 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4537 only when this specific exception is handled.
4538 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4539
4540 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4541 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4542 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4543 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4544 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4545 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4546 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4547 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4548 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4549
4550 @item exception unhandled
4551 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4552 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4553
4554 @item assert
4555 @kindex catch assert
4556 A failed Ada assertion.
4557
4558 @item exec
4559 @kindex catch exec
4560 @cindex break on fork/exec
4561 A call to @code{exec}.
4562
4563 @anchor{catch syscall}
4564 @item syscall
4565 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4566 @kindex catch syscall
4567 @cindex break on a system call.
4568 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4569 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4570 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4571 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4572 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4573 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4577 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4578 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4579 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4580
4581 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4582 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4583 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4584 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4585
4586 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4587 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4588 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4589 available choices.
4590
4591 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4592 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4593 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4594 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4595 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4596 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4597 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4598 behind the OS upgrades).
4599
4600 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4601 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4602 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4603 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4604 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4605 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4606 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4607 syscall groups available on your environment.
4608
4609 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4610 arguments to it:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4614 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4615 (@value{GDBP}) r
4616 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4617
4618 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4619 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4620 (@value{GDBP}) c
4621 Continuing.
4622
4623 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4624 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4625 (@value{GDBP})
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4632 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4633 (@value{GDBP}) r
4634 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4635
4636 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4637 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4638 (@value{GDBP}) c
4639 Continuing.
4640
4641 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4642 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4643 (@value{GDBP})
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4647 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4648 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4652 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4653 (@value{GDBP}) r
4654 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4655
4656 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4657 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4658 (@value{GDBP}) c
4659 Continuing.
4660
4661 Program exited normally.
4662 (@value{GDBP})
4663 @end smallexample
4664
4665 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4669 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4670 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4671 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4672 (@value{GDBP}) r
4673 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4674
4675 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4676 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4677
4678 (@value{GDBP}) c
4679 Continuing.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4683 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4684 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4685 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4689 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4690 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4691 (@value{GDBP})
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4695 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4696 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4697 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4698 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4699 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4703 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4704 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4705 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4706 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4707 (@value{GDBP})
4708 @end smallexample
4709
4710 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4711
4712 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4713 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4717 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4721
4722 @item fork
4723 @kindex catch fork
4724 A call to @code{fork}.
4725
4726 @item vfork
4727 @kindex catch vfork
4728 A call to @code{vfork}.
4729
4730 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4731 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4732 @kindex catch load
4733 @kindex catch unload
4734 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4735 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4736 matches one of the affected libraries.
4737
4738 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4739 @kindex catch signal
4740 The delivery of a signal.
4741
4742 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4743 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4744 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4745
4746 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4747 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4748 signal names.
4749
4750 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4751 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4752 will be caught.
4753
4754 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4755 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4756 catchpoint.
4757
4758 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4759 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4760 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4761 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4762 commands.
4763
4764 @end table
4765
4766 @item tcatch @var{event}
4767 @kindex tcatch
4768 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4769 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4770
4771 @end table
4772
4773 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4774
4775
4776 @node Delete Breaks
4777 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4778
4779 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4780 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4781 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4782 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4783 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4784 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4785
4786 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4787 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4788 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4789 their breakpoint numbers.
4790
4791 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4792 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4793 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4794
4795 @table @code
4796 @kindex clear
4797 @item clear
4798 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4799 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4800 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4801 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4802
4803 @item clear @var{location}
4804 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4805 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4806 most useful ones are listed below:
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @item clear @var{function}
4810 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4811 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4812
4813 @item clear @var{linenum}
4814 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4815 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4816 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @cindex delete breakpoints
4820 @kindex delete
4821 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4822 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4824 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4825 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4826 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 @node Disabling
4830 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4831
4832 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4833 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4834 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4835 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4836 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4837
4838 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4839 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4840 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4841 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4842 do not know which numbers to use.
4843
4844 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4845 affects all of its locations.
4846
4847 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4848 different states of enablement:
4849
4850 @itemize @bullet
4851 @item
4852 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4853 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4854 @item
4855 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4856 @item
4857 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4858 disabled.
4859 @item
4860 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4861 N times, then becomes disabled.
4862 @item
4863 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4864 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4865 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4866 @end itemize
4867
4868 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4869 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4870
4871 @table @code
4872 @kindex disable
4873 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4874 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4876 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4877 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4878 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4879 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4880
4881 @kindex enable
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4884 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4885
4886 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4887 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4888 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4892 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4893 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4894 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4895 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4896 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4897
4898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4899 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4900 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4901 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4902 @end table
4903
4904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4907 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4912 Stepping}.)
4913
4914 @node Conditions
4915 @subsection Break Conditions
4916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4918
4919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4927
4928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4933
4934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4938 one.
4939
4940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4948 conditions for the
4949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4951
4952 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4953 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4954 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4955 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4956 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4957 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4958
4959 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4960 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4961 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4962 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4963 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4964
4965 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4966 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4967 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4968 with the @code{condition} command.
4969
4970 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4971 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4972 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4973 catchpoint.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex condition
4977 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4978 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4979 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4980 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4981 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4982 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4983 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4984 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4985 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4986 prints an error message:
4987
4988 @smallexample
4989 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 @value{GDBN} does
4994 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4995 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4996 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4997
4998 @item condition @var{bnum}
4999 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5000 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5004 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5005 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5006 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5007 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5008 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5009 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5010 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5011 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5012 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5013 your program reaches it.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex ignore
5017 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5018 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5019 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5020 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5021 takes no action.
5022
5023 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5024 a count of zero.
5025
5026 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5027 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5028 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5029 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5030
5031 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5032 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5033 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5034
5035 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5036 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5037 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5038 Variables}.
5039 @end table
5040
5041 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5042
5043
5044 @node Break Commands
5045 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5046
5047 @cindex breakpoint commands
5048 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5049 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5050 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5051 enable other breakpoints.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @kindex commands
5055 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5056 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5057 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5058 @itemx end
5059 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5060 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5061 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5062
5063 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5064 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5065
5066 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5067 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5068 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5069 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5070 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5071 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5072 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5073 Expressions}).
5074 @end table
5075
5076 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5077 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5078
5079 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5080 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5081 that resumes execution.
5082
5083 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5084 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5085 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5086 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5087 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5088
5089 @kindex silent
5090 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5091 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5092 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5093 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5094 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5095 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5096
5097 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5098 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5099 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5100
5101 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5102 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5103
5104 @smallexample
5105 break foo if x>0
5106 commands
5107 silent
5108 printf "x is %d\n",x
5109 cont
5110 end
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5114 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5115 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5116 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5117 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5118 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5119 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 break 403
5123 commands
5124 silent
5125 set x = y + 4
5126 cont
5127 end
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 @node Dynamic Printf
5131 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5132
5133 @cindex dynamic printf
5134 @cindex dprintf
5135 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5136 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5137 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5138 having to recompile it.
5139
5140 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5141 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5142 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5143 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5144 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5145 redirects to files and so forth.
5146
5147 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5148 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5149 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5150 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5151 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5152 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5153 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @kindex dprintf
5157 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5158 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5159 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5160 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5161
5162 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5163 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5164 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5165 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5166 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5167 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item gdb
5171 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5172 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5173
5174 @item call
5175 @kindex dprintf-style call
5176 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5177 @code{printf}).
5178
5179 @item agent
5180 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5181 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5182 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5183 support running commands on the target.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5187 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5188 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5189 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5190 command.
5191
5192 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5193 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5194 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5195 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5196 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5197 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5198
5199 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5200 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5201 you could do the following:
5202
5203 @example
5204 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5205 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5206 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5207 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5208 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5209 (gdb) info break
5210 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5211 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5212 continue
5213 (gdb)
5214 @end example
5215
5216 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5217 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5218 the variable settings.
5219
5220 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5221 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5222 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5223 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5224 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5225 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5226
5227 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5228 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5229 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5234 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5235 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5236 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5237 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5238 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5239
5240 @node Save Breakpoints
5241 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5242
5243 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5244 breakpoints}} command.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex save breakpoints
5248 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5249 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5250 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5251 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5252 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5253 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5254 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5255 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5256 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5257 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5258 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5259 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5260 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5261 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5262 that can no longer be recreated.
5263 @end table
5264
5265 @node Static Probe Points
5266 @subsection Static Probe Points
5267
5268 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5269 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5270 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5271 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5272 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5273
5274 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5275 ELF-compatible systems:
5276
5277 @itemize @bullet
5278
5279 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5280 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5281 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5282 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5283 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5284 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5285 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5286 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5287
5288 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5289 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5290 C@t{++} languages.
5291 @end itemize
5292
5293 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5294 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5295 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5296 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5297 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5298 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5299 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5300 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5301 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5302
5303 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5304 probes}, with optional arguments:
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @kindex info probes
5308 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5309 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5310 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5311 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5312
5313 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5314 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5315 probes from all providers are listed.
5316
5317 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5318 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5319 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5320
5321 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5322 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5323 given, all object files are considered.
5324
5325 @item info probes all
5326 List the available static probes, from all types.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5330 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5331 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5332 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5333 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5334
5335 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5336 commands, with optional arguments:
5337
5338 @table @code
5339 @kindex enable probes
5340 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5342 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5343 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5344
5345 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5346 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5347 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5348
5349 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5350 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5351 given, all object files are considered.
5352
5353 @kindex disable probes
5354 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5355 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5356 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5360 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5361 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5362 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5363 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5364 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5365 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5366 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5367 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5368 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5369 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5370 at the current probe point.
5371
5372 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5373 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5374 an error message.
5375
5376
5377 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5378 @node Error in Breakpoints
5379 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5380
5381 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5382 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5383
5384 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5385 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5386 @smallexample
5387 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5388 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @noindent
5392 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5393 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5394 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5395
5396 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5397 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5398
5399 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5400 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5401 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5402
5403 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5404 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5405 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5406 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5407
5408 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5409 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5410 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5411 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5412 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5413 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5414 first in the bundle.
5415
5416 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5417 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5418 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5419 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5420 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5421 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5422 is hit.
5423
5424 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5425 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5432 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5433 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5434 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5435 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5436 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5437 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5438 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5441 adjusted breakpoints:
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5445 to 0x00010410.
5446 @end smallexample
5447
5448 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5449 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5450 frequently than expected.
5451
5452 @node Continuing and Stepping
5453 @section Continuing and Stepping
5454
5455 @cindex stepping
5456 @cindex continuing
5457 @cindex resuming execution
5458 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5459 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5460 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5461 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5462 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5463 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5464 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5465 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5466 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5467 handlers}).)
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @kindex continue
5471 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5472 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5473 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5474 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5475 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5476 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5477 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5478 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5479 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5480 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5481
5482 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5483 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5484 @code{continue} is ignored.
5485
5486 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5487 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5488 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5489 @code{continue}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5493 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5494 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5495 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5496
5497 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5498 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5499 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5500 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5501 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5502 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex step
5506 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5507 @item step
5508 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5509 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5510 abbreviated @code{s}.
5511
5512 @quotation
5513 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5514 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5515 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5516 @c distinction here.
5517 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5518 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5519 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5520 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5521 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5522 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5523 below.
5524 @end quotation
5525
5526 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5527 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5528 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5529 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5530 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5531 called within the line.
5532
5533 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5534 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5535 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5536 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5537 was any debugging information about the routine.
5538
5539 @item step @var{count}
5540 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5541 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5542 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5543
5544 @kindex next
5545 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5546 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5548 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5549 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5550 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5551 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5552 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5553
5554 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5555
5556
5557 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5558 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5559 @c
5560 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5561 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5562 @c function are executed without stopping.
5563
5564 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5565 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5566 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5567
5568 @kindex set step-mode
5569 @item set step-mode
5570 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5571 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5572 @itemx set step-mode on
5573 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5574 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5575 information rather than stepping over it.
5576
5577 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5578 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5579 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5580
5581 @item set step-mode off
5582 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5583 debug information. This is the default.
5584
5585 @item show step-mode
5586 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5587 source line debug information.
5588
5589 @kindex finish
5590 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5591 @item finish
5592 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5593 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5594 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5595
5596 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5597 ,Returning from a Function}).
5598
5599 @kindex until
5600 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5601 @cindex run until specified location
5602 @item until
5603 @itemx u
5604 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5605 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5606 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5607 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5608 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5609 than the address of the jump.
5610
5611 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5612 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5613 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5614 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5615 through the next iteration.
5616
5617 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5618 stack frame.
5619
5620 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5621 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5622 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5623 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5624 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (@value{GDBP}) f
5628 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5629 206 expand_input();
5630 (@value{GDBP}) until
5631 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5635 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5636 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5637 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5638 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5639 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5640 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5641
5642 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5643 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5644 argument.
5645
5646 @item until @var{location}
5647 @itemx u @var{location}
5648 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5649 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5650 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5651 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5652 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5653 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5654 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5655 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5656 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5657 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5658 invocations have returned.
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 94 int factorial (int value)
5662 95 @{
5663 96 if (value > 1) @{
5664 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5665 98 @}
5666 99 return (value);
5667 100 @}
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670
5671 @kindex advance @var{location}
5672 @item advance @var{location}
5673 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5674 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5675 @ref{Specify Location}.
5676 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5677 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5678 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5679 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5680
5681
5682 @kindex stepi
5683 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5684 @item stepi
5685 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5686 @itemx si
5687 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5688
5689 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5690 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5691 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5692 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5693
5694 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5695
5696 @need 750
5697 @kindex nexti
5698 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5699 @item nexti
5700 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5701 @itemx ni
5702 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5703 proceed until the function returns.
5704
5705 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5706
5707 @end table
5708
5709 @anchor{range stepping}
5710 @cindex range stepping
5711 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5712 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5713 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5714 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5715 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5716 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5717 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5718 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5719 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5720 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5721 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5722 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5723 if necessary:
5724
5725 @table @code
5726 @kindex set range-stepping
5727 @kindex show range-stepping
5728 @item set range-stepping
5729 @itemx show range-stepping
5730 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5731
5732 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5733 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5734 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5735 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5736 default is @code{on}.
5737
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5741 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5742 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5743
5744 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5745 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5746 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5747 a particular file when stepping.
5748
5749 For example, consider the following C function:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 101 int func()
5753 102 @{
5754 103 foo(boring());
5755 104 bar(boring());
5756 105 @}
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 @noindent
5760 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5761 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5762 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5763 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5764
5765 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5766 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5767 is called from many places.
5768
5769 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5770 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5771 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5772 @code{foo}.
5773
5774 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5775 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5776 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5777
5778 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5779 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5780 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5781 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5782 the underlying system.
5783 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5784 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @kindex skip
5788 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5789 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5790 that specify what to skip.
5791 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5792
5793 @table @code
5794 @item -file @var{file}
5795 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5796 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5797
5798 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5799 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5800 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5801 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5802 over when stepping.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5806 @end smallexample
5807
5808 @item -function @var{linespec}
5809 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5810 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5811 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5812 @xref{Specify Location}.
5813
5814 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5815 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5816 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5817 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5818
5819 This form is useful for complex function names.
5820 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5821 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5822 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5823 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5824 regular expression makes this easier.
5825
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5831 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5832
5833 @smallexample
5834 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5835 @end smallexample
5836 @end table
5837
5838 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5839 will be skipped.
5840
5841 @kindex skip function
5842 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5843 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5844 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5845 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5846
5847 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5848 will be skipped.
5849
5850 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5851 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5852
5853 @kindex skip file
5854 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5855 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5856 will be skipped over when stepping.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5860 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5864 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5868 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex info skip
5872 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5873 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5874 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5875 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5876
5877 @table @emph
5878 @item Identifier
5879 A number identifying this skip.
5880 @item Enabled or Disabled
5881 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5882 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5883 @item Glob
5884 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5885 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5886 @item File
5887 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5888 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5889 @item RE
5890 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5891 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5892 @item Function
5893 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5894 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5895 @end table
5896
5897 @kindex skip delete
5898 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5899 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5900 skips.
5901
5902 @kindex skip enable
5903 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5904 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5905 skips.
5906
5907 @kindex skip disable
5908 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5909 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5910 skips.
5911
5912 @kindex set debug skip
5913 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5914 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5915
5916 @kindex show debug skip
5917 @item show debug skip
5918 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 @node Signals
5923 @section Signals
5924 @cindex signals
5925
5926 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5927 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5928 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5929 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5930 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5931 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5932 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5933 requested an alarm).
5934
5935 @cindex fatal signals
5936 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5937 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5938 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5939 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5940 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5941 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5942
5943 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5944 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5945 signal.
5946
5947 @cindex handling signals
5948 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5949 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5950 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5951 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5952 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @kindex info signals
5956 @kindex info handle
5957 @item info signals
5958 @itemx info handle
5959 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5960 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5961 the defined types of signals.
5962
5963 @item info signals @var{sig}
5964 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5965
5966 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5967
5968 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5969 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5970 for details about this command.
5971
5972 @kindex handle
5973 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5974 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5975 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5976 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5977 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5978 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5979 say what change to make.
5980 @end table
5981
5982 @c @group
5983 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5984 Their full names are:
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @item nostop
5988 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5989 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5990
5991 @item stop
5992 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5993 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5994
5995 @item print
5996 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5997
5998 @item noprint
5999 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6000 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6001
6002 @item pass
6003 @itemx noignore
6004 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6005 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6006 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6007
6008 @item nopass
6009 @itemx ignore
6010 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6011 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6012 @end table
6013 @c @end group
6014
6015 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6016 program until you
6017 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6018 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6019 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6020 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6021 program sees that signal when you continue.
6022
6023 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6024 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6025 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6026 erroneous signals.
6027
6028 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6029 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6030 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6031 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6032 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6033 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6034 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6035 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6036 Program a Signal}.
6037
6038 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6039 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6042 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6043 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6044 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6045 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6046 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6047 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6048 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6049 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6050 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6051 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6052 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6053 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6054
6055 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6056
6057 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6058 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6059 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6060 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6061
6062 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6063 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6064 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6065 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6066
6067 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6068 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6072 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6073 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6074 (@value{GDBP}) c
6075 Continuing.
6076
6077 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6078 main () sigusr1.c:28
6079 28 p = 0;
6080 (@value{GDBP}) si
6081 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6082 9 @{
6083 @end smallexample
6084
6085 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6086 program to receive the signal first:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 (@value{GDBP}) n
6090 28 p = 0;
6091 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6092 (@value{GDBP}) si
6093 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6094 9 @{
6095 (@value{GDBP})
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 @cindex extra signal information
6099 @anchor{extra signal information}
6100
6101 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6102 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6103 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6104 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6105 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6106 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6107 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6108 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6109 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6110 system header.
6111
6112 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6113 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6118 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6119 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6120 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6122 type = struct @{
6123 int si_signo;
6124 int si_errno;
6125 int si_code;
6126 union @{
6127 int _pad[28];
6128 struct @{...@} _kill;
6129 struct @{...@} _timer;
6130 struct @{...@} _rt;
6131 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6132 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6133 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6134 @} _sifields;
6135 @}
6136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6137 type = struct @{
6138 void *si_addr;
6139 @}
6140 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6141 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6142 @end group
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6146
6147 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6148 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6149 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6150 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6151 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6152 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6153 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6154 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6155 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6156 information is displayed.
6157
6158 The usual output of a segfault is:
6159 @smallexample
6160 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6161 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6162 68 value = *(p + len);
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 While a bound violation is presented as:
6166 @smallexample
6167 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6168 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6169 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6170 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6171 68 value = *(p + len);
6172 @end smallexample
6173
6174 @node Thread Stops
6175 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6176
6177 @cindex stopped threads
6178 @cindex threads, stopped
6179
6180 @cindex continuing threads
6181 @cindex threads, continuing
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6184 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6185 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6186 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6187 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6188 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6189 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6190 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6191 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6192
6193 @menu
6194 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6195 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6196 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6197 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6198 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6199 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6200 @end menu
6201
6202 @node All-Stop Mode
6203 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6204
6205 @cindex all-stop mode
6206
6207 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6208 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6209 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6210 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6211 underfoot.
6212
6213 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6214 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6215 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6216
6217 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6218 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6219 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6220 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6221 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6222 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6223 stops.
6224
6225 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6226 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6227 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6228 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6229
6230 @cindex automatic thread selection
6231 @cindex switching threads automatically
6232 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6233 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6234 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6235 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6236 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6237 thread.
6238
6239 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6240 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6244 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6245 @cindex lock scheduler
6246 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6247 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6248 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6249 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6250 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6251 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6252 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6253 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6254 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6255 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6256 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6257 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6258 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6259 @code{on} in replay mode.
6260
6261 @item show scheduler-locking
6262 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6266 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6267 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6268 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6269 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6270 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6271 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6272 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6273 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6274 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6275 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6276 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6277 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6278 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6282 @item set schedule-multiple
6283 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6284 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6285 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6286 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6287 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6288 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6289
6290 @item show schedule-multiple
6291 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6292 multiple processes.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 @node Non-Stop Mode
6296 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6297
6298 @cindex non-stop mode
6299
6300 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6301 @c with more details.
6302
6303 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6304 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6305 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6306 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6307 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6308 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6309
6310 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6311 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6312 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6313 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6314 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6315 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6316 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6317 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6318 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6319 independently and simultaneously.
6320
6321 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6322 or attach to your program:
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6326 set pagination off
6327
6328 # Finally, turn it on!
6329 set non-stop on
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @kindex set non-stop
6336 @item set non-stop on
6337 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6338 @item set non-stop off
6339 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6340 @kindex show non-stop
6341 @item show non-stop
6342 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6343 @end table
6344
6345 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6346 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6347 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6348 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6349 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6350 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6351 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6352 default.
6353
6354 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6355 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6356 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6357
6358 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6359 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6360 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6361 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6362 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6363
6364 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6365 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6366 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6367 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6368 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6369
6370 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6371
6372 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6373 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6374 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6375 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6376 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6377 previously current thread.
6378
6379 @node Background Execution
6380 @subsection Background Execution
6381
6382 @cindex foreground execution
6383 @cindex background execution
6384 @cindex asynchronous execution
6385 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6386
6387 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6388 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6389 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6390 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6391 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6392 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6393
6394 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6395 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6396
6397 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6398 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6399 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6400 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6401 are:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @kindex run&
6405 @item run
6406 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6407
6408 @item attach
6409 @kindex attach&
6410 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6411
6412 @item step
6413 @kindex step&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6415
6416 @item stepi
6417 @kindex stepi&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6419
6420 @item next
6421 @kindex next&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6423
6424 @item nexti
6425 @kindex nexti&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6427
6428 @item continue
6429 @kindex continue&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6431
6432 @item finish
6433 @kindex finish&
6434 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6435
6436 @item until
6437 @kindex until&
6438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6439
6440 @end table
6441
6442 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6443 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6444 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6445 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6446 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6447 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6448
6449 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6450 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @kindex interrupt
6454 @item interrupt
6455 @itemx interrupt -a
6456
6457 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6458 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6459 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6460 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6464 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6465
6466 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6467 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6468 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6472 @cindex thread breakpoints
6473 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6474 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6475 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6476 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6477 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6478 specify some source line.
6479
6480 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6481 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6482 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6483 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6484 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6485
6486 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6487 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6488 program.
6489
6490 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6491 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6492 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6501 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6502 thread list. For example:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 (@value{GDBP}) c
6506 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6510 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6511 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6512 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6513 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6514 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6515 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6516 command.
6517
6518 @node Interrupted System Calls
6519 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6520
6521 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6522 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6523 @cindex premature return from system calls
6524 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6525 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6526 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6527 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6528 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6529 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6530 stop execution.
6531
6532 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6533 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6534 style anyways.
6535
6536 For example, do not write code like this:
6537
6538 @smallexample
6539 sleep (10);
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6543 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6544
6545 Instead, write this:
6546
6547 @smallexample
6548 int unslept = 10;
6549 while (unslept > 0)
6550 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6551 @end smallexample
6552
6553 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6554 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6555 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6556 @value{GDBN}.
6557
6558 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6559 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6560 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6561 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6562
6563 @node Observer Mode
6564 @subsection Observer Mode
6565
6566 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6567 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6568 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6569 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6570 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6571
6572 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6573 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6574 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6575 mode.
6576
6577 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6578 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6579 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6580 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6581 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6582
6583 @table @code
6584
6585 @kindex observer
6586 @item set observer on
6587 @itemx set observer off
6588 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6589 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6590 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6591 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6592
6593 @item show observer
6594 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6595
6596 @kindex may-write-registers
6597 @item set may-write-registers on
6598 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6599 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6600 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6601 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6602
6603 @item show may-write-registers
6604 Show the current permission to write registers.
6605
6606 @kindex may-write-memory
6607 @item set may-write-memory on
6608 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6609 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6610 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6611 defaults to @code{on}.
6612
6613 @item show may-write-memory
6614 Show the current permission to write memory.
6615
6616 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6617 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6618 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6619 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6620 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6621 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6627 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6628 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6630 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6631 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6632 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6635 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6636
6637 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6639 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6640 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6641 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6642 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6643 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6644
6645 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6646 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6647
6648 @kindex may-interrupt
6649 @item set may-interrupt on
6650 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6651 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6652 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6653 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6654 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6655
6656 @item show may-interrupt
6657 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6658
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Reverse Execution
6662 @chapter Running programs backward
6663 @cindex reverse execution
6664 @cindex running programs backward
6665
6666 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6667 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6668 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6669 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6670
6671 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6672 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6673 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6674 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6675 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6676 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6677
6678 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6679 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6680 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6681 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6682 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6683 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6684 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6685 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6686 prior values@footnote{
6687 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6688 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6689 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6690
6691 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6692 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6693 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6694 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6695 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6696 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6697 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6698 }.
6699
6700 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6701 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @kindex reverse-continue
6705 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6706 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6707 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6708 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6709 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6710 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6711 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6712
6713 @kindex reverse-step
6714 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6715 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6716 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6717 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6718
6719 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6720 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6721 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6722 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6723 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6724 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6725
6726 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6727 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6728
6729 @kindex reverse-stepi
6730 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6731 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6732 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6733 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6734 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6735 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6736 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6737
6738 @kindex reverse-next
6739 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6740 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6741 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6742 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6743 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6744 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6745 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6746 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6747 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6748 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6749
6750 @kindex reverse-nexti
6751 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6752 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6753 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6754 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6755 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6756 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6757 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6758 frame) is reached.
6759
6760 @kindex reverse-finish
6761 @item reverse-finish
6762 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6763 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6764 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6765 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6766
6767 @kindex set exec-direction
6768 @item set exec-direction
6769 Set the direction of target execution.
6770 @item set exec-direction reverse
6771 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6772 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6773 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6774 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6775 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6776 @item set exec-direction forward
6777 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6778 This is the default.
6779 @end table
6780
6781
6782 @node Process Record and Replay
6783 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6784 @cindex process record and replay
6785 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6786
6787 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6788 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6789 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6790
6791 @cindex replay mode
6792 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6793 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6794 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6795 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6796 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6797 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6798 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6799 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6800 execution log.
6801
6802 @cindex record mode
6803 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6804 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6805 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6806 for future replay.
6807
6808 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6809 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6810 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6811 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6812 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6813 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6814
6815 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6816 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6817 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6818 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6819
6820 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6821 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @kindex target record
6825 @kindex target record-full
6826 @kindex target record-btrace
6827 @kindex record
6828 @kindex record full
6829 @kindex record btrace
6830 @kindex record btrace bts
6831 @kindex record btrace pt
6832 @kindex record bts
6833 @kindex record pt
6834 @kindex rec
6835 @kindex rec full
6836 @kindex rec btrace
6837 @kindex rec btrace bts
6838 @kindex rec btrace pt
6839 @kindex rec bts
6840 @kindex rec pt
6841 @item record @var{method}
6842 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6843 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6844 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6845 recording methods are available:
6846
6847 @table @code
6848 @item full
6849 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6850 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6851 execution.
6852
6853 @item btrace @var{format}
6854 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6855 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6856 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6857 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6858 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6859 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6860 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6861
6862 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6863 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6864 formats are available:
6865
6866 @table @code
6867 @item bts
6868 @cindex branch trace store
6869 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6870 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6871 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6872
6873 @item pt
6874 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6875 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6876 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6877 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6878
6879 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6880 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6881 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6882
6883 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6884 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6885 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6886 buffer-size with care.
6887 @end table
6888
6889 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6890 @end table
6891
6892 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6893 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6894 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6895 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6896
6897 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6898 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6899 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6900 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6901 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6902
6903 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6904 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6905 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6906 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6907 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6908 does not support these two modes.
6909
6910 @kindex record stop
6911 @kindex rec s
6912 @item record stop
6913 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6914 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6915 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6916
6917 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6918 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6919 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6920 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6921 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6922
6923 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6924 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6925 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6926 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6927 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6928
6929 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6930 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6931
6932 @kindex record goto
6933 @item record goto
6934 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6935 ways to specify the location to go to:
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @item record goto begin
6939 @itemx record goto start
6940 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6941
6942 @item record goto end
6943 Go to the end of the execution log.
6944
6945 @item record goto @var{n}
6946 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 @kindex record save
6950 @item record save @var{filename}
6951 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6953 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6954
6955 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6956
6957 @kindex record restore
6958 @item record restore @var{filename}
6959 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6960 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6961
6962 @kindex set record full
6963 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6964 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6965 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6966 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6967
6968 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6969 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6970 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6971 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6972 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6973 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6974 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6975 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6976
6977 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6978 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6979 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6980
6981 @kindex show record full
6982 @item show record full insn-number-max
6983 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6984 recording method.
6985
6986 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6987 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6988 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6989 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6990 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6991 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6992 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6993 oldest one to be deleted.
6994
6995 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6996 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6997
6998 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6999 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7000
7001 @item set record full memory-query
7002 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7003 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7004 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7005 case.
7006
7007 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7008 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7009 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7010 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7011 results.
7012
7013 @item show record full memory-query
7014 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7015
7016 @kindex set record btrace
7017 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7018 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7019 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7020 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7021 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7022 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7023 You can use the following command for that:
7024
7025 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7026 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7027 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7028 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7029 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7030 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7031 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7032 position.
7033
7034 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7035 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7036 errata when decoding the trace.
7037
7038 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7039 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7040 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7041 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7042 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7043 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7044 which the trace was recorded.
7045
7046 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7047 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7048 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7049 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7050 disable the workarounds.
7051
7052 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7053 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7054 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7055 (default).
7056
7057 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7058 identifiers are currently supported:
7059
7060 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7061
7062 @item @code{intel}
7063 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7064
7065 @end multitable
7066
7067 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7068 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7069
7070 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7071 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7072 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7073
7074 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7075 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7076 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7077 supports.
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 (gdb) info record
7081 Active record target: record-btrace
7082 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7083 Buffer size: 16kB.
7084 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7085 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7086 (gdb) info record
7087 Active record target: record-btrace
7088 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7089 Buffer size: 16kB.
7090 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7091 @end smallexample
7092
7093 @kindex show record btrace
7094 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7095 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7096
7097 @item show record btrace cpu
7098 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7099 workarounds.
7100
7101 @kindex set record btrace bts
7102 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7103 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7104 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7105 format. Default is 64KB.
7106
7107 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7109 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7110 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7111 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7112 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7113 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7114
7115 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7116 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7117
7118 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7119 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7120
7121 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7122 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7123 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7124
7125 @kindex set record btrace pt
7126 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7127 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7128 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7129 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7130
7131 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7132 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7133 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7134 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7135 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7136 actual buffer size for each thread.
7137
7138 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7139 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7140
7141 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7142 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7143
7144 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7145 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7146 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7147
7148 @kindex info record
7149 @item info record
7150 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7151 method:
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item full
7155 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7156 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7157
7158 @itemize @bullet
7159 @item
7160 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7161 @item
7162 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7163 @item
7164 Highest recorded instruction number.
7165 @item
7166 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7167 @item
7168 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7169 @item
7170 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7171 @end itemize
7172
7173 @item btrace
7174 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7175
7176 @itemize @bullet
7177 @item
7178 Recording format.
7179 @item
7180 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7181 @item
7182 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7183 instructions.
7184 @item
7185 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7186 @end itemize
7187
7188 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7189 @itemize @bullet
7190 @item
7191 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7192 @end itemize
7193
7194 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7195 @itemize @bullet
7196 @item
7197 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7198 @end itemize
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @kindex record delete
7202 @kindex rec del
7203 @item record delete
7204 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7205 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7206 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7207 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7208
7209 @kindex record instruction-history
7210 @kindex rec instruction-history
7211 @item record instruction-history
7212 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7213 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7214 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7215 are printed in execution order.
7216
7217 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7218 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7219 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7220
7221 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7222 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7223 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7224 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7225 @code{/p} modifier.
7226
7227 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7228 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7229 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7230
7231 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7232 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7233
7234 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7235 disassemble:
7236
7237 @table @code
7238 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7239 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7240 @var{insn}.
7241
7242 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7243 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7244 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7245 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7246 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7247 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7248
7249 @item record instruction-history
7250 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7251
7252 @item record instruction-history -
7253 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7254
7255 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7256 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7257 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7258 number @var{end} is included.
7259 @end table
7260
7261 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7262
7263 @kindex set record
7264 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7265 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7266 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7267 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7268 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7269
7270 @kindex show record
7271 @item show record instruction-history-size
7272 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7273 instruction-history} command.
7274
7275 @kindex record function-call-history
7276 @kindex rec function-call-history
7277 @item record function-call-history
7278 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7279 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7280 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7281 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7282 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7283 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7284 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7285 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7286 given together.
7287
7288 @smallexample
7289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7290 1 void foo (void)
7291 2 @{
7292 3 @}
7293 4
7294 5 void bar (void)
7295 6 @{
7296 7 ...
7297 8 foo ();
7298 9 ...
7299 10 @}
7300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7301 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7302 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7303 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7304 @end smallexample
7305
7306 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7307 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7308 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7309 to print:
7310
7311 @table @code
7312 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7313 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7314
7315 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7316 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7317 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7318 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7319 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7320
7321 @item record function-call-history
7322 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7323
7324 @item record function-call-history -
7325 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7326
7327 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7328 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7329 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7330 @end table
7331
7332 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7333
7334 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7335 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7336 Define how many lines to print in the
7337 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7338 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7339
7340 @item show record function-call-history-size
7341 Show how many lines to print in the
7342 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7343 @end table
7344
7345
7346 @node Stack
7347 @chapter Examining the Stack
7348
7349 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7350 stopped and how it got there.
7351
7352 @cindex call stack
7353 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7354 is generated.
7355 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7356 the arguments of the call,
7357 and the local variables of the function being called.
7358 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7359 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7360 stack}.
7361
7362 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7363 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7364
7365 @cindex selected frame
7366 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7367 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7368 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7369 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7370 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7371 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7372
7373 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7374 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7375 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7376
7377 @menu
7378 * Frames:: Stack frames
7379 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7380 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7381 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7382 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7383 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7384
7385 @end menu
7386
7387 @node Frames
7388 @section Stack Frames
7389
7390 @cindex frame, definition
7391 @cindex stack frame
7392 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7393 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7394 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7395 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7396 which the function is executing.
7397
7398 @cindex initial frame
7399 @cindex outermost frame
7400 @cindex innermost frame
7401 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7402 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7403 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7404 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7405 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7406 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7407 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7408 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7409
7410 @cindex frame pointer
7411 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7412 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7413 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7414 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7415 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7416 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7417
7418 @cindex frame level
7419 @cindex frame number
7420 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7421 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7422 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7423 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7424 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7425 describe this number.
7426
7427 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7428 @c underflow problems.
7429 @cindex frameless execution
7430 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7431 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7432 @smallexample
7433 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 generates functions without a frame.)
7436 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7437 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7438 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7439 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7440 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7441 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7442 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7443
7444 @node Backtrace
7445 @section Backtraces
7446
7447 @cindex traceback
7448 @cindex call stack traces
7449 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7450 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7451 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7452 stack.
7453
7454 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7455 @kindex backtrace
7456 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7457 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7458 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7459 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7460 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7461 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7462
7463 @table @code
7464 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7465 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7466 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7467 be one of the following:
7468
7469 @table @code
7470 @item @var{n}
7471 @itemx @var{n}
7472 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7473 number.
7474
7475 @item -@var{n}
7476 @itemx -@var{n}
7477 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7478 number.
7479
7480 @item full
7481 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7482 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7483
7484 @item no-filters
7485 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7486 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7487 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7488 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7489 support.
7490
7491 @item hide
7492 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7493 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7494 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7495 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7496 @end table
7497 @end table
7498
7499 @kindex where
7500 @kindex info stack
7501 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7502 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7503
7504 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7505 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7506 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7507 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7508 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7509 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7510 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7511 multi-threaded program.
7512
7513 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7514 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7515 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7516 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7517 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7518 line number.
7519
7520 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7521 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7526 at builtin.c:993
7527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7529 at macro.c:71
7530 (More stack frames follow...)
7531 @end group
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7536 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7537 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7538
7539 @noindent
7540 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7541 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7542 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7543 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7544 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7545
7546 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7547 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7548 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7549 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7550 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7551 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7552 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7553 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7554 such a backtrace might look like:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 @group
7558 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7559 at builtin.c:993
7560 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7561 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7562 at macro.c:71
7563 (More stack frames follow...)
7564 @end group
7565 @end smallexample
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7569 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7570
7571 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7572 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7573 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7574
7575 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7576 @cindex program entry point
7577 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7578 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7579 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7580 @code{main}@footnote{
7581 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7582 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7583 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7584 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7585 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7586 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7587
7588 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7589 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item set backtrace past-main
7593 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7594 @kindex set backtrace
7595 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-main off
7598 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7599 default.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace past-main
7602 @kindex show backtrace
7603 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7604
7605 @item set backtrace past-entry
7606 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7607 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7608 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7609 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7610
7611 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7612 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7613 application. This is the default.
7614
7615 @item show backtrace past-entry
7616 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7617
7618 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7619 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7620 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7621 @cindex backtrace limit
7622 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7623 or zero means unlimited levels.
7624
7625 @item show backtrace limit
7626 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7627 @end table
7628
7629 You can control how file names are displayed.
7630
7631 @table @code
7632 @item set filename-display
7633 @itemx set filename-display relative
7634 @cindex filename-display
7635 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7636
7637 @item set filename-display basename
7638 Display only basename of a filename.
7639
7640 @item set filename-display absolute
7641 Display an absolute filename.
7642
7643 @item show filename-display
7644 Show the current way to display filenames.
7645 @end table
7646
7647 @node Selection
7648 @section Selecting a Frame
7649
7650 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7651 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7652 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7653 of the stack frame just selected.
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7657 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7658 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7659 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7660 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7661 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7662
7663 @table @code
7664 @kindex frame level
7665 @item @var{num}
7666 @item level @var{num}
7667 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7668 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7669 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7670 for @code{main}.
7671
7672 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7673 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7674 commands are equivalent:
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7678 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @kindex frame address
7682 @item address @var{stack-address}
7683 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7684 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7685 @command{info frame}, for example:
7686
7687 @smallexample
7688 (gdb) info frame
7689 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7690 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7691 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7692 source language c++.
7693 Arglist at unknown address.
7694 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7698 indicated by the line:
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex frame function
7705 @item function @var{function-name}
7706 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7707 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7708 most stack frame is selected.
7709
7710 @kindex frame view
7711 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7712 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7713 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7714 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7715
7716 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7717 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7718 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7719 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7720
7721 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7722 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7723 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7724 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7725
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @kindex up
7729 @item up @var{n}
7730 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7731 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7732 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7733
7734 @kindex down
7735 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7736 @item down @var{n}
7737 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7738 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7739 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7740 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7741 @end table
7742
7743 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7744 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7745 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7746 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7747
7748 @need 1000
7749 For example:
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 @group
7753 (@value{GDBP}) up
7754 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7755 at env.c:10
7756 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7757 @end group
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7761 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7762 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7763 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7764 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7765 for details.
7766
7767 @table @code
7768 @kindex select-frame
7769 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7770 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7771 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7772 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7773 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7774 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7775 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7776
7777 @kindex down-silently
7778 @kindex up-silently
7779 @item up-silently @var{n}
7780 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7781 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7782 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7783 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7784 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7785 distracting.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 @node Frame Info
7789 @section Information About a Frame
7790
7791 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7792 stack frame.
7793
7794 @table @code
7795 @item frame
7796 @itemx f
7797 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7798 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7799 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7800 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7801 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7802
7803 @kindex info frame
7804 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7805 @item info frame
7806 @itemx info f
7807 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7808 including:
7809
7810 @itemize @bullet
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame
7813 @item
7814 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7815 @item
7816 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7817 @item
7818 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7819 @item
7820 the address of the frame's arguments
7821 @item
7822 the address of the frame's local variables
7823 @item
7824 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7825 @item
7826 which registers were saved in the frame
7827 @end itemize
7828
7829 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7830 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7831 the usual conventions.
7832
7833 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7834 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7835 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7836 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7837 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7838 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7839
7840 @kindex info args
7841 @item info args [-q]
7842 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7843
7844 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7845 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7846 have been printed.
7847
7848 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7849 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7850 with the provided regexp(s).
7851
7852 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7853 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7854
7855 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7856 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7857 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7858 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7859 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7860 of special characters or quotes.
7861
7862 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7863 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7864 @var{type_regexp}.
7865
7866 @item info locals [-q]
7867 @kindex info locals
7868 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7869 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7870 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7871
7872 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7873 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7874 have been printed.
7875
7876 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7877 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7878 with the provided regexp(s).
7879
7880 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7881 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7882
7883 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7884 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7885 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7886 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7887 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7888 of special characters or quotes.
7889
7890 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7891 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7892 @var{type_regexp}.
7893
7894 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7895 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7896 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7897 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7898 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7899 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7900 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7901 @smallexample
7902 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7903 @end smallexample
7904 @noindent
7905 or the equivalent shorter form
7906 @smallexample
7907 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7908 @end smallexample
7909
7910 @end table
7911
7912 @node Frame Apply
7913 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7914 @kindex frame apply
7915 @cindex apply command to several frames
7916 @table @code
7917 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7918 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7919 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @item @code{all}
7923 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7924
7925 @item @var{count}
7926 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7927 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7928
7929 @item @var{-count}
7930 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7931 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7932
7933 @item @code{level}
7934 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7935 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7936 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7937 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7938 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7939 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7940
7941 @end table
7942
7943 @end table
7944
7945 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7946 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7947 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7948 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7949
7950 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7951 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7952 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7953 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7954 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7955
7956 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7957 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7958 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7959 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7960
7961 @table @code
7962 @item -c
7963 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7964 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7965 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7966 @item -s
7967 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7968 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7969 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7970 are not printed.
7971 @item -q
7972 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7973 information.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7977 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7978 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7979 @code{#1 main} frame.
7980
7981 @smallexample
7982 @group
7983 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7984 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7985 No symbol "j" in current context.
7986 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7987 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7988 No symbol "j" in current context.
7989 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7990 $1 = 5
7991 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7992 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7993 $2 = 5
7994 (gdb)
7995 @end group
7996 @end smallexample
7997
7998 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7999 information before the command output:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 @group
8003 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8004 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8005 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8006 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8007 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8008 (gdb)
8009 @end group
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8016 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8017 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8018 (gdb)
8019 @end group
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @table @code
8023
8024 @kindex faas
8025 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8026 @item faas @var{command}
8027 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8028 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8029
8030 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8031 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8032 is, using:
8033 @smallexample
8034 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8035 @end smallexample
8036
8037 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8038 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8039 @end table
8040
8041
8042 @node Frame Filter Management
8043 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8044 @cindex managing frame filters
8045
8046 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8047 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8048
8049 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8050 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @kindex info frame-filter
8054 @item info frame-filter
8055 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8056 their name, priority and enabled status.
8057
8058 @kindex disable frame-filter
8059 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8060 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8061 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8062 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8063 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8064 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8065 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8066 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8067 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8069 may be enabled again later.
8070
8071 @kindex enable frame-filter
8072 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8073 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8074 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8075 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8076 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8077 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8078 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8079 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8080 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8081
8082 Example:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 (gdb) info frame-filter
8086
8087 global frame-filters:
8088 Priority Enabled Name
8089 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8090 100 Yes Reverse
8091
8092 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8093 Priority Enabled Name
8094 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8095
8096 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8097 Priority Enabled Name
8098 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8099
8100 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8101 (gdb) info frame-filter
8102
8103 global frame-filters:
8104 Priority Enabled Name
8105 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8106 100 Yes Reverse
8107
8108 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8109 Priority Enabled Name
8110 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8111
8112 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8113 Priority Enabled Name
8114 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8115
8116 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8117 (gdb) info frame-filter
8118
8119 global frame-filters:
8120 Priority Enabled Name
8121 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8122 100 Yes Reverse
8123
8124 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8125 Priority Enabled Name
8126 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8127
8128 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8129 Priority Enabled Name
8130 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8134 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8135 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8140
8141 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8142 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8143 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8144 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8145 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8146 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8147 dictionary resides.
8148
8149 Example:
8150
8151 @smallexample
8152 (gdb) info frame-filter
8153
8154 global frame-filters:
8155 Priority Enabled Name
8156 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8157 100 Yes Reverse
8158
8159 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8160 Priority Enabled Name
8161 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8162
8163 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8164 Priority Enabled Name
8165 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8166
8167 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8168 (gdb) info frame-filter
8169
8170 global frame-filters:
8171 Priority Enabled Name
8172 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8173 50 Yes Reverse
8174
8175 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8176 Priority Enabled Name
8177 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8178
8179 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8180 Priority Enabled Name
8181 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8182 @end smallexample
8183 @end table
8184
8185 @node Source
8186 @chapter Examining Source Files
8187
8188 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8189 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8190 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8191 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8192 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8193 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8194 source files by explicit command.
8195
8196 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8197 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8198 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8199
8200 @menu
8201 * List:: Printing source lines
8202 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8203 * Edit:: Editing source files
8204 * Search:: Searching source files
8205 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8206 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8207 @end menu
8208
8209 @node List
8210 @section Printing Source Lines
8211
8212 @kindex list
8213 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8214 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8215 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8216 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8217 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8218
8219 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8220
8221 @table @code
8222 @item list @var{linenum}
8223 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8224 current source file.
8225
8226 @item list @var{function}
8227 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8228 @var{function}.
8229
8230 @item list
8231 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8232 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8233 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8234 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8235 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8236
8237 @item list -
8238 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8242 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8243 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex set listsize
8247 @item set listsize @var{count}
8248 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8249 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8250 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8251 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8252
8253 @kindex show listsize
8254 @item show listsize
8255 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8256 @end table
8257
8258 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8259 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8260 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8261 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8262 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8263
8264 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8265 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8266 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8267 to specify some source line.
8268
8269 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @item list @var{location}
8273 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8274
8275 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8276 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8277 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8278 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8279 the same source file as the first location.
8280
8281 @item list ,@var{last}
8282 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8283
8284 @item list @var{first},
8285 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8286
8287 @item list +
8288 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8289
8290 @item list -
8291 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8292
8293 @item list
8294 As described in the preceding table.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 @node Specify Location
8298 @section Specifying a Location
8299 @cindex specifying location
8300 @cindex location
8301 @cindex source location
8302
8303 @menu
8304 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8305 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8306 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8307 @end menu
8308
8309 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8310 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8311 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8312 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8313 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8314
8315 @node Linespec Locations
8316 @subsection Linespec Locations
8317 @cindex linespec locations
8318
8319 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8320 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8321 specifying a linespec:
8322
8323 @table @code
8324 @item @var{linenum}
8325 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8326
8327 @item -@var{offset}
8328 @itemx +@var{offset}
8329 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8330 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8331 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8332 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8333 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8334 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8335 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8336 linespec.
8337
8338 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8339 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8340 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8341 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8342 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8343 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8344 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8345
8346 @item @var{function}
8347 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8348 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8349
8350 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8351 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8352 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8353 means in all packages.
8354
8355 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8356 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8357 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8358
8359 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8360 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8361 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8362 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8363
8364 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8365
8366 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8367 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8368
8369 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8370 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8371 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8372 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8373 functions in different source files.
8374
8375 @item @var{label}
8376 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8377 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8378 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8379 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8380
8381 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8382 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8383 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8384 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8385 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8386 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8387
8388 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8389 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8390 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8391 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8392 each one of those probes.
8393 @end table
8394
8395 @node Explicit Locations
8396 @subsection Explicit Locations
8397 @cindex explicit locations
8398
8399 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8400 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8401
8402 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8403 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8404 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8405 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8406 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8407
8408 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8409 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8410 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8411 the symbol table to know.
8412
8413 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8414 following table:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item -source @var{filename}
8418 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8419 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8420 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8421 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8422 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8423
8424 @item -function @var{function}
8425 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8426 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8427 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8428 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8429
8430 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8431 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8432 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8433 means in all packages.
8434
8435 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8436 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8437 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8438 breakpoint on both symbols.
8439
8440 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8441
8442 @item -qualified
8443
8444 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8445 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8446
8447 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8448 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8449 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8450
8451 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8452 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8453 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8454
8455 @item -label @var{label}
8456 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8457 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8458 selected stack frame.
8459
8460 @item -line @var{number}
8461 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8462 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8463 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8464 relative to the current line.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8468 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8469
8470 @node Address Locations
8471 @subsection Address Locations
8472 @cindex address locations
8473
8474 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8475 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8476
8477 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8478 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8479 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8480 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8481 source files.
8482
8483 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8484 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8485 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8486 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8487 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8488 of @var{address}:
8489
8490 @table @code
8491 @item @var{expression}
8492 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8493
8494 @item @var{funcaddr}
8495 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8496 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8497 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8498 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8499 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8500 (although the Pascal form also works).
8501
8502 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8503 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8504
8505 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8506 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8507 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8508 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8509 functions with identical names in different source files.
8510 @end table
8511
8512 @node Edit
8513 @section Editing Source Files
8514 @cindex editing source files
8515
8516 @kindex edit
8517 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8518 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8519 The editing program of your choice
8520 is invoked with the current line set to
8521 the active line in the program.
8522 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8523 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{location}
8527 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8528 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8529 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8530 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8531 command most commonly used:
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @item edit @var{number}
8535 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8536
8537 @item edit @var{function}
8538 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8539 @end table
8540
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8544 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8545 @footnote{
8546 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8547 following command-line syntax:
8548 @smallexample
8549 ex +@var{number} file
8550 @end smallexample
8551 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8552 the file where to start editing.}.
8553 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8554 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8555 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8556 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8557 @smallexample
8558 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8559 export EDITOR
8560 gdb @dots{}
8561 @end smallexample
8562 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8563 @smallexample
8564 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8565 gdb @dots{}
8566 @end smallexample
8567
8568 @node Search
8569 @section Searching Source Files
8570 @cindex searching source files
8571
8572 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8573 regular expression.
8574
8575 @table @code
8576 @kindex search
8577 @kindex forward-search
8578 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8579 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8580 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8582 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8583 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8584 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8585 @code{fo}.
8586
8587 @kindex reverse-search
8588 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8589 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8590 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8591 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8592 this command as @code{rev}.
8593 @end table
8594
8595 @node Source Path
8596 @section Specifying Source Directories
8597
8598 @cindex source path
8599 @cindex directories for source files
8600 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8601 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8602 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8603 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8604 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8605 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8606 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8607
8608 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8609 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8610 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8611 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8612 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8613 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8614 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8615 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8616 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8617 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8618 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8619
8620 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8621 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8622 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8623 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8624 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8625 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8626
8627 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8628 source files.
8629
8630 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8631 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8632 each line is in the file.
8633
8634 @kindex directory
8635 @kindex dir
8636 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8637 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8638 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8639
8640 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8641 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8642
8643 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8644 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8645 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8646 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8647 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8648 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8649 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8650 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8651 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8652 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8653 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8654 name to look up the sources.
8655
8656 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8657 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8658 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8659 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8660 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8661 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8662 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8663 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8664
8665 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8666 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8667 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8668 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8669 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8670 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8671 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8672
8673 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8674 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8675 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8676 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8677 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8678 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8679 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8680 command.
8681
8682 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8683 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8684 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8685 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8686 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8687 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8688 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8689
8690 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8691 @cindex default source path substitution
8692 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8693 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8694 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8695 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8696 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8697 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8698 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8699 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8700 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8701 together.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8705 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8706 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8707 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8708 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8709 part of absolute file names) or
8710 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8711 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8712
8713 @kindex cdir
8714 @kindex cwd
8715 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8716 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8717 @cindex compilation directory
8718 @cindex current directory
8719 @cindex working directory
8720 @cindex directory, current
8721 @cindex directory, compilation
8722 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8723 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8724 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8725 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8726 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8727 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8728
8729 @item directory
8730 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8731
8732 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8733 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8734
8735 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8736 @kindex set directories
8737 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8738 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8739
8740 @item show directories
8741 @kindex show directories
8742 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8743
8744 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8745 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8746 @kindex set substitute-path
8747 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8748 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8749 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8750
8751 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8752 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8760 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8761 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8762
8763 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8764 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8765 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8766 the substitution.
8767
8768 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8769
8770 @smallexample
8771 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8772 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8777 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8778 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8779 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8780
8781
8782 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex unset substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8785 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8786 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8787
8788 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8789
8790 @item show substitute-path [path]
8791 @kindex show substitute-path
8792 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8793 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8794
8795 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8796 rules.
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8801 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8802 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8803
8804 @enumerate
8805 @item
8806 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8807
8808 @item
8809 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8810 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8811 directories in one command.
8812 @end enumerate
8813
8814 @node Machine Code
8815 @section Source and Machine Code
8816 @cindex source line and its code address
8817
8818 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8819 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8820 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8821 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8822 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8823 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8824 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8825 well as hex.
8826
8827 @table @code
8828 @kindex info line
8829 @item info line
8830 @itemx info line @var{location}
8831 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8832 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8833 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8834 information about the current source line is printed.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8838 the object code for the first line of function
8839 @code{m4_changequote}:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8843 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8844 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 @cindex code address and its source line
8849 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8850 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8851 @smallexample
8852 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8853 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8854 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8858 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8859 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8860 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8861 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8862 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8863 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8864 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8865 Variables}).
8866
8867 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8868 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8869 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8870 line.
8871
8872 @table @code
8873 @kindex disassemble
8874 @cindex assembly instructions
8875 @cindex instructions, assembly
8876 @cindex machine instructions
8877 @cindex listing machine instructions
8878 @item disassemble
8879 @itemx disassemble /m
8880 @itemx disassemble /s
8881 @itemx disassemble /r
8882 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8883 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8884 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8885 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8886 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8887 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8888 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8889 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8890 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8891 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8895 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8896 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8897 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8898 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8899 @end table
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8903 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8904
8905 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8906 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8907
8908 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8909 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8913 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8917 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8918 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8919 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8920 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8921 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8922 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8923 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8924 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8925 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8926 End of assembler dump.
8927 @end smallexample
8928
8929 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8930 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8931 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8935 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8936 5 @{
8937 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8938 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8939 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8940 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8941 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8942
8943 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8944 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8945 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8946
8947 7 return 0;
8948 8 @}
8949 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8950 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8951 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8952
8953 End of assembler dump.
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8957 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8958 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8959 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8960 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8961 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8962 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8963 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8964 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8965
8966 @file{foo.h}:
8967
8968 @smallexample
8969 int
8970 foo (int a)
8971 @{
8972 if (a < 0)
8973 return a * 2;
8974 if (a == 0)
8975 return 1;
8976 return a + 10;
8977 @}
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 @file{foo.c}:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 #include "foo.h"
8984 volatile int x, y;
8985 int
8986 main ()
8987 @{
8988 x = foo (y);
8989 return 0;
8990 @}
8991 @end smallexample
8992
8993 @smallexample
8994 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8995 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8996 5 @{
8997
8998 6 x = foo (y);
8999 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9000 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9001
9002 7 return 0;
9003 8 @}
9004 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9005 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9006 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9007 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9008
9009 End of assembler dump.
9010 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9011 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9012 foo.c:
9013 5 @{
9014 6 x = foo (y);
9015 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9016
9017 foo.h:
9018 4 if (a < 0)
9019 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9021
9022 6 if (a == 0)
9023 7 return 1;
9024 8 return a + 10;
9025 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9026 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9027 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9028 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9029
9030 foo.c:
9031 6 x = foo (y);
9032 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9033
9034 7 return 0;
9035 8 @}
9036 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9037 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9038
9039 foo.h:
9040 5 return a * 2;
9041 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9042 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9043 End of assembler dump.
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9047
9048 @smallexample
9049 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9050 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9051 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9052 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9053 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9054 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9055 End of assembler dump.
9056 @end smallexample
9057
9058 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9059 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9060 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9061 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9062
9063 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9064 mnemonics or other syntax.
9065
9066 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9067 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9068 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9069 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9070 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @kindex set disassembler-options
9074 @cindex disassembler options
9075 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9076 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9077 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9078 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9079 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9080 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9081 The default value is the empty string.
9082
9083 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9084 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9085 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9086 and S/390.
9087
9088 @kindex show disassembler-options
9089 @item show disassembler-options
9090 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9091 @end table
9092
9093 @table @code
9094 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9095 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9096 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9097 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9098 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9099 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9100
9101 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9102 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9103 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9104 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9105
9106 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9107 @item show disassembly-flavor
9108 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9109 @end table
9110
9111 @table @code
9112 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9113 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9114 @item set disassemble-next-line
9115 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9116 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9117 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9118 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9119 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9120 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9121 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9122 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9123 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9124 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9125 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9126 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9127 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9128 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9129 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9130 instruction.
9131 @end table
9132
9133
9134 @node Data
9135 @chapter Examining Data
9136
9137 @cindex printing data
9138 @cindex examining data
9139 @kindex print
9140 @kindex inspect
9141 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9142 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9143 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9144 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9145 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9146 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @item print @var{expr}
9150 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9151 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9152 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9153 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9154 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9155 Formats}.
9156
9157 @item print
9158 @itemx print /@var{f}
9159 @cindex reprint the last value
9160 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9161 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9162 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9163 @end table
9164
9165 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9166 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9167 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9168
9169 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9170 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9171 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9172 Table}.
9173
9174 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9175 @kindex explore
9176 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9177 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9178 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9179 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9180 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9181 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9182 embedded in the higher level data types.
9183
9184 @table @code
9185 @item explore @var{arg}
9186 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9187 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9191 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9192 C program as
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 struct SimpleStruct
9196 @{
9197 int i;
9198 double d;
9199 @};
9200
9201 struct ComplexStruct
9202 @{
9203 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9204 int arr[10];
9205 @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 followed by variable declarations as
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9213 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 @noindent
9217 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9218 @code{explore} command as follows.
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 (gdb) explore cs
9222 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9223 the following fields:
9224
9225 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9226 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9227
9228 Enter the field number of choice:
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @noindent
9232 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9233 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9234 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9235 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9236 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9237 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9238 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9239 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9243 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9244 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9245 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9246
9247 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9248 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9249
9250 Press enter to return to parent value:
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @noindent
9254 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9255 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9256 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9257 to explore.
9258
9259 @smallexample
9260 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9261 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9262
9263 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9264
9265 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9266
9267 Press enter to return to parent value:
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9271 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9272 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9273 level data structure).
9274
9275 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9276 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9277 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9278 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9279 same example as above, your can explore the type
9280 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9281 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9282
9283 @smallexample
9284 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @noindent
9288 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9289 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9290 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9291 example.
9292
9293 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9294 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9295 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9296 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9297 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9298
9299 @table @code
9300 @item explore value @var{expr}
9301 @cindex explore value
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9303 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9304 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9305 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9306 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9307
9308 @item explore type @var{arg}
9309 @cindex explore type
9310 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9311 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9312 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9313 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9314 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9315 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9316 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9317 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9318 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9319 @end table
9320
9321 @menu
9322 * Expressions:: Expressions
9323 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9324 * Variables:: Program variables
9325 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9326 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9327 * Memory:: Examining memory
9328 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9329 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9330 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9331 * Value History:: Value history
9332 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9333 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9334 * Registers:: Registers
9335 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9336 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9337 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9338 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9339 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9340 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9341 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9342 character set than GDB does
9343 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9344 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9345 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9346 @end menu
9347
9348 @node Expressions
9349 @section Expressions
9350
9351 @cindex expressions
9352 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9353 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9354 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9355 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9356 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9357 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9358 @ref{Compilation}.
9359
9360 @cindex arrays in expressions
9361 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9362 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9363 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9364 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9365 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9366 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9367
9368 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9369 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9370 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9371 languages.
9372
9373 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9374 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9375
9376 @cindex casts, in expressions
9377 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9378 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9379 at that address in memory.
9380 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9381
9382 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9383 to programming languages:
9384
9385 @table @code
9386 @item @@
9387 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9388 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9389
9390 @item ::
9391 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9392 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9393
9394 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9395 @cindex type casting memory
9396 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9397 @cindex casts, to view memory
9398 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9399 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9400 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9401 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9402 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9403 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9404 @end table
9405
9406 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9407 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9408 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9409
9410 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9411 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9412 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9413 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9414 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9415 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9416 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9417
9418 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9419 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9420 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9421 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9422 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9423 as well.
9424
9425 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9426 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9427 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9428 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9429 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9430 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9431 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9432 choices.
9433
9434 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9435 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9436 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9437
9438 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9439 @smallexample
9440 @group
9441 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9442 [0] cancel
9443 [1] all
9444 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9445 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9446 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9447 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9448 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9449 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9450 > 2 4 6
9451 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9452 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9453 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9454 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9455 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9456 breakpoints.
9457 (@value{GDBP})
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @table @code
9462 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9463 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9464 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9465
9466 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9467 is ambiguous.
9468
9469 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9470 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9471 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9472 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9473 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9474 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9475 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9476 in the use of the menu.
9477
9478 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9479 when an ambiguity is detected.
9480
9481 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9482 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9483
9484 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9485 @item show multiple-symbols
9486 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9487 @end table
9488
9489 @node Variables
9490 @section Program Variables
9491
9492 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9493 in your program.
9494
9495 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9496 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9497
9498 @itemize @bullet
9499 @item
9500 global (or file-static)
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent or
9504
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item
9507 visible according to the scope rules of the
9508 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511 @noindent This means that in the function
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 foo (a)
9515 int a;
9516 @{
9517 bar (a);
9518 @{
9519 int b = test ();
9520 bar (b);
9521 @}
9522 @}
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 @noindent
9526 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9527 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9528 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9529 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9530
9531 @cindex variable name conflict
9532 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9533 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9534 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9535 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9536 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9537 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9538 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9539
9540 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9541 @ifnotinfo
9542 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9543 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9544 @end ifnotinfo
9545 @smallexample
9546 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9547 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9548 @end smallexample
9549
9550 @noindent
9551 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9552 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9553 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9554 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9561 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9562 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9563 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9564 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9565
9566 @smallexample
9567 void
9568 foo (int a)
9569 @{
9570 if (a < 10)
9571 bar (a);
9572 else
9573 process (a); /* Stop here */
9574 @}
9575
9576 int
9577 bar (int a)
9578 @{
9579 foo (a + 5);
9580 @}
9581 @end smallexample
9582
9583 @noindent
9584 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9585 here is what you might see
9586 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9590 $1 = 10
9591 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9592 $2 = 5
9593 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9594 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9595 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9596 $3 = 5
9597 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9598 $4 = 0
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9602 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9603 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9604 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9605 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9606
9607 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9608 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9609 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9610 @code{some_global}.
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9614 $1 = 23
9615 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9616 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9617 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9618 $2 = 27
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @cindex wrong values
9622 @cindex variable values, wrong
9623 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9624 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9625 @quotation
9626 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9627 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9628 scope, and just before exit.
9629 @end quotation
9630 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9631 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9632 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9633 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9634 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9635 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9636 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9637 variable definitions may be gone.
9638
9639 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9640 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9641 when compiling.
9642
9643 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9644 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9645 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9646 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9647 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9648 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9649 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9650
9651 @smallexample
9652 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9653 @end smallexample
9654
9655 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9656 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9657 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9658 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9659 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9660
9661 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9662 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9663 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9664 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9665
9666 @cindex no debug info variables
9667 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9668 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9669 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9670 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9671 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9672 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9673 example, in a C program:
9674
9675 @smallexample
9676 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9677 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9678 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9679 $1 = 3.14
9680 @end smallexample
9681
9682 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9683 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9684 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9685 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9686 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9687
9688 @smallexample
9689 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9690 29 i++;
9691 (gdb) next
9692 30 e (i);
9693 (gdb) print i
9694 $1 = 31
9695 (gdb) print i@@entry
9696 $2 = 30
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9700 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9701 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9702 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9703 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9704 For program code
9705
9706 @smallexample
9707 char var0[] = "A";
9708 signed char var1[] = "A";
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 You get during debugging
9712 @smallexample
9713 (gdb) print var0
9714 $1 = "A"
9715 (gdb) print var1
9716 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9717 @end smallexample
9718
9719 @node Arrays
9720 @section Artificial Arrays
9721
9722 @cindex artificial array
9723 @cindex arrays
9724 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9725 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9726 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9727 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9728 program.
9729
9730 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9731 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9732 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9733 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9734 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9735 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9736 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9737 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9738 example. If a program says
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9742 @end smallexample
9743
9744 @noindent
9745 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9746
9747 @smallexample
9748 p *array@@len
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9752 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9753 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9754 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9755 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9756
9757 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9758 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9759 The value need not be in memory:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9762 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9766 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9767 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9768 @smallexample
9769 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9770 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9774 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9775 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9776 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9777 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9778 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9779 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9780 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9781 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9782 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9783
9784 @smallexample
9785 set $i = 0
9786 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9787 @key{RET}
9788 @key{RET}
9789 @dots{}
9790 @end smallexample
9791
9792 @node Output Formats
9793 @section Output Formats
9794
9795 @cindex formatted output
9796 @cindex output formats
9797 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9798 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9799 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9800 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9801 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9802
9803 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9804 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9805 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9806 letters supported are:
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item x
9810 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9811 hexadecimal.
9812
9813 @item d
9814 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9815
9816 @item u
9817 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9818
9819 @item o
9820 Print as integer in octal.
9821
9822 @item t
9823 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9824 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9825 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9826 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9827
9828 @item a
9829 @cindex unknown address, locating
9830 @cindex locate address
9831 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9832 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9833 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9837 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9838 @end smallexample
9839
9840 @noindent
9841 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9842 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9843
9844 @item c
9845 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9846 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9847 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9848 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9849
9850 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9851 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9852 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9853 data.
9854
9855 @item f
9856 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9857 using typical floating point syntax.
9858
9859 @item s
9860 @cindex printing strings
9861 @cindex printing byte arrays
9862 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9863 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9864 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9865 natural types.
9866
9867 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9868 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9869 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9870 array.
9871
9872 @item z
9873 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9874 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9875 to the size of the integer type.
9876
9877 @item r
9878 @cindex raw printing
9879 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9880 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9881 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9882 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9883 pretty-printer which might exist.
9884 @end table
9885
9886 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 p/x $pc
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9894 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9895
9896 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9897 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9898 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9899
9900 @node Memory
9901 @section Examining Memory
9902
9903 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9904 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9905
9906 @cindex examining memory
9907 @table @code
9908 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9909 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9910 @itemx x @var{addr}
9911 @itemx x
9912 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9913 @end table
9914
9915 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9916 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9917 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9918 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9919 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9920
9921 @table @r
9922 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9923 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9924 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9925 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9926 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9927 @c 4.1.2.
9928
9929 @item @var{f}, the display format
9930 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9931 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9932 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9933 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9934 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9935
9936 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9937 The unit size is any of
9938
9939 @table @code
9940 @item b
9941 Bytes.
9942 @item h
9943 Halfwords (two bytes).
9944 @item w
9945 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9946 @item g
9947 Giant words (eight bytes).
9948 @end table
9949
9950 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9951 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9952 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9953 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9954 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9955 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9956 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9957 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9958 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9959 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9960 be altered.
9961
9962 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9963 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9964 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9965 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9966 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9967 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9968 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9969 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9970 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9971 a value from memory).
9972 @end table
9973
9974 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9975 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9976 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9977 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9978 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9979
9980 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9981 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9982 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9983
9984 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9985 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9986 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9987 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9988 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9989
9990 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9991 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9992 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9993 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9994 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9995 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9996 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9997 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9998 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9999
10000 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10001 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10002 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10003 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10004 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10005 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10006
10007 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10008 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10009 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10010 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10011 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10012 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10013 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10014
10015 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10016 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10020 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10021 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10022 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10023 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10024 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10028 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10029 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10030 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10031 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10032 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10033 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10034 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10035 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10036
10037 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10038 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10039 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10040
10041 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10042 @cindex addressable memory unit
10043 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10044 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10045 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10046 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10047 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10048 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10049 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10050 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10051 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10052
10053 @cindex remote memory comparison
10054 @cindex target memory comparison
10055 @cindex verify remote memory image
10056 @cindex verify target memory image
10057 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10058 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10059 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10060 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10061 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10062 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10063
10064 @table @code
10065 @kindex compare-sections
10066 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10067 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10068 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10069 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10070 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10071 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10072
10073 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10074 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10075 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @node Auto Display
10079 @section Automatic Display
10080 @cindex automatic display
10081 @cindex display of expressions
10082
10083 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10084 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10085 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10086 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10087 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10088 The automatic display looks like this:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 2: foo = 38
10092 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10097 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10098 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10099 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10100 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10101 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10102
10103 @table @code
10104 @kindex display
10105 @item display @var{expr}
10106 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10107 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10108
10109 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10110
10111 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10112 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10113 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10114 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10115 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10116
10117 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10118 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10119 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10120 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10121 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10122 @end table
10123
10124 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10125 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10126 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10127
10128 @table @code
10129 @kindex delete display
10130 @kindex undisplay
10131 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10132 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10133 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10134 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10135 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10136 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10137 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10138
10139 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10140 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10141
10142 @kindex disable display
10143 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10144 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10145 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10146 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10147 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10148 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10149 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10150 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10151
10152 @kindex enable display
10153 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10154 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10155 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10156 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10157 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10158 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10159 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10160
10161 @item display
10162 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10163 done when your program stops.
10164
10165 @kindex info display
10166 @item info display
10167 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10168 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10169 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10170 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10171 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10172 @end table
10173
10174 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10175 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10176 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10177 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10178 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10179 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10180 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10181 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10182 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10183 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10184 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10185
10186 @node Print Settings
10187 @section Print Settings
10188
10189 @cindex format options
10190 @cindex print settings
10191 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10192 and symbols are printed.
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @kindex set print
10199 @item set print address
10200 @itemx set print address on
10201 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10202 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10203 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10204 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10205 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10206 @code{set print address on}:
10207
10208 @smallexample
10209 @group
10210 (@value{GDBP}) f
10211 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10212 at input.c:530
10213 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10214 @end group
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @item set print address off
10218 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10219 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222 @group
10223 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10224 (@value{GDBP}) f
10225 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10226 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10227 @end group
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10231 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10232 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10233 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10234
10235 @kindex show print
10236 @item show print address
10237 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10238 @end table
10239
10240 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10241 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10242 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10243 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10244 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10245 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10246 it prints a symbolic address:
10247
10248 @table @code
10249 @item set print symbol-filename on
10250 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10251 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10252 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10253 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254
10255 @item set print symbol-filename off
10256 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10257 default.
10258
10259 @item show print symbol-filename
10260 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10261 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10262 @end table
10263
10264 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10265 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10266 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10267
10268 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10269 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10273 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10274 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10275 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10276 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10277 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10278 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10279 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10280
10281 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10282 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10283 symbolic address.
10284 @end table
10285
10286 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10287 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10288 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10289 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10290 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10291 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10292 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10293 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10297 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10298 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10299 @end smallexample
10300
10301 @quotation
10302 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10303 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10304 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10305 @end quotation
10306
10307 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10308 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10309
10310 @table @code
10311 @item set print symbol on
10312 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10313 one exists.
10314
10315 @item set print symbol off
10316 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10317 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10318 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10319
10320 @item show print symbol
10321 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10322 address.
10323 @end table
10324
10325 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10326
10327 @table @code
10328 @item set print array
10329 @itemx set print array on
10330 @cindex pretty print arrays
10331 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10332 but uses more space. The default is off.
10333
10334 @item set print array off
10335 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10336
10337 @item show print array
10338 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10339 arrays.
10340
10341 @cindex print array indexes
10342 @item set print array-indexes
10343 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10344 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10345 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10346 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10347
10348 @item set print array-indexes off
10349 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10350
10351 @item show print array-indexes
10352 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10353 arrays.
10354
10355 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10356 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10357 @cindex number of array elements to print
10358 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10359 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10360 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10361 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10362 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10363 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10364 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10365 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10366
10367 @item show print elements
10368 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10369 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10370
10371 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10372 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10373 @cindex printing frame argument values
10374 @cindex print all frame argument values
10375 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10376 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10377 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10378 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10379 values are:
10380
10381 @table @code
10382 @item all
10383 The values of all arguments are printed.
10384
10385 @item scalars
10386 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10387 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10388 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10389 only scalar arguments are shown:
10390
10391 @smallexample
10392 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10393 at frame-args.c:23
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 @item none
10397 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10398 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10399
10400 @smallexample
10401 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10402 at frame-args.c:23
10403 @end smallexample
10404 @end table
10405
10406 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10407 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10408 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10409 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10410 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10411 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10412 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10413 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10414 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10415 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10416
10417 @item show print frame-arguments
10418 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10419
10420 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10421 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10422
10423 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10424 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10425 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10426 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10427 This is the default.
10428
10429 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10430 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10431
10432 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10433 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10434 @kindex set print entry-values
10435 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10436 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10437 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10438 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10439 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10440
10441 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10442 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10443 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10444 @code{no} setting.
10445
10446 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10447 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10448 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10449 this information.
10450
10451 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10452
10453 @table @code
10454 @item no
10455 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10456 point.
10457 @smallexample
10458 #0 equal (val=5)
10459 #0 different (val=6)
10460 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10461 #0 born (val=10)
10462 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @item only
10466 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10467 values are never printed.
10468 @smallexample
10469 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10470 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10471 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10472 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10473 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @item preferred
10477 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10478 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10479 value for such parameter.
10480 @smallexample
10481 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10482 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10483 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10484 #0 born (val=10)
10485 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item if-needed
10489 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10490 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10491 parameter.
10492 @smallexample
10493 #0 equal (val=5)
10494 #0 different (val=6)
10495 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10496 #0 born (val=10)
10497 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10498 @end smallexample
10499
10500 @item both
10501 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10502 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10503 optimizations.
10504 @smallexample
10505 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10506 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10507 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10508 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10509 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10510 @end smallexample
10511
10512 @item compact
10513 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10514 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10515 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10516 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10517 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10518 @smallexample
10519 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10520 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10521 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10522 #0 born (val=10)
10523 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @item default
10527 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10528 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10529 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10530 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10531 @smallexample
10532 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10533 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10534 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10535 #0 born (val=10)
10536 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10537 @end smallexample
10538 @end table
10539
10540 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10541 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10542
10543 @item show print entry-values
10544 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10545 entry.
10546
10547 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10548 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10549 @cindex repeated array elements
10550 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10551 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10552 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10553 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10554 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10555 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10556 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10557 is 10.
10558
10559 @item show print repeats
10560 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10561 elements.
10562
10563 @item set print null-stop
10564 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10565 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10566 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10567 contain only short strings.
10568 The default is off.
10569
10570 @item show print null-stop
10571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10572 @sc{null} character.
10573
10574 @item set print pretty on
10575 @cindex print structures in indented form
10576 @cindex indentation in structure display
10577 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10578 per line, like this:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 @group
10582 $1 = @{
10583 next = 0x0,
10584 flags = @{
10585 sweet = 1,
10586 sour = 1
10587 @},
10588 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10589 @}
10590 @end group
10591 @end smallexample
10592
10593 @item set print pretty off
10594 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10595
10596 @smallexample
10597 @group
10598 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10599 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10600 @end group
10601 @end smallexample
10602
10603 @noindent
10604 This is the default format.
10605
10606 @item show print pretty
10607 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10608
10609 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10610 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10611 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10612 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10613 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10614 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10615 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10616 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10617
10618 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10619 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10620 international character sets, and is the default.
10621
10622 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10623 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10624
10625 @item set print union on
10626 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10627 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10628 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10629
10630 @item set print union off
10631 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10632 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10633 instead.
10634
10635 @item show print union
10636 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10637 structures and other unions.
10638
10639 For example, given the declarations
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10643 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10644 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10645 Bug_forms;
10646
10647 struct thing @{
10648 Species it;
10649 union @{
10650 Tree_forms tree;
10651 Bug_forms bug;
10652 @} form;
10653 @};
10654
10655 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 @noindent
10659 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10674 and in Pascal.
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @need 1000
10678 @noindent
10679 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10680
10681 @table @code
10682 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10683 @item set print demangle
10684 @itemx set print demangle on
10685 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10686 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10687 linkage. The default is on.
10688
10689 @item show print demangle
10690 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10691
10692 @item set print asm-demangle
10693 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10694 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10695 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10696 The default is off.
10697
10698 @item show print asm-demangle
10699 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10700 or demangled form.
10701
10702 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10703 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10704 @kindex set demangle-style
10705 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10706 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
10707 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
10708 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
10709 decoding style by inspecting your program.
10710
10711 @item show demangle-style
10712 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10713
10714 @item set print object
10715 @itemx set print object on
10716 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10717 @cindex display derived types
10718 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10719 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10720 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10721 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10722 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10723 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10724 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10725
10726 @item set print object off
10727 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10728 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10729
10730 @item show print object
10731 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10732
10733 @item set print static-members
10734 @itemx set print static-members on
10735 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10736 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10737
10738 @item set print static-members off
10739 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10740
10741 @item show print static-members
10742 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10743
10744 @item set print pascal_static-members
10745 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10746 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10747 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10748 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10749
10750 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10751 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10752
10753 @item show print pascal_static-members
10754 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10755
10756 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10757 @item set print vtbl
10758 @itemx set print vtbl on
10759 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10760 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10761 @cindex VTBL display
10762 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10763 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10764 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10765
10766 @item set print vtbl off
10767 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10768
10769 @item show print vtbl
10770 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10771 @end table
10772
10773 @node Pretty Printing
10774 @section Pretty Printing
10775
10776 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10777 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10778 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10779
10780 @menu
10781 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10782 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10783 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10784 @end menu
10785
10786 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10787 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10788
10789 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10790 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10791 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10792
10793 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10794 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10795 pretty-printers with their names.
10796 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10797 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10798 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10799 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10800
10801 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10802 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10803 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10804 do anything special.
10805
10806 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10807
10808 @itemize @bullet
10809 @item
10810 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10811 all inferiors.
10812
10813 @item
10814 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10815 when debugging that program.
10816 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10817
10818 @item
10819 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10820 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10821 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10822 @end itemize
10823
10824 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10825 pretty-printers are selected,
10826
10827 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10828 for new types.
10829
10830 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10831 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10832
10833 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10834
10835 @smallexample
10836 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10837 $1 = @{
10838 static npos = 4294967295,
10839 _M_dataplus = @{
10840 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10841 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10842 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10843 @},
10844 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10845 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10846 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10847 @}
10848 @}
10849 @end smallexample
10850
10851 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10852
10853 @smallexample
10854 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10855 $2 = "abcd"
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10859 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10860 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10861
10862 @table @code
10863 @kindex info pretty-printer
10864 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10865 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10866 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10867
10868 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10869 whose pretty-printers to list.
10870 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10871 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10872 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10873 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10874 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10875
10876 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10877 to list.
10878
10879 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10880 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10881 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10882 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10883
10884 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10885 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10886 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10887 @end table
10888
10889 Example:
10890
10891 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10892 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10893 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10894 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10895
10896 @smallexample
10897 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10898 library1.so:
10899 foo
10900 library2.so:
10901 bar
10902 bar1
10903 bar2
10904 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10905 library2.so:
10906 bar
10907 bar1
10908 bar2
10909 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10910 1 printer disabled
10911 2 of 3 printers enabled
10912 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10913 library1.so:
10914 foo [disabled]
10915 library2.so:
10916 bar
10917 bar1
10918 bar2
10919 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10920 1 printer disabled
10921 1 of 3 printers enabled
10922 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10923 library1.so:
10924 foo [disabled]
10925 library2.so:
10926 bar
10927 bar1 [disabled]
10928 bar2
10929 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10930 1 printer disabled
10931 0 of 3 printers enabled
10932 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10933 library1.so:
10934 foo [disabled]
10935 library2.so:
10936 bar [disabled]
10937 bar1 [disabled]
10938 bar2
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10942 as can each individual subprinter.
10943
10944 @node Value History
10945 @section Value History
10946
10947 @cindex value history
10948 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10949 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10950 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10951 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10952 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10953 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10954 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10955 symbol table.
10956
10957 @cindex @code{$}
10958 @cindex @code{$$}
10959 @cindex history number
10960 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10961 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10962 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10963 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10964 history number.
10965
10966 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10967 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10968 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10969 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10970 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10971 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10972 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10973
10974 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10975 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10976
10977 @smallexample
10978 p *$
10979 @end smallexample
10980
10981 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10982 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10983
10984 @smallexample
10985 p *$.next
10986 @end smallexample
10987
10988 @noindent
10989 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10990 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10991
10992 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10993 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 print x
10997 set x=5
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @noindent
11001 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11002 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11003
11004 @table @code
11005 @kindex show values
11006 @item show values
11007 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11008 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11009 values} does not change the history.
11010
11011 @item show values @var{n}
11012 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11013
11014 @item show values +
11015 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11016 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11017 @end table
11018
11019 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11020 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11021
11022 @node Convenience Vars
11023 @section Convenience Variables
11024
11025 @cindex convenience variables
11026 @cindex user-defined variables
11027 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11028 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11029 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11030 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11031 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11032
11033 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11034 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11035 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11036 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11037 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11038
11039 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11040 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11041 For example:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 set $foo = *object_ptr
11045 @end smallexample
11046
11047 @noindent
11048 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11049 @code{object_ptr}.
11050
11051 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11052 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11053 value with another assignment at any time.
11054
11055 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11056 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11057 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11058 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11059
11060 @table @code
11061 @kindex show convenience
11062 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11063 @item show convenience
11064 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11065 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11066 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11067
11068 @kindex init-if-undefined
11069 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11070 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11071 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11072 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11073 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11074 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11075 override default values used in a command script.
11076
11077 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11078 any side-effects do not occur.
11079 @end table
11080
11081 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11082 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11083 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 set $i = 0
11087 print bar[$i++]->contents
11088 @end smallexample
11089
11090 @noindent
11091 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11092
11093 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11094 values likely to be useful.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11098 @item $_
11099 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11100 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11101 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11102 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11103 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11104 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11105 to the type of @code{$__}.
11106
11107 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11108 @item $__
11109 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11110 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11111 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11112
11113 @item $_exitcode
11114 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11115 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11116 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11117 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11118
11119 @item $_exitsignal
11120 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11121 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11122 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11123 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11124
11125 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11126 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11127 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11128 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11129 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 #include <signal.h>
11133
11134 int
11135 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11136 @{
11137 raise (SIGALRM);
11138 return 0;
11139 @}
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11143 or signalled would be:
11144
11145 @smallexample
11146 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11147 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11148 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11149 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11150 >echo The program has exited\n
11151 >else
11152 >echo The program has signalled\n
11153 >end
11154 >end
11155 (@value{GDBP}) run
11156 Starting program:
11157
11158 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11159 The program no longer exists.
11160 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11161 The program has signalled
11162 @end smallexample
11163
11164 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11165 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11166 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11167 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11171 The program has exited
11172 @end smallexample
11173
11174 @item $_exception
11175 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11176 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11177
11178 @item $_probe_argc
11179 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11180 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11181
11182 @item $_sdata
11183 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11184 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11185 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11186 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11187 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11188
11189 @item $_siginfo
11190 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11191 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11192 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11193 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11194 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11195
11196 @item $_tlb
11197 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11198 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11199 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11200 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11201 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11202 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11203
11204 @item $_inferior
11205 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11206 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11207
11208 @item $_thread
11209 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11210
11211 @item $_gthread
11212 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11213
11214 @item $_gdb_major
11215 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11216 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11217 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11218 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11219 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11220 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11221 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11222 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11223 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11224 versions.
11225 @end table
11226
11227 @node Convenience Funs
11228 @section Convenience Functions
11229
11230 @cindex convenience functions
11231 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11232 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11233 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11234 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11235 @value{GDBN}.
11236
11237 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11238 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11239
11240 @table @code
11241
11242 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11243 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11244 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11245 returns zero.
11246
11247 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11248 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11249 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11250 it is @code{void}:
11251
11252 @smallexample
11253 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11254 $1 = void
11255 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11256 $2 = 1
11257 (@value{GDBP}) run
11258 Starting program: ./a.out
11259 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11260 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11261 $3 = 0
11262 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11263 $4 = 0
11264 @end smallexample
11265
11266 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11267 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11268 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11269 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11270 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11271 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11272 anymore.
11273
11274 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11275 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11276
11277 @smallexample
11278 void
11279 foo (void)
11280 @{
11281 @}
11282 @end smallexample
11283
11284 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11285
11286 @smallexample
11287 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11288 $1 = void
11289 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11290 $2 = 1
11291 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11292 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11293 $3 = void
11294 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11295 $4 = 1
11296 @end smallexample
11297
11298 @end table
11299
11300 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11301 @code{Python} support.
11302
11303 @table @code
11304
11305 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11306 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11307 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11308 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11309 Otherwise it returns zero.
11310
11311 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11312 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11313 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11314 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11315 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11316 regular expression support.
11317
11318 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11319 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11320 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11321 Otherwise it returns zero.
11322
11323 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11324 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11325 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11326
11327 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11328 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11329 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11330 Otherwise it returns zero.
11331
11332 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11333 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11334 The default is 1.
11335
11336 Example:
11337
11338 @smallexample
11339 (gdb) backtrace
11340 #0 bottom_func ()
11341 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11342 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11343 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11344 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11345 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11346 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11347 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11348 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11349 $1 = 1
11350 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11351 $1 = 1
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11355 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11356 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11357 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11358
11359 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11360 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11361 The default is 1.
11362
11363 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11364 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11365 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11366 Otherwise it returns zero.
11367
11368 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11369 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11370 The default is 1.
11371
11372 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11373 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11374 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11375 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11376
11377 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11378 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11379 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11380 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11381
11382 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11383 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11384 The default is 1.
11385
11386 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11387 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11388 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11389 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11390
11391 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11392 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11393 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11394
11395 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11396 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11397 an enumerated type:
11398
11399 @smallexample
11400 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11401 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11402 @end smallexample
11403
11404 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
11405 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
11406 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
11407 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
11408 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
11409 the complex number @var{value}.
11410
11411 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
11412 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
11413 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
11414
11415 @end table
11416
11417 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11418 convenience functions.
11419
11420 @table @code
11421 @item help function
11422 @kindex help function
11423 @cindex show all convenience functions
11424 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11425 @end table
11426
11427 @node Registers
11428 @section Registers
11429
11430 @cindex registers
11431 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11432 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11433 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11434 your machine.
11435
11436 @table @code
11437 @kindex info registers
11438 @item info registers
11439 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11440 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11441
11442 @kindex info all-registers
11443 @cindex floating point registers
11444 @item info all-registers
11445 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11446 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11447
11448 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11449 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11450 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11451 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11452
11453 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11454 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11455 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11456 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11457 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11458 @end table
11459
11460 @anchor{standard registers}
11461 @cindex stack pointer register
11462 @cindex program counter register
11463 @cindex process status register
11464 @cindex frame pointer register
11465 @cindex standard registers
11466 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11467 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11468 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11469 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11470 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11471 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11472 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11473 you could print the program counter in hex with
11474
11475 @smallexample
11476 p/x $pc
11477 @end smallexample
11478
11479 @noindent
11480 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11481
11482 @smallexample
11483 x/i $pc
11484 @end smallexample
11485
11486 @noindent
11487 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11488 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11489 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11490 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11491 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11492 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11493 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11494
11495 @smallexample
11496 set $sp += 4
11497 @end smallexample
11498
11499 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11500 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11501 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11502 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11503 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11504 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11505 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11506
11507 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11508 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11509 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11510 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11511 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11512 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11513 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11514
11515 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11516 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11517 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11518 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11519 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11520 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11521 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11522 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11523 prints the data in both formats.
11524
11525 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11526 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11527 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11528 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11529 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11530 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11531 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11532
11533 @smallexample
11534 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11535 $1 = @{
11536 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11537 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11538 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11539 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11540 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11541 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11542 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11543 @}
11544 @end smallexample
11545
11546 @noindent
11547 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11548 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11549 value to a @code{struct} member:
11550
11551 @smallexample
11552 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11553 @end smallexample
11554
11555 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11556 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11557 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11558 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11559 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11560 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11561
11562 @cindex caller-saved registers
11563 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11564 @cindex volatile registers
11565 @cindex <not saved> values
11566 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11567 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11568 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11569 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11570 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11571 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11572 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11573 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11574 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11575 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11576 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11577 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11578 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11579 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11580 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11581 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11582 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11583 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11584 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11585 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11586 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11587 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11588 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11589
11590 @node Floating Point Hardware
11591 @section Floating Point Hardware
11592 @cindex floating point
11593
11594 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11595 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11596
11597 @table @code
11598 @kindex info float
11599 @item info float
11600 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11601 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11602 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11603 the ARM and x86 machines.
11604 @end table
11605
11606 @node Vector Unit
11607 @section Vector Unit
11608 @cindex vector unit
11609
11610 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11611 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11612
11613 @table @code
11614 @kindex info vector
11615 @item info vector
11616 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11617 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11618 @end table
11619
11620 @node OS Information
11621 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11622 @cindex OS information
11623
11624 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11625 you debug your program.
11626
11627 @cindex auxiliary vector
11628 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11629 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11630 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11631 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11632 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11633 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11634 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11635 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11636 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11637 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11638 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11639 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11640
11641 @table @code
11642 @kindex info auxv
11643 @item info auxv
11644 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11645 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11646 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11647 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11648 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11649 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11650 an unrecognized tag.
11651 @end table
11652
11653 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11654 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11655 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11656 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11657 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11658 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11659 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11660
11661 @table @code
11662 @kindex info os
11663 @item info os @var{infotype}
11664
11665 Display OS information of the requested type.
11666
11667 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11668
11669 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11670 @table @code
11671 @kindex info os cpus
11672 @item cpus
11673 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11674 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11675 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11676 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11677 kernel initialization.
11678
11679 @kindex info os files
11680 @item files
11681 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11682 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11683 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11684 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11685
11686 @kindex info os modules
11687 @item modules
11688 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11689 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11690 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11691 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11692 in memory.
11693
11694 @kindex info os msg
11695 @item msg
11696 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11697 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11698 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11699 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11700 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11701 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11702 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11703 the message queue was last changed.
11704
11705 @kindex info os processes
11706 @item processes
11707 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11708 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11709 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11710 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11711 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11712 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11713
11714 @kindex info os procgroups
11715 @item procgroups
11716 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11717 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11718 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11719 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11720 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11721 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11722 and the process group leader is listed first.
11723
11724 @kindex info os semaphores
11725 @item semaphores
11726 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11727 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11728 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11729 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11730 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11731
11732 @kindex info os shm
11733 @item shm
11734 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11735 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11736 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11737 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11738 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11739 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11740 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11741
11742 @kindex info os sockets
11743 @item sockets
11744 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11745 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11746 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11747 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11748 connection.
11749
11750 @kindex info os threads
11751 @item threads
11752 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11753 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11754 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11755 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11756 process is not listed.
11757 @end table
11758
11759 @item info os
11760 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11761 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11762 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11763 types, this command will report an error.
11764 @end table
11765
11766 @node Memory Region Attributes
11767 @section Memory Region Attributes
11768 @cindex memory region attributes
11769
11770 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11771 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11772 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11773 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11774 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11775 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11776 user can override the fetched regions.
11777
11778 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11779 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11780 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11781 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11782 all memory.
11783
11784 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11785 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11786
11787 @table @code
11788 @kindex mem
11789 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11790 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11791 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11792 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11793 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11794 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11795
11796 @item mem auto
11797 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11798 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11799
11800 @kindex delete mem
11801 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11802 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11803 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11804
11805 @kindex disable mem
11806 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11807 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11808 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11809 It may be enabled again later.
11810
11811 @kindex enable mem
11812 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11813 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11814
11815 @kindex info mem
11816 @item info mem
11817 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11818 for each region:
11819
11820 @table @emph
11821 @item Memory Region Number
11822 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11823 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11824 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11825
11826 @item Lo Address
11827 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11828
11829 @item Hi Address
11830 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11831
11832 @item Attributes
11833 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11834 @end table
11835 @end table
11836
11837
11838 @subsection Attributes
11839
11840 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11841 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11842 write accesses to a memory region.
11843
11844 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11845 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11846 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11847
11848 @table @code
11849 @item ro
11850 Memory is read only.
11851 @item wo
11852 Memory is write only.
11853 @item rw
11854 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11855 @end table
11856
11857 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11858 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11859 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11860 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11861 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11862
11863 @table @code
11864 @item 8
11865 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11866 @item 16
11867 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11868 @item 32
11869 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11870 @item 64
11871 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11872 @end table
11873
11874 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11875 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11876 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11877 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11878 @c
11879 @c @table @code
11880 @c @item hwbreak
11881 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11882 @c @item swbreak (default)
11883 @c @end table
11884
11885 @subsubsection Data Cache
11886 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11887 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11888 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11889 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11890 registers.
11891
11892 @table @code
11893 @item cache
11894 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11895 @item nocache
11896 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11897 @end table
11898
11899 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11900 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11901 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11902 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11903 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11904
11905 @table @code
11906 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11907 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11908 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11909 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11910 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11911 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11912 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11913 The default value is @code{on}.
11914 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11915 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11916 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11917 @end table
11918
11919
11920 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11921 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11922 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11923 @c
11924 @c @table @code
11925 @c @item verify
11926 @c @item noverify (default)
11927 @c @end table
11928
11929 @node Dump/Restore Files
11930 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11931 @cindex dump/restore files
11932 @cindex append data to a file
11933 @cindex dump data to a file
11934 @cindex restore data from a file
11935
11936 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11937 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11938 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11939 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11940 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11941 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11942 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11943
11944 @table @code
11945
11946 @kindex dump
11947 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11948 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11949 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11950 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11951
11952 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11953 @table @code
11954 @item binary
11955 Raw binary form.
11956 @item ihex
11957 Intel hex format.
11958 @item srec
11959 Motorola S-record format.
11960 @item tekhex
11961 Tektronix Hex format.
11962 @item verilog
11963 Verilog Hex format.
11964 @end table
11965
11966 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11967 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11968 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11969 form.
11970
11971 @kindex append
11972 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11973 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11974 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11975 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11976 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11977
11978 @kindex restore
11979 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11980 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11981 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11982 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11983 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11984
11985 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11986 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11987 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11988 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11989 from that location.
11990
11991 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11992 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11993 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11994 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11995
11996 @end table
11997
11998 @node Core File Generation
11999 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
12000 @cindex dump core from inferior
12001
12002 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12003 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12004 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12005 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12006 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12007 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12008 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12009
12010 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12011 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12012 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12013
12014 @table @code
12015 @kindex gcore
12016 @kindex generate-core-file
12017 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12018 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12019 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12020 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12021 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12022 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12023
12024 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12025 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12026
12027 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12028 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12029 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12030 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12031 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12032
12033 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12034 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12035 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12036 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12037 Enable or disable the use of the file
12038 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12039 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12040 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12041 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12042
12043 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12044 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12045 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12046 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12047 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12048 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12049 about the bits that can be set in the
12050 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12051 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12052
12053 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12054 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12055 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12056 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12057 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12058 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12059 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12060 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12061
12062 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12063 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12064 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12065 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12066 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12067 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12068 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12069
12070 The default value is @code{off}.
12071 @end table
12072
12073 @node Character Sets
12074 @section Character Sets
12075 @cindex character sets
12076 @cindex charset
12077 @cindex translating between character sets
12078 @cindex host character set
12079 @cindex target character set
12080
12081 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12082 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12083 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12084 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12085 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12086 @dfn{target character set}.
12087
12088 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12089 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12090 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12091 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12092 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12093 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12094 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12095 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12096 character and string literals in expressions.
12097
12098 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12099 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12100 target-charset} command, described below.
12101
12102 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12103 support:
12104
12105 @table @code
12106 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12107 @kindex set target-charset
12108 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12109 list of supported target character sets, type
12110 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12111
12112 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12113 @kindex set host-charset
12114 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12115
12116 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12117 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12118 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12119 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12120 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12121
12122 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12123 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12124 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12125
12126 @item set charset @var{charset}
12127 @kindex set charset
12128 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12129 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12130 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12131 for both host and target.
12132
12133 @item show charset
12134 @kindex show charset
12135 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12136
12137 @item show host-charset
12138 @kindex show host-charset
12139 Show the name of the current host character set.
12140
12141 @item show target-charset
12142 @kindex show target-charset
12143 Show the name of the current target character set.
12144
12145 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12146 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12147 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12148 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12149 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12150 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12151
12152 @item show target-wide-charset
12153 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12154 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12155 @end table
12156
12157 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12158 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12159 @file{charset-test.c}:
12160
12161 @smallexample
12162 #include <stdio.h>
12163
12164 char ascii_hello[]
12165 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12166 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12167 char ibm1047_hello[]
12168 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12169 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12170
12171 main ()
12172 @{
12173 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12174 @}
12175 @end smallexample
12176
12177 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12178 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12179 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12180
12181 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12182
12183 @smallexample
12184 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12185 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12186 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12187 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12188 @dots{}
12189 (@value{GDBP})
12190 @end smallexample
12191
12192 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12193 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12194 strings:
12195
12196 @smallexample
12197 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12198 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12199 (@value{GDBP})
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12203 initial character set:
12204 @smallexample
12205 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12206 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12207 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12208 (@value{GDBP})
12209 @end smallexample
12210
12211 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12212 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12213 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12214 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12215 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12216
12217 @smallexample
12218 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12219 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12220 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12221 $2 = 72 'H'
12222 (@value{GDBP})
12223 @end smallexample
12224
12225 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12226 literals you use in expressions:
12227
12228 @smallexample
12229 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12230 $3 = 43 '+'
12231 (@value{GDBP})
12232 @end smallexample
12233
12234 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12235 character.
12236
12237 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12238 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12239 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12240
12241 @smallexample
12242 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12243 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12244 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12245 $5 = 200 '\310'
12246 (@value{GDBP})
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12250 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12251
12252 @smallexample
12253 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12254 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12255 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12259 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12260 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12261 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12262 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12263
12264 @smallexample
12265 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12266 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12267 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12268 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12269 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12270 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12271 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12272 $7 = 72 '\110'
12273 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12274 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12275 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12276 $9 = 200 'H'
12277 (@value{GDBP})
12278 @end smallexample
12279
12280 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12281 string literals you use in expressions:
12282
12283 @smallexample
12284 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12285 $10 = 78 '+'
12286 (@value{GDBP})
12287 @end smallexample
12288
12289 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12290 character.
12291
12292 @node Caching Target Data
12293 @section Caching Data of Targets
12294 @cindex caching data of targets
12295
12296 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12297 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12298 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12299 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12300 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12301 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12302 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12303 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12304 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12305 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12306 is executing.
12307 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12308 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12309 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12310 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12311 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12312 in the code segment.
12313 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12314 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12315
12316 @table @code
12317 @kindex set remotecache
12318 @item set remotecache on
12319 @itemx set remotecache off
12320 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12321 with old scripts.
12322
12323 @kindex show remotecache
12324 @item show remotecache
12325 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12326
12327 @kindex set stack-cache
12328 @item set stack-cache on
12329 @itemx set stack-cache off
12330 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12331 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12332
12333 @kindex show stack-cache
12334 @item show stack-cache
12335 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12336
12337 @kindex set code-cache
12338 @item set code-cache on
12339 @itemx set code-cache off
12340 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12341 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12342 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12343
12344 @kindex show code-cache
12345 @item show code-cache
12346 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12347 accesses.
12348
12349 @kindex info dcache
12350 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12351 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12352 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12353 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12354 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12355 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12356
12357 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12358 printed in hex.
12359
12360 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12361 @cindex dcache size
12362 @kindex set dcache size
12363 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12364
12365 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12366 @cindex dcache line-size
12367 @kindex set dcache line-size
12368 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12369 Must be a power of 2.
12370
12371 @item show dcache size
12372 @kindex show dcache size
12373 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12374
12375 @item show dcache line-size
12376 @kindex show dcache line-size
12377 Show default size of dcache lines.
12378
12379 @end table
12380
12381 @node Searching Memory
12382 @section Search Memory
12383 @cindex searching memory
12384
12385 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12386 @code{find} command.
12387
12388 @table @code
12389 @kindex find
12390 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12391 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12392 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12393 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12394 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12395 @end table
12396
12397 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12398 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12399
12400 @table @r
12401 @item @var{s}, search query size
12402 The size of each search query value.
12403
12404 @table @code
12405 @item b
12406 bytes
12407 @item h
12408 halfwords (two bytes)
12409 @item w
12410 words (four bytes)
12411 @item g
12412 giant words (eight bytes)
12413 @end table
12414
12415 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12416 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12417 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12418 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12419 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12420
12421 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12422 value's type in the current language.
12423 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12424 pattern as a mixture of types.
12425 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12426 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12427 which is typically four bytes.
12428
12429 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12430 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12431 @end table
12432
12433 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12434 (@code{"}).
12435 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12436 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12437
12438 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12439 number of matches found.
12440
12441 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12442 @samp{$_}.
12443 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12444
12445 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12446
12447 @smallexample
12448 void
12449 hello ()
12450 @{
12451 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12452 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12453 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12454 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12455 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12456 @}
12457 @end smallexample
12458
12459 @noindent
12460 you get during debugging:
12461
12462 @smallexample
12463 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12464 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12465 1 pattern found
12466 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12467 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12468 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12469 2 patterns found.
12470 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12471 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12472 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12473 2 patterns found.
12474 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12475 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12476 1 pattern found
12477 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12478 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12479 1 pattern found
12480 (gdb) print $numfound
12481 $1 = 1
12482 (gdb) print $_
12483 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12484 @end smallexample
12485
12486 @node Value Sizes
12487 @section Value Sizes
12488
12489 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12490 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12491 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12492 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12493 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12494
12495 @table @code
12496 @kindex set max-value-size
12497 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12498 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12499 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12500 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12501 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12502
12503 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12504 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12505
12506 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12507 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12508 currently 16 bytes.
12509
12510 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12511 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12512 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12513 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12514 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12515 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12516 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12517 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12518
12519 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12520
12521 @kindex show max-value-size
12522 @item show max-value-size
12523 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12524 allocate for the contents of a value.
12525 @end table
12526
12527 @node Optimized Code
12528 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12529 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12530 @cindex debugging optimized code
12531
12532 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12533 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12534 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12535 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12536 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12537 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12538 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12539
12540 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12541 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12542 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12543 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12544
12545 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12546 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12547 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12548 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12549 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12550 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12551
12552 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12553 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12554 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12555 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12556 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12557
12558 @menu
12559 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12560 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12561 @end menu
12562
12563 @node Inline Functions
12564 @section Inline Functions
12565 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12566
12567 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12568 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12569 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12570 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12571 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12572 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12573 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12574 @code{info frame} command.
12575
12576 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12577 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12578 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12579 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12580 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12581 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12582 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12583 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12584 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12585 local variables in the caller.
12586
12587 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12588 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12589 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12590 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12591 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12592 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12593 instructions are executed.
12594
12595 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12596 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12597 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12598 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12599
12600 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12601 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12602
12603 @itemize @bullet
12604 @item
12605 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12606 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12607 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12608 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12609 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12610 or inside the inlined function instead.
12611
12612 @item
12613 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12614 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12615 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12616 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12617
12618 @end itemize
12619
12620 @node Tail Call Frames
12621 @section Tail Call Frames
12622 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12623
12624 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12625 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12626 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12627 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12628 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12629
12630 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12631 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12632 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12633 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12634 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12635 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12636 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12637
12638 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12639 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12640 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12641 this information.
12642
12643 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12644 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12645
12646 @smallexample
12647 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12648 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12649 (gdb) info frame
12650 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12651 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12652 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12653 source language c++.
12654 Arglist at unknown address.
12655 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12656 @end smallexample
12657
12658 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12659 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12660 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12661 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12662 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12663 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12664
12665 @table @code
12666 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12667 @item set debug entry-values
12668 @kindex set debug entry-values
12669 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12670 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12671 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12672 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12673 result.
12674
12675 @item show debug entry-values
12676 @kindex show debug entry-values
12677 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12678 values at function entry and tail calls.
12679 @end table
12680
12681 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12682 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12683 reference by variable @code{x}):
12684
12685 @smallexample
12686 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12687 void (*x) (void) = c;
12688 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12689 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12690 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12691
12692 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12693 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12694 a () at t.c:3
12695 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12696 (gdb) bt
12697 #0 a () at t.c:3
12698 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12699 @end smallexample
12700
12701 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12702
12703 @smallexample
12704 int i;
12705 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12706 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12707 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12708 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12709 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12710 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12711 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12712 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12713
12714 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12715 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12716 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12717 (gdb) bt
12718 #0 f () at t.c:2
12719 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12720 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12721 @end smallexample
12722
12723 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12724 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12725
12726 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12727 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12728 @set ARROW @click{}
12729 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12730 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12731 @end ifset
12732 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12733 @set ARROW ->
12734 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12735 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12736 @end ifclear
12737
12738 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12739 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12740 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12741
12742 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12743 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12744 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12745 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12746 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12747 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12748
12749 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12750 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12751 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12752 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12753 omitted.
12754
12755 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12756 entry may fail:
12757
12758 @smallexample
12759 int v;
12760 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12761 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12762 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12763 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12764 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12765 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12766
12767 (gdb) bt
12768 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12769 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12770 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12771 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12772 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12776 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12777 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12778 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12779 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12780
12781 @node Macros
12782 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12783
12784 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12785 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12786 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12787 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12788 where it was defined.
12789
12790 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12791 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12792 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12793 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12794
12795 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12796 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12797 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12798 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12799 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12800 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12801 see @ref{List}.
12802
12803 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12804 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12805 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12806
12807 @table @code
12808
12809 @kindex macro expand
12810 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12811 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12812 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12813 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12814 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12815 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12816 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12817 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12818 it can be any string of tokens.
12819
12820 @kindex macro exp1
12821 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12822 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12823 @cindex expand macro once
12824 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12825 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12826 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12827 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12828 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12829 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12830 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12831 can be any string of tokens.
12832
12833 @kindex info macro
12834 @cindex macro definition, showing
12835 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12836 @cindex macros, from debug info
12837 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12838 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12839 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12840 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12841 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12842 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12843
12844 @kindex info macros
12845 @item info macros @var{location}
12846 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12847 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12848 command-line where those definitions were established.
12849
12850 @kindex macro define
12851 @cindex user-defined macros
12852 @cindex defining macros interactively
12853 @cindex macros, user-defined
12854 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12855 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12856 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12857 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12858 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12859 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12860 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12861 @var{arglist}.
12862
12863 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12864 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12865 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12866 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12867 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12868
12869 @kindex macro undef
12870 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12871 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12872 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12873 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12874 in the program being debugged.
12875
12876 @kindex macro list
12877 @item macro list
12878 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12879 @end table
12880
12881 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12882 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12883 show our source files:
12884
12885 @smallexample
12886 $ cat sample.c
12887 #include <stdio.h>
12888 #include "sample.h"
12889
12890 #define M 42
12891 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12892
12893 main ()
12894 @{
12895 #define N 28
12896 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12897 #undef N
12898 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12899 #define N 1729
12900 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12901 @}
12902 $ cat sample.h
12903 #define Q <
12904 $
12905 @end smallexample
12906
12907 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12908 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12909 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12910 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12911 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12912 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12913 information.
12914
12915 @smallexample
12916 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12917 $
12918 @end smallexample
12919
12920 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12921
12922 @smallexample
12923 $ gdb -nw sample
12924 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12925 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12926 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12927 (@value{GDBP})
12928 @end smallexample
12929
12930 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12931 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12932 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12933
12934 @smallexample
12935 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12936 3
12937 4 #define M 42
12938 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12939 6
12940 7 main ()
12941 8 @{
12942 9 #define N 28
12943 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12944 11 #undef N
12945 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12946 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12947 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12948 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12949 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12950 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12951 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12952 #define Q <
12953 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12954 expands to: (42 + 1)
12955 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12956 expands to: once (M + 1)
12957 (@value{GDBP})
12958 @end smallexample
12959
12960 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12961 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12962 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12963 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12964
12965 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12966 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12967
12968 @smallexample
12969 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12970 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12971 (@value{GDBP}) run
12972 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12973
12974 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12975 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12976 (@value{GDBP})
12977 @end smallexample
12978
12979 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12980
12981 @smallexample
12982 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12983 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12984 #define N 28
12985 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12986 expands to: 28 < 42
12987 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12988 $1 = 1
12989 (@value{GDBP})
12990 @end smallexample
12991
12992 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12993 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12994 thereof) in force at each point:
12995
12996 @smallexample
12997 (@value{GDBP}) next
12998 Hello, world!
12999 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13000 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13001 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13002 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13003 (@value{GDBP}) next
13004 We're so creative.
13005 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13006 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13007 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13008 #define N 1729
13009 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13010 expands to: 1729 < 42
13011 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13012 $2 = 0
13013 (@value{GDBP})
13014 @end smallexample
13015
13016 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13017 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13018 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13019 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13020
13021 @smallexample
13022 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13023 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13024 -D__STDC__=1
13025 (@value{GDBP})
13026 @end smallexample
13027
13028
13029 @node Tracepoints
13030 @chapter Tracepoints
13031 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13032 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13033
13034 @cindex tracepoints
13035 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13036 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13037 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13038 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13039 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13040 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13041 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13042
13043 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13044 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13045 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13046 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13047 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13048 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13049 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13050 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13051 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13052 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13053 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13054
13055 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13056 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13057 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13058 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13059 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13060 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13061 Packets}.
13062
13063 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13064 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13065 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13066
13067 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13068
13069 @menu
13070 * Set Tracepoints::
13071 * Analyze Collected Data::
13072 * Tracepoint Variables::
13073 * Trace Files::
13074 @end menu
13075
13076 @node Set Tracepoints
13077 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13078
13079 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13080 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13081 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13082 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13083 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13084 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13085 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13086
13087 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13088 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13089 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13090 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13091 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13092 tracepoint was hit.
13093
13094 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13095 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13096 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13097 either.
13098
13099 @cindex fast tracepoints
13100 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13101 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13102 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13103
13104 @cindex static tracepoints
13105 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13106 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13107 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13108 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13109 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13110 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13111 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13112 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13113 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13114 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13115 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13116 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13117 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13118 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13119 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13120 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13121 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13122 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13123 static tracepoint marker.
13124
13125 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13126 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13127
13128 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13129 conditions and actions.
13130
13131 @menu
13132 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13133 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13134 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13135 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13136 * Trace State Variables::
13137 * Tracepoint Actions::
13138 * Listing Tracepoints::
13139 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13140 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13141 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13142 @end menu
13143
13144 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13145 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13146
13147 @table @code
13148 @cindex set tracepoint
13149 @kindex trace
13150 @item trace @var{location}
13151 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13152 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13153 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13154 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13155 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13156 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13157 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13158 in tracing}).
13159 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13160 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13161 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13162 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13163 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13164 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13165 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13166 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13167 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13168 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13169 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13170 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13171
13172 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13173
13174 @smallexample
13175 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13176
13177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13178
13179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13180
13181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13182
13183 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13184 @end smallexample
13185
13186 @noindent
13187 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13188
13189 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13190 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13191 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13192 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13193 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13194 information on tracepoint conditions.
13195
13196 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13197 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13198 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13199 @kindex ftrace
13200 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13201 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13202 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13203 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13204 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13205 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13206 message.
13207
13208 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13209 @code{trace}.
13210
13211 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13212 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13213 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13214 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13215 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13216 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13217 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13218 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13219
13220 @example
13221 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13222 @end example
13223
13224 @noindent
13225 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13226 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13227
13228 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13229 @cindex set static tracepoint
13230 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13231 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13232 @kindex strace
13233 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13234 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13235 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13236 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13237 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13238
13239 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13240 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13241 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13242 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13243 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13244 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13245 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13246 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13247 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13248 tracing engine:
13249
13250 @smallexample
13251 main ()
13252 @{
13253 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13254 @}
13255 @end smallexample
13256
13257 @noindent
13258 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13259 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13260
13261 @smallexample
13262 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13263 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13264 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13265 Data: "str %s"
13266 [etc...]
13267 @end smallexample
13268
13269 @noindent
13270 so you may probe the marker above with:
13271
13272 @smallexample
13273 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13274 @end smallexample
13275
13276 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13277 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13278 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13279 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13280 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13281 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13282 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13283 the @samp{Data:} field.
13284
13285 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13286 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13287 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13288
13289 @vindex $tpnum
13290 @cindex last tracepoint number
13291 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13292 @cindex tracepoint number
13293 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13294 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13295
13296 @kindex delete tracepoint
13297 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13298 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13299 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13300 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13301 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13302
13303 Examples:
13304
13305 @smallexample
13306 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13307
13308 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13309 @end smallexample
13310
13311 @noindent
13312 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13313 @end table
13314
13315 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13316 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13317
13318 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13319
13320 @table @code
13321 @kindex disable tracepoint
13322 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13323 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13324 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13325 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13326 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13327 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13328 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13329 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13330 next trace experiment.
13331
13332 @kindex enable tracepoint
13333 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13334 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13335 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13336 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13337 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13338 next time a trace experiment is run.
13339 @end table
13340
13341 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13342 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13343
13344 @table @code
13345 @kindex passcount
13346 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13347 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13348 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13349 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13350 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13351 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13352 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13353 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13354 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13355 user.
13356
13357 Examples:
13358
13359 @smallexample
13360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13361 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13362
13363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13364 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13368 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13370 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13371 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13372 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13373 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13374 @end smallexample
13375 @end table
13376
13377 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13378 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13379 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13380 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13381
13382 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13383 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13384 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13385 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13386 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13387 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13388 is true.
13389
13390 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13391 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13392 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13393 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13394 just as with breakpoints.
13395
13396 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13397 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13398 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13399 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13400 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13401 accesses, and so forth.
13402
13403 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13404 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13405 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13406 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13407 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13408 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13409 search through.
13410
13411 @smallexample
13412 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13413 @end smallexample
13414
13415 @node Trace State Variables
13416 @subsection Trace State Variables
13417 @cindex trace state variables
13418
13419 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13420 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13421 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13422 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13423 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13424 integers.
13425
13426 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13427 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13428 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13429 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13430
13431 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13432 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13433 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13434 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13435 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13436 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13437 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13438 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13439 variable with the same name.
13440
13441 @table @code
13442
13443 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13444 @kindex tvariable
13445 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13446 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13447 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13448 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13449 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13450 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13451 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13452 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13453 value. The default initial value is 0.
13454
13455 @item info tvariables
13456 @kindex info tvariables
13457 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13458 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13459 currently running.
13460
13461 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13462 @kindex delete tvariable
13463 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13464 are specified.
13465
13466 @end table
13467
13468 @node Tracepoint Actions
13469 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13470
13471 @table @code
13472 @kindex actions
13473 @cindex tracepoint actions
13474 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13475 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13476 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13477 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13478 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13479 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13480 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13481 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13482 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13483 @code{while-stepping}.
13484
13485 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13486 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13487 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13488
13489 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13490 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13491 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13492
13493 @smallexample
13494 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13495
13496 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13497
13498 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13499 @end smallexample
13500
13501 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13502 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13503 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13504 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13505 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13506 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13507 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13508 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13509
13510 @smallexample
13511 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13513 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13514 > collect bar,baz
13515 > collect $regs
13516 > while-stepping 12
13517 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13518 > end
13519 end
13520 @end smallexample
13521
13522 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13523 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13524 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13525 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13526 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13527 special arguments are supported:
13528
13529 @table @code
13530 @item $regs
13531 Collect all registers.
13532
13533 @item $args
13534 Collect all function arguments.
13535
13536 @item $locals
13537 Collect all local variables.
13538
13539 @item $_ret
13540 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13541 of a backtrace.
13542
13543 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13544 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13545 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13546 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13547 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13548 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13549
13550 @item $_probe_argc
13551 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13552 tracepoint is located.
13553 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13554
13555 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13556 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13557 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13558 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13559
13560 @item $_sdata
13561 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13562 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13563 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13564 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13565 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13566 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13567 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13568 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13569 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13570
13571 @smallexample
13572 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13573 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13574 @end smallexample
13575
13576 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13577 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13578 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13579 @value{GDBN}.
13580 @end table
13581
13582 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13583 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13584 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13585
13586 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13587 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13588 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13589 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13590 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13591 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13592 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13593 @samp{mystr}.
13594
13595 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13596 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13597
13598 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13599 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13600 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13601 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13602 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13603 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13604 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13605 action were used.
13606
13607 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13608 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13609 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13610 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13611 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13612 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13613
13614 @smallexample
13615 > while-stepping 12
13616 > collect $regs, myglobal
13617 > end
13618 >
13619 @end smallexample
13620
13621 @noindent
13622 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13623 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13624 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13625 @code{stepping}.
13626
13627 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13628 @kindex set default-collect
13629 @cindex default collection action
13630 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13631 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13632 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13633 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13634 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13635 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13636
13637 @item show default-collect
13638 @kindex show default-collect
13639 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13640 tracepoint hit.
13641
13642 @end table
13643
13644 @node Listing Tracepoints
13645 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13646
13647 @table @code
13648 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13649 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13650 @cindex information about tracepoints
13651 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13652 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13653 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13654 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13655 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13656 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13657
13658 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13659 tracing:
13660
13661 @itemize @bullet
13662 @item
13663 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13664
13665 @item
13666 the state about installed on target of each location
13667 @end itemize
13668
13669 @smallexample
13670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13671 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13672 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13673 while-stepping 20
13674 collect globfoo, $regs
13675 end
13676 collect globfoo2
13677 end
13678 pass count 1200
13679 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13680 collect $eip
13681 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13682 installed on target
13683 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13684 installed on target
13685 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13686 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13687 not installed on target
13688 (@value{GDBP})
13689 @end smallexample
13690
13691 @noindent
13692 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13693 @end table
13694
13695 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13696 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13697
13698 @table @code
13699 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13700 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13701 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13702 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13703 program.
13704
13705 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13706
13707 @table @emph
13708 @item Count
13709 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13710 stable identifier.
13711 @item ID
13712 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13713 @item Enabled or Disabled
13714 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13715 that are not enabled.
13716 @item Address
13717 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13718 @item What
13719 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13720 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13721 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13722 will be left blank.
13723 @end table
13724
13725 @noindent
13726 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13727
13728 @table @emph
13729 @item Data
13730 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13731 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13732 marker call.
13733 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13734 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13735 @end table
13736
13737 @smallexample
13738 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13739 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13740 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13741 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13742 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13743 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13744 Data: str %s
13745 (@value{GDBP})
13746 @end smallexample
13747 @end table
13748
13749 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13750 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13751
13752 @table @code
13753 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13754 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13755 @cindex collected data discarded
13756 @item tstart
13757 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13758 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13759 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13760 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13761 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13762 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13763 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13764 information, and so forth.
13765
13766 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13767 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13768 @item tstop
13769 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13770 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13771 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13772 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13773 needs to be stopped quickly.
13774
13775 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13776 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13777 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13778
13779 @kindex tstatus
13780 @cindex status of trace data collection
13781 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13782 @item tstatus
13783 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13784 collection.
13785 @end table
13786
13787 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13788
13789 @smallexample
13790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13792 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13793 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13794 > while-stepping 11
13795 > collect $regs
13796 > end
13797 > end
13798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13799 [time passes @dots{}]
13800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13801 @end smallexample
13802
13803 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13804 @cindex disconnected tracing
13805 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13806 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13807 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13808 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13809 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13810 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13811 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13812 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13813
13814 @table @code
13815 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13816 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13817 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13818 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13819 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13820 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13821 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13822 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13823
13824 @item show disconnected-tracing
13825 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13826 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13827
13828 @end table
13829
13830 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13831 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13832 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13833 it will continue after reconnection.
13834
13835 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13836 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13837 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13838 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13839 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13840 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13841 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13842 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13843 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13844 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13845
13846 @cindex circular trace buffer
13847 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13848 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13849 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13850 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13851 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13852 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13853 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13854 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13855 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13856 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13857 the next run.
13858
13859 @table @code
13860 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13861 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13862 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13863 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13864 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13865 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13866 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13867
13868 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13869 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13870 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13871 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13872 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13873 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13874
13875 @end table
13876
13877 @table @code
13878 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13879 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13880 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13881 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13882 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13883 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13884 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13885 likes. This is also the default.
13886
13887 @item show trace-buffer-size
13888 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13889 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13890 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13891 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13892 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13893 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13894 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13895 @end table
13896
13897 @table @code
13898 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13899 @kindex set trace-user
13900
13901 @item show trace-user
13902 @kindex show trace-user
13903
13904 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13905 @kindex set trace-notes
13906 Set the trace run's notes.
13907
13908 @item show trace-notes
13909 @kindex show trace-notes
13910 Show the trace run's notes.
13911
13912 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13913 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13914 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13915 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13916 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13917
13918 @item show trace-stop-notes
13919 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13920 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13921
13922 @end table
13923
13924 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13925 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13926
13927 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13928 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13929 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13930 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13931 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13932 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13933 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13934 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13935 mentioned here.
13936
13937 @itemize @bullet
13938
13939 @item
13940 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13941 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13942 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13943 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13944 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13945 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13946 cannot be collected either.
13947
13948 @item
13949 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13950 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13951 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13952 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13953 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13954 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13955 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13956 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13957 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13958 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13959
13960 @item
13961 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13962 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13963 in a misleading way.
13964
13965 @item
13966 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13967 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13968 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13969 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13970 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13971 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13972 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13973 by @code{ptr}.
13974
13975 @item
13976 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13977 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13978 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13979 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13980 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13981 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13982 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13983 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13984 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13985 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13986 invalid address.
13987
13988 @item
13989 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13990 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13991 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13992 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13993 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13994 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13995 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13996 it to zero.
13997
13998 @end itemize
13999
14000 @node Analyze Collected Data
14001 @section Using the Collected Data
14002
14003 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14004 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14005 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14006 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14007 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14008 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14009 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14010 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14011 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14012 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14013 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14014 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14015 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14016 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14017 the buffer will fail.
14018
14019 @menu
14020 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14021 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14022 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14023 @end menu
14024
14025 @node tfind
14026 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14027
14028 @kindex tfind
14029 @cindex select trace snapshot
14030 @cindex find trace snapshot
14031 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14032 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14033 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14034 snapshot is selected.
14035
14036 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14037
14038 @table @code
14039 @item tfind start
14040 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14041 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14042
14043 @item tfind none
14044 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14045
14046 @item tfind end
14047 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14048
14049 @item tfind
14050 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14051 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14052
14053 @item tfind -
14054 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14055 retracing earlier steps.
14056
14057 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14058 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14059 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14060 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14061 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14062
14063 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14064 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14065 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14066 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14067 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14068
14069 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14070 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14071 addresses (exclusive).
14072
14073 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14074 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14075 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14076
14077 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14078 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14079 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14080 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14081 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14082 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14083 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14084 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14085 @end table
14086
14087 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14088 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14089 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14090 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14091 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14092 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14093 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14094 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14095 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14096 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14097 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14098 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14099 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14100 tracepoint as the current one.
14101
14102 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14103 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14104 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14105 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14106 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14107
14108 @smallexample
14109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14110 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14111 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14112 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14113 > tfind
14114 > end
14115
14116 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14117 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14118 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14119 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14120 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14121 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14122 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14123 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14124 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14125 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14126 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14127 @end smallexample
14128
14129 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14130 the buffer:
14131
14132 @smallexample
14133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14134 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14135 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14136 > tfind line
14137 > end
14138
14139 Frame 0, X = 1
14140 Frame 7, X = 2
14141 Frame 13, X = 255
14142 @end smallexample
14143
14144 @node tdump
14145 @subsection @code{tdump}
14146 @kindex tdump
14147 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14148 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14149
14150 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14151 the current trace snapshot.
14152
14153 @smallexample
14154 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14156 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14157 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14158 > end
14159
14160 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14161
14162 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14163 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14164 at gdb_test.c:444
14165 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14166
14167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14168 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14169 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14170 d1 0x18 24
14171 d2 0x80 128
14172 d3 0x33 51
14173 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14174 d5 0x22 34
14175 d6 0xe0 224
14176 d7 0x380035 3670069
14177 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14178 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14179 a2 0x100 256
14180 a3 0x322000 3284992
14181 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14182 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14183 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14184 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14185 ps 0x0 0
14186 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14187 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14188 fpstatus 0x0 0
14189 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14190 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14191 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14192 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14193 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14194 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14195 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14196 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14197 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14198
14199 (@value{GDBP})
14200 @end smallexample
14201
14202 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14203 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14204 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14205 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14206
14207 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14208 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14209 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14210 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14211 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14212 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14213 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14214 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14215 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14216 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14217
14218 @node save tracepoints
14219 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14220 @kindex save tracepoints
14221 @kindex save-tracepoints
14222 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14223
14224 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14225 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14226 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14227 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14228 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14229 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14230
14231 @node Tracepoint Variables
14232 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14233 @cindex tracepoint variables
14234 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14235
14236 @table @code
14237 @vindex $trace_frame
14238 @item (int) $trace_frame
14239 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14240 snapshot is selected.
14241
14242 @vindex $tracepoint
14243 @item (int) $tracepoint
14244 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14245
14246 @vindex $trace_line
14247 @item (int) $trace_line
14248 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14249
14250 @vindex $trace_file
14251 @item (char []) $trace_file
14252 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14253
14254 @vindex $trace_func
14255 @item (char []) $trace_func
14256 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14257 @end table
14258
14259 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14260 use @code{output} instead.
14261
14262 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14263 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14264 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14265 which are managed by the target.
14266
14267 @smallexample
14268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14269
14270 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14271 > output $trace_file
14272 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14273 > tfind
14274 > end
14275 @end smallexample
14276
14277 @node Trace Files
14278 @section Using Trace Files
14279 @cindex trace files
14280
14281 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14282 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14283 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14284 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14285 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14286
14287 @table @code
14288
14289 @kindex tsave
14290 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14291 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14292 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14293 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14294 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14295 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14296 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14297 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14298 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14299 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14300 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14301 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14302 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14303 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14304 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14305
14306 @kindex target tfile
14307 @kindex tfile
14308 @kindex target ctf
14309 @kindex ctf
14310 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14311 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14312 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14313 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14314 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14315 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14316 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14317 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14318 the host.
14319
14320 @smallexample
14321 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14322 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14323 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14324 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14325 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14326 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14327 i = 0
14328 a = 0
14329 b = 1 '\001'
14330 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14331 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14332 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14333 $1 = 1
14334 @end smallexample
14335
14336 @end table
14337
14338 @node Overlays
14339 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14340 @cindex overlays
14341
14342 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14343 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14344 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14345 use overlays.
14346
14347 @menu
14348 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14349 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14350 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14351 mapped by asking the inferior.
14352 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14353 @end menu
14354
14355 @node How Overlays Work
14356 @section How Overlays Work
14357 @cindex mapped overlays
14358 @cindex unmapped overlays
14359 @cindex load address, overlay's
14360 @cindex mapped address
14361 @cindex overlay area
14362
14363 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14364 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14365 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14366 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14367 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14368
14369 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14370 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14371 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14372 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14373 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14374 largest overlay as well.
14375
14376 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14377 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14378 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14379 there.
14380
14381 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14382 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14383 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14384
14385 @smallexample
14386 @group
14387 Data Instruction Larger
14388 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14389 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14390 | | | | | |
14391 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14392 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14393 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14394 | and heap | | | | | |
14395 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14396 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14397 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14398 | | | | | |
14399 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14400 address | | | | | |
14401 | overlay | <-' | | |
14402 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14403 | | <---. | | load address
14404 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14405 | | | |
14406 +-----------+ | |
14407 +-----------+
14408 | |
14409 +-----------+
14410
14411 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14412 @end group
14413 @end smallexample
14414
14415 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14416 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14417 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14418 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14419 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14420 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14421 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14422 program and the overlay area.
14423
14424 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14425 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14426 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14427 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14428 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14429 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14430 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14431
14432 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14433 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14434 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14435
14436 @itemize @bullet
14437
14438 @item
14439 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14440 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14441 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14442 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14443
14444 @item
14445 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14446 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14447 your program's performance.
14448
14449 @item
14450 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14451 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14452 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14453 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14454 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14455 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14456 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14457
14458 @item
14459 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14460 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14461 instruction and data spaces.
14462
14463 @end itemize
14464
14465 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14466 improved in many ways:
14467
14468 @itemize @bullet
14469
14470 @item
14471 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14472 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14473 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14474 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14475 area in the usual way.
14476
14477 @item
14478 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14479 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14480
14481 @item
14482 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14483 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14484 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14485 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14486 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14487 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14488 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14489
14490 @end itemize
14491
14492
14493 @node Overlay Commands
14494 @section Overlay Commands
14495
14496 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14497 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14498 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14499 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14500 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14501 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14502
14503 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14504 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14505
14506 @table @code
14507 @item overlay off
14508 @kindex overlay
14509 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14510 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14511 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14512 overlay support is disabled.
14513
14514 @item overlay manual
14515 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14516 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14517 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14518 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14519 commands described below.
14520
14521 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14522 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14523 @cindex map an overlay
14524 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14525 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14526 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14527 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14528 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14529 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14530
14531 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14532 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14533 @cindex unmap an overlay
14534 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14535 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14536 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14537 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14538
14539 @item overlay auto
14540 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14541 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14542 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14543 Overlay Debugging}.
14544
14545 @item overlay load-target
14546 @itemx overlay load
14547 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14548 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14549 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14550 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14551 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14552 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14553
14554 @item overlay list-overlays
14555 @itemx overlay list
14556 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14557 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14558 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14559
14560 @end table
14561
14562 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14563 of the function the address falls in:
14564
14565 @smallexample
14566 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14567 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14568 @end smallexample
14569 @noindent
14570 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14571 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14572 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14573 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14574
14575 @smallexample
14576 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14577 No sections are mapped.
14578 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14579 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14580 @end smallexample
14581 @noindent
14582 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14583 name normally:
14584
14585 @smallexample
14586 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14587 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14588 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14589 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14590 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14591 @end smallexample
14592
14593 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14594 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14595 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14596 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14597 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14598
14599 @itemize @bullet
14600 @item
14601 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14602 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14603 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14604 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14605 @item
14606 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14607 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14608 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14609 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14610 breakpoints properly.
14611 @end itemize
14612
14613
14614 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14615 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14616 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14617
14618 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14619 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14620 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14621 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14622 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14623 current state of the overlays.
14624
14625 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14626 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14627
14628 @table @asis
14629
14630 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14631 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14632
14633 @smallexample
14634 struct
14635 @{
14636 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14637 unsigned long vma;
14638
14639 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14640 unsigned long size;
14641
14642 /* The overlay's load address. */
14643 unsigned long lma;
14644
14645 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14646 zero otherwise. */
14647 unsigned long mapped;
14648 @}
14649 @end smallexample
14650
14651 @item @code{_novlys}:
14652 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14653 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14654
14655 @end table
14656
14657 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14658 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14659 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14660 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14661 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14662 currently mapped.
14663
14664 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14665 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14666 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14667 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14668 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14669 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14670 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14671 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14672 are not being executed.
14673
14674 @node Overlay Sample Program
14675 @section Overlay Sample Program
14676 @cindex overlay example program
14677
14678 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14679 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14680 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14681 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14682 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14683 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14684 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14685
14686 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14687 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14688 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14689 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14690
14691 @table @file
14692 @item overlays.c
14693 The main program file.
14694 @item ovlymgr.c
14695 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14696 @item foo.c
14697 @itemx bar.c
14698 @itemx baz.c
14699 @itemx grbx.c
14700 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14701 @item d10v.ld
14702 @itemx m32r.ld
14703 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14704 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14705 @end table
14706
14707 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14708 cross-compiler like this:
14709
14710 @smallexample
14711 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14712 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14713 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14714 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14715 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14716 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14717 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14718 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14719 @end smallexample
14720
14721 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14722 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14723 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14724
14725
14726 @node Languages
14727 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14728 @cindex languages
14729
14730 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14731 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14732 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14733 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14734 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14735 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14736
14737 @cindex working language
14738 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14739 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14740 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14741 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14742 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14743 language}.
14744
14745 @menu
14746 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14747 * Show:: Displaying the language
14748 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14749 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14750 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14751 @end menu
14752
14753 @node Setting
14754 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14755
14756 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14757 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14758 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14759 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14760 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14761 are printed, etc.
14762
14763 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14764 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14765 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14766 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14767 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14768 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14769 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14770 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14771 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14772 Displaying the Language}.
14773
14774 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14775 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14776 another language. In that case, make the
14777 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14778 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14779 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14780
14781 @menu
14782 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14783 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14784 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14785 @end menu
14786
14787 @node Filenames
14788 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14789
14790 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14791 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14792
14793 @table @file
14794 @item .ada
14795 @itemx .ads
14796 @itemx .adb
14797 @itemx .a
14798 Ada source file.
14799
14800 @item .c
14801 C source file
14802
14803 @item .C
14804 @itemx .cc
14805 @itemx .cp
14806 @itemx .cpp
14807 @itemx .cxx
14808 @itemx .c++
14809 C@t{++} source file
14810
14811 @item .d
14812 D source file
14813
14814 @item .m
14815 Objective-C source file
14816
14817 @item .f
14818 @itemx .F
14819 Fortran source file
14820
14821 @item .mod
14822 Modula-2 source file
14823
14824 @item .s
14825 @itemx .S
14826 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14827 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14828 @end table
14829
14830 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14831 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14832
14833 @node Manually
14834 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14835
14836 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14837 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14838 your program.
14839
14840 @kindex set language
14841 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14842 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14843 a language, such as
14844 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14845 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14846
14847 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14848 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14849 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14850 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14851 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14852 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14853 command such as:
14854
14855 @smallexample
14856 print a = b + c
14857 @end smallexample
14858
14859 @noindent
14860 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14861 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14862 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14863 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14864
14865 @node Automatically
14866 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14867
14868 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14869 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14870 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14871 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14872 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14873 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14874 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14875 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14876 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14877
14878 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14879 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14880 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14881 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14882 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14883
14884 @node Show
14885 @section Displaying the Language
14886
14887 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14888 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14889
14890 @table @code
14891 @item show language
14892 @anchor{show language}
14893 @kindex show language
14894 Display the current working language. This is the
14895 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14896 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14897
14898 @item info frame
14899 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14900 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14901 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14902 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14903 information listed here.
14904
14905 @item info source
14906 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14907 Display the source language of this source file.
14908 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14909 information listed here.
14910 @end table
14911
14912 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14913 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14914 with a language explicitly:
14915
14916 @table @code
14917 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14918 @kindex set extension-language
14919 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14920 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14921
14922 @item info extensions
14923 @kindex info extensions
14924 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14925 @end table
14926
14927 @node Checks
14928 @section Type and Range Checking
14929
14930 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14931 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14932 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14933 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14934 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14935 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14936 errors when your program is running.
14937
14938 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14939 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14940 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14941 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14942
14943 @menu
14944 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14945 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14946 @end menu
14947
14948 @cindex type checking
14949 @cindex checks, type
14950 @node Type Checking
14951 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14952
14953 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14954 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14955 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14956 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14957
14958 @smallexample
14959 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14960
14961 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14962 $1 = 2
14963 @exdent but
14964 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14965 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14969 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14970
14971 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14972 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14973 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14974 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14975 expressions like the second example above.
14976
14977 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14978 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14979 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14980 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14981 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14982 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14983
14984 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14985
14986 @kindex set check type
14987 @kindex show check type
14988 @table @code
14989 @item set check type on
14990 @itemx set check type off
14991 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14992 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14993 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14994
14995 @item show check type
14996 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14997 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14998 @end table
14999
15000 @cindex range checking
15001 @cindex checks, range
15002 @node Range Checking
15003 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15004
15005 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15006 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15007 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15008 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15009 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15010
15011 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15012 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15013 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15014 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15015
15016 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15017 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15018 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15019 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15020 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15021 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15022
15023 @smallexample
15024 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15025 @end smallexample
15026
15027 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15028 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15029 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15030
15031 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15032
15033 @kindex set check range
15034 @kindex show check range
15035 @table @code
15036 @item set check range auto
15037 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15038 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15039 each language.
15040
15041 @item set check range on
15042 @itemx set check range off
15043 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15044 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15045 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15046 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15047
15048 @item set check range warn
15049 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15050 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15051 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15052 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15053 systems).
15054
15055 @item show range
15056 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15057 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15058 @end table
15059
15060 @node Supported Languages
15061 @section Supported Languages
15062
15063 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15064 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15065 @c This is false ...
15066 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15067 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15068 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15069 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15070 language.
15071
15072 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15073 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15074 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15075 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15076 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15077 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15078 language reference or tutorial.
15079
15080 @menu
15081 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15082 * D:: D
15083 * Go:: Go
15084 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15085 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15086 * Fortran:: Fortran
15087 * Pascal:: Pascal
15088 * Rust:: Rust
15089 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15090 * Ada:: Ada
15091 @end menu
15092
15093 @node C
15094 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15095
15096 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15097 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15098
15099 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15100 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15101 together.
15102
15103 @cindex C@t{++}
15104 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15105 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15106 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15107 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15108 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15109 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15110 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15111
15112 @menu
15113 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15114 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15115 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15116 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15117 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15118 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15119 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15120 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15121 @end menu
15122
15123 @node C Operators
15124 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15125
15126 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15127
15128 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15129 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15130 often defined on groups of types.
15131
15132 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15133
15134 @itemize @bullet
15135
15136 @item
15137 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15138 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15139
15140 @item
15141 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15142 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15143
15144 @item
15145 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15146
15147 @item
15148 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15149
15150 @end itemize
15151
15152 @noindent
15153 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15154 in order of increasing precedence:
15155
15156 @table @code
15157 @item ,
15158 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15159 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15160 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15161
15162 @item =
15163 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15164 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15165
15166 @item @var{op}=
15167 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15168 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15169 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15170 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15171 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15172
15173 @item ?:
15174 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15175 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15176 should be of an integral type.
15177
15178 @item ||
15179 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15180
15181 @item &&
15182 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15183
15184 @item |
15185 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15186
15187 @item ^
15188 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15189
15190 @item &
15191 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15192
15193 @item ==@r{, }!=
15194 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15195 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15196
15197 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15198 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15199 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15200 and non-zero for true.
15201
15202 @item <<@r{, }>>
15203 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15204
15205 @item @@
15206 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15207
15208 @item +@r{, }-
15209 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15210 pointer types.
15211
15212 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15213 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15214 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15215 integral types.
15216
15217 @item ++@r{, }--
15218 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15219 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15220 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15221 operation takes place.
15222
15223 @item *
15224 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15225 @code{++}.
15226
15227 @item &
15228 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15229
15230 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15231 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15232 to examine the address
15233 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15234 stored.
15235
15236 @item -
15237 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15238 precedence as @code{++}.
15239
15240 @item !
15241 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15242 @code{++}.
15243
15244 @item ~
15245 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15246 @code{++}.
15247
15248
15249 @item .@r{, }->
15250 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15251 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15252 pointer based on the stored type information.
15253 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15254
15255 @item .*@r{, }->*
15256 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15257
15258 @item []
15259 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15260 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15261
15262 @item ()
15263 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15264
15265 @item ::
15266 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15267 and @code{class} types.
15268
15269 @item ::
15270 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15271 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15272 above.
15273 @end table
15274
15275 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15276 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15277 predefined meaning.
15278
15279 @node C Constants
15280 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15281
15282 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15283
15284 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15285 following ways:
15286
15287 @itemize @bullet
15288 @item
15289 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15290 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15291 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15292 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15293 @code{long} value.
15294
15295 @item
15296 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15297 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15298 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15299 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15300 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15301 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15302 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15303 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15304 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15305 constant.
15306
15307 @item
15308 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15309 integral equivalents.
15310
15311 @item
15312 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15313 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15314 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15315 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15316 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15317 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15318 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15319 @samp{\n} for newline.
15320
15321 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15322 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15323 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15324 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15325
15326 @item
15327 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15328 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15329 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15330 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15331 characters.
15332
15333 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15334 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15335 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15336
15337 @item
15338 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15339 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15340
15341 @item
15342 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15343 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15344 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15345 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15346 @end itemize
15347
15348 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15349 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15350
15351 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15352 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15353
15354 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15355 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15356 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15357 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15358 @quotation
15359 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15360 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15361 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15362 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15363 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15364 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15365 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15366 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15367 @end quotation
15368
15369 @enumerate
15370
15371 @cindex member functions
15372 @item
15373 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15374
15375 @smallexample
15376 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15377 @end smallexample
15378
15379 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15380 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15381 @item
15382 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15383 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15384 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15385 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15386 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15387
15388 @cindex call overloaded functions
15389 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15390 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15391 @item
15392 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15393 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15394 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15395 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15396 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15397 default arguments.
15398
15399 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15400 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15401 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15402 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15403 number of function arguments.
15404
15405 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15406 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15407 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15408
15409 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15410 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15411 @smallexample
15412 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15413 @end smallexample
15414
15415 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15416 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15417
15418 @cindex reference declarations
15419 @item
15420 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15421 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15422 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15423
15424 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15425 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15426 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15427 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15428 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15429
15430 @item
15431 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15432 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15433 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15434 necessary, for example in an expression like
15435 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15436 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15437 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15438
15439 @item
15440 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15441 specification.
15442 @end enumerate
15443
15444 @node C Defaults
15445 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15446
15447 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15448
15449 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15450 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15451 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15452 selects the working language.
15453
15454 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15455 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15456 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15457 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15458 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15459 for further details.
15460
15461 @node C Checks
15462 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15463
15464 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15465
15466 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15467 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15468 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15469 constants to pointers.
15470
15471 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15472 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15473 that is not itself an array.
15474
15475 @node Debugging C
15476 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15477
15478 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15479 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15480 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15481 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15482
15483 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15484 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15485 ,Expressions}.
15486
15487 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15488 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15489
15490 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15491
15492 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15493 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15494
15495 @table @code
15496 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15497 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15498 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15499 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15500 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15501 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15502
15503 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15504 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15505 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15506 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15507 classes.
15508 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15509
15510 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15511 @item catch throw
15512 @itemx catch rethrow
15513 @itemx catch catch
15514 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15515 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15516
15517 @cindex inheritance
15518 @item ptype @var{typename}
15519 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15520 @var{typename}.
15521 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15522
15523 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15524 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15525 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15526 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15527 multiple inheritance is in use.
15528
15529 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15530 @item demangle @var{name}
15531 Demangle @var{name}.
15532 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15533
15534 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15535 @item set print demangle
15536 @itemx show print demangle
15537 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15538 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15539 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15540 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15541 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15542
15543 @item set print object
15544 @itemx show print object
15545 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15546 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15547
15548 @item set print vtbl
15549 @itemx show print vtbl
15550 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15551 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15552 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15553 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15554
15555 @kindex set overload-resolution
15556 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15557 @item set overload-resolution on
15558 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15559 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15560 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15561 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15562 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15563 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15564
15565 @item set overload-resolution off
15566 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15567 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15568 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15569 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15570 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15571 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15572 argument types.
15573
15574 @kindex show overload-resolution
15575 @item show overload-resolution
15576 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15577
15578 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15579 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15580 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15581 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15582 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15583 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15584 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15585
15586 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15587
15588 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15589 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15590 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15591 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15592 for more detail.
15593
15594 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15595 function that returns a std::string:
15596
15597 @smallexample
15598 std::string function(int);
15599 @end smallexample
15600
15601 @noindent
15602 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15603 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15604
15605 @smallexample
15606 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15607 @end smallexample
15608
15609 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15610 tag. For example:
15611
15612 @smallexample
15613 (gdb) b function(int)
15614 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15615 (gdb) info breakpoints
15616 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15617 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15618 at main.cc:10
15619 @end smallexample
15620
15621 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15622 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15623 name, like:
15624
15625 @smallexample
15626 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15627 @end smallexample
15628 @end table
15629
15630 @node Decimal Floating Point
15631 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15632 @cindex decimal floating point format
15633
15634 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15635 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15636 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15637 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15638
15639 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15640 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15641 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15642 configured target.
15643
15644 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15645 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15646 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15647
15648 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15649 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15650 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15651
15652 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15653 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15654 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15655
15656 @node D
15657 @subsection D
15658
15659 @cindex D
15660 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15661 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15662 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15663
15664 @node Go
15665 @subsection Go
15666
15667 @cindex Go (programming language)
15668 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15669 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15670
15671 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15672
15673 @table @code
15674 @cindex current Go package
15675 @item The current Go package
15676 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15677 specifying global variables and functions.
15678
15679 For example, given the program:
15680
15681 @example
15682 package main
15683 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15684 func main () @{
15685 // ...
15686 @}
15687 @end example
15688
15689 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15690
15691 @example
15692 (gdb) p myglob
15693 (gdb) p main.myglob
15694 @end example
15695
15696 @cindex builtin Go types
15697 @item Builtin Go types
15698 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15699 as a string.
15700
15701 @cindex builtin Go functions
15702 @item Builtin Go functions
15703 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15704 function and handles it internally.
15705
15706 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15707 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15708 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15709 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15710 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15711 @end table
15712
15713 @node Objective-C
15714 @subsection Objective-C
15715
15716 @cindex Objective-C
15717 This section provides information about some commands and command
15718 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15719 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15720 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15721
15722 @menu
15723 * Method Names in Commands::
15724 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15725 @end menu
15726
15727 @node Method Names in Commands
15728 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15729
15730 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15731 names as line specifications:
15732
15733 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15734 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15735 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15736 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15737 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15738 @itemize
15739 @item @code{clear}
15740 @item @code{break}
15741 @item @code{info line}
15742 @item @code{jump}
15743 @item @code{list}
15744 @end itemize
15745
15746 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15747
15748 @smallexample
15749 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15750 @end smallexample
15751
15752 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15753 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15754 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15755 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15756 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15757 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15758 debugged, enter:
15759
15760 @smallexample
15761 break -[Fruit create]
15762 @end smallexample
15763
15764 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15765 enter:
15766
15767 @smallexample
15768 list +[NSText initialize]
15769 @end smallexample
15770
15771 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15772 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15773 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15774 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15775
15776 @smallexample
15777 break create
15778 @end smallexample
15779
15780 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15781 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15782 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15783 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15784 none apply.
15785
15786 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15787 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15788
15789 @smallexample
15790 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15791 @end smallexample
15792
15793 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15794 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15795 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15796 @kindex print-object
15797 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15798
15799 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15800
15801 @smallexample
15802 print -[@var{object} hash]
15803 @end smallexample
15804
15805 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15806 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15807 @noindent
15808 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15809 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15810 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15811 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15812 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15813 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15814
15815 @node OpenCL C
15816 @subsection OpenCL C
15817
15818 @cindex OpenCL C
15819 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15820
15821 @menu
15822 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15823 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15824 * OpenCL C Operators::
15825 @end menu
15826
15827 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15828 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15829
15830 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15831 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15832 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15833 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15834 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15835
15836 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15837 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15838
15839 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15840 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15841 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15842 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15843
15844 @node OpenCL C Operators
15845 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15846
15847 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15848 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15849 vector data types.
15850
15851 @node Fortran
15852 @subsection Fortran
15853 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15854
15855 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15856 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15857
15858 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15859 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15860 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15861 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15862 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15863 underscore.
15864
15865 @menu
15866 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15867 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15868 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15869 @end menu
15870
15871 @node Fortran Operators
15872 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15873
15874 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15875
15876 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15877 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15878 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15879
15880 @table @code
15881 @item **
15882 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15883 of the second one.
15884
15885 @item :
15886 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15887 represent a section of array.
15888
15889 @item %
15890 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15891 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15892 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15893 union type.
15894 @end table
15895
15896 @node Fortran Defaults
15897 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15898
15899 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15900
15901 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15902 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15903 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15904 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15905
15906 @node Special Fortran Commands
15907 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15908
15909 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15910
15911 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15912 such as displaying common blocks.
15913
15914 @table @code
15915 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15916 @kindex info common
15917 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15918 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15919 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15920 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15921 printed.
15922 @end table
15923
15924 @node Pascal
15925 @subsection Pascal
15926
15927 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15928 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15929 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15930 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15931 syntax.
15932
15933 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15934 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15935 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15936
15937 @node Rust
15938 @subsection Rust
15939
15940 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15941 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15942 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15943 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15944
15945 @itemize @bullet
15946 @item
15947 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15948 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15949 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15950
15951 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15952 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15953 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15954 @samp{B}.
15955
15956 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15957 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15958
15959 @item
15960 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15961 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15962 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15963 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15964 @samp{K::x::y}.
15965
15966 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15967 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15968 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15969 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15970 scope.
15971
15972 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15973 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15974
15975 @item
15976 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15977 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15978
15979 @item
15980 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15981
15982 @item
15983 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15984 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15985 never be destroyed.
15986
15987 @item
15988 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15989 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15990 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15991
15992 @item
15993 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15994 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15995 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15996 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15997 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15998 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15999 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
16000 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16001
16002 @item
16003 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16004 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16005 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16006 @itemize @bullet
16007
16008 @item
16009 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16010
16011 @item
16012 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16013
16014 @item
16015 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16016 type names.
16017
16018 @item
16019 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16020
16021 @item
16022 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16023 available in the crate.
16024 @end itemize
16025 @end itemize
16026
16027 @node Modula-2
16028 @subsection Modula-2
16029
16030 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16031
16032 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16033 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16034 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16035 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16036 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16037 table.
16038
16039 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16040 @menu
16041 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16042 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16043 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16044 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16045 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16046 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16047 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16048 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16049 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16050 @end menu
16051
16052 @node M2 Operators
16053 @subsubsection Operators
16054 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16055
16056 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16057 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16058 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16059 following definitions hold:
16060
16061 @itemize @bullet
16062
16063 @item
16064 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16065 their subranges.
16066
16067 @item
16068 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16069
16070 @item
16071 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16072
16073 @item
16074 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16075 @var{type}}.
16076
16077 @item
16078 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16079
16080 @item
16081 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16082
16083 @item
16084 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16085 @end itemize
16086
16087 @noindent
16088 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16089 increasing precedence:
16090
16091 @table @code
16092 @item ,
16093 Function argument or array index separator.
16094
16095 @item :=
16096 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16097 @var{value}.
16098
16099 @item <@r{, }>
16100 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16101 types.
16102
16103 @item <=@r{, }>=
16104 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16105 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16106 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16107
16108 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16109 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16110 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16111 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16112 comment character.
16113
16114 @item IN
16115 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16116 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16117
16118 @item OR
16119 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16120
16121 @item AND@r{, }&
16122 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16123
16124 @item @@
16125 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16126
16127 @item +@r{, }-
16128 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16129 and difference on set types.
16130
16131 @item *
16132 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16133 on set types.
16134
16135 @item /
16136 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16137 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16138
16139 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16140 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16141 precedence as @code{*}.
16142
16143 @item -
16144 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16145
16146 @item ^
16147 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16148
16149 @item NOT
16150 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16151 @code{^}.
16152
16153 @item .
16154 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16155 precedence as @code{^}.
16156
16157 @item []
16158 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16159
16160 @item ()
16161 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16162 as @code{^}.
16163
16164 @item ::@r{, }.
16165 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16166 @end table
16167
16168 @quotation
16169 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16170 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16171 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16172 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16173 @end quotation
16174
16175
16176 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16177 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16178 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16179
16180 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16181 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16182
16183 @table @var
16184
16185 @item a
16186 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16187
16188 @item c
16189 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16190
16191 @item i
16192 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16193
16194 @item m
16195 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16196 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16197 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16198
16199 @item n
16200 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16201
16202 @item r
16203 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16204
16205 @item t
16206 represents a type.
16207
16208 @item v
16209 represents a variable.
16210
16211 @item x
16212 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16213 explanation of the function for details.
16214 @end table
16215
16216 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16217
16218 @table @code
16219 @item ABS(@var{n})
16220 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16221
16222 @item CAP(@var{c})
16223 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16224 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16225
16226 @item CHR(@var{i})
16227 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16228
16229 @item DEC(@var{v})
16230 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16231
16232 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16233 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16234 new value.
16235
16236 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16237 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16238 set.
16239
16240 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16241 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16242
16243 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16244 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16245
16246 @item INC(@var{v})
16247 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16248
16249 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16250 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16251 new value.
16252
16253 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16254 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16255 there. Returns the new set.
16256
16257 @item MAX(@var{t})
16258 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16259
16260 @item MIN(@var{t})
16261 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16262
16263 @item ODD(@var{i})
16264 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16265
16266 @item ORD(@var{x})
16267 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16268 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16269 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16270 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16271
16272 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16273 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16274 variable or a type.
16275
16276 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16277 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16278
16279 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16280 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16281 variable or a type.
16282
16283 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16284 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16285 @end table
16286
16287 @quotation
16288 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16289 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16290 an error.
16291 @end quotation
16292
16293 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16294 @node M2 Constants
16295 @subsubsection Constants
16296
16297 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16298 ways:
16299
16300 @itemize @bullet
16301
16302 @item
16303 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16304 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16305 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16306 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16307
16308 @item
16309 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16310 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16311 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16312 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16313 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16314 digits.
16315
16316 @item
16317 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16318 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16319 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16320 followed by a @samp{C}.
16321
16322 @item
16323 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16324 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16325 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16326 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16327 sequences.
16328
16329 @item
16330 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16331
16332 @item
16333 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16334 @code{FALSE}.
16335
16336 @item
16337 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16338
16339 @item
16340 Set constants are not yet supported.
16341 @end itemize
16342
16343 @node M2 Types
16344 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16345 @cindex Modula-2 types
16346
16347 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16348 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16349 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16350 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16351 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16352 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16353
16354 The first example contains the following section of code:
16355
16356 @smallexample
16357 VAR
16358 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16359 r: [20..40] ;
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 @noindent
16363 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16364 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16368 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16369 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16370 SET OF CHAR
16371 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16372 21
16373 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16374 [20..40]
16375 @end smallexample
16376
16377 @noindent
16378 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16379
16380 @smallexample
16381 VAR
16382 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16383 @end smallexample
16384
16385 @noindent
16386 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16387
16388 @smallexample
16389 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16390 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16391 @end smallexample
16392
16393 @noindent
16394 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16395 expressions using the debugger.
16396
16397 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16398 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16399
16400 @smallexample
16401 VAR
16402 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16403 @end smallexample
16404
16405 @smallexample
16406 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16407 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16408 @end smallexample
16409
16410 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16411 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16412 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16413 above.
16414
16415 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16416
16417 @smallexample
16418 TYPE
16419 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16420 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16421 VAR
16422 s: t ;
16423 BEGIN
16424 s := blue ;
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 @noindent
16428 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16429 and value of a variable.
16430
16431 @smallexample
16432 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16433 $1 = blue
16434 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16435 type = [blue..yellow]
16436 @end smallexample
16437
16438 @noindent
16439 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16440 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16441 their @code{C} counterparts.
16442
16443 @smallexample
16444 VAR
16445 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16446 BEGIN
16447 s[1] := 1 ;
16448 @end smallexample
16449
16450 @smallexample
16451 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16452 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16453 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16454 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16458 pointer types as shown in this example:
16459
16460 @smallexample
16461 VAR
16462 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16463 BEGIN
16464 NEW(s) ;
16465 s^[1] := 1 ;
16466 @end smallexample
16467
16468 @noindent
16469 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16473 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16474 @end smallexample
16475
16476 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16477 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16478 types:
16479
16480 @smallexample
16481 TYPE
16482 foo = RECORD
16483 f1: CARDINAL ;
16484 f2: CHAR ;
16485 f3: myarray ;
16486 END ;
16487
16488 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16489 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16490 VAR
16491 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 @noindent
16495 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16496 below.
16497
16498 @smallexample
16499 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16500 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16501 f1 : CARDINAL;
16502 f2 : CHAR;
16503 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16504 END
16505 @end smallexample
16506
16507 @node M2 Defaults
16508 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16509 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16510
16511 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16512 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16513 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16514 selected the working language.
16515
16516 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16517 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16518 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16519 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16520
16521 @node Deviations
16522 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16523 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16524
16525 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16526 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16527
16528 @itemize @bullet
16529 @item
16530 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16531 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16532 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16533 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16534 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16535 returned a pointer.)
16536
16537 @item
16538 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16539 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16540 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16541 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16542
16543 @item
16544 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16545 argument.
16546
16547 @item
16548 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16549 @end itemize
16550
16551 @node M2 Checks
16552 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16553 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16554
16555 @quotation
16556 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16557 range checking.
16558 @end quotation
16559 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16560
16561 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16562
16563 @itemize @bullet
16564 @item
16565 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16566 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16567
16568 @item
16569 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16570 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16571 @end itemize
16572
16573 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16574 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16575
16576 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16577 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16578
16579 @node M2 Scope
16580 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16581 @cindex scope
16582 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16583 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16584 @ifinfo
16585 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16586 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16587 @end ifinfo
16588 @ifnotinfo
16589 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16590 @end ifnotinfo
16591
16592 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16593 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16594 similar syntax:
16595
16596 @smallexample
16597
16598 @var{module} . @var{id}
16599 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16600 @end smallexample
16601
16602 @noindent
16603 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16604 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16605 identifier within your program, except another module.
16606
16607 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16608 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16609 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16610 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16611
16612 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16613 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16614 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16615 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16616 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16617 @var{module}.
16618
16619 @node GDB/M2
16620 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16621
16622 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16623 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16624 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16625 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16626 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16627 analogue in Modula-2.
16628
16629 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16630 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16631 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16632 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16633 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16634 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16635
16636 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16637 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16638 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16639
16640 @node Ada
16641 @subsection Ada
16642 @cindex Ada
16643
16644 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16645 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16646 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16647 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16648 to be difficult.
16649
16650
16651 @cindex expressions in Ada
16652 @menu
16653 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16654 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16655 in @value{GDBN}.
16656 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16657 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16658 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16659 subprograms.
16660 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16661 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16662 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16663 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16664 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16665 Profile
16666 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16667 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16668 @end menu
16669
16670 @node Ada Mode Intro
16671 @subsubsection Introduction
16672 @cindex Ada mode, general
16673
16674 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16675 syntax, with some extensions.
16676 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16677
16678 @itemize @bullet
16679 @item
16680 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16681 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16682 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16683 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16684
16685 @item
16686 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16687 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16688
16689 @item
16690 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16691 @end itemize
16692
16693 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16694 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16695 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16696 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16697 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16698
16699 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16700 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16701 was translated from an Ada source file.
16702
16703 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16704 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16705 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16706 middle (to allow based literals).
16707
16708 @node Omissions from Ada
16709 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16710 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16711
16712 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16713
16714 @itemize @bullet
16715 @item
16716 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16717
16718 @itemize @minus
16719 @item
16720 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16721 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16722
16723 @item
16724 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16725
16726 @item
16727 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16728
16729 @item
16730 @t{'Tag}.
16731
16732 @item
16733 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16734 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16735
16736 @item
16737 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16738 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16739
16740 @item
16741 @t{'Address}.
16742 @end itemize
16743
16744 @item
16745 The names in
16746 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16747 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16748 not currently available.
16749
16750 @item
16751 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16752 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16753 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16754 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16755 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16756 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16757 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16758 indeterminate values.
16759
16760 @item
16761 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16762 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16763 are not implemented.
16764
16765 @item
16766 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16767 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16768 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16769 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16770 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16771
16772 @smallexample
16773 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16774 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16775 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16776 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16777 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16778 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16779 @end smallexample
16780
16781 Changing a
16782 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16783 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16784 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16785 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16786 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16787 declared to have a type such as:
16788
16789 @smallexample
16790 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16791 Id : Integer;
16792 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16793 end record;
16794 @end smallexample
16795
16796 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16797 assignments:
16798
16799 @smallexample
16800 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16801 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16805 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16806 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16807 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16808 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16809 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16810 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16811 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16812
16813 @item
16814 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16815
16816 @item
16817 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16818 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16819 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16820 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16821 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16822 the proper resolution.
16823
16824 @item
16825 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16826
16827 @item
16828 Entry calls are not implemented.
16829
16830 @item
16831 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16832 formats are not supported.
16833
16834 @item
16835 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16836
16837 @item
16838 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16839 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16840 context.
16841 Should your program
16842 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16843 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16844 @end itemize
16845
16846 @node Additions to Ada
16847 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16848 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16849
16850 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16851 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16852
16853 @itemize @bullet
16854 @item
16855 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16856 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16857 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16858 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16859 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16860 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16861 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16862 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16863
16864 @item
16865 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16866 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16867 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16868
16869 @item
16870 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16871 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16872
16873 @item
16874 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16875 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16876 @end itemize
16877
16878 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16879 additions specific to Ada:
16880
16881 @itemize @bullet
16882 @item
16883 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16884 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16885
16886 @smallexample
16887 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16888 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16889 @end smallexample
16890
16891 @item
16892 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16893 the value of its right-hand operand.
16894 This allows, for example,
16895 complex conditional breaks:
16896
16897 @smallexample
16898 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16899 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16900 @end smallexample
16901
16902 @item
16903 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16904 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16905 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16906 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16907 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16908 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16909 in strings. For example,
16910 @smallexample
16911 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16912 @end smallexample
16913 @noindent
16914 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16915 after each period.
16916
16917 @item
16918 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16919 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16920 to write
16921
16922 @smallexample
16923 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16924 @end smallexample
16925
16926 @item
16927 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16928 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16929 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16930 of 3 might print as
16931
16932 @smallexample
16933 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16934 @end smallexample
16935
16936 @noindent
16937 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16938 clause.
16939
16940 @item
16941 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16942 multi-character subsequence of
16943 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16944 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16945 in place of @t{a'length}.
16946
16947 @item
16948 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16949 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16950 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16951 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16952 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16953 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16954 For example,
16955 @smallexample
16956 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16957 @end smallexample
16958
16959 @item
16960 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16961 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16962 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16963 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16964 object.
16965
16966 @end itemize
16967
16968 @node Overloading support for Ada
16969 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16970 @cindex overloading, Ada
16971
16972 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16973 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16974 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16975 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16976 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16977 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16978
16979 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16980 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16981 use, for instance:
16982
16983 @smallexample
16984 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16985 Multiple matches for f
16986 [0] cancel
16987 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16988 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16989 >
16990 @end smallexample
16991
16992 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16993 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16994 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16995
16996 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16997 case:
16998
16999 @table @code
17000
17001 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17002 @item set ada print-signatures
17003 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17004 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17005 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17006
17007 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17008 @item show ada print-signatures
17009 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17010 overloads selection menu.
17011 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17012
17013 @end table
17014
17015 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17016 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17017
17018 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17019 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17020 before reaching the main procedure.
17021 As defined in the Ada Reference
17022 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17023 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17024 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17025 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17026
17027 @node Ada Exceptions
17028 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17029
17030 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17031
17032 @table @code
17033 @kindex info exceptions
17034 @item info exceptions
17035 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17036 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17037 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17038 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17039 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17040 @end table
17041
17042 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17043 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17044 argument.
17045
17046 @smallexample
17047 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17048 All defined Ada exceptions:
17049 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17050 program_error: 0x613d20
17051 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17052 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17053 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17054 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17055 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17056 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17057 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17058 @end smallexample
17059
17060 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17061 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17062
17063 @node Ada Tasks
17064 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17065 @cindex Ada, tasking
17066
17067 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17068 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17069
17070 @table @code
17071 @kindex info tasks
17072 @item info tasks
17073 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17074
17075
17076 @smallexample
17077 @iftex
17078 @leftskip=0.5cm
17079 @end iftex
17080 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17081 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17082 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17083 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17084 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17085 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17086
17087 @end smallexample
17088
17089 @noindent
17090 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17091 task currently being inspected.
17092
17093 @table @asis
17094 @item ID
17095 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17096
17097 @item TID
17098 The Ada task ID.
17099
17100 @item P-ID
17101 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17102
17103 @item Pri
17104 The base priority of the task.
17105
17106 @item State
17107 Current state of the task.
17108
17109 @table @code
17110 @item Unactivated
17111 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17112 executing.
17113
17114 @item Runnable
17115 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17116 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17117
17118 @item Terminated
17119 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17120 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17121 terminated themselves.
17122
17123 @item Child Activation Wait
17124 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17125
17126 @item Accept Statement
17127 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17128
17129 @item Waiting on entry call
17130 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17131
17132 @item Async Select Wait
17133 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17134 select statement.
17135
17136 @item Delay Sleep
17137 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17138 alternative open.
17139
17140 @item Child Termination Wait
17141 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17142 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17143 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17144
17145 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17146 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17147 finish terminating.
17148
17149 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17150 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17151 @end table
17152
17153 @item Name
17154 Name of the task in the program.
17155
17156 @end table
17157
17158 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17159 @item info task @var{taskno}
17160 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17161 the following example:
17162 @smallexample
17163 @iftex
17164 @leftskip=0.5cm
17165 @end iftex
17166 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17167 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17168 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17169 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17170 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17171 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17172 Name: task_1
17173 Thread: 0
17174 LWP: 0x1fac
17175 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17176 Base Priority: 15
17177 State: Runnable
17178 @end smallexample
17179
17180 @item task
17181 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17182 @cindex current Ada task ID
17183 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17184
17185 @smallexample
17186 @iftex
17187 @leftskip=0.5cm
17188 @end iftex
17189 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17190 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17191 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17192 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17193 (@value{GDBP}) task
17194 [Current task is 2]
17195 @end smallexample
17196
17197 @item task @var{taskno}
17198 @cindex Ada task switching
17199 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17200 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17201 from the current task to the given task.
17202
17203 @smallexample
17204 @iftex
17205 @leftskip=0.5cm
17206 @end iftex
17207 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17208 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17209 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17210 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17211 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17212 [Switching to task 1]
17213 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17214 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17215 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17216 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17217 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17218 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17219 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17220 @end smallexample
17221
17222 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17223 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17224 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17225 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17226 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17227 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17228 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17229 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17230 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17231
17232 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17233 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17234 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17235 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17236 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17237
17238 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17239 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17240 program.
17241
17242 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17243 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17244 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17245
17246 For example,
17247
17248 @smallexample
17249 @iftex
17250 @leftskip=0.5cm
17251 @end iftex
17252 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17253 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17254 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17255 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17256 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17257 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17258 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17259 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17260 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17261 Continuing.
17262 task # 1 running
17263 task # 2 running
17264
17265 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17266 15 flush;
17267 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17268 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17269 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17270 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17271 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17272 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17273 @end smallexample
17274 @end table
17275
17276 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17277 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17278 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17279
17280 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17281 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17282 the platform being used.
17283 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17284 switching is not supported.
17285
17286 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17287 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17288 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17289 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17290 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17291 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17292
17293 @node Ravenscar Profile
17294 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17295 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17296
17297 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17298 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17299 requirements.
17300
17301 @table @code
17302 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17303 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17304 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17305 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17306 Profile. This is the default.
17307
17308 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17309 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17310 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17311 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17312 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17313 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17314 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17315
17316 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17317 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17318 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17319 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17320
17321 @end table
17322
17323 @node Ada Settings
17324 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17325 @cindex Ada settings
17326
17327 @table @code
17328 @kindex set varsize-limit
17329 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17330 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17331 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17332 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17333 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17334 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17335 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17336
17337 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17338 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17339 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17340 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17341 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17342 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17343 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17344 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17345 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17346 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17347 size is less than @var{size}.
17348
17349 @kindex show varsize-limit
17350 @item show varsize-limit
17351 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17352 @end table
17353
17354 @node Ada Glitches
17355 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17356 @cindex Ada, problems
17357
17358 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17359 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17360 @value{GDBN},
17361 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17362 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17363
17364 @itemize @bullet
17365 @item
17366 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17367 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17368
17369 @item
17370 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17371 argument lists are treated as positional).
17372
17373 @item
17374 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17375
17376 @item
17377 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17378 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17379 the host machine.
17380
17381 @item
17382 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17383 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17384 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17385 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17386 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17387 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17388 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17389 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17390 you can usually resolve the confusion
17391 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17392 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17393 @end itemize
17394
17395 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17396 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17397 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17398 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17399 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17400 enabled.
17401
17402 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17403 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17404 @table @code
17405
17406 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17407 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17408 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17409 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17410 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17411 This is the default.
17412
17413 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17414 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17415 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17416 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17417 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17418 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17419 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17420
17421 @end table
17422
17423 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17424 @cindex GNAT encoding
17425 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17426 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17427 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17428 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17429 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17430 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17431
17432 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17433 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17434 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17435 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17436 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17437 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17438 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17439 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17440
17441 @table @code
17442
17443 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17444 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17445 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17446 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17447
17448 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17449 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17450 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17451
17452 @end table
17453
17454 @node Unsupported Languages
17455 @section Unsupported Languages
17456
17457 @cindex unsupported languages
17458 @cindex minimal language
17459 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17460 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17461 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17462 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17463 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17464 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17465
17466 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17467 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17468 language.
17469
17470 @node Symbols
17471 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17472
17473 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17474 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17475 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17476 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17477 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17478 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17479 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17480
17481 @cindex symbol names
17482 @cindex names of symbols
17483 @cindex quoting names
17484 @anchor{quoting names}
17485 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17486 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17487 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17488 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17489 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17490 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17491 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17492 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17493
17494 @smallexample
17495 p 'foo.c'::x
17496 @end smallexample
17497
17498 @noindent
17499 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17500
17501 @table @code
17502 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17503 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17504 @kindex set case-sensitive
17505 @item set case-sensitive on
17506 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17507 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17508 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17509 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17510 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17511 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17512 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17513 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17514 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17515 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17516 case-insensitive matches.
17517
17518 @kindex show case-sensitive
17519 @item show case-sensitive
17520 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17521 lookups.
17522
17523 @kindex set print type methods
17524 @item set print type methods
17525 @itemx set print type methods on
17526 @itemx set print type methods off
17527 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17528 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17529 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17530 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17531 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17532 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17533
17534 @kindex show print type methods
17535 @item show print type methods
17536 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17537 classes.
17538
17539 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17540 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17541 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17542 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17543 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17544 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17545 types defined in classes.
17546
17547 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17548 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17549 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17550 printing classes.
17551
17552 @kindex set print type typedefs
17553 @item set print type typedefs
17554 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17555 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17556
17557 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17558 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17559 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17560 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17561 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17562 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17563 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17564 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17565 types.
17566
17567 @kindex show print type typedefs
17568 @item show print type typedefs
17569 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17570 printing classes.
17571
17572 @kindex info address
17573 @cindex address of a symbol
17574 @item info address @var{symbol}
17575 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17576 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17577 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17578 is always stored.
17579
17580 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17581 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17582 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17583
17584 @kindex info symbol
17585 @cindex symbol from address
17586 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17587 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17588 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17589 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17590 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17591
17592 @smallexample
17593 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17594 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17595 @end smallexample
17596
17597 @noindent
17598 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17599 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17600
17601 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17602 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17603
17604 @smallexample
17605 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17606 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17607 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17608 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17609 @end smallexample
17610
17611 @kindex demangle
17612 @cindex demangle
17613 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17614 Demangle @var{name}.
17615 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17616 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17617
17618 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17619 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17620
17621 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17622 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17623
17624 @kindex whatis
17625 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17626 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17627 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17628 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17629
17630 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17631 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17632 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17633
17634 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17635 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17636 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17637 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17638 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17639 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17640 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17641 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17642 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17643
17644 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17645 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17646 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17647 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17648 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17649 unroll it.
17650
17651 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17652 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17653 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17654
17655 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17656 Available flags are:
17657
17658 @table @code
17659 @item r
17660 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17661 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17662 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17663
17664 @item m
17665 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17666
17667 @item M
17668 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17669 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17670
17671 @item t
17672 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17673 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17674 names are substituted when printing other types.
17675
17676 @item T
17677 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17678 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17679
17680 @item o
17681 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17682 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17683
17684 For example, given the following declarations:
17685
17686 @smallexample
17687 struct tuv
17688 @{
17689 int a1;
17690 char *a2;
17691 int a3;
17692 @};
17693
17694 struct xyz
17695 @{
17696 int f1;
17697 char f2;
17698 void *f3;
17699 struct tuv f4;
17700 @};
17701
17702 union qwe
17703 @{
17704 struct tuv fff1;
17705 struct xyz fff2;
17706 @};
17707
17708 struct tyu
17709 @{
17710 int a1 : 1;
17711 int a2 : 3;
17712 int a3 : 23;
17713 char a4 : 2;
17714 int64_t a5;
17715 int a6 : 5;
17716 int64_t a7 : 3;
17717 @};
17718 @end smallexample
17719
17720 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17721
17722 @smallexample
17723 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17724 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17725 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17726 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17727 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17728 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17729
17730 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17731 @}
17732 @end smallexample
17733
17734 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17735 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17736 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17737 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17738 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17739 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17740 its fields.
17741
17742 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17743
17744 @smallexample
17745 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17746 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17747 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17748 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17749 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17750 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17751 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17752
17753 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17754 @} fff1;
17755 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17756 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17757 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17758 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17759 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17760 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17761 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17762 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17763 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17764 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17765
17766 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17767 @} f4;
17768
17769 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17770 @} fff2;
17771
17772 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17773 @}
17774 @end smallexample
17775
17776 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17777 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17778 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17779 of these structures' fields.
17780
17781 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17782 bitfields:
17783
17784 @smallexample
17785 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17786 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17787 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17788 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17789 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17790 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17791 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17792 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17793 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17794 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17795 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17796
17797 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17798 @}
17799 @end smallexample
17800
17801 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17802 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17803 @end table
17804
17805 @kindex ptype
17806 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17807 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17808 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17809 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17810
17811 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17812 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17813 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17814 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17815 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17816 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17817 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17818 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17819
17820 For example, for this variable declaration:
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 typedef double real_t;
17824 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17825 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17826 complex_t var;
17827 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17828 @end smallexample
17829
17830 @noindent
17831 the two commands give this output:
17832
17833 @smallexample
17834 @group
17835 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17836 type = complex_t
17837 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17838 type = struct complex @{
17839 real_t real;
17840 double imag;
17841 @}
17842 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17843 type = struct complex
17844 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17845 type = struct complex
17846 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17847 type = struct complex @{
17848 real_t real;
17849 double imag;
17850 @}
17851 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17852 type = real_t *
17853 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17854 type = double *
17855 @end group
17856 @end smallexample
17857
17858 @noindent
17859 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17860 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17861
17862 @cindex incomplete type
17863 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17864 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17865 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17866 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17867 given these declarations:
17868
17869 @smallexample
17870 struct foo;
17871 struct foo *fooptr;
17872 @end smallexample
17873
17874 @noindent
17875 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17876
17877 @smallexample
17878 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17879 $1 = <incomplete type>
17880 @end smallexample
17881
17882 @noindent
17883 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17884 completely specified.
17885
17886 @cindex unknown type
17887 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17888 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17889 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17890 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17891 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17892 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17893 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17894 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17895
17896 @smallexample
17897 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17898 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17899 @end smallexample
17900
17901 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17902 of such variables.
17903
17904 @kindex info types
17905 @item info types @var{regexp}
17906 @itemx info types
17907 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17908 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17909 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17910 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17911 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17912 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17913 name is @code{value}.
17914
17915 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17916 to print the type description according to the
17917 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17918 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17919 language of the type, other values mean to use
17920 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17921
17922 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17923 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17924 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17925
17926 @kindex info type-printers
17927 @item info type-printers
17928 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17929 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17930 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17931 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17932 type printers.
17933
17934 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17935
17936 @kindex enable type-printer
17937 @kindex disable type-printer
17938 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17939 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17940 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17941
17942 @kindex info scope
17943 @cindex local variables
17944 @item info scope @var{location}
17945 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17946 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17947 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17948 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17949 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17950
17951 @smallexample
17952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17953 Scope for command_line_handler:
17954 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17955 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17956 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17957 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17958 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17959 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17960 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17961 @end smallexample
17962
17963 @noindent
17964 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17965 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17966 collect}.
17967
17968 @kindex info source
17969 @item info source
17970 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17971 the function containing the current point of execution:
17972 @itemize @bullet
17973 @item
17974 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17975 @item
17976 the directory it was compiled in,
17977 @item
17978 its length, in lines,
17979 @item
17980 which programming language it is written in,
17981 @item
17982 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17983 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17984 @item
17985 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17986 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17987 @item
17988 whether the debugging information includes information about
17989 preprocessor macros.
17990 @end itemize
17991
17992
17993 @kindex info sources
17994 @item info sources
17995 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17996 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17997 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17998
17999 @kindex info functions
18000 @item info functions [-q]
18001 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18002 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18003 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18004 number.
18005
18006 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18007 to print the function name and type according to the
18008 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18009 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18010 language of the function, other values mean to use
18011 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18012
18013 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18014 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18015 have been printed.
18016
18017 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18018 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18019 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18020
18021 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18022 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18023 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18024 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18025 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18026 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18027 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18028
18029 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18030 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18031 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18032 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18033 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18034 of special characters or quotes.
18035 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18036 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18037 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18038 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18039 int.
18040
18041 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18042 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18043 @var{type_regexp}.
18044
18045
18046 @kindex info variables
18047 @item info variables [-q]
18048 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18049 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18050 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18051 their respective source line numbers.
18052
18053 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18054 to print the variable name and type according to the
18055 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18056 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18057 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18058 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18059
18060 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18061 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18062 have been printed.
18063
18064 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18065 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18066 with the provided regexp(s).
18067
18068 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18069 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18070
18071 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18072 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18073 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18074 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18075 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18076 of special characters or quotes.
18077
18078 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18079 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18080 @var{type_regexp}.
18081
18082 @kindex info classes
18083 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18084 @item info classes
18085 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18086 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18087 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18088 expression.
18089
18090 @kindex info selectors
18091 @item info selectors
18092 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18093 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18094 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18095 expression.
18096
18097 @ignore
18098 This was never implemented.
18099 @kindex info methods
18100 @item info methods
18101 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18102 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18103 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18104 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18105 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18106 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18107 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18108 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18109 @end ignore
18110
18111 @cindex opaque data types
18112 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18113 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18114 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18115 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18116 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18117 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18118 another source file. The default is on.
18119
18120 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18121 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18122
18123 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18124 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18125 is printed as follows:
18126 @smallexample
18127 @{<no data fields>@}
18128 @end smallexample
18129
18130 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18131 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18132 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18133
18134 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18135 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18136 @item set print symbol-loading
18137 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18138 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18139 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18140 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18141 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18142 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18143 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18144 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18145 can be annoying.
18146 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18147 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18148 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18149 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18150
18151 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18152 @item show print symbol-loading
18153 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18154 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18155
18156 @kindex maint print symbols
18157 @cindex symbol dump
18158 @kindex maint print psymbols
18159 @cindex partial symbol dump
18160 @kindex maint print msymbols
18161 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18162 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18163 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18164 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18165 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18166 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18167 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18168 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18169 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18170 that objfile.
18171 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18172 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18173 @code{main}.
18174 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18175 source file.
18176
18177 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18178 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18179 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18180 tables.
18181 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18182 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18183 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18184 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18185 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18186 ``ELF symbols''.
18187
18188 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18189 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18190
18191 @kindex maint info symtabs
18192 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18193 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18194 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18195 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18196 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18197 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18198 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18199
18200 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18201 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18202 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18203 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18204 structure in more detail. For example:
18205
18206 @smallexample
18207 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18208 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18209 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18210 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18211 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18212 readin no
18213 fullname (null)
18214 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18215 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18216 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18217 dependencies (none)
18218 @}
18219 @}
18220 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18221 (@value{GDBP})
18222 @end smallexample
18223 @noindent
18224 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18225 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18226 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18227 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18228 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18229
18230 @smallexample
18231 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18232 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18233 line 1574.
18234 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18235 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18236 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18237 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18238 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18239 dirname (null)
18240 fullname (null)
18241 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18242 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18243 debugformat DWARF 2
18244 @}
18245 @}
18246 (@value{GDBP})
18247 @end smallexample
18248
18249 @kindex maint info line-table
18250 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18251 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18252 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18253
18254 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18255 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18256 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18257
18258 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18259 @cindex symbol cache size
18260 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18261 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18262 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18263 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18264 with different sizes.
18265
18266 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18267 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18268 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18269
18270 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18271 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18272 @item maint print symbol-cache
18273 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18274 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18275
18276 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18277 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18278 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18279 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18280 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18281
18282 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18283 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18284 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18285 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18286 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18287 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18288
18289 @end table
18290
18291 @node Altering
18292 @chapter Altering Execution
18293
18294 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18295 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18296 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18297 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18298 program.
18299
18300 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18301 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18302 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18303
18304 @menu
18305 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18306 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18307 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18308 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18309 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18310 * Patching:: Patching your program
18311 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18312 @end menu
18313
18314 @node Assignment
18315 @section Assignment to Variables
18316
18317 @cindex assignment
18318 @cindex setting variables
18319 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18320 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18321
18322 @smallexample
18323 print x=4
18324 @end smallexample
18325
18326 @noindent
18327 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18328 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18329 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18330 information on operators in supported languages.
18331
18332 @kindex set variable
18333 @cindex variables, setting
18334 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18335 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18336 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18337 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18338 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18339
18340 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18341 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18342 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18343 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18344 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18345 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18346 command @code{set width}:
18347
18348 @smallexample
18349 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18350 type = double
18351 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18352 $4 = 13
18353 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18354 Invalid syntax in expression.
18355 @end smallexample
18356
18357 @noindent
18358 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18359 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18363 @end smallexample
18364
18365 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18366 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18367 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18368 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18369 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18370 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18371
18372 @smallexample
18373 @group
18374 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18375 type = double
18376 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18377 $1 = 1
18378 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18379 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18380 $2 = 1
18381 (@value{GDBP}) r
18382 The program being debugged has been started already.
18383 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18384 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18385 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18386 Invalid bfd target.
18387 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18388 The current BFD target is "=4".
18389 @end group
18390 @end smallexample
18391
18392 @noindent
18393 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18394 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18395 @code{g}, use
18396
18397 @smallexample
18398 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18402 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18403 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18404 same length or shorter.
18405 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18406 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18407
18408 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18409 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18410 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18411 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18412 and representation in memory), and
18413
18414 @smallexample
18415 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18416 @end smallexample
18417
18418 @noindent
18419 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18420
18421 @node Jumping
18422 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18423
18424 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18425 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18426 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18427
18428 @table @code
18429 @kindex jump
18430 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18431 @item jump @var{location}
18432 @itemx j @var{location}
18433 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18434 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18435 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18436 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18437 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18438
18439 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18440 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18441 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18442 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18443 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18444 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18445 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18446 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18447 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18448 @end table
18449
18450 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18451 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18452 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18453 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18454 example,
18455
18456 @smallexample
18457 set $pc = 0x485
18458 @end smallexample
18459
18460 @noindent
18461 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18462 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18463 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18464
18465 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18466 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18467 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18468 detail.
18469
18470 @c @group
18471 @node Signaling
18472 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18473 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18474
18475 @table @code
18476 @kindex signal
18477 @item signal @var{signal}
18478 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18479 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18480 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18481 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18482
18483 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18484 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18485 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18486 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18487 signal.
18488
18489 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18490 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18491 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18492 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18493 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18494 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18495 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18496 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18497
18498 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18499 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18500 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18501 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18502 passes the signal directly to your program.
18503
18504 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18505 after executing the command.
18506
18507 @kindex queue-signal
18508 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18509 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18510 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18511 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18512 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18513 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18514 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18515 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18516 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18517
18518 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18519 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18520 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18521 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18522 @code{continue} command.
18523
18524 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18525 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18526 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18527 (@pxref{Signals}).
18528 @end table
18529 @c @end group
18530
18531 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18532 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18533
18534 @node Returning
18535 @section Returning from a Function
18536
18537 @table @code
18538 @cindex returning from a function
18539 @kindex return
18540 @item return
18541 @itemx return @var{expression}
18542 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18543 command. If you give an
18544 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18545 value.
18546 @end table
18547
18548 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18549 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18550 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18551 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18552
18553 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18554 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18555 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18556 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18557 of functions.
18558
18559 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18560 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18561 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18562 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18563 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18564
18565 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18566 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18567 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18568 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18569 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18570 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18571 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18572 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18573 assignment into the right register(s).
18574
18575 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18576 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18577 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18578 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18579 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18580 into a @code{long long int}:
18581
18582 @smallexample
18583 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18584 29 return 31;
18585 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18586 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18587 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18588 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18589 (@value{GDBP})
18590 @end smallexample
18591
18592 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18593 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18594 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18595 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18596 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18597 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18598 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18599 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18600
18601 @smallexample
18602 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18603 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18604 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18605 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18606 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18607 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18608 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18609 (@value{GDBP})
18610 @end smallexample
18611
18612 @node Calling
18613 @section Calling Program Functions
18614
18615 @table @code
18616 @cindex calling functions
18617 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18618 @item print @var{expr}
18619 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18620 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18621 debugged.
18622
18623 @kindex call
18624 @item call @var{expr}
18625 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18626 returned values.
18627
18628 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18629 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18630 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18631 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18632 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18633 value history.
18634 @end table
18635
18636 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18637 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18638 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18639 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18640
18641 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18642 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18643 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18644 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18645 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18646 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18647 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18648 in that case is controlled by the
18649 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18650
18651 @table @code
18652 @item set unwindonsignal
18653 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18654 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18655 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18656 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18657 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18658 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18659 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18660 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18661 received.
18662
18663 @item show unwindonsignal
18664 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18665 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18666 @value{GDBN}.
18667
18668 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18669 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18670 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18671 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18672 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18673 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18674 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18675 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18676 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18677 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18678
18679 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18680 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18681 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18682 @value{GDBN}.
18683
18684 @end table
18685
18686 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18687
18688 @cindex no debug info functions
18689 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18690 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18691 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18692 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18693 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18694 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18695
18696 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18697 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18698 declared return type. For example:
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18702 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18703 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18704 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18708 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18709 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18710 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18711
18712 @smallexample
18713 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18714 @end smallexample
18715
18716 @noindent
18717 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18718
18719 @smallexample
18720 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18721 @end smallexample
18722
18723 @noindent
18724 these calls are equivalent:
18725
18726 @smallexample
18727 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18728 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18729 @end smallexample
18730
18731 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18732 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18733 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18734 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18735 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18736 float parameters, and no debug info:
18737
18738 @smallexample
18739 float
18740 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18741 float v1, v2;
18742 @{
18743 return v1 * v2;
18744 @}
18745 @end smallexample
18746
18747 @noindent
18748 you call it like this:
18749
18750 @smallexample
18751 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18752 @end smallexample
18753
18754 @node Patching
18755 @section Patching Programs
18756
18757 @cindex patching binaries
18758 @cindex writing into executables
18759 @cindex writing into corefiles
18760
18761 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18762 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18763 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18764 patching your program's binary.
18765
18766 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18767 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18768 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18769 repairs.
18770
18771 @table @code
18772 @kindex set write
18773 @item set write on
18774 @itemx set write off
18775 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18776 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18777 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18778
18779 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18780 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18781 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18782
18783 @item show write
18784 @kindex show write
18785 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18786 as well as reading.
18787 @end table
18788
18789 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18790 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18791 @cindex injecting code
18792 @cindex writing into executables
18793 @cindex compiling code
18794
18795 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18796 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18797 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18798 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18799
18800 @table @code
18801 @kindex compile code
18802 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18803 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18804 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18805 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18806 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18807 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18808 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18809 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18810 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18811 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18812 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18813 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18814
18815 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18816 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18817 E.g.:
18818
18819 @smallexample
18820 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18821 @end smallexample
18822
18823 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18824 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18825 from actual source code. E.g.:
18826
18827 @smallexample
18828 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18829 @end smallexample
18830
18831 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18832 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18833 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18834 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18835 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18836 editor.
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 compile code
18840 >printf ("hello\n");
18841 >printf ("world\n");
18842 >end
18843 @end smallexample
18844
18845 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18846 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18847 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18848 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18849 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18850 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18851 inferior symbols otherwise.
18852
18853 @kindex compile file
18854 @item compile file @var{filename}
18855 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18856 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18857
18858 @smallexample
18859 compile file /home/user/example.c
18860 @end smallexample
18861 @end table
18862
18863 @table @code
18864 @item compile print @var{expr}
18865 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18866 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18867 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18868 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18869 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18870 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18871 Formats}.
18872
18873 @item compile print
18874 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18875 @cindex reprint the last value
18876 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18877 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18878 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18879 multiple-line editor.
18880 @end table
18881
18882 @noindent
18883 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18884
18885 @table @code
18886 @anchor{set debug compile}
18887 @item set debug compile
18888 @cindex compile command debugging info
18889 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18890 injecting the code. The default is off.
18891
18892 @item show debug compile
18893 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18894 compiling and injecting the code.
18895
18896 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18897 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18898 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18899 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18900 The default is off.
18901
18902 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18903 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18904 C@t{++} type conversion.
18905 @end table
18906
18907 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18908
18909 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18910 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18911 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18912 injecting process.
18913
18914 @noindent
18915 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18916
18917 @table @asis
18918 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18919 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18920 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18921 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18922
18923 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18924 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18925 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18926 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18927 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18928 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18929 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18930 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18931
18932 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18933 @end table
18934
18935 @noindent
18936 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18937
18938 @table @code
18939 @item set compile-args
18940 @cindex compile command options override
18941 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18942 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18943 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18944 compilation.
18945
18946 @item show compile-args
18947 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18948 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18949 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18950 @end table
18951
18952 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18953
18954 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18955 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18956 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18957
18958 @table @asis
18959 @item C code examples and caveats
18960 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18961 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18962 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18963 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18964 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18965
18966 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18967 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18968 much like any other normal debugging session.
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 void function1 (void)
18972 @{
18973 int i = 42;
18974 printf ("function 1\n");
18975 @}
18976
18977 void function2 (void)
18978 @{
18979 int j = 12;
18980 function1 ();
18981 @}
18982
18983 int main(void)
18984 @{
18985 int k = 6;
18986 int *p;
18987 function2 ();
18988 return 0;
18989 @}
18990 @end smallexample
18991
18992 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18993 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18994 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18995
18996 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18997 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18998 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18999 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
19000 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19001
19002 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19003 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19004 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19005 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19006 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19007 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19008 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19009 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19010 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19011 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 compile code k = 3;
19015 @end smallexample
19016
19017 @noindent
19018 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19019 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19020 @code{compile} command changes it.
19021
19022 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19023 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19024 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19025 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19026 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19027
19028 @smallexample
19029 compile code j = 3;
19030 @end smallexample
19031
19032 @noindent
19033 will result in a compilation error message.
19034
19035 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19036 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19037 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19038
19039 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19040 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19041 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19042 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19043
19044 @smallexample
19045 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19046 @end smallexample
19047
19048 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19049 command has completed:
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055 @noindent
19056 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19057 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19058 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19059 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19060 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19061
19062 @smallexample
19063 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19064 @end smallexample
19065
19066 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19067 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19068 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19069 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19070 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19071 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19072 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19073 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19074
19075 @smallexample
19076 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19077 @end smallexample
19078
19079 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19080 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19081 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19082 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19083 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19084 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19085 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19086
19087 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19088 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19089 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19090 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19091 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19092 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19093
19094 @smallexample
19095 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19096 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19097 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19098 Compilation failed.
19099 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19100 42
19101 @end smallexample
19102
19103 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19104 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19105 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19106 will print to the console.
19107 @end table
19108
19109 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19110
19111 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19112 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19113 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19114 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19115 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19116 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19117 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19118 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19119
19120
19121 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19122 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19123 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19124 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19125 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19126 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19127 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19128
19129 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19130 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19131 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19132 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19133 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19134 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19135 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19136
19137 @table @code
19138 @item set compile-gcc
19139 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19140 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19141 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19142 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19143 default.
19144
19145 @item show compile-gcc
19146 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19147 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19148 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19149 @end table
19150
19151 @node GDB Files
19152 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19153
19154 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19155 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19156 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19157 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19158
19159 @menu
19160 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19161 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19162 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19163 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19164 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19165 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19166 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19167 @end menu
19168
19169 @node Files
19170 @section Commands to Specify Files
19171
19172 @cindex symbol table
19173 @cindex core dump file
19174
19175 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19176 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19177 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19178 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19179
19180 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19181 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19182 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19183 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19184 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19185 new files are useful.
19186
19187 @table @code
19188 @cindex executable file
19189 @kindex file
19190 @item file @var{filename}
19191 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19192 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19193 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19194 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19195 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19196 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19197 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19198 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19199
19200 @cindex unlinked object files
19201 @cindex patching object files
19202 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19203 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19204 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19205 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19206 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19207 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19208 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19209 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19210
19211 @item file
19212 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19213 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19214
19215 @kindex exec-file
19216 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19217 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19218 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19219 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19220 discard information on the executable file.
19221
19222 @kindex symbol-file
19223 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19224 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19225 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19226 table and program to run from the same file.
19227
19228 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19229 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19230 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19231 enabled.
19232
19233 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19234 program's symbol table.
19235
19236 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19237 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19238 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19239 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19240 @value{GDBN}.
19241
19242 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19243 executing it once.
19244
19245 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19246 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19247 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19248 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19249 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19250 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19251 optimized code.
19252
19253 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19254 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19255 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19256 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19257 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19258
19259 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19260 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19261 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19262 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19263 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19264 Warnings and Messages}.)
19265
19266 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19267 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19268 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19269 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19270 in stabs format.
19271
19272 @kindex readnow
19273 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19274 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19275 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19276 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19277 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19278 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19279 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19280 entire symbol table available.
19281
19282 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19283 @cindex never read symbols
19284 @cindex symbols, never read
19285 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19286 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19287 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19288 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19289 @xref{--readnever}.
19290
19291 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19292 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19293 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19294 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19295 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19296 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19297 @c files.
19298
19299 @kindex core-file
19300 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19301 @itemx core
19302 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19303 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19304 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19305 executable file itself for other parts.
19306
19307 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19308 to be used.
19309
19310 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19311 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19312 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19313 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19314 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19315
19316 @kindex add-symbol-file
19317 @cindex dynamic linking
19318 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19319 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19320 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19321 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19322 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19323 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19324 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19325 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19326 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19327 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19328 can be given as an expression.
19329
19330 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19331 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19332 specified explicitly.
19333
19334 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19335 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19336 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19337 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19338
19339 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19340
19341 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19342 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19343 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19344 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19345 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19346 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19347 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19348 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19349 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19350
19351 @itemize @bullet
19352 @item
19353 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19354 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19355 @item
19356 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19357 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19358 @item
19359 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19360 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19361 @end itemize
19362
19363 @noindent
19364 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19365 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19366 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19367 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19368 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19369 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19370 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19371 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19372 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19373 way.
19374
19375 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19376
19377 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19378 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19379 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19380 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19381 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19382 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19383
19384 @smallexample
19385 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19386 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19387 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19388 (y or n) y
19389 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19390 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19391 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19392 (gdb)
19393 @end smallexample
19394
19395
19396 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19397
19398 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19399 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19400 @cindex load symbols from memory
19401 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19402 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19403 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19404 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19405 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19406 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19407 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19408 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19409 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19410
19411 @kindex section
19412 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19413 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19414 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19415 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19416 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19417 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19418 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19419 their addresses.
19420
19421 @kindex info files
19422 @kindex info target
19423 @item info files
19424 @itemx info target
19425 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19426 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19427 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19428 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19429 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19430 current ones.
19431
19432 @kindex maint info sections
19433 @item maint info sections
19434 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19435 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19436 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19437 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19438 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19439 may be arbitrarily combined):
19440
19441 @table @code
19442 @item ALLOBJ
19443 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19444 @item @var{sections}
19445 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19446 @item @var{section-flags}
19447 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19448 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19449 @table @code
19450 @item ALLOC
19451 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19452 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19453 @item LOAD
19454 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19455 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19456 @item RELOC
19457 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19458 @item READONLY
19459 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19460 @item CODE
19461 Section contains executable code only.
19462 @item DATA
19463 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19464 @item ROM
19465 Section will reside in ROM.
19466 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19467 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19468 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19469 Section is not empty.
19470 @item NEVER_LOAD
19471 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19472 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19473 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19474 COFF shared library information.
19475 @item IS_COMMON
19476 Section contains common symbols.
19477 @end table
19478 @end table
19479 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19480 @cindex read-only sections
19481 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19482 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19483 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19484 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19485 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19486 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19487 enhancement to debugging performance.
19488
19489 The default is off.
19490
19491 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19492 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19493 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19494 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19495
19496 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19497 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19498 @end table
19499
19500 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19501 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19502 name and remembers it that way.
19503
19504 @cindex shared libraries
19505 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19506 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19507 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19508 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19509
19510 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19511 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19512
19513 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19514 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19515 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19516 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19517 debugging a core file).
19518
19519 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19520 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19521 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19522
19523 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19524 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19525 particularly large or there are many of them.
19526
19527 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19528 commands:
19529
19530 @table @code
19531 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19532 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19533 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19534 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19535 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19536 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19537 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19538 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19539
19540 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19541 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19542 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19543 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19544 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19545 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19546 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19547 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19548 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19549
19550 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19551 @item show auto-solib-add
19552 Display the current autoloading mode.
19553 @end table
19554
19555 @cindex load shared library
19556 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19557 command:
19558
19559 @table @code
19560 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19561 @kindex info share
19562 @item info share @var{regex}
19563 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19564 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19565 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19566 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19567
19568 @kindex info dll
19569 @item info dll @var{regex}
19570 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19571
19572 @kindex sharedlibrary
19573 @kindex share
19574 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19575 @itemx share @var{regex}
19576 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19577 Unix regular expression.
19578 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19579 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19580 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19581 loaded.
19582
19583 @item nosharedlibrary
19584 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19585 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19586 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19587 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19588 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19589 discarded.
19590 @end table
19591
19592 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19593 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19594 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19595 Catchpoints}).
19596
19597 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19598 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19599 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19600 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19601
19602 @table @code
19603 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19604 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19605 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19606 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19607 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19608 shared library.
19609
19610 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19611 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19612 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19613 library events happen.
19614 @end table
19615
19616 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19617 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19618 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19619 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19620 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19621 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19622 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19623 not.
19624
19625 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19626 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19627 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19628 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19629 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19630
19631 @table @code
19632 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19633 @cindex system root, alternate
19634 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19635 @kindex set sysroot
19636 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19637 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19638 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19639 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19640 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19641 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19642 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19643 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19644 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19645 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19646 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19647 @var{path}.
19648
19649 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19650 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19651 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19652 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19653 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19654 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19655 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19656 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19657 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19658 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19659 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19660 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19661 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19662 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19663
19664 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19665 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19666 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19667 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19668 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19669
19670 @smallexample
19671 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19672 @end smallexample
19673
19674 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19675 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19676 system:
19677
19678 @smallexample
19679 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19680 @end smallexample
19681
19682 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19683 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19684 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19685 colons:
19686
19687 @smallexample
19688 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19692 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19693 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19694 @samp{z}):
19695
19696 @smallexample
19697 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19698 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19699 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19700 @end smallexample
19701
19702 @noindent
19703 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19704 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19705 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19706
19707 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19708 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19709
19710 @smallexample
19711 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19712 @end smallexample
19713
19714 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19715 if you don't want or need to.
19716
19717 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19718 sysroot}.
19719
19720 @cindex default system root
19721 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19722 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19723 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19724 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19725 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19726 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19727 location.
19728
19729 @kindex show sysroot
19730 @item show sysroot
19731 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19732
19733 @kindex set solib-search-path
19734 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19735 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19736 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19737 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19738 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19739 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19740 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19741 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19742 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19743 of shared library symbols.
19744
19745 @kindex show solib-search-path
19746 @item show solib-search-path
19747 Display the current shared library search path.
19748
19749 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19750 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19751 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19752 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19753 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19754
19755 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19756 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19757 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19758 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19759 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19760 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19761 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19762 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19763 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19764 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19765 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19766 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19767 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19768 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19769 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19770 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19771 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19772 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19773 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19774 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19775 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19776 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19777
19778 @table @code
19779 @item unix
19780 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19781 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19782 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19783 the forward slash.
19784
19785 @item dos-based
19786 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19787 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19788 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19789 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19790 considered directory separators.
19791
19792 @item auto
19793 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19794 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19795 This is the default.
19796 @end table
19797 @end table
19798
19799 @cindex file name canonicalization
19800 @cindex base name differences
19801 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19802 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19803 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19804 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19805 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19806 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19807 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19808 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19809 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19810 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19811 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19812 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19813 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19814 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19815 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19816
19817 @table @code
19818 @item set basenames-may-differ
19819 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19820 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19821
19822 @item show basenames-may-differ
19823 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19824 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19825 @end table
19826
19827 @node File Caching
19828 @section File Caching
19829 @cindex caching of opened files
19830 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19831
19832 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19833 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19834 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19835 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19836
19837 @table @code
19838 @kindex maint info bfds
19839 @item maint info bfds
19840 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19841 @value{GDBN}.
19842
19843 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19844 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19845 @kindex bfd caching
19846 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19847 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19848 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19849 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19850 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19851 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19852 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19853 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19854 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19855
19856 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19857 @kindex bfd caching
19858 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19859 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19860
19861 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19862 @kindex bfd caching
19863 @item show debug bfd-cache
19864 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19865 @end table
19866
19867 @node Separate Debug Files
19868 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19869 @cindex separate debugging information files
19870 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19871 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19872 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19873 @cindex global debugging information directories
19874 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19875 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19876
19877 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19878 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19879 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19880 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19881 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19882 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19883 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19884
19885 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19886 file:
19887
19888 @itemize @bullet
19889 @item
19890 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19891 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19892 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19893 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19894 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19895 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19896 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19897 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19898
19899 @item
19900 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19901 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19902 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19903 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19904 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19905 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19906 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19907 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19908 below.
19909 @end itemize
19910
19911 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19912 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19913
19914 @itemize @bullet
19915 @item
19916 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19917 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19918 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19919 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19920 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19921
19922 @item
19923 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19924 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19925 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19926 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19927 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19928 hex characters, not 10.)
19929 @end itemize
19930
19931 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19932 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19933 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19934 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19935 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19936 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19937
19938 @itemize @minus
19939 @item
19940 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19941 @item
19942 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19943 @item
19944 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19945 @item
19946 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19947 @end itemize
19948
19949 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19950 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19951 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19952 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19953 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19954
19955 @table @code
19956
19957 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19958 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19959 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19960 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19961 concatenating them by a path separator.
19962
19963 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19964 @item show debug-file-directory
19965 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19966 information files.
19967
19968 @end table
19969
19970 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19971 @cindex debug link sections
19972 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19973 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19974
19975 @itemize
19976 @item
19977 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19978 a zero byte,
19979 @item
19980 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19981 boundary within the section, and
19982 @item
19983 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19984 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19985 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19986 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19987 @end itemize
19988
19989 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19990 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19991 described above.
19992
19993 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19994 @cindex build ID sections
19995 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19996 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19997 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19998 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19999 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
20000 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20001 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20002 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20003 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20004
20005 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20006 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20007 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20008 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20009 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20010 in an ordinary executable.
20011
20012 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20013 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20014 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20015 following commands:
20016
20017 @smallexample
20018 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20019 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20020 @end smallexample
20021
20022 @noindent
20023 These commands remove the debugging
20024 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20025 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20026 two files:
20027
20028 @itemize @bullet
20029 @item
20030 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20031 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20032
20033 @smallexample
20034 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20035 @end smallexample
20036
20037 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20038 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20039 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20040 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20041
20042 @item
20043 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20044 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20045 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20046 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20047 @end itemize
20048
20049 @noindent
20050
20051 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20052 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20053 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20054
20055 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20056 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20057 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20058 @c different ways!
20059 @ifhtml
20060 @display
20061 @html
20062 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20063 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20064 @end html
20065 @end display
20066 @end ifhtml
20067 @ifnothtml
20068 @display
20069 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20070 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20071 @end display
20072 @end ifnothtml
20073
20074 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20075 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20076 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20077 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20078 CRC.
20079
20080 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20081 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20082 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20083 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20084 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20085
20086 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20087 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20088 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20089 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20090 @code{0xffffffff}.
20091
20092 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20093 @smallexample
20094 unsigned long
20095 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20096 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20097 @{
20098 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20099 @{
20100 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20101 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20102 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20103 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20104 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20105 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20106 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20107 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20108 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20109 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20110 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20111 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20112 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20113 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20114 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20115 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20116 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20117 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20118 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20119 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20120 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20121 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20122 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20123 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20124 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20125 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20126 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20127 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20128 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20129 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20130 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20131 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20132 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20133 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20134 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20135 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20136 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20137 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20138 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20139 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20140 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20141 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20142 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20143 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20144 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20145 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20146 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20147 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20148 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20149 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20150 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20151 0x2d02ef8d
20152 @};
20153 unsigned char *end;
20154
20155 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20156 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20157 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20158 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20159 @}
20160 @end smallexample
20161
20162 @noindent
20163 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20164
20165 @node MiniDebugInfo
20166 @section Debugging information in a special section
20167 @cindex separate debug sections
20168 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20169
20170 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20171 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20172 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20173 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20174
20175 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20176 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20177 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20178 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20179 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20180 debugging information might be included in the section.
20181
20182 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20183 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20184 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20185
20186 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20187 standard utilities:
20188
20189 @smallexample
20190 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20191 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20192 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20193 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20194
20195 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20196 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20197 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20198 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20199 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20200 | sort > funcsyms
20201
20202 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20203 # table.
20204 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20205
20206 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20207 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20208
20209 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20210 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20211 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20212 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20213
20214 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20215 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20216
20217 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20218 # original binary.
20219 xz mini_debuginfo
20220 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20221 @end smallexample
20222
20223 @node Index Files
20224 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20225 @cindex index files
20226 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20227
20228 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20229 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20230 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20231 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20232 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20233 startup.
20234
20235 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20236 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20237 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20241 @end smallexample
20242
20243 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20244
20245 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20246 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20247
20248 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20249 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20250 using @command{objcopy}.
20251
20252 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20253
20254 @table @code
20255 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20256 @kindex save gdb-index
20257 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20258 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20259 default creates it produces a single file
20260 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20261 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20262 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20263 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20264 given @var{directory}.
20265 @end table
20266
20267 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20268 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20269
20270 @smallexample
20271 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20272 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20273 @end smallexample
20274
20275 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20276
20277 @smallexample
20278 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20279 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20280 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20281 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20282 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20283 @end smallexample
20284
20285 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20286 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20287 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20288 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20289 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20290 The default is @code{off}.
20291 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20292 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20293
20294 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20295 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20296
20297 @smallexample
20298 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20299 @end smallexample
20300
20301 Instead you must do, for example,
20302
20303 @smallexample
20304 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20308 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20309 currently work for programs using Ada.
20310
20311 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20312
20313 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20314 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20315 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20316 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20317
20318 @table @code
20319
20320 @item set index-cache on
20321 @itemx set index-cache off
20322 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20323
20324 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20325 @itemx show index-cache directory
20326 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20327
20328 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20329 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20330 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20331 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20332 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20333 differ according to local convention.
20334
20335 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20336 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20337
20338 @item show index-cache stats
20339 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20340
20341 @end table
20342
20343 @node Symbol Errors
20344 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20345
20346 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20347 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20348 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20349 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20350 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20351 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20352 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20353 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20354 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20355 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20356 Messages}).
20357
20358 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20359
20360 @table @code
20361 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20362
20363 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20364 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20365 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20366 in its outer scope blocks.
20367
20368 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20369 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20370 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20371 function.
20372
20373 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20374
20375 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20376 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20377 do so.
20378
20379 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20380 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20381 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20382 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20383 Messages}.)
20384
20385 @item bad block start address patched
20386
20387 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20388 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20389 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20390
20391 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20392 starting on the previous source line.
20393
20394 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20395
20396 @cindex foo
20397 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20398 larger than the size of the string table.
20399
20400 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20401 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20402 with this name.
20403
20404 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20405
20406 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20407 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20408 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20409
20410 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20411 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20412 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20413 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20414 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20415 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20416
20417 @item stub type has NULL name
20418
20419 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20420
20421 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20422 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20423 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20424 it.
20425
20426 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20427
20428 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20429
20430 @end table
20431
20432 @node Data Files
20433 @section GDB Data Files
20434
20435 @cindex prefix for data files
20436 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20437 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20438
20439 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20440 is currently using.
20441
20442 @table @code
20443 @kindex set data-directory
20444 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20445 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20446 to @var{directory}.
20447
20448 @kindex show data-directory
20449 @item show data-directory
20450 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20451 @end table
20452
20453 @cindex default data directory
20454 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20455 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20456 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20457 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20458 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20459 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20460 location.
20461
20462 The data directory may also be specified with the
20463 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20464 @xref{Mode Options}.
20465
20466 @node Targets
20467 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20468
20469 @cindex debugging target
20470 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20471
20472 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20473 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20474 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20475 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20476 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20477 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20478 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20479 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20480
20481 @cindex target architecture
20482 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20483 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20484 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20485 command.
20486
20487 @table @code
20488 @kindex set architecture
20489 @kindex show architecture
20490 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20491 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20492 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20493 supported architectures.
20494
20495 @item show architecture
20496 Show the current target architecture.
20497
20498 @item set processor
20499 @itemx processor
20500 @kindex set processor
20501 @kindex show processor
20502 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20503 and @code{show architecture}.
20504 @end table
20505
20506 @menu
20507 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20508 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20509 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20510 @end menu
20511
20512 @node Active Targets
20513 @section Active Targets
20514
20515 @cindex stacking targets
20516 @cindex active targets
20517 @cindex multiple targets
20518
20519 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20520 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20521 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20522 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20523 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20524 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20525 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20526 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20527 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20528
20529 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20530 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20531 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20532 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20533
20534 @node Target Commands
20535 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20536
20537 @table @code
20538 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20539 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20540 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20541 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20542 protocol of the target machine.
20543
20544 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20545 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20546 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20547
20548 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20549 after executing the command.
20550
20551 @kindex help target
20552 @item help target
20553 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20554 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20555 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20556
20557 @item help target @var{name}
20558 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20559 select it.
20560
20561 @kindex set gnutarget
20562 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20563 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20564 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20565 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20566 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20567 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20568
20569 @quotation
20570 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20571 you must know the actual BFD name.
20572 @end quotation
20573
20574 @noindent
20575 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20576
20577 @kindex show gnutarget
20578 @item show gnutarget
20579 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20580 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20581 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20582 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20583 @end table
20584
20585 @cindex common targets
20586 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20587 configuration):
20588
20589 @table @code
20590 @kindex target
20591 @item target exec @var{program}
20592 @cindex executable file target
20593 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20594 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20595
20596 @item target core @var{filename}
20597 @cindex core dump file target
20598 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20599 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20600
20601 @item target remote @var{medium}
20602 @cindex remote target
20603 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20604 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20605 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20606
20607 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20608 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 target remote /dev/ttya
20612 @end smallexample
20613
20614 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20615 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20616 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20617 clobbered by the download.
20618
20619 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20620 @cindex built-in simulator target
20621 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20622 In general,
20623 @smallexample
20624 target sim
20625 load
20626 run
20627 @end smallexample
20628 @noindent
20629 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20630 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20631 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20632 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20633 Processors}.
20634
20635 @item target native
20636 @cindex native target
20637 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20638 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20639 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20640 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20641
20642 @end table
20643
20644 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20645 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20646
20647 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20648 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20649 various aspects of this process.
20650
20651 @table @code
20652
20653 @item set hash
20654 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20655 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20656 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20657 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20658 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20659 monitor.
20660
20661 @item show hash
20662 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20663 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20664
20665 @item set debug monitor
20666 @kindex set debug monitor
20667 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20668 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20669 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20670
20671 @item show debug monitor
20672 @kindex show debug monitor
20673 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20674 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20675 @end table
20676
20677 @table @code
20678
20679 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20680 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20681 @anchor{load}
20682 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20683 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20684 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20685 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20686 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20687 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20688
20689 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20690 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20691 target is @dots{}}''
20692
20693 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20694 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20695 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20696 specifies a fixed address.
20697 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20698
20699 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20700 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20701 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20702
20703 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20704 load programs into flash memory.
20705
20706 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20707 @end table
20708
20709 @table @code
20710
20711 @kindex flash-erase
20712 @item flash-erase
20713 @anchor{flash-erase}
20714
20715 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20716
20717 @end table
20718
20719 @node Byte Order
20720 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20721
20722 @cindex choosing target byte order
20723 @cindex target byte order
20724
20725 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20726 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20727 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20728 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20729 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20730 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20731
20732 @table @code
20733 @kindex set endian
20734 @item set endian big
20735 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20736
20737 @item set endian little
20738 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20739
20740 @item set endian auto
20741 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20742 executable.
20743
20744 @item show endian
20745 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20746
20747 @end table
20748
20749 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20750 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20751 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20752 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20753 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20754 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20755 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20756 and @code{big} otherwise.
20757
20758 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20759 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20760 target system.
20761
20762
20763 @node Remote Debugging
20764 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20765 @cindex remote debugging
20766
20767 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20768 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20769 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20770 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20771 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20772
20773 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20774 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20775 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20776 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20777 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20778 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20779
20780 Other remote targets may be available in your
20781 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20782
20783 @menu
20784 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20785 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20786 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20787 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20788 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20789 @end menu
20790
20791 @node Connecting
20792 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20793 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20794 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20795 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20796 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20797 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20798 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20799
20800 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20801 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20802 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20803 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20804
20805 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20806
20807 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20808 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20809 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20810 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20811
20812 @table @asis
20813
20814 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20815 @item Result of detach or program exit
20816 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20817 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20818 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20819
20820 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20821 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20822 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20823 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20824
20825 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20826 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20827 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20828 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20829
20830 @item Specifying the program to debug
20831 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20832 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20833 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20834 target.
20835
20836 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20837 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20838 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20839
20840 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20841 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20842 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20843 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20844
20845 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20846 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20847 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20848 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20849 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20850 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20851 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20852 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20853 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20854
20855 @item The @code{run} command
20856 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20857 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20858 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20859 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20860 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20861
20862 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20863 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20864 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20865 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20866 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20867
20868 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20869 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20870 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20871 @code{target remote} mode.
20872
20873 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20874 @item Attaching
20875 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20876 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20877 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20878
20879 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20880 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20881 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20882 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20883 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20884
20885 @end table
20886
20887 @anchor{Host and target files}
20888 @subsection Host and Target Files
20889 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20890 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20891
20892 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20893 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20894 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20895 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20896 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20897
20898 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20899 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20900 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20901 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20902 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20903
20904 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20905 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20906 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20907 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20908 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20909 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20910 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20911 target libraries.
20912
20913 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20914 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20915 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20916 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20917 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20918 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20919 programs.
20920
20921 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20922 @cindex remote connection commands
20923 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20924 local Unix domain socket, or
20925 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20926 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20927 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20928 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20929 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20930 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20931
20932 @table @code
20933
20934 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20935 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20936 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20937 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20938 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20939
20940 @smallexample
20941 target remote /dev/ttyb
20942 @end smallexample
20943
20944 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20945 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20946 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20947 @code{target} command.
20948
20949 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20950 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20951 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20952 @cindex Unix domain socket
20953 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20954 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20955
20956 @smallexample
20957 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20958 @end smallexample
20959
20960 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20961 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20962 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20963 of connection.
20964 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20965 Unix domain sockets.
20966
20967 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20968 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20969 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20970 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20971 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20972 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20973 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20974 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20975 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20976 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20977 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20978 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20979 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20980 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20981 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20982 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20983 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20984 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20985 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20986 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20987 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20988 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20989
20990 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20991 @code{manyfarms}:
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 target remote manyfarms:2828
20995 @end smallexample
20996
20997 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20998 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20999 square bracket syntax:
21000
21001 @smallexample
21002 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21003 @end smallexample
21004
21005 @noindent
21006 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21007
21008 @smallexample
21009 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21010 @end smallexample
21011
21012 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21013 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21014 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21015 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21016 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21017 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21018
21019 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21020 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21021 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21022 port 1234 on your local machine:
21023
21024 @smallexample
21025 target remote :1234
21026 @end smallexample
21027 @noindent
21028
21029 Note that the colon is still required here.
21030
21031 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21032 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21033 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21034 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21035 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21036 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21037 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21038 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21039 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21040 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21041 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21042 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21043 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21050 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21051 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21052 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21053
21054 @item target remote | @var{command}
21055 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21056 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21057 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21058 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21059 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21060 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21061 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21062 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21063 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21064
21065 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21066 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21067 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21068
21069 @end table
21070
21071 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21072 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21073 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21074 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21075 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21076 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21077 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21078
21079 @smallexample
21080 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21081 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21085 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21086 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21087 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21088
21089 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21090 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21091
21092 @table @code
21093 @kindex detach (remote)
21094 @item detach
21095 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21096 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21097 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21098 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21099 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21100 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21101 still connected to the target.
21102
21103 @kindex disconnect
21104 @item disconnect
21105 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21106 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21107 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21108 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21109 another target.
21110
21111 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21112 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21113 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21114 @kindex monitor
21115 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21116 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21117 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21118 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21119 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21120 and implement.
21121 @end table
21122
21123 @node File Transfer
21124 @section Sending files to a remote system
21125 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21126 @cindex file transfer
21127 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21128
21129 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21130 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21131 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21132 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21133 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21134 the only way to upload or download files.
21135
21136 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21137
21138 @table @code
21139 @kindex remote put
21140 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21141 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21142 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21143
21144 @kindex remote get
21145 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21146 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21147 on the host system.
21148
21149 @kindex remote delete
21150 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21151 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21152
21153 @end table
21154
21155 @node Server
21156 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21157
21158 @kindex gdbserver
21159 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21160 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21161 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21162 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21163 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21164
21165 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21166 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21167 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21168 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21169 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21170 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21171 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21172 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21173 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21174 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21175 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21176 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21177 choice for debugging.
21178
21179 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21180 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21181 protocol.
21182
21183 @quotation
21184 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21185 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21186 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21187 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21188 @code{gdbserver}.
21189 @end quotation
21190
21191 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21192 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21193 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21194 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21195
21196 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21197 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21198 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21199 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21200 system does all the symbol handling.
21201
21202 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21203 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21204 syntax is:
21205
21206 @smallexample
21207 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21211 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21212 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21213 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21214 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21215 @file{/dev/com1}:
21216
21217 @smallexample
21218 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21219 @end smallexample
21220
21221 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21222 with it.
21223
21224 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21225
21226 @smallexample
21227 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21228 @end smallexample
21229
21230 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21231 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21232 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21233 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21234 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21235 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21236 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21237 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21238 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21239 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21240 @code{target remote} command.
21241
21242 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21243 with ssh:
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21247 @end smallexample
21248
21249 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21250 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21251 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21252 You could elide it if you want to.
21253
21254 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21255 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21256 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21257 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21258
21259 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21260 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21261 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21262 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21263
21264 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21265 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21266
21267 @smallexample
21268 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21269 @end smallexample
21270
21271 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21272 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21273
21274 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21275 @value{GDBN} attach command
21276 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21277
21278 @pindex pidof
21279 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21280 @code{pidof} utility:
21281
21282 @smallexample
21283 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21284 @end smallexample
21285
21286 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21287 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21288 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21289
21290 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21291
21292 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21293 port.
21294
21295 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21296 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21297 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21298 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21299 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21300 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21301 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21302 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21303
21304 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21305 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21306 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21307
21308 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21309 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21310 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21311 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21312 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21313 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21314 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21315 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21316 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21317 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21318 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21319 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21320
21321 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21322 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21323
21324 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21325 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21326 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21327 program. For more information,
21328 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21329
21330 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21331 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21332 status information about the debugging process.
21333 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21334 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21335 remote protocol debug output.
21336 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
21337 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
21338 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
21339 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
21340 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21341
21342 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21343 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21344 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21345 Possible options are:
21346
21347 @table @code
21348 @item none
21349 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21350 @item all
21351 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21352 @item timestamps
21353 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21354 @end table
21355
21356 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21357 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21358
21359 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21360 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21361 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21362 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21363 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21364
21365 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21366 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21367 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21368 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21369
21370 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21371 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21372 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21373 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21374
21375 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21376 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21377 environment:
21378
21379 @smallexample
21380 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21384 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21385
21386 @smallexample
21387 $ gdbserver --selftest
21388 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21389 @end smallexample
21390
21391 These tests are disabled in release.
21392 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21393
21394 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21395 @itemize
21396
21397 @item
21398 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21399
21400 @item
21401 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21402 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21403 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21404 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21405 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21406 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21407
21408 @item
21409 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21410 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21411 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21412 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21413 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21414 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21415 program is already on the target.
21416
21417 @end itemize
21418
21419 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21420 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21421 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21422
21423 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21424 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21425 Here are the available commands.
21426
21427 @table @code
21428 @item monitor help
21429 List the available monitor commands.
21430
21431 @item monitor set debug 0
21432 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21433 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21434
21435 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21436 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21437 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21438 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21439
21440 @item monitor set debug-file filename
21441 @itemx monitor set debug-file
21442 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
21443
21444 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21445 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21446 Possible options are:
21447
21448 @table @code
21449 @item none
21450 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21451 @item all
21452 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21453 @item timestamps
21454 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21455 @end table
21456
21457 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21458 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21459
21460 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21461 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21462 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21463 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21464 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21465 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21466
21467 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21468 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21469
21470 @item monitor exit
21471 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21472 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21473 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21474 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21475 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21476
21477 @end table
21478
21479 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21480 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21481
21482 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21483 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21484
21485 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21486 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21487 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21488 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21489 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21490 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21491 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21492 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21493 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21494 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21495 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21496 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21497
21498 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21499
21500 @table @code
21501 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21502
21503 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21504 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21505 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21506
21507 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21508
21509 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21510 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21511 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21512 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21513 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21514 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21515
21516 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21517
21518 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21519 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21520 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21521 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21522 command for that. For example:
21523
21524 @smallexample
21525 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21526 @end smallexample
21527
21528 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21529 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21530 @end table
21531
21532 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21533 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21534 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21535 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21536 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21537 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21538 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21539 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21540 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21541 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21542
21543 @smallexample
21544 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21545 @end smallexample
21546
21547 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21548
21549 @smallexample
21550 $ gdb myprogram
21551 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21552 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21553 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21554 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21555 @end smallexample
21556
21557 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21558 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21559 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21560 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21561 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21562 tracing.
21563
21564 @node Remote Configuration
21565 @section Remote Configuration
21566
21567 @kindex set remote
21568 @kindex show remote
21569 This section documents the configuration options available when
21570 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21571 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21572 system-call-allowed}.
21573
21574 @table @code
21575 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21576 @cindex address size for remote targets
21577 @cindex bits in remote address
21578 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21579 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21580 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21581 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21582
21583 @item show remoteaddresssize
21584 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21585
21586 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21587 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21588 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21589 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21590 remote targets.
21591
21592 @item show serial baud
21593 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21594
21595 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21596 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21597 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21598
21599 @item show serial parity
21600 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21601
21602 @item set remotebreak
21603 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21604 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21605 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21606 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21607 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21608 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21609 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21610 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21611
21612 @item show remotebreak
21613 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21614 interrupt the remote program.
21615
21616 @item set remoteflow on
21617 @itemx set remoteflow off
21618 @kindex set remoteflow
21619 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21620 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21621
21622 @item show remoteflow
21623 @kindex show remoteflow
21624 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21625
21626 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21627 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21628 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21629 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21630 @code{ascii}.
21631
21632 @item show remotelogbase
21633 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21634 protocol.
21635
21636 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21637 @cindex record serial communications on file
21638 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21639 default is not to record at all.
21640
21641 @item show remotelogfile
21642 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21643 serial communications.
21644
21645 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21646 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21647 @cindex remote timeout
21648 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21649 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21650
21651 @item show remotetimeout
21652 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21653 responses.
21654
21655 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21656 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21657 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21658 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21659 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21660 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21661 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21662 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21663 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21664 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21665
21666 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21667 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21668 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21669 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21670
21671 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21672 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21673 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21674 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21675 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21676 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21677 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21678 length.
21679
21680 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21681 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21682 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21683
21684 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21685 @itemx show remote exec-file
21686 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21687 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21688 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21689 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21690 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21691 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21692
21693 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21694 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21695 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21696 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21697 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21698 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21699 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21700 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21701 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21702 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21703
21704 @item show interrupt-sequence
21705 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21706 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21707 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21708 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21709
21710 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21711 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21712 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21713 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21714 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21715 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21716
21717 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21718 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21719 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21720
21721 @kindex set tcp
21722 @kindex show tcp
21723 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21724 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21725 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21726 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21727 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21728 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21729 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21730 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21731 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21732
21733 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21734 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21735
21736 @item show tcp auto-retry
21737 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21738
21739 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21740 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21741 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21742 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21743 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21744 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21745 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21746 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21747 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21748 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21749 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21750
21751 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21752 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21753 @end table
21754
21755 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21756 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21757 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21758 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21759 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21760 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21761 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21762 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21763 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21764
21765 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21766 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21767 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21768 @value{GDBN} developers.
21769
21770 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21771 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21772 are:
21773
21774 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21775 @item Command Name
21776 @tab Remote Packet
21777 @tab Related Features
21778
21779 @item @code{fetch-register}
21780 @tab @code{p}
21781 @tab @code{info registers}
21782
21783 @item @code{set-register}
21784 @tab @code{P}
21785 @tab @code{set}
21786
21787 @item @code{binary-download}
21788 @tab @code{X}
21789 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21790
21791 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21792 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21793 @tab @code{info auxv}
21794
21795 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21796 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21797 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21798
21799 @item @code{attach}
21800 @tab @code{vAttach}
21801 @tab @code{attach}
21802
21803 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21804 @tab @code{vCont}
21805 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21806
21807 @item @code{run}
21808 @tab @code{vRun}
21809 @tab @code{run}
21810
21811 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21812 @tab @code{Z0}
21813 @tab @code{break}
21814
21815 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21816 @tab @code{Z1}
21817 @tab @code{hbreak}
21818
21819 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21820 @tab @code{Z2}
21821 @tab @code{watch}
21822
21823 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21824 @tab @code{Z3}
21825 @tab @code{rwatch}
21826
21827 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21828 @tab @code{Z4}
21829 @tab @code{awatch}
21830
21831 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21832 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21833 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21834
21835 @item @code{target-features}
21836 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21837 @tab @code{set architecture}
21838
21839 @item @code{library-info}
21840 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21841 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21842
21843 @item @code{memory-map}
21844 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21845 @tab @code{info mem}
21846
21847 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21848 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21849 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21850
21851 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21852 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21853 @tab @code{info spu}
21854
21855 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21856 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21857 @tab @code{info spu}
21858
21859 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21860 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21861 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21862
21863 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21864 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21865 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21866
21867 @item @code{threads}
21868 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21869 @tab @code{info threads}
21870
21871 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21872 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21873 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21874
21875 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21876 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21877 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21878
21879 @item @code{search-memory}
21880 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21881 @tab @code{find}
21882
21883 @item @code{supported-packets}
21884 @tab @code{qSupported}
21885 @tab Remote communications parameters
21886
21887 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21888 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21889 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21890
21891 @item @code{pass-signals}
21892 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21893 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21894
21895 @item @code{program-signals}
21896 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21897 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21898
21899 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21900 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21901 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21902
21903 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21904 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21905 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21906
21907 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21908 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21909 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21910
21911 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21912 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21913 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21914
21915 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21916 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21917 @tab @code{remote delete}
21918
21919 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21920 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21921 @tab Host I/O
21922
21923 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21924 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21925 @tab Host I/O
21926
21927 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21928 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21929 @tab Host I/O
21930
21931 @item @code{noack-packet}
21932 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21933 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21934
21935 @item @code{osdata}
21936 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21937 @tab @code{info os}
21938
21939 @item @code{query-attached}
21940 @tab @code{qAttached}
21941 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21942
21943 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21944 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21945 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21946
21947 @item @code{trace-status}
21948 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21949 @tab @code{tstatus}
21950
21951 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21952 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21953 @tab Traceframe info
21954
21955 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21956 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21957 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21958
21959 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21960 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21961 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21962
21963 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21964 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21965 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21966
21967 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21968 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21969 @tab @code{set environment}
21970
21971 @item @code{environment-unset}
21972 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21973 @tab @code{unset environment}
21974
21975 @item @code{environment-reset}
21976 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21977 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21978
21979 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21980 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21981 @tab @code{set cwd}
21982
21983 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21984 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21985 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21986
21987 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21988 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21989 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21990
21991 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21992 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21993 @tab @code{break}
21994
21995 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21996 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21997 @tab @code{hbreak}
21998
21999 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
22000 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
22001 @tab @code{fork}
22002
22003 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
22004 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
22005 @tab @code{vfork}
22006
22007 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
22008 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22009 @tab @code{exec}
22010
22011 @item @code{thread-events}
22012 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22013 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22014
22015 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22016 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22017 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22018
22019 @end multitable
22020
22021 @node Remote Stub
22022 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22023
22024 @cindex debugging stub, example
22025 @cindex remote stub, example
22026 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22027 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22028 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22029 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22030 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22031 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22032 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22033 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22034
22035 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22036 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22037 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22038 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22039 program, you need:
22040
22041 @enumerate
22042 @item
22043 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22044 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22045 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22046
22047 @item
22048 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22049 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22050
22051 @item
22052 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22053 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22054 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22055 documentation.
22056 @end enumerate
22057
22058 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22059 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22060 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22061
22062 @table @emph
22063 @item On the host,
22064 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22065 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22066 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22067
22068 @item On the target,
22069 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22070 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22071 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22072
22073 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22074 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22075 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22076 @end table
22077
22078 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22079 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22080 @sc{sparc} boards.
22081
22082 @cindex remote serial stub list
22083 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22084
22085 @table @code
22086
22087 @item i386-stub.c
22088 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22089 @cindex Intel
22090 @cindex i386
22091 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22092
22093 @item m68k-stub.c
22094 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22095 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22096 @cindex m680x0
22097 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22098
22099 @item sh-stub.c
22100 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22101 @cindex Renesas
22102 @cindex SH
22103 For Renesas SH architectures.
22104
22105 @item sparc-stub.c
22106 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22107 @cindex Sparc
22108 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22109
22110 @item sparcl-stub.c
22111 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22112 @cindex Fujitsu
22113 @cindex SparcLite
22114 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22115
22116 @end table
22117
22118 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22119 recently added stubs.
22120
22121 @menu
22122 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22123 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22124 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22125 @end menu
22126
22127 @node Stub Contents
22128 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22129
22130 @cindex remote serial stub
22131 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22132 subroutines:
22133
22134 @table @code
22135 @item set_debug_traps
22136 @findex set_debug_traps
22137 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22138 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22139 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22140 program's startup code.
22141
22142 @item handle_exception
22143 @findex handle_exception
22144 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22145 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22146 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22147 run when a trap is triggered.
22148
22149 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22150 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22151 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22152 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22153 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22154 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22155 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22156 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22157 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22158 machine.
22159
22160 @item breakpoint
22161 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22162 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22163 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22164 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22165 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22166 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22167 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22168 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22169 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22170 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22171 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22172
22173 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22174 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22175 start of your debugging session.
22176 @end table
22177
22178 @node Bootstrapping
22179 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22180
22181 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22182 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22183 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22184 debugging target machine.
22185
22186 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22187 serial port.
22188
22189 @table @code
22190 @item int getDebugChar()
22191 @findex getDebugChar
22192 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22193 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22194 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22195
22196 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22197 @findex putDebugChar
22198 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22199 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22200 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22201 @end table
22202
22203 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22204 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22205 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22206 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22207 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22208 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22209 remote system to stop.
22210
22211 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22212 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22213 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22214 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22215
22216 Other routines you need to supply are:
22217
22218 @table @code
22219 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22220 @findex exceptionHandler
22221 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22222 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22223 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22224 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22225 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22226 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22227 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22228 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22229 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22230 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22231 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22232 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22233 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22234
22235 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22236 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22237 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22238 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22239 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22240
22241 @item void flush_i_cache()
22242 @findex flush_i_cache
22243 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22244 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22245 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22246
22247 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22248 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22249 @end table
22250
22251 @noindent
22252 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22253
22254 @table @code
22255 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22256 @findex memset
22257 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22258 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22259 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22260 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22261 @end table
22262
22263 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22264 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22265 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22266 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22267
22268
22269 @node Debug Session
22270 @subsection Putting it All Together
22271
22272 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22273 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22274 steps.
22275
22276 @enumerate
22277 @item
22278 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22279 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22280 @display
22281 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22282 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22283 @end display
22284
22285 @item
22286 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22287 procedure is called:
22288
22289 @smallexample
22290 set_debug_traps();
22291 breakpoint();
22292 @end smallexample
22293
22294 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22295 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22296 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22297 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22298 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22299 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22300 progress.
22301
22302 @item
22303 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22304 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22305
22306 @smallexample
22307 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22308 @end smallexample
22309
22310 @noindent
22311 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22312 function in your program, that function is called when
22313 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22314 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22315 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22316
22317 @item
22318 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22319 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22320
22321 @item
22322 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22323 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22324
22325 @item
22326 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22327 @c document that. FIXME.
22328 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22329 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22330
22331 @item
22332 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22333 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22334
22335 @end enumerate
22336
22337 @node Configurations
22338 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22339
22340 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22341 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22342 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22343
22344 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22345 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22346 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22347 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22348 are quite different from each other.
22349
22350 @menu
22351 * Native::
22352 * Embedded OS::
22353 * Embedded Processors::
22354 * Architectures::
22355 @end menu
22356
22357 @node Native
22358 @section Native
22359
22360 This section describes details specific to particular native
22361 configurations.
22362
22363 @menu
22364 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22365 * Process Information:: Process information
22366 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22367 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22368 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22369 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22370 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
22371 @end menu
22372
22373 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22374 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22375
22376 @cindex libkvm
22377 @cindex kernel memory image
22378 @cindex kernel crash dump
22379
22380 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22381 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22382 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22383 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22384 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22385 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22386 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22387 @code{kvm} target:
22388
22389 @smallexample
22390 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22391 @end smallexample
22392
22393 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22394 argument:
22395
22396 @smallexample
22397 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22398 @end smallexample
22399
22400 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22401 available:
22402
22403 @table @code
22404 @kindex kvm
22405 @item kvm pcb
22406 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22407
22408 @item kvm proc
22409 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22410 modern FreeBSD systems.
22411 @end table
22412
22413 @node Process Information
22414 @subsection Process Information
22415 @cindex /proc
22416 @cindex examine process image
22417 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22418
22419 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22420 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22421 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22422 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22423 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22424 any process running on your system.
22425
22426 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22427 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22428 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22429 systems.
22430
22431 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22432 information.
22433
22434 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22435 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22436 information available from a live process. Process information is
22437 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22438 systems.
22439
22440 @table @code
22441 @kindex info proc
22442 @cindex process ID
22443 @item info proc
22444 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22445 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22446 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22447 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22448 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22449 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22450 executable file's absolute file name.
22451
22452 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22453 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22454 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22455 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22456 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22457 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22458
22459 @item info proc cmdline
22460 @cindex info proc cmdline
22461 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22462 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22463
22464 @item info proc cwd
22465 @cindex info proc cwd
22466 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22467 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22468
22469 @item info proc exe
22470 @cindex info proc exe
22471 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22472 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22473
22474 @item info proc files
22475 @cindex info proc files
22476 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22477 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22478 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22479 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22480 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22481 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22482 FreeBSD.
22483
22484 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22485 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22486
22487 @smallexample
22488 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22489 process 22136
22490 Open files:
22491
22492 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22493 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22494 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22495 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22496 root dir - r-------- /
22497 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22498 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22499 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22500 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22501 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22502 @end smallexample
22503
22504 @item info proc mappings
22505 @cindex memory address space mappings
22506 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22507 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22508 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22509 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22510 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22511
22512 @item info proc stat
22513 @itemx info proc status
22514 @cindex process detailed status information
22515 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22516 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22517 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22518 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22519 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22520
22521 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22522 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22523
22524 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22525 proc status}.
22526
22527 @item info proc all
22528 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22529 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22530
22531 @ignore
22532 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22533 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22534 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22535 @kindex info proc times
22536 @item info proc times
22537 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22538 its children.
22539
22540 @kindex info proc id
22541 @item info proc id
22542 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22543 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22544 @end ignore
22545
22546 @item set procfs-trace
22547 @kindex set procfs-trace
22548 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22549 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22550
22551 @item show procfs-trace
22552 @kindex show procfs-trace
22553 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22554
22555 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22556 @kindex set procfs-file
22557 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22558 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22559 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22560 standard output.
22561
22562 @item show procfs-file
22563 @kindex show procfs-file
22564 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22565
22566 @item proc-trace-entry
22567 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22568 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22569 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22570 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22571 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22572 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22573 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22574 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22575 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22576
22577 @item info pidlist
22578 @kindex info pidlist
22579 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22580 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22581 processes and all the threads within each process.
22582
22583 @item info meminfo
22584 @kindex info meminfo
22585 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22586 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22587 @end table
22588
22589 @node DJGPP Native
22590 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22591 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22592 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22593 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22594
22595 @cindex DPMI
22596 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22597 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22598 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22599 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22600
22601 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22602 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22603 subsection describes those commands.
22604
22605 @table @code
22606 @kindex info dos
22607 @item info dos
22608 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22609 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22610
22611 @kindex sysinfo
22612 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22613 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22614 @item info dos sysinfo
22615 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22616 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22617 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22618
22619 @cindex GDT
22620 @cindex LDT
22621 @cindex IDT
22622 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22623 @cindex descriptor tables display
22624 @item info dos gdt
22625 @itemx info dos ldt
22626 @itemx info dos idt
22627 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22628 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22629 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22630 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22631 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22632 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22633 rights.
22634
22635 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22636 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22637 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22638 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22639 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22640
22641 @cindex garbled pointers
22642 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22643 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22644 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22645 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22646 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22647 debugged program's data segment:
22648
22649 @smallexample
22650 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22651 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22652 @end smallexample
22653
22654 @noindent
22655 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22656 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22657
22658 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22659 @item info dos pde
22660 @itemx info dos pte
22661 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22662 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22663 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22664 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22665 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22666 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22667 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22668 that is currently in use.
22669
22670 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22671 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22672 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22673 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22674 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22675 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22676 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22677
22678 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22679 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22680 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22681 controller.
22682
22683 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22684
22685 @cindex physical address from linear address
22686 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22687 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22688 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22689 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22690 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22691 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22692 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22693
22694 @smallexample
22695 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22696 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22697 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22698 @end smallexample
22699
22700 @noindent
22701 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22702 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22703 attributes of that page.
22704
22705 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22706 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22707 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22708 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22709 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22710 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22711
22712 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22713 transfer buffer:
22714
22715 @smallexample
22716 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22717 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22718 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22719 @end smallexample
22720
22721 @noindent
22722 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22723 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22724 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22725 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22726 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22727
22728 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22729 @end table
22730
22731 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22732 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22733 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22734 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22735
22736 @table @code
22737 @kindex set com1base
22738 @kindex set com1irq
22739 @kindex set com2base
22740 @kindex set com2irq
22741 @kindex set com3base
22742 @kindex set com3irq
22743 @kindex set com4base
22744 @kindex set com4irq
22745 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22746 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22747 port.
22748
22749 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22750 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22751 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22752
22753 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22754 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22755 other 3 COM ports.
22756
22757 @kindex show com1base
22758 @kindex show com1irq
22759 @kindex show com2base
22760 @kindex show com2irq
22761 @kindex show com3base
22762 @kindex show com3irq
22763 @kindex show com4base
22764 @kindex show com4irq
22765 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22766 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22767 lines used by the COM ports.
22768
22769 @item info serial
22770 @kindex info serial
22771 @cindex DOS serial port status
22772 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22773 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22774 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22775 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22776 @end table
22777
22778
22779 @node Cygwin Native
22780 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22781 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22782 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22783 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22784
22785 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22786 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22787
22788 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22789 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22790 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22791 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22792 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22793 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22794 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22795 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22796
22797 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22798 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22799 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22800
22801 @table @code
22802 @kindex info w32
22803 @item info w32
22804 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22805 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22806
22807 @item info w32 selector
22808 This command displays information returned by
22809 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22810 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22811 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22812 Without argument, this command displays information
22813 about the six segment registers.
22814
22815 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22816 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22817 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22818 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22819
22820 @kindex signal-event
22821 @item signal-event @var{id}
22822 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22823 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22824
22825 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22826 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22827 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22828 (for x86_64 versions):
22829
22830 @itemize @minus
22831 @item
22832 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22833 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22834 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22835
22836 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22837 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22838 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22839 to attach.
22840
22841 @item
22842 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22843 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22844 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22845 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22846 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22847 @end itemize
22848
22849 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22850 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22851 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22852 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22853 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22854 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22855 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22856 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22857 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22858 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22859 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22860
22861 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22862 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22863 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22864 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22865
22866 @kindex set new-console
22867 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22868 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22869 be started in a new console on next start.
22870 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22871 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22872
22873 @kindex show new-console
22874 @item show new-console
22875 Displays whether a new console is used
22876 when the debuggee is started.
22877
22878 @kindex set new-group
22879 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22880 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22881 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22882 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22883 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22884
22885 @kindex show new-group
22886 @item show new-group
22887 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22888
22889 @kindex set debugevents
22890 @item set debugevents
22891 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22892 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22893 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22894 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22895 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22896
22897 @kindex set debugexec
22898 @item set debugexec
22899 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22900 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22901
22902 @kindex set debugexceptions
22903 @item set debugexceptions
22904 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22905 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22906
22907 @kindex set debugmemory
22908 @item set debugmemory
22909 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22910 and writes by the debugger.
22911
22912 @kindex set shell
22913 @item set shell
22914 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22915 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22916
22917 @kindex show shell
22918 @item show shell
22919 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22920
22921 @end table
22922
22923 @menu
22924 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22925 @end menu
22926
22927 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22928 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22929 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22930 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22931
22932 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22933 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22934 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22935 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22936 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22937 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22938 ``minimal symbols''.
22939
22940 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22941 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22942 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22943 program run once to completion.
22944
22945 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22946
22947 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22948 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22949 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22950 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22951 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22952 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22953 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22954 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22955 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22956
22957 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22958 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22959 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22960 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22961 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22962 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22963
22964 @smallexample
22965 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22966 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22967
22968 Non-debugging symbols:
22969 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22970 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22971 @end smallexample
22972
22973 @smallexample
22974 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22975 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22976
22977 Non-debugging symbols:
22978 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22979 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22980 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22981 [etc...]
22982 @end smallexample
22983
22984 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22985
22986 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22987 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22988 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22989 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22990 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22991 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22992 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22993
22994 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22995 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22996 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22997 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22998 problem:
22999
23000 @smallexample
23001 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
23002 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23003 @end smallexample
23004
23005 @smallexample
23006 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
23007 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23008 @end smallexample
23009
23010 And two possible solutions:
23011
23012 @smallexample
23013 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23014 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23015 @end smallexample
23016
23017 @smallexample
23018 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23019 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23020 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23021 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23022 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23023 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23024 @end smallexample
23025
23026 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23027 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23028 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23029 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23030 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23031
23032 @smallexample
23033 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23034 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23035 @end smallexample
23036
23037 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23038 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23039 safe.
23040
23041 @node Hurd Native
23042 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23043 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23044
23045 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23046 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23047
23048 @table @code
23049 @item set signals
23050 @itemx set sigs
23051 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23052 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23053 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23054 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23055 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23056 @code{signals}.
23057
23058 @item show signals
23059 @itemx show sigs
23060 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23061 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23062 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23063
23064 @item set signal-thread
23065 @itemx set sigthread
23066 @kindex set signal-thread
23067 @kindex set sigthread
23068 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23069 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23070 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23071 signal-thread}.
23072
23073 @item show signal-thread
23074 @itemx show sigthread
23075 @kindex show signal-thread
23076 @kindex show sigthread
23077 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23078 delivered a signal.
23079
23080 @item set stopped
23081 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23082 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23083 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23084 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23085
23086 @item show stopped
23087 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23088 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23089 stopped.
23090
23091 @item set exceptions
23092 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23093 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23094 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23095 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23096 trapping on.
23097
23098 @item show exceptions
23099 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23100 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23101
23102 @item set task pause
23103 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23104 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23105 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23106 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23107 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23108 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23109 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23110 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23111 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23112
23113 @item show task pause
23114 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23115 Show the current state of task suspension.
23116
23117 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23118 @cindex task suspend count
23119 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23120 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23121 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23122
23123 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23124 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23125
23126 @item set task exception-port
23127 @itemx set task excp
23128 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23129 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23130 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23131 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23132
23133 @item set noninvasive
23134 @cindex noninvasive task options
23135 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23136 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23137 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23138 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23139
23140 @item info send-rights
23141 @itemx info receive-rights
23142 @itemx info port-rights
23143 @itemx info port-sets
23144 @itemx info dead-names
23145 @itemx info ports
23146 @itemx info psets
23147 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23148 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23149 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23150 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23151 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23152 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23153 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23154 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23155 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23156
23157 @item set thread pause
23158 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23159 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23160 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23161 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23162 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23163 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23164 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23165 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23166 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23167 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23168 only the current thread.
23169
23170 @item show thread pause
23171 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23172 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23173
23174 @item set thread run
23175 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23176
23177 @item show thread run
23178 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23179
23180 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23181 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23182 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23183 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23184 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23185 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23186 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23187
23188 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23189 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23190 detaching.
23191
23192 @item set thread exception-port
23193 @itemx set thread excp
23194 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23195 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23196 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23197
23198 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23199 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23200 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23201 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23202
23203 @item set thread default
23204 @itemx show thread default
23205 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23206 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23207 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23208 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23209 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23210 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23211 the non-default commands.
23212 @end table
23213
23214 @node Darwin
23215 @subsection Darwin
23216 @cindex Darwin
23217
23218 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23219
23220 @table @code
23221 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23222 @kindex set debug darwin
23223 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23224 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23225
23226 @item show debug darwin
23227 @kindex show debug darwin
23228 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23229
23230 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23231 @kindex set debug mach-o
23232 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23233 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23234 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23235 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23236 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23237 usage.
23238
23239 @item show debug mach-o
23240 @kindex show debug mach-o
23241 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23242
23243 @item set mach-exceptions on
23244 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23245 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23246 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23247 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23248 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23249 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23250
23251 @item show mach-exceptions
23252 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23253 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23254 @end table
23255
23256 @node FreeBSD
23257 @subsection FreeBSD
23258 @cindex FreeBSD
23259
23260 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23261 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23262 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23263 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23264 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23265 are also caught.
23266
23267 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23268 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23269 both variants:
23270
23271 @smallexample
23272 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23273 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23274 (@value{GDBP})
23275 @end smallexample
23276
23277
23278 @node Embedded OS
23279 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23280
23281 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23282 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23283 architectures.
23284
23285 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23286 various real-time operating systems.
23287
23288 @node Embedded Processors
23289 @section Embedded Processors
23290
23291 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23292 configurations.
23293
23294 @cindex send command to simulator
23295 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23296 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23297
23298 @table @code
23299 @item sim @var{command}
23300 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23301 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23302 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23303 acceptable commands.
23304 @end table
23305
23306
23307 @menu
23308 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23309 * ARM:: ARM
23310 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23311 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23312 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23313 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23314 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23315 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23316 * CRIS:: CRIS
23317 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23318 @end menu
23319
23320 @node ARC
23321 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23322 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23323 @cindex ARC specific commands
23324 @cindex ARC600
23325 @cindex ARC700
23326 @cindex ARC EM
23327 @cindex ARC HS
23328
23329 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23330
23331 @table @code
23332 @item set debug arc
23333 @kindex set debug arc
23334 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23335 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23336
23337 @item show debug arc
23338 @kindex show debug arc
23339 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23340
23341 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23342 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23343 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23344
23345 @end table
23346
23347 @node ARM
23348 @subsection ARM
23349
23350 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23351
23352 @table @code
23353 @item set arm disassembler
23354 @kindex set arm
23355 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23356 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23357
23358 @item show arm disassembler
23359 @kindex show arm
23360 Show the current disassembly style.
23361
23362 @item set arm apcs32
23363 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23364 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23365
23366 @item show arm apcs32
23367 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23368
23369 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23370 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23371 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23372
23373 @table @code
23374 @item auto
23375 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23376 @item softfpa
23377 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23378 processors.
23379 @item fpa
23380 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23381 @item softvfp
23382 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23383 @item vfp
23384 VFP co-processor.
23385 @end table
23386
23387 @item show arm fpu
23388 Show the current type of the FPU.
23389
23390 @item set arm abi
23391 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23392
23393 @item show arm abi
23394 Show the currently used ABI.
23395
23396 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23397 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23398 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23399 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23400 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23401 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23402 register).
23403
23404 @item show arm fallback-mode
23405 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23406
23407 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23408 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23409 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23410 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23411 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23412
23413 @item show arm force-mode
23414 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23415
23416 @item set debug arm
23417 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23418 target support subsystem.
23419
23420 @item show debug arm
23421 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23422 @end table
23423
23424 @table @code
23425 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23426 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23427
23428 @table @code
23429 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23430 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23431 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23432 The default value is @code{all}.
23433
23434 @table @code
23435 @item none
23436 @item demon
23437 @item angel
23438 @item redboot
23439 @item all
23440 @end table
23441 @end table
23442 @end table
23443
23444 @node M68K
23445 @subsection M68k
23446
23447 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23448
23449 @node MicroBlaze
23450 @subsection MicroBlaze
23451 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23452 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23453
23454 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23455 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23456 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23457 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23458 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23459 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23460 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23461 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23462 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23463 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23464 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23465
23466 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23467
23468 @table @code
23469 @item target remote :1234
23470 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23471 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23472
23473 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23474 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23475 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23476
23477 @item load
23478 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23479
23480 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23481 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23482
23483 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23484 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23485 @end table
23486
23487 @node MIPS Embedded
23488 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23489
23490 @noindent
23491 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23492
23493 @table @code
23494 @item set mipsfpu double
23495 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23496 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23497 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23498 @itemx show mipsfpu
23499 @kindex set mipsfpu
23500 @kindex show mipsfpu
23501 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23502 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23503 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23504 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23505 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23506 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23507 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23508 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23509 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23510 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23511 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23512 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23513 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23514
23515 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23516 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23517 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23518
23519 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23520 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23521 @end table
23522
23523 @node OpenRISC 1000
23524 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23525 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23526
23527 @noindent
23528 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23529 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23530 FPGA's.
23531
23532 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23533 a target:
23534
23535 @table @code
23536
23537 @kindex target sim
23538 @item target sim
23539
23540 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23541 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23542 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23543 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23544
23545 Example: @code{target sim}
23546
23547 @item set debug or1k
23548 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23549 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23550
23551 @item show debug or1k
23552 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23553 @end table
23554
23555 @node PowerPC Embedded
23556 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23557
23558 @cindex DVC register
23559 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23560 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23561
23562 @smallexample
23563 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23564 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23565 @end smallexample
23566
23567 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23568 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23569 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23570 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23571 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23572 or newer.
23573
23574 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23575 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23576 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23577 watching variables of scalar types.
23578
23579 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23580 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23581
23582 @smallexample
23583 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23584 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23585 @end smallexample
23586
23587 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23588 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23589
23590 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23591 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23592 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23593 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23594 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23595 use the @code{break-range} command.
23596
23597 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23598
23599 @table @code
23600 @kindex break-range
23601 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23602 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23603 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23604 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23605 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23606 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23607 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23608 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23609 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23610
23611 @kindex set powerpc
23612 @item set powerpc soft-float
23613 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23614 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23615 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23616 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23617
23618 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23619 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23620 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23621 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23622 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23623 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23624 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23625 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23626
23627 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23628 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23629 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23630 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23631 address of its first byte.
23632
23633 @end table
23634
23635 @node AVR
23636 @subsection Atmel AVR
23637 @cindex AVR
23638
23639 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23640 following AVR-specific commands:
23641
23642 @table @code
23643 @item info io_registers
23644 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23645 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23646 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23647 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23648 @end table
23649
23650 @node CRIS
23651 @subsection CRIS
23652 @cindex CRIS
23653
23654 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23655 following CRIS-specific commands:
23656
23657 @table @code
23658 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23659 @cindex CRIS version
23660 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23661 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23662 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23663
23664 @item show cris-version
23665 Show the current CRIS version.
23666
23667 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23668 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23669 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23670 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23671 @code{R59}.
23672
23673 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23674 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23675
23676 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23677 @cindex CRIS mode
23678 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23679 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23680 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23681
23682 @item show cris-mode
23683 Show the current CRIS mode.
23684 @end table
23685
23686 @node Super-H
23687 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23688 @cindex Super-H
23689
23690 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23691 commands:
23692
23693 @table @code
23694 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23695 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23696 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23697 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23698 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23699 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23700 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23701 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23702 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23703 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23704 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23705 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23706
23707 @item show sh calling-convention
23708 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23709 Show the current calling convention setting.
23710
23711 @end table
23712
23713
23714 @node Architectures
23715 @section Architectures
23716
23717 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23718 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23719
23720 @menu
23721 * AArch64::
23722 * i386::
23723 * Alpha::
23724 * MIPS::
23725 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23726 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23727 * PowerPC::
23728 * Nios II::
23729 * Sparc64::
23730 * S12Z::
23731 @end menu
23732
23733 @node AArch64
23734 @subsection AArch64
23735 @cindex AArch64 support
23736
23737 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23738 following special commands:
23739
23740 @table @code
23741 @item set debug aarch64
23742 @kindex set debug aarch64
23743 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23744 messages are to be displayed.
23745
23746 @item show debug aarch64
23747 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23748
23749 @end table
23750
23751 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23752 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23753
23754 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23755 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23756 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23757 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23758 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23759 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23760
23761 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23762 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23763 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23764 target process.
23765
23766
23767 @node i386
23768 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23769
23770 @table @code
23771 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23772 @kindex set struct-convention
23773 @cindex struct return convention
23774 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23775 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23776 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23777 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23778 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23779 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23780 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23781 be returned in a register.
23782
23783 @item show struct-convention
23784 @kindex show struct-convention
23785 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23786 from functions.
23787 @end table
23788
23789
23790 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23791 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23792
23793 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23794 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23795 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23796 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23797 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23798 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23799 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23800
23801 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23802 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23803 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23804 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23805 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23806 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23807
23808 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23809 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23810 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23811
23812 @smallexample
23813 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23814 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23815 @end smallexample
23816
23817 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23818 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23819 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23820 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23821 the pointer.
23822
23823 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23824 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23825 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23826 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23827 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23828
23829 @table @code
23830 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23831 @kindex show mpx bound
23832 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23833
23834 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23835 @kindex set mpx bound
23836 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23837 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23838 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23839 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23840 @end table
23841
23842 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23843 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23844 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23845 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23846
23847 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23848 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23849 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23850 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23851 function.
23852
23853 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23854 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23855 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23856 continuing the execution. For example:
23857
23858 @smallexample
23859 $ break *upper
23860 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23861 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23862 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23863 $ print $bnd0
23864 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23865 @end smallexample
23866
23867 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23868 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23869 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23870
23871 @node Alpha
23872 @subsection Alpha
23873
23874 See the following section.
23875
23876 @node MIPS
23877 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23878
23879 @cindex stack on Alpha
23880 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23881 @cindex Alpha stack
23882 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23883 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23884 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23885 find the beginning of a function.
23886
23887 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23888 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23889 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23890 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23891 commands:
23892
23893 @table @code
23894 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23895 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23896 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23897 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23898 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23899 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23900 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23901 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23902
23903 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23904 Display the current limit.
23905 @end table
23906
23907 @noindent
23908 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23909 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23910
23911 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23912 programs:
23913
23914 @table @code
23915 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23916 @kindex set mips abi
23917 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23918 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23919 values of @var{arg} are:
23920
23921 @table @samp
23922 @item auto
23923 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23924 default).
23925 @item o32
23926 @item o64
23927 @item n32
23928 @item n64
23929 @item eabi32
23930 @item eabi64
23931 @end table
23932
23933 @item show mips abi
23934 @kindex show mips abi
23935 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23936
23937 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23938 @kindex set mips compression
23939 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23940 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23941 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23942 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23943 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23944 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23945 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23946 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23947 provided by the executable.
23948
23949 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23950 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23951 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23952 identified as such.
23953
23954 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23955 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23956 implicitly from an executable.
23957
23958 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23959 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23960 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23961 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23962 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23963
23964 @item show mips compression
23965 @kindex show mips compression
23966 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23967 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23968
23969 @item set mipsfpu
23970 @itemx show mipsfpu
23971 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23972
23973 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23974 @kindex set mips mask-address
23975 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23976 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23977 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23978 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23979 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23980
23981 @item show mips mask-address
23982 @kindex show mips mask-address
23983 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23984 not.
23985
23986 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23987 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23988 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23989 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23990 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23991 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23992
23993 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23994 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23995 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23996
23997 @item set debug mips
23998 @kindex set debug mips
23999 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
24000 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24001
24002 @item show debug mips
24003 @kindex show debug mips
24004 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
24005 @end table
24006
24007
24008 @node HPPA
24009 @subsection HPPA
24010 @cindex HPPA support
24011
24012 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24013 following special commands:
24014
24015 @table @code
24016 @item set debug hppa
24017 @kindex set debug hppa
24018 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24019 messages are to be displayed.
24020
24021 @item show debug hppa
24022 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24023
24024 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24025 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24026 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24027 given @var{address}.
24028
24029 @end table
24030
24031
24032 @node SPU
24033 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24034 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24035 @cindex SPU
24036
24037 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24038 it provides the following special commands:
24039
24040 @table @code
24041 @item info spu event
24042 @kindex info spu
24043 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24044 and pending event status.
24045
24046 @item info spu signal
24047 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24048 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24049 notification channels.
24050
24051 @item info spu mailbox
24052 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24053 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24054 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24055
24056 @item info spu dma
24057 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24058 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24059 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24060
24061 @item info spu proxydma
24062 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24063 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24064 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24065
24066 @end table
24067
24068 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24069 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24070 special commands:
24071
24072 @table @code
24073 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24074 @kindex set spu
24075 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24076 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24077 function. The default is @code{off}.
24078
24079 @item show spu stop-on-load
24080 @kindex show spu
24081 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24082
24083 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24084 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24085 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24086 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24087 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24088 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24089
24090 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24091 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24092
24093 @end table
24094
24095 @node PowerPC
24096 @subsection PowerPC
24097 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24098
24099 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24100 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24101 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24102 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24103 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24104
24105 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24106 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24107 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24108
24109 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24110 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24111
24112 @node Nios II
24113 @subsection Nios II
24114 @cindex Nios II architecture
24115
24116 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24117 it provides the following special commands:
24118
24119 @table @code
24120
24121 @item set debug nios2
24122 @kindex set debug nios2
24123 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24124 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24125
24126 @item show debug nios2
24127 @kindex show debug nios2
24128 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24129 @end table
24130
24131 @node Sparc64
24132 @subsection Sparc64
24133 @cindex Sparc64 support
24134 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24135 @subsubsection ADI Support
24136
24137 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24138 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24139 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24140 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24141 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24142 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24143 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24144 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24145 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24146 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24147 signal.
24148
24149 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24150 ADI-enabled.
24151
24152 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24153 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24154
24155
24156 @table @code
24157 @kindex adi examine
24158 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24159
24160 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24161 cacheline.
24162
24163 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24164 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24165 block size, to display.
24166
24167 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24168 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24169
24170 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24171
24172 @smallexample
24173 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24174 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24175 @end smallexample
24176
24177 @kindex adi assign
24178 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24179
24180 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24181 to an address.
24182
24183 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24184 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24185 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24186
24187 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24188 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24189
24190 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24191
24192 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24193 variable "shmaddr":
24194
24195 @smallexample
24196 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24197 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24198 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24199 @end smallexample
24200
24201 @end table
24202
24203 @node S12Z
24204 @subsection S12Z
24205 @cindex S12Z support
24206
24207 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24208 it provides the following special command:
24209
24210 @table @code
24211 @item maint info bdccsr
24212 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24213 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24214 BDCCSR register.
24215 @end table
24216
24217
24218 @node Controlling GDB
24219 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24220
24221 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24222 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24223 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24224 described here.
24225
24226 @menu
24227 * Prompt:: Prompt
24228 * Editing:: Command editing
24229 * Command History:: Command history
24230 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24231 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24232 * Numbers:: Numbers
24233 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24234 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24235 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24236 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24237 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24238 @end menu
24239
24240 @node Prompt
24241 @section Prompt
24242
24243 @cindex prompt
24244
24245 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24246 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24247 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24248 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24249 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24250 which one you are talking to.
24251
24252 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24253 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24254 or a prompt that does not.
24255
24256 @table @code
24257 @kindex set prompt
24258 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24259 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24260
24261 @kindex show prompt
24262 @item show prompt
24263 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24264 @end table
24265
24266 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24267 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24268 are:
24269
24270 @table @code
24271 @kindex set extended-prompt
24272 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24273 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24274 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24275 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24276 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24277 is displayed.
24278
24279 For example:
24280
24281 @smallexample
24282 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24283 @end smallexample
24284
24285 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24286 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24287
24288 @kindex show extended-prompt
24289 @item show extended-prompt
24290 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24291 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24292 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24293 @end table
24294
24295 @node Editing
24296 @section Command Editing
24297 @cindex readline
24298 @cindex command line editing
24299
24300 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24301 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24302 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24303 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24304 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24305 debugging sessions.
24306
24307 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24308 command @code{set}.
24309
24310 @table @code
24311 @kindex set editing
24312 @cindex editing
24313 @item set editing
24314 @itemx set editing on
24315 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24316
24317 @item set editing off
24318 Disable command line editing.
24319
24320 @kindex show editing
24321 @item show editing
24322 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24323 @end table
24324
24325 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24326 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24327 @end ifset
24328 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24329 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24330 @end ifclear
24331 for more details about the Readline
24332 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24333 encouraged to read that chapter.
24334
24335 @node Command History
24336 @section Command History
24337 @cindex command history
24338
24339 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24340 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24341 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24342 history facility.
24343
24344 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24345 package, to provide the history facility.
24346 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24347 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24348 @end ifset
24349 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24350 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24351 @end ifclear
24352 for the detailed description of the History library.
24353
24354 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24355 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24356 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24357 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24358 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24359 pressed on a line by itself.
24360
24361 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24362 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24363 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24364 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24365
24366 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24367 history.
24368
24369 @table @code
24370 @cindex history substitution
24371 @cindex history file
24372 @kindex set history filename
24373 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24374 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24375 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24376 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24377 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24378 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24379 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24380 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24381 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24382 is not set.
24383
24384 @cindex save command history
24385 @kindex set history save
24386 @item set history save
24387 @itemx set history save on
24388 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24389 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24390
24391 @item set history save off
24392 Stop recording command history in a file.
24393
24394 @cindex history size
24395 @kindex set history size
24396 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24397 @item set history size @var{size}
24398 @itemx set history size unlimited
24399 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24400 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24401 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24402 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24403 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24404 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24405
24406 @cindex remove duplicate history
24407 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24408 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24409 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24410 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24411 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24412 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24413 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24414 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24415 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24416
24417 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24418 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24419
24420 @end table
24421
24422 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24423 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24424 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24425 @end ifset
24426 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24427 @xref{Event Designators},
24428 @end ifclear
24429 for more details.
24430
24431 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24432 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24433 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24434 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24435 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24436 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24437 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24438 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24439
24440 The commands to control history expansion are:
24441
24442 @table @code
24443 @item set history expansion on
24444 @itemx set history expansion
24445 @kindex set history expansion
24446 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24447
24448 @item set history expansion off
24449 Disable history expansion.
24450
24451 @c @group
24452 @kindex show history
24453 @item show history
24454 @itemx show history filename
24455 @itemx show history save
24456 @itemx show history size
24457 @itemx show history expansion
24458 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24459 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24460 @c @end group
24461 @end table
24462
24463 @table @code
24464 @kindex show commands
24465 @cindex show last commands
24466 @cindex display command history
24467 @item show commands
24468 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24469
24470 @item show commands @var{n}
24471 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24472
24473 @item show commands +
24474 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24475 @end table
24476
24477 @node Screen Size
24478 @section Screen Size
24479 @cindex size of screen
24480 @cindex screen size
24481 @cindex pagination
24482 @cindex page size
24483 @cindex pauses in output
24484
24485 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24486 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24487 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24488 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24489 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24490 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24491 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24492 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24493 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24494 following line.
24495
24496 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24497 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24498 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24499 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24500 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24501 width} commands:
24502
24503 @table @code
24504 @kindex set height
24505 @kindex set width
24506 @kindex show width
24507 @kindex show height
24508 @item set height @var{lpp}
24509 @itemx set height unlimited
24510 @itemx show height
24511 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24512 @itemx set width unlimited
24513 @itemx show width
24514 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24515 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24516 commands display the current settings.
24517
24518 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24519 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24520 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24521 buffer.
24522
24523 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24524 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24525
24526 @item set pagination on
24527 @itemx set pagination off
24528 @kindex set pagination
24529 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24530 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24531 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24532 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24533
24534 @item show pagination
24535 @kindex show pagination
24536 Show the current pagination mode.
24537 @end table
24538
24539 @node Output Styling
24540 @section Output Styling
24541 @cindex styling
24542 @cindex colors
24543
24544 @kindex set style
24545 @kindex show style
24546 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
24547 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
24548 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
24549 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
24550
24551 @table @code
24552 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
24553 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
24554 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
24555
24556 @item show style enabled
24557 Show the current state of styling.
24558
24559 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
24560 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
24561 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
24562 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
24563 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
24564 default is @samp{on}.
24565
24566 @item show style sources
24567 Show the current state of source code styling.
24568 @end table
24569
24570 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
24571 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
24572 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
24573 intensity.
24574
24575 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
24576 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
24577
24578 @table @code
24579 @item set style filename background @var{color}
24580 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24581 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24582 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24583 and@samp{white}.
24584
24585 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
24586 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24587 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24588 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24589 and@samp{white}.
24590
24591 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
24592 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
24593 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
24594 @end table
24595
24596 The style-able objects are:
24597 @table @code
24598 @item filename
24599 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
24600 foreground color is green.
24601
24602 @item function
24603 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
24604 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
24605 style's foreground color is yellow.
24606
24607 @item variable
24608 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
24609 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
24610 foreground color is cyan.
24611
24612 @item address
24613 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
24614 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
24615 foreground color is blue.
24616 @end table
24617
24618 @node Numbers
24619 @section Numbers
24620 @cindex number representation
24621 @cindex entering numbers
24622
24623 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24624 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24625 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24626 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24627 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24628 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24629 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24630 both input and output with the commands described below.
24631
24632 @table @code
24633 @kindex set input-radix
24634 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24635 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24636 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24637 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24638 example, any of
24639
24640 @smallexample
24641 set input-radix 012
24642 set input-radix 10.
24643 set input-radix 0xa
24644 @end smallexample
24645
24646 @noindent
24647 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24648 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24649 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24650 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24651 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24652 change the radix.
24653
24654 @kindex set output-radix
24655 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24656 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24657 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24658 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24659
24660 @kindex show input-radix
24661 @item show input-radix
24662 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24663
24664 @kindex show output-radix
24665 @item show output-radix
24666 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24667
24668 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24669 @itemx show radix
24670 @kindex set radix
24671 @kindex show radix
24672 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24673 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24674 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24675 default value of 10.
24676
24677 @end table
24678
24679 @node ABI
24680 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24681
24682 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24683 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24684 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24685 current ABI.
24686
24687 @cindex OS ABI
24688 @kindex set osabi
24689 @kindex show osabi
24690 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24691
24692 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24693 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24694 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24695 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24696 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24697 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24698 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24699 platform provides.
24700
24701 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24702 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24703 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24704 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24705
24706 @table @code
24707 @item show osabi
24708 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24709
24710 @item set osabi
24711 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24712
24713 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24714 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24715 @end table
24716
24717 @cindex float promotion
24718
24719 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24720 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24721 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24722 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24723 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24724 @code{double} and then passed.
24725
24726 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24727 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24728 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24729
24730 @table @code
24731 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24732 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24733 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24734 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24735 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24736
24737 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24738 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24739 functions.
24740
24741 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24742 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24743 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24744 @end table
24745
24746 @kindex set cp-abi
24747 @kindex show cp-abi
24748 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24749 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24750 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24751 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24752 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24753 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24754 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24755 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24756 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24757 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24758 ``auto''.
24759
24760 @table @code
24761 @item show cp-abi
24762 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24763
24764 @item set cp-abi
24765 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24766
24767 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24768 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24769 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24770 @end table
24771
24772 @node Auto-loading
24773 @section Automatically loading associated files
24774 @cindex auto-loading
24775
24776 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24777 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24778 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24779 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24780 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24781 sources).
24782
24783 @menu
24784 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24785 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24786
24787 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24788 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24789 @end menu
24790
24791 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24792 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24793 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24794
24795 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24796 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24797 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24798
24799 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24800 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24801
24802 @table @code
24803 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24804 @kindex set auto-load off
24805 @item set auto-load off
24806 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24807 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24808 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24809 @smallexample
24810 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24811 @end smallexample
24812
24813 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24814 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24815 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24816 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24817 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24818 @code{set auto-load no}.
24819
24820 @anchor{show auto-load}
24821 @kindex show auto-load
24822 @item show auto-load
24823 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24824 or disabled.
24825
24826 @smallexample
24827 (gdb) show auto-load
24828 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24829 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24830 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24831 is on.
24832 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24833 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24834 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24835 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24836 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24837 @end smallexample
24838
24839 @anchor{info auto-load}
24840 @kindex info auto-load
24841 @item info auto-load
24842 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24843 not.
24844
24845 @smallexample
24846 (gdb) info auto-load
24847 gdb-scripts:
24848 Loaded Script
24849 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24850 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24851 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24852 loaded.
24853 python-scripts:
24854 Loaded Script
24855 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24856 @end smallexample
24857 @end table
24858
24859 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24860
24861 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24862 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24863 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24864 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24865 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24866 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24867 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24868 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24869 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24870 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24871 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24872 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24873 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24874 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24875 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24876 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24877 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24878 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24879 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24880 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24881 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24882 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24883 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24884 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24885 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24886 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24887 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24888 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24889 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24890 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24891 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24892 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24893 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24894 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24895 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24896 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24897 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24898 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24899 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24900 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24901 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24902 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24903 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24904 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24905 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24906 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24907 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24908 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24909 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24910 @end multitable
24911
24912 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24913 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24914 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24915
24916 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24917 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24918 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24919
24920 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24921 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24922
24923 @table @code
24924 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24925 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24926 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24927 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24928 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24929
24930 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24931 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24932 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24933 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24934 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24935
24936 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24937 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24938 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24939 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24940 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24941 @end table
24942
24943 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24944 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24945 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24946
24947 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24948
24949 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24950 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24951
24952 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24953 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24954 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24955 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24956 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24957 library.
24958
24959 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24960 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24961
24962 @table @code
24963 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24964 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24965 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24966 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24967
24968 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24969 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24970 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24971 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24972 enabled or disabled.
24973
24974 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24975 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24976 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24977 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24978 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24979 @end table
24980
24981 @node Auto-loading safe path
24982 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24983 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24984
24985 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24986 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24987 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24988 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24989 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24990
24991 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24992 get loaded:
24993
24994 @smallexample
24995 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24996 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24997 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24998 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24999 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25000 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
25001 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25002 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25003 @end smallexample
25004
25005 @noindent
25006 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
25007 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
25008
25009 @smallexample
25010 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
25011 @end smallexample
25012
25013 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
25014
25015 @table @code
25016 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
25017 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
25018 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25019 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25020 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25021 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25022 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25023 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25024 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25025 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25026
25027 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25028 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25029 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25030
25031 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25032 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25033 @item show auto-load safe-path
25034 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25035 scripts.
25036
25037 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25038 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25039 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25040 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25041 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25042 by the host platform path separator in use.
25043 @end table
25044
25045 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25046 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25047 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25048 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25049 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25050
25051 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25052 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25053 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25054 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25055 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25056 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25057 init file in the current directory
25058 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25059
25060 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25061 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25062
25063 @table @asis
25064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25065 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25066 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25067 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25068
25069 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25070 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25071 @value{GDBN} session.
25072
25073 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25074 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25075 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25076 from trusted sources.
25077
25078 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25079 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25080 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25081 trusted sources.
25082 @end table
25083
25084 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25085 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25086
25087 @table @asis
25088 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25089 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25090
25091 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25092 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25093 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25094 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25095 @end table
25096
25097 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25098 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25099 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25100 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25101 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25102 recommended to be entered.
25103
25104 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25105 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25106 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25107
25108 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25109 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25110 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25111 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25112 be printed.
25113
25114 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25115 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25116 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25117
25118 @smallexample
25119 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25120 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25121 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25122 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25123 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25124 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25125 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25126 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25127 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25128 @end smallexample
25129
25130 @table @code
25131 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25132 @kindex set debug auto-load
25133 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25134 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25135
25136 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25137 @kindex show debug auto-load
25138 @item show debug auto-load
25139 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25140 on or off.
25141 @end table
25142
25143 @node Messages/Warnings
25144 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25145
25146 @cindex verbose operation
25147 @cindex optional warnings
25148 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25149 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25150 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25151 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25152
25153 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25154 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25155 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25156
25157 @table @code
25158 @kindex set verbose
25159 @item set verbose on
25160 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25161
25162 @item set verbose off
25163 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25164
25165 @kindex show verbose
25166 @item show verbose
25167 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25168 @end table
25169
25170 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25171 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25172 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25173 Symbol Files}).
25174
25175 @table @code
25176
25177 @kindex set complaints
25178 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25179 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25180 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25181 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25182 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25183
25184 @kindex show complaints
25185 @item show complaints
25186 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25187
25188 @end table
25189
25190 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25191 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25192 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25193 you try to run a program which is already running:
25194
25195 @smallexample
25196 (@value{GDBP}) run
25197 The program being debugged has been started already.
25198 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25199 @end smallexample
25200
25201 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25202 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25203
25204 @table @code
25205
25206 @kindex set confirm
25207 @cindex flinching
25208 @cindex confirmation
25209 @cindex stupid questions
25210 @item set confirm off
25211 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25212 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25213 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25214
25215 @item set confirm on
25216 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25217
25218 @kindex show confirm
25219 @item show confirm
25220 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25221
25222 @end table
25223
25224 @cindex command tracing
25225 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25226 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25227 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25228 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25229
25230 @table @code
25231 @kindex set trace-commands
25232 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25233 @item set trace-commands on
25234 Enable command tracing.
25235 @item set trace-commands off
25236 Disable command tracing.
25237 @item show trace-commands
25238 Display the current state of command tracing.
25239 @end table
25240
25241 @node Debugging Output
25242 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25243 @cindex optional debugging messages
25244
25245 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25246 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25247 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25248 section documents those commands.
25249
25250 @table @code
25251 @kindex set exec-done-display
25252 @item set exec-done-display
25253 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25254 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25255 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25256 @kindex show exec-done-display
25257 @item show exec-done-display
25258 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25259 notification.
25260 @kindex set debug
25261 @cindex ARM AArch64
25262 @item set debug aarch64
25263 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25264 The default is off.
25265 @kindex show debug
25266 @item show debug aarch64
25267 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25268 ARM AArch64.
25269 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25270 @cindex architecture debugging info
25271 @item set debug arch
25272 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25273 @item show debug arch
25274 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25275 @item set debug aix-solib
25276 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25277 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25278 support module. The default is off.
25279 @item show debug aix-thread
25280 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25281 @item set debug aix-thread
25282 @cindex AIX threads
25283 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25284 module.
25285 @item show debug aix-thread
25286 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25287 @item set debug check-physname
25288 @cindex physname
25289 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25290 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25291 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25292 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25293 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25294 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25295 @item show debug check-physname
25296 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25297 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25298 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25299 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25300 exported symbols. The default is off.
25301 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25302 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25303 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25304 @item set debug dwarf-die
25305 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25306 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25307 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25308 A value of zero turns off the display.
25309 @item show debug dwarf-die
25310 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25311 @item set debug dwarf-line
25312 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25313 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25314 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25315 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25316 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25317 @item show debug dwarf-line
25318 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25319 @item set debug dwarf-read
25320 @cindex DWARF Reading
25321 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25322 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25323 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25324 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25325 @item show debug dwarf-read
25326 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25327 @item set debug displaced
25328 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25329 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25330 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25331 @item show debug displaced
25332 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25333 related to displaced stepping.
25334 @item set debug event
25335 @cindex event debugging info
25336 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25337 default is off.
25338 @item show debug event
25339 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25340 info.
25341 @item set debug expression
25342 @cindex expression debugging info
25343 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25344 expression parsing. The default is off.
25345 @item show debug expression
25346 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25347 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25348 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25349 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25350 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25351 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25352 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25353 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25354 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25355 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25356 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25357 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25358 @item set debug frame
25359 @cindex frame debugging info
25360 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25361 default is off.
25362 @item show debug frame
25363 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25364 info.
25365 @item set debug gnu-nat
25366 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25367 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25368 @item show debug gnu-nat
25369 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25370 @item set debug infrun
25371 @cindex inferior debugging info
25372 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25373 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25374 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25375 @item show debug infrun
25376 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25377 @item set debug jit
25378 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25379 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25380 @item show debug jit
25381 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25382 @item set debug lin-lwp
25383 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25384 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25385 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25386 @item show debug lin-lwp
25387 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25388 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25389 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25390 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25391 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25392 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25393 @item set debug mach-o
25394 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25395 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25396 processing. The default is off.
25397 @item show debug mach-o
25398 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25399 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25400 @item set debug notification
25401 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25402 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25403 The default is off.
25404 @item show debug notification
25405 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25406 @item set debug observer
25407 @cindex observer debugging info
25408 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25409 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25410 @item show debug observer
25411 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25412 @item set debug overload
25413 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25414 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25415 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25416 is off.
25417 @item show debug overload
25418 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25419 debugging info.
25420 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25421 @cindex debug expression parser
25422 @item set debug parser
25423 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25424 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25425 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25426 details. The default is off.
25427 @item show debug parser
25428 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25429 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25430 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25431 @cindex debug remote protocol
25432 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25433 @cindex display remote packets
25434 @item set debug remote
25435 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25436 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25437 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25438 @item show debug remote
25439 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25440
25441 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25442 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25443 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25444 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25445
25446 @item set debug serial
25447 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25448 default is off.
25449 @item show debug serial
25450 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25451 info.
25452 @item set debug solib-frv
25453 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25454 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25455 @item show debug solib-frv
25456 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25457 messages.
25458 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25459 @cindex symbol lookup
25460 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25461 The default is 0 (off).
25462 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25463 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25464 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25465 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25466 @item set debug symfile
25467 @cindex symbol file functions
25468 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25469 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25470 @item show debug symfile
25471 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25472 @item set debug symtab-create
25473 @cindex symbol table creation
25474 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25475 The default is 0 (off).
25476 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25477 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25478 @item show debug symtab-create
25479 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25480 @item set debug target
25481 @cindex target debugging info
25482 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25483 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25484 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25485 value of large memory transfers.
25486 @item show debug target
25487 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25488 info.
25489 @item set debug timestamp
25490 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25491 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25492 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25493 message.
25494 @item show debug timestamp
25495 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25496 debugging info.
25497 @item set debug varobj
25498 @cindex variable object debugging info
25499 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25500 info. The default is off.
25501 @item show debug varobj
25502 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25503 debugging info.
25504 @item set debug xml
25505 @cindex XML parser debugging
25506 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25507 @item show debug xml
25508 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25509 @end table
25510
25511 @node Other Misc Settings
25512 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25513 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25514
25515 @table @code
25516 @kindex set interactive-mode
25517 @item set interactive-mode
25518 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25519 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25520 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25521 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25522 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25523 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25524 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25525 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25526
25527 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25528 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25529 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25530 inside a cygwin window.
25531
25532 @kindex show interactive-mode
25533 @item show interactive-mode
25534 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25535 @end table
25536
25537 @node Extending GDB
25538 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25539 @cindex extending GDB
25540
25541 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25542 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25543 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25544 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25545 being debugged.
25546
25547 @menu
25548 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25549 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25550 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25551 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25552 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25553 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25554 @end menu
25555
25556 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25557 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25558 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25559 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25560 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25561 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25562
25563 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25564 setting:
25565
25566 @table @code
25567 @kindex set script-extension
25568 @kindex show script-extension
25569 @item set script-extension off
25570 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25571
25572 @item set script-extension soft
25573 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25574 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25575 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25576 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25577
25578 @item set script-extension strict
25579 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25580 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25581 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25582
25583 @item show script-extension
25584 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25585
25586 @end table
25587
25588 @node Sequences
25589 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25590
25591 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25592 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25593 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25594 files.
25595
25596 @menu
25597 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25598 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25599 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25600 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25601 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25602 @end menu
25603
25604 @node Define
25605 @subsection User-defined Commands
25606
25607 @cindex user-defined command
25608 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25609 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25610 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25611 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25612 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25613 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25614
25615 @smallexample
25616 define adder
25617 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25618 end
25619 @end smallexample
25620
25621 @noindent
25622 To execute the command use:
25623
25624 @smallexample
25625 adder 1 2 3
25626 @end smallexample
25627
25628 @noindent
25629 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25630 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25631 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25632 functions calls.
25633
25634 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25635 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25636 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25637 been passed.
25638
25639 @smallexample
25640 define adder
25641 if $argc == 2
25642 print $arg0 + $arg1
25643 end
25644 if $argc == 3
25645 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25646 end
25647 end
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25651 to process a variable number of arguments:
25652
25653 @smallexample
25654 define adder
25655 set $i = 0
25656 set $sum = 0
25657 while $i < $argc
25658 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25659 set $i = $i + 1
25660 end
25661 print $sum
25662 end
25663 @end smallexample
25664
25665 @table @code
25666
25667 @kindex define
25668 @item define @var{commandname}
25669 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25670 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25671 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25672 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25673 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25674 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25675
25676 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25677 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25678 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25679
25680 @kindex document
25681 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25682 @item document @var{commandname}
25683 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25684 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25685 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25686 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25687 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25688 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25689
25690 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25691 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25692 does not change the documentation.
25693
25694 @kindex dont-repeat
25695 @cindex don't repeat command
25696 @item dont-repeat
25697 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25698 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25699 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25700
25701 @kindex help user-defined
25702 @item help user-defined
25703 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25704 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25705 included (if any).
25706
25707 @kindex show user
25708 @item show user
25709 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25710 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25711 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25712 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25713 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25714
25715 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25716 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25717 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25718 @item show max-user-call-depth
25719 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25720 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25721 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25722 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25723 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25724 @end table
25725
25726 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25727 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25728
25729 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25730 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25731 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25732
25733 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25734 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25735 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25736 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25737
25738 @node Hooks
25739 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25740 @cindex command hooks
25741 @cindex hooks, for commands
25742 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25743
25744 @kindex hook
25745 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25746 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25747 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25748 before that command.
25749
25750 @cindex hooks, post-command
25751 @kindex hookpost
25752 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25753 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25754 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25755 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25756 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25757
25758 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25759 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25760
25761 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25762 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25763
25764 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25765 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25766 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25767 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25768 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25769
25770 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25771 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25772 you could define:
25773
25774 @smallexample
25775 define hook-stop
25776 handle SIGALRM nopass
25777 end
25778
25779 define hook-run
25780 handle SIGALRM pass
25781 end
25782
25783 define hook-continue
25784 handle SIGALRM pass
25785 end
25786 @end smallexample
25787
25788 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25789 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25790 you could define:
25791
25792 @smallexample
25793 define hook-echo
25794 echo <<<---
25795 end
25796
25797 define hookpost-echo
25798 echo --->>>\n
25799 end
25800
25801 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25802 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25803 (@value{GDBP})
25804
25805 @end smallexample
25806
25807 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25808 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25809 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25810 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25811 @c or not?
25812 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25813 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25814 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25815
25816 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25817 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25818 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25819
25820 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25821 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25822
25823 @node Command Files
25824 @subsection Command Files
25825
25826 @cindex command files
25827 @cindex scripting commands
25828 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25829 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25830 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25831 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25832 terminal.
25833
25834 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25835 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25836 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25837 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25838 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25839
25840 @table @code
25841 @kindex source
25842 @cindex execute commands from a file
25843 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25844 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25845 @end table
25846
25847 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25848 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25849 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25850 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25851 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25852
25853 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25854 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25855 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25856 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25857 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25858 is not relevant to scripts.
25859
25860 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25861 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25862 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25863 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25864 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25865 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25866 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25867 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25868 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25869 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25870 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25871 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25872 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25873 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25874
25875 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25876 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25877 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25878
25879 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25880 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25881 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25882 when called from command files.
25883
25884 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25885 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25886 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25887 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25888 the next command.
25889
25890 @smallexample
25891 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25892 @end smallexample
25893
25894 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25895 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25896 would be directed to @file{log}.
25897
25898 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25899 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25900 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25901 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25902 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25903 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25904 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25905 conditionally, etc.
25906
25907 @table @code
25908 @kindex if
25909 @kindex else
25910 @item if
25911 @itemx else
25912 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25913 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25914 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25915 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25916 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25917 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25918 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25919
25920 @kindex while
25921 @item while
25922 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25923 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25924 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25925 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25926 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25927 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25928
25929 @kindex loop_break
25930 @item loop_break
25931 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25932 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25933 line.
25934
25935 @kindex loop_continue
25936 @item loop_continue
25937 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25938 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25939 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25940 the controlling expression.
25941
25942 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25943 @item end
25944 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25945 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25946 @end table
25947
25948
25949 @node Output
25950 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25951
25952 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25953 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25954 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25955 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25956 want.
25957
25958 @table @code
25959 @kindex echo
25960 @item echo @var{text}
25961 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25962 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25963 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25964 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25965 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25966 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25967 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25968 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25969 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25970 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25971 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25972
25973 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25974 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25975
25976 @smallexample
25977 echo This is some text\n\
25978 which is continued\n\
25979 onto several lines.\n
25980 @end smallexample
25981
25982 produces the same output as
25983
25984 @smallexample
25985 echo This is some text\n
25986 echo which is continued\n
25987 echo onto several lines.\n
25988 @end smallexample
25989
25990 @kindex output
25991 @item output @var{expression}
25992 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25993 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25994 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25995 on expressions.
25996
25997 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25998 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25999 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
26000 Formats}, for more information.
26001
26002 @kindex printf
26003 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26004 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26005 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
26006 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
26007 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
26008 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
26009 executing the code below:
26010
26011 @smallexample
26012 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
26013 @end smallexample
26014
26015 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
26016 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
26017 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
26018 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26019 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26020 printed.
26021
26022 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26023
26024 @smallexample
26025 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26026 @end smallexample
26027
26028 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26029 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26030 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26031
26032 @itemize @bullet
26033 @item
26034 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26035
26036 @item
26037 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26038 width.
26039
26040 @item
26041 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26042 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26043
26044 @item
26045 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26046 supported.
26047
26048 @item
26049 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26050
26051 @item
26052 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26053 @end itemize
26054
26055 @noindent
26056 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26057 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26058 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26059 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26060
26061 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26062 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26063 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26064 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26065 supported.
26066
26067 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26068 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26069 together with a floating point specifier.
26070 letters:
26071
26072 @itemize @bullet
26073 @item
26074 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26075
26076 @item
26077 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26078
26079 @item
26080 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26081 @end itemize
26082
26083 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26084 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26085 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26086
26087 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26088 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26089
26090 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26091 @smallexample
26092 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26093 @end smallexample
26094
26095 @anchor{eval}
26096 @kindex eval
26097 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26098 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26099 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26100
26101 @end table
26102
26103 @node Auto-loading sequences
26104 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26105 @cindex native script auto-loading
26106
26107 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26108 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26109 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26110 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26111
26112 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26113 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26114
26115 @table @code
26116 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26117 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26118 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26119 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26120
26121 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26122 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26123 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26124 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26125 disabled.
26126
26127 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26128 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26129 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26130 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26131 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26132 auto-loaded.
26133 @end table
26134
26135 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26136 matching names are printed.
26137
26138 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26139 @include python.texi
26140
26141 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26142 @include guile.texi
26143
26144 @node Auto-loading extensions
26145 @section Auto-loading extensions
26146 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26147
26148 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26149 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26150 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26151 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26152 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26153
26154 @menu
26155 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26156 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26157 * Which flavor to choose?::
26158 @end menu
26159
26160 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26161 debugging commands and features.
26162
26163 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26164 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26165 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26166 for more information.
26167 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26168 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26169
26170 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26171 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26172
26173 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26174 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26175 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26176 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26177 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26178
26179 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26180 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26181 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26182 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26183
26184 @table @code
26185 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26186 GDB's own command language
26187 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26188 Python
26189 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26190 Guile
26191 @end table
26192
26193 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26194 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26195 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26196 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26197 script in the specified extension language.
26198
26199 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26200 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26201
26202 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26203 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26204
26205 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26206 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26207 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26208 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26209 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26210 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26211
26212 @table @code
26213 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26214 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26215 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26216 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26217 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26218 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26219
26220 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26221 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26222
26223 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26224 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26225 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26226 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26227
26228 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26229 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26230 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26231 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26232 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26233 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26234 platform.
26235
26236 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26237 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26238 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26239
26240 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26241 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26242 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26243 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26244
26245 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26246 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26247 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26248 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26249 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26250 @end table
26251
26252 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26253 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26254 @var{objfile} is opened.
26255 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26256 is evaluated more than once.
26257
26258 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26259 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26260 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26261
26262 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26263 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26264 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26265 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26266 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26267 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26268 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26269
26270 The following entries are supported:
26271
26272 @table @code
26273 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26274 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26275 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26276 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26277 @end table
26278
26279 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26280
26281 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26282 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26283 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26284 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26285 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26286
26287 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26288 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26289
26290 @example
26291 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26292 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26293 asm("\
26294 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26295 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26296 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26297 .popsection \n\
26298 ");
26299 @end example
26300
26301 @noindent
26302 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26303 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26304
26305 @example
26306 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26307 @end example
26308
26309 The script name may include directories if desired.
26310
26311 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26312 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26313
26314 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26315 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26316 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26317 will remove duplicates.
26318
26319 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26320
26321 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26322 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26323 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26324 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26325 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26326 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26327 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26328 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26329 on its name.
26330
26331 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26332 testsuite.
26333
26334 @example
26335 #include "symcat.h"
26336 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26337 asm(
26338 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26339 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26340 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26341 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26342 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26343 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26344 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26345 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26346 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26347 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26348 ".byte 0\n"
26349 ".popsection\n"
26350 );
26351 @end example
26352
26353 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26354 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26355 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26356 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26357
26358 @node Which flavor to choose?
26359 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26360
26361 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26362 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26363
26364 @noindent
26365 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26366
26367 @itemize @bullet
26368 @item
26369 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26370
26371 @item
26372 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26373
26374 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26375 in the source search path.
26376 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26377 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26378
26379 @item
26380 Doesn't require source code additions.
26381 @end itemize
26382
26383 @noindent
26384 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26385
26386 @itemize @bullet
26387 @item
26388 Works with static linking.
26389
26390 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26391 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26392 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26393 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26394 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26395
26396 @item
26397 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26398
26399 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26400 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26401
26402 @item
26403 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26404
26405 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26406 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26407 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26408 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26409 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26410 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26411 @end itemize
26412
26413 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26414 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26415
26416 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26417 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26418 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26419
26420 @subsection Python comes first
26421
26422 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26423 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26424 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26425 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26426 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26427 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26428 pretty-printed form of a value).
26429 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26430 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26431 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26432
26433 @node Aliases
26434 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26435 @cindex aliases for commands
26436
26437 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26438 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26439 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26440 that involves less typing.
26441
26442 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26443 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26444 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26445
26446 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26447 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26448 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26449
26450 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26451
26452 @table @code
26453
26454 @kindex alias
26455 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26456
26457 @end table
26458
26459 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26460 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26461 underscores.
26462
26463 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26464 that is being aliased.
26465
26466 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26467 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26468 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26469
26470 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26471 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26472
26473 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26474 of a command so that there is less to type.
26475 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26476 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26477 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26478 The following will accomplish this.
26479
26480 @smallexample
26481 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26482 @end smallexample
26483
26484 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26485 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26486 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26487 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26488
26489 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26490 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26491 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26492 of a command.
26493
26494 @smallexample
26495 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26496 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26497 (gdb) set p elms 20
26498 (gdb) show p elms
26499 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26500 @end smallexample
26501
26502 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26503 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26504 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26505
26506 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26507 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26508
26509 @smallexample
26510 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26511 @end smallexample
26512
26513 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26514 alias for a more complex command.
26515 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26516
26517 @smallexample
26518 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26519 (gdb) spe 20
26520 @end smallexample
26521
26522 @node Interpreters
26523 @chapter Command Interpreters
26524 @cindex command interpreters
26525
26526 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26527 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26528 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26529
26530 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26531 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26532 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26533 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26534
26535 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26536 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26537 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26538 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26539
26540 @table @code
26541 @item console
26542 @cindex console interpreter
26543 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26544 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26545 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26546
26547 @item mi
26548 @cindex mi interpreter
26549 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
26550 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26551 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26552 Interface}.
26553
26554 @item mi3
26555 @cindex mi3 interpreter
26556 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
26557
26558 @item mi2
26559 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26560 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
26561
26562 @item mi1
26563 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26564 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
26565
26566 @end table
26567
26568 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26569
26570 @kindex interpreter-exec
26571 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26572 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26573 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26574
26575 @smallexample
26576 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26577 @end smallexample
26578
26579 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26580 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26581
26582 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26583 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26584 permanently.
26585
26586 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26587
26588 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26589 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26590 device (usually a tty).
26591
26592 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26593 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26594 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26595 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26596 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26597 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26598 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26599 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26600 the separate MI interpreter.
26601
26602 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26603 @code{new-ui} command:
26604
26605 @kindex new-ui
26606 @cindex new user interface
26607 @smallexample
26608 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26609 @end smallexample
26610
26611 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26612 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26613 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26614 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26615 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26616 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26617
26618 @smallexample
26619 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26620 @end smallexample
26621
26622 @noindent
26623 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26624
26625 @node TUI
26626 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26627 @cindex TUI
26628 @cindex Text User Interface
26629
26630 @menu
26631 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26632 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26633 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26634 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26635 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26636 @end menu
26637
26638 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26639 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26640 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26641 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26642 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26643 is available.
26644
26645 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26646 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26647 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26648 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26649 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26650 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26651
26652 @node TUI Overview
26653 @section TUI Overview
26654
26655 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26656
26657 @table @emph
26658 @item command
26659 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26660 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26661 managed using readline.
26662
26663 @item source
26664 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26665 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26666
26667 @item assembly
26668 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26669
26670 @item register
26671 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26672 when their values change.
26673 @end table
26674
26675 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26676 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26677 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26678 indicates the breakpoint type:
26679
26680 @table @code
26681 @item B
26682 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26683
26684 @item b
26685 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26686
26687 @item H
26688 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26689
26690 @item h
26691 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26692 @end table
26693
26694 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26695
26696 @table @code
26697 @item +
26698 Breakpoint is enabled.
26699
26700 @item -
26701 Breakpoint is disabled.
26702 @end table
26703
26704 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26705 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26706 changes.
26707
26708 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26709 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26710 layouts:
26711
26712 @itemize @bullet
26713 @item
26714 source only,
26715
26716 @item
26717 assembly only,
26718
26719 @item
26720 source and assembly,
26721
26722 @item
26723 source and registers, or
26724
26725 @item
26726 assembly and registers.
26727 @end itemize
26728
26729 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26730
26731 @table @emph
26732 @item target
26733 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26734 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26735
26736 @item process
26737 Gives the current process or thread number.
26738 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26739
26740 @item function
26741 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26742 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26743 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26744 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26745
26746 @item line
26747 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26748 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26749
26750 @item pc
26751 Indicates the current program counter address.
26752 @end table
26753
26754 @node TUI Keys
26755 @section TUI Key Bindings
26756 @cindex TUI key bindings
26757
26758 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26759 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26760 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26761 @end ifset
26762 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26763 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26764 @end ifclear
26765 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26766 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26767
26768 @table @kbd
26769 @kindex C-x C-a
26770 @item C-x C-a
26771 @kindex C-x a
26772 @itemx C-x a
26773 @kindex C-x A
26774 @itemx C-x A
26775 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26776 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26777 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26778 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26779 The screen is then refreshed.
26780
26781 @kindex C-x 1
26782 @item C-x 1
26783 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26784 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26785 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26786
26787 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26788
26789 @kindex C-x 2
26790 @item C-x 2
26791 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26792 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26793 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26794 previous layout and the new one.
26795
26796 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26797
26798 @kindex C-x o
26799 @item C-x o
26800 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26801 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26802 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26803
26804 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26805
26806 @kindex C-x s
26807 @item C-x s
26808 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26809 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26810 @end table
26811
26812 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26813
26814 @table @asis
26815 @kindex PgUp
26816 @item @key{PgUp}
26817 Scroll the active window one page up.
26818
26819 @kindex PgDn
26820 @item @key{PgDn}
26821 Scroll the active window one page down.
26822
26823 @kindex Up
26824 @item @key{Up}
26825 Scroll the active window one line up.
26826
26827 @kindex Down
26828 @item @key{Down}
26829 Scroll the active window one line down.
26830
26831 @kindex Left
26832 @item @key{Left}
26833 Scroll the active window one column left.
26834
26835 @kindex Right
26836 @item @key{Right}
26837 Scroll the active window one column right.
26838
26839 @kindex C-L
26840 @item @kbd{C-L}
26841 Refresh the screen.
26842 @end table
26843
26844 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26845 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26846 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26847 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26848 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26849
26850 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26851 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26852 @cindex TUI single key mode
26853
26854 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26855 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26856 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26857
26858 @table @kbd
26859 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26860 @item c
26861 continue
26862
26863 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26864 @item d
26865 down
26866
26867 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26868 @item f
26869 finish
26870
26871 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26872 @item n
26873 next
26874
26875 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26876 @item o
26877 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26878
26879 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26880 @item q
26881 exit the SingleKey mode.
26882
26883 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26884 @item r
26885 run
26886
26887 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26888 @item s
26889 step
26890
26891 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26892 @item i
26893 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26894
26895 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26896 @item u
26897 up
26898
26899 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26900 @item v
26901 info locals
26902
26903 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26904 @item w
26905 where
26906 @end table
26907
26908 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26909 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26910 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26911 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26912 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26913 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26914
26915
26916 @node TUI Commands
26917 @section TUI-specific Commands
26918 @cindex TUI commands
26919
26920 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26921 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26922 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26923 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26924
26925 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26926 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26927 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26928 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26929 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26930
26931 @table @code
26932 @item tui enable
26933 @kindex tui enable
26934 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26935 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26936 otherwise a default layout is used.
26937
26938 @item tui disable
26939 @kindex tui disable
26940 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26941
26942 @item info win
26943 @kindex info win
26944 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26945
26946 @item layout @var{name}
26947 @kindex layout
26948 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26949 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26950 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26951
26952 @table @code
26953 @item next
26954 Display the next layout.
26955
26956 @item prev
26957 Display the previous layout.
26958
26959 @item src
26960 Display the source and command windows.
26961
26962 @item asm
26963 Display the assembly and command windows.
26964
26965 @item split
26966 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26967
26968 @item regs
26969 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26970 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26971 register, assembler, and command windows.
26972 @end table
26973
26974 @item focus @var{name}
26975 @kindex focus
26976 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26977 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26978
26979 @table @code
26980 @item next
26981 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26982
26983 @item prev
26984 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26985
26986 @item src
26987 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26988
26989 @item asm
26990 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26991
26992 @item regs
26993 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26994
26995 @item cmd
26996 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26997 @end table
26998
26999 @item refresh
27000 @kindex refresh
27001 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
27002
27003 @item tui reg @var{group}
27004 @kindex tui reg
27005 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
27006 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
27007 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
27008 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
27009 following groups are available on most targets:
27010 @table @code
27011 @item next
27012 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27013 through all of the available register groups.
27014
27015 @item prev
27016 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27017 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
27018 @var{next}.
27019
27020 @item general
27021 Display the general registers.
27022 @item float
27023 Display the floating point registers.
27024 @item system
27025 Display the system registers.
27026 @item vector
27027 Display the vector registers.
27028 @item all
27029 Display all registers.
27030 @end table
27031
27032 @item update
27033 @kindex update
27034 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27035
27036 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27037 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27038 @kindex winheight
27039 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27040 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27041 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27042 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27043 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27044 @end table
27045
27046 @node TUI Configuration
27047 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27048 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27049
27050 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27051
27052 @table @code
27053 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27054 @kindex set tui border-kind
27055 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27056 The possible values are the following:
27057 @table @code
27058 @item space
27059 Use a space character to draw the border.
27060
27061 @item ascii
27062 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27063
27064 @item acs
27065 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27066 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27067 @end table
27068
27069 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27070 @kindex set tui border-mode
27071 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27072 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27073 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27074 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27075 @table @code
27076 @item normal
27077 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27078
27079 @item standout
27080 Use standout mode.
27081
27082 @item reverse
27083 Use reverse video mode.
27084
27085 @item half
27086 Use half bright mode.
27087
27088 @item half-standout
27089 Use half bright and standout mode.
27090
27091 @item bold
27092 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27093
27094 @item bold-standout
27095 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27096 @end table
27097
27098 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27099 @kindex set tui tab-width
27100 @kindex tabset
27101 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27102 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27103 assembly windows.
27104 @end table
27105
27106 @node Emacs
27107 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27108
27109 @cindex Emacs
27110 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27111 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27112 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27113 @value{GDBN}.
27114
27115 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27116 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27117 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27118 created Emacs buffer.
27119 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27120
27121 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27122 things:
27123
27124 @itemize @bullet
27125 @item
27126 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27127 the GUD buffer.
27128
27129 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27130 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27131
27132 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27133 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27134 in this way.
27135
27136 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27137 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27138 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27139 stop.
27140
27141 @item
27142 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27143
27144 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27145 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27146 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27147 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27148 and the source.
27149
27150 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27151 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27152 @end itemize
27153
27154 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27155 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27156 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27157 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27158
27159 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27160 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27161 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27162 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27163 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27164 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27165 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27166 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27167 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27168
27169 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27170 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27171 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27172 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27173
27174 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27175 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27176 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27177 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27178 one you want.
27179
27180 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27181 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27182
27183 @table @kbd
27184 @item C-h m
27185 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27186
27187 @item C-c C-s
27188 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27189 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27190
27191 @item C-c C-n
27192 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27193 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27194 to show the current file and location.
27195
27196 @item C-c C-i
27197 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27198 display window accordingly.
27199
27200 @item C-c C-f
27201 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27202 @code{finish} command.
27203
27204 @item C-c C-r
27205 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27206 command.
27207
27208 @item C-c <
27209 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27210 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27211 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27212
27213 @item C-c >
27214 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27215 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27216 @end table
27217
27218 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27219 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27220
27221 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27222 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27223 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27224 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27225 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27226 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27227 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27228
27229 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27230 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27231 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27232 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27233 frame.
27234
27235 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27236 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27237 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27238 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27239 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27240 to correspond properly with the code.
27241
27242 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27243 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27244 Emacs Manual}).
27245
27246 @node GDB/MI
27247 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27248
27249 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27250
27251 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27252 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27253 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27254 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27255 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27256 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27257
27258 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27259 in the form of a reference manual.
27260
27261 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27262 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27263 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27264
27265 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27266
27267 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27268 This chapter uses the following notation:
27269
27270 @itemize @bullet
27271 @item
27272 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27273
27274 @item
27275 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27276 it may or may not be given.
27277
27278 @item
27279 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27280 may repeat zero or more times.
27281
27282 @item
27283 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27284 may repeat one or more times.
27285
27286 @item
27287 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27288 @end itemize
27289
27290 @ignore
27291 @heading Dependencies
27292 @end ignore
27293
27294 @menu
27295 * GDB/MI General Design::
27296 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27297 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27298 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27299 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27300 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27301 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27302 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27303 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27304 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27305 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27306 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27307 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27308 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27309 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27310 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27311 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27312 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27313 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27314 @ignore
27315 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27316 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27317 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27318 @end ignore
27319 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27320 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27321 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27322 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27323 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27324 @end menu
27325
27326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27327 @node GDB/MI General Design
27328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27329 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27330
27331 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27332 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27333 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27334 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27335 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27336 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27337 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27338 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27339 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27340 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27341
27342 The important examples of notifications are:
27343 @itemize @bullet
27344
27345 @item
27346 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27347 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27348 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27349 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27350 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27351 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27352 command itself was successfully executed.
27353
27354 @item
27355 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27356 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27357 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27358 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27359 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27360 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27361
27362 @item
27363 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27364 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27365 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27366 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27367 orthogonal frontend design.
27368
27369 @end itemize
27370
27371 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27372 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27373 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27374 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27375 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27376 the user interface.
27377
27378
27379 @menu
27380 * Context management::
27381 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27382 * Thread groups::
27383 @end menu
27384
27385 @node Context management
27386 @subsection Context management
27387
27388 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27389
27390 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27391 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27392 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27393 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27394 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27395 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27396 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27397 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27398 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27399
27400 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27401 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27402 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27403 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27404 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27405 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27406 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27407 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27408 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27409 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27410 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27411
27412 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27413 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27414 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27415 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27416 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27417 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27418 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27419 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27420 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27421 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27422
27423 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27424 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27425 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27426 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27427 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27428 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27429 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27430 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27431 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27432 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27433 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27434 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27435 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27436 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27437 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27438 @samp{--frame} options.
27439
27440 @subsubsection Language
27441
27442 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27443 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27444 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27445 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27446 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27447 For instance:
27448
27449 @smallexample
27450 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27451 ^done,value="4"
27452 (gdb)
27453 @end smallexample
27454
27455 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27456 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27457 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27458
27459 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27460 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27461
27462 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27463 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27464 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27465 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27466 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27467 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27468 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27469 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27470 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27471
27472 @table @code
27473 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27474 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27475 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27476
27477 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27478 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27479 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27480
27481 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27482 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27483 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27484 MI commands even while the target is running.
27485
27486 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27487 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27488 @end table
27489
27490 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27491 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27492 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27493 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27494 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27495 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27496
27497 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27498 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27499 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27500 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27501 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27502 are running.
27503
27504 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27505 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27506 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27507 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27508 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27509 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27510 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27511 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27512 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27513 @samp{--thread} option).
27514
27515 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27516 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27517 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27518 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27519
27520 @node Thread groups
27521 @subsection Thread groups
27522 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27523 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27524 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27525 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27526 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27527
27528 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27529 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27530 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27531 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27532 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27533 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27534 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27535 into processes.
27536
27537 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27538 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27539 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27540 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27541 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27542 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27543 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27544 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27545 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27546 the members of specific thread group.
27547
27548 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27549 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27550 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27551 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27552 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27553 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27554 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27555 after attaching to that thread group.
27556
27557 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27558 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27559 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27560 such thread groups.
27561
27562 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27563 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27564 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27565
27566 @menu
27567 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27568 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27569 @end menu
27570
27571 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27572 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27573
27574 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27575 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27576 @table @code
27577 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27578 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27579
27580 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27581 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27582 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27583
27584 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27585 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27586 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27587
27588 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27589 "any sequence of digits"
27590
27591 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27592 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27593
27594 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27595 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27596
27597 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27598 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27599
27600 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27601 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27602 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27603
27604 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27605 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27606
27607 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27608 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27609 @end table
27610
27611 @noindent
27612 Notes:
27613
27614 @itemize @bullet
27615 @item
27616 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27617 output is described below.
27618
27619 @item
27620 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27621 finishes.
27622
27623 @item
27624 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27625 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27626 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27627 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27628 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27629 @end itemize
27630
27631 Pragmatics:
27632
27633 @itemize @bullet
27634 @item
27635 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27636
27637 @item
27638 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27639 @end itemize
27640
27641 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27642 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27643
27644 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27645 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27646 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27647 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27648 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27649 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27650
27651 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27652 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27653 @var{token}.
27654
27655 @table @code
27656 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27657 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27658
27659 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27660 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27661
27662 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27663 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27664
27665 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27666 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27667
27668 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27669 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27670
27671 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27672 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27673
27674 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27675 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27676
27677 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27678 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27679
27680 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27681 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27682
27683 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27684 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27685 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27686
27687 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27688 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27689
27690 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27691 @code{ @var{string} }
27692
27693 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27694 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27695
27696 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27697 @code{@var{c-string}}
27698
27699 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27700 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27701
27702 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27703 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27704 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27705
27706 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27707 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27708
27709 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27710 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27711
27712 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27713 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27714
27715 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27716 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27717
27718 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27719 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27720
27721 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27722 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27723 @end table
27724
27725 @noindent
27726 Notes:
27727
27728 @itemize @bullet
27729 @item
27730 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27731
27732 @item
27733 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27734 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27735 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27736 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27737 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27738 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27739 prior command.
27740
27741 @item
27742 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27743 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27744 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27745 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27746
27747 @item
27748 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27749 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27750 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27751 @samp{*}.
27752
27753 @item
27754 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27755 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27756 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27757 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27758
27759 @item
27760 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27761 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27762 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27763 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27764
27765 @item
27766 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27767 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27768 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27769
27770 @item
27771 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27772 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27773 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27774 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27775
27776 @item
27777 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27778 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27779 @var{values}.
27780
27781
27782 @end itemize
27783
27784 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27785 details about the various output records.
27786
27787 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27788 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27789 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27790
27791 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27792 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27793
27794 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27795 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27796 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27797 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27798 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27799 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27800
27801 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27802 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27803 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27804
27805 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27806 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27807 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27808 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27809
27810 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27811 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27812
27813 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
27814 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
27815 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
27816 does.
27817
27818 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27819 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27820 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27821 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27822
27823 @itemize @bullet
27824 @item
27825 New MI commands may be added.
27826
27827 @item
27828 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27829
27830 @item
27831 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27832 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27833
27834 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27835 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27836
27837 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27838 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27839 @end itemize
27840
27841 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27842 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
27843 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
27844 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
27845
27846 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
27847 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
27848 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
27849 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
27850
27851 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
27852 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
27853 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
27854
27855 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
27856 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
27857
27858 @item
27859 @center 1
27860 @tab
27861 @center 5.1
27862 @tab
27863 None
27864
27865 @item
27866 @center 2
27867 @tab
27868 @center 6.0
27869 @tab
27870
27871 @itemize
27872 @item
27873 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
27874 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
27875 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
27876
27877 @item
27878 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
27879 than a tuple.
27880
27881 @item
27882 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
27883 a tuple.
27884 @end itemize
27885
27886 @item
27887 @center 3
27888 @tab
27889 @center 9.1
27890 @tab
27891
27892 @itemize
27893 @item
27894 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
27895 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
27896 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
27897 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
27898 is a list.
27899 @end itemize
27900
27901 @end multitable
27902
27903 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
27904 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
27905 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
27906
27907 @table @code
27908
27909 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
27910 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
27911 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
27912 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
27913
27914 @end table
27915
27916 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27917 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27918 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27919 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27920 @cindex mailing lists
27921
27922 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27923 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27924 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27925
27926 @menu
27927 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27928 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27929 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27930 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27931 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27932 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27933 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27934 @end menu
27935
27936 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27937 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27938
27939 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27940 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27941 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27942 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27943
27944 @table @code
27945 @findex ^done
27946 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27947 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27948 values.
27949
27950 @item "^running"
27951 @findex ^running
27952 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27953 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27954 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27955 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27956 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27957 which threads are resumed.
27958
27959 @item "^connected"
27960 @findex ^connected
27961 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27962
27963 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27964 @findex ^error
27965 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27966 the corresponding error message.
27967
27968 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27969 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27970 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27971
27972 @table @samp
27973 @item "undefined-command"
27974 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27975 @end table
27976
27977 @item "^exit"
27978 @findex ^exit
27979 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27980
27981 @end table
27982
27983 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27984 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27985
27986 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27987 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27988 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27989 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27990 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27991
27992 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27993 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27994 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27995 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27996 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27997
27998 @table @code
27999 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28000 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28001 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28002
28003 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28004 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28005 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28006 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28007
28008 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28009 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28010 internals.
28011 @end table
28012
28013 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28014 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28015
28016 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28017 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28018 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28019 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28020 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28021 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28022
28023 The following is the list of possible async records:
28024
28025 @table @code
28026
28027 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28028 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28029 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28030 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28031 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28032 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28033 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28034 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28035 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28036 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28037 it run freely.
28038
28039 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28040 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28041 following values:
28042
28043 @table @code
28044 @item breakpoint-hit
28045 A breakpoint was reached.
28046 @item watchpoint-trigger
28047 A watchpoint was triggered.
28048 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28049 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28050 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28051 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28052 @item function-finished
28053 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28054 @item location-reached
28055 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28056 @item watchpoint-scope
28057 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28058 @item end-stepping-range
28059 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28060 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28061 @item exited-signalled
28062 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28063 @item exited
28064 The inferior exited.
28065 @item exited-normally
28066 The inferior exited normally.
28067 @item signal-received
28068 A signal was received by the inferior.
28069 @item solib-event
28070 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28071 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28072 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28073 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28074 @item fork
28075 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28076 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28077 @item vfork
28078 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28079 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28080 @item syscall-entry
28081 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28082 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28083 @item syscall-return
28084 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28085 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28086 @item exec
28087 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28088 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28089 @end table
28090
28091 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28092 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28093 Depending on whether all-stop
28094 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28095 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28096 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28097 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28098 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28099 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28100 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28101 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28102 if such information is not available.
28103
28104 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28105 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28106 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28107 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28108 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28109 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28110 cannot be used in any way.
28111
28112 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28113 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28114 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28115 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28116 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28117 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28118
28119 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28120 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28121 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28122 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28123 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28124 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28125
28126 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28127 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28128 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28129 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28130 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28131
28132 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28133 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28134 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28135 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28136 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28137 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28138 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28139 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28140 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28141
28142 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28143 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28144
28145 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28146 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28147 that thread.
28148
28149 @item =library-loaded,...
28150 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28151 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28152 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28153 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28154 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28155 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28156 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28157 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28158 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28159 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28160 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28161 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28162 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28163 to this library.
28164
28165 @item =library-unloaded,...
28166 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28167 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28168 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28169 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28170 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28171 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28172 thread groups.
28173
28174 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28175 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28176 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28177 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28178 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28179
28180 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28181 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28182 initial value @var{initial}.
28183
28184 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28185 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28186 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28187 trace state variables are deleted.
28188
28189 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28190 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28191 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28192 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28193 value of trace state variable is known.
28194
28195 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28196 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28197 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28198 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28199 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28200 user.
28201
28202 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28203 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28204 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28205
28206 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28207 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28208
28209 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28210 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28211 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28212 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28213 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28214
28215 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28216 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28217 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28218 for existing method and format values.
28219
28220 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28221 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28222 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28223 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28224 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28225 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28226
28227 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28228 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28229 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28230 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28231 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28232 executable code.
28233 @end table
28234
28235 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28236 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28237
28238 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28239 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28240 following fields:
28241
28242 @table @code
28243 @item number
28244 The breakpoint number.
28245
28246 @item type
28247 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28248 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28249
28250 @item catch-type
28251 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28252 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28253
28254 @item disp
28255 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28256 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28257 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28258
28259 @item enabled
28260 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28261 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28262 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28263
28264 @item addr
28265 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28266 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28267 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28268 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28269 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28270
28271 @item func
28272 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28273 If not known, this field is not present.
28274
28275 @item filename
28276 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28277 If not known, this field is not present.
28278
28279 @item fullname
28280 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28281 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28282
28283 @item line
28284 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28285 If not known, this field is not present.
28286
28287 @item at
28288 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28289 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28290 by a symbol name.
28291
28292 @item pending
28293 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28294 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28295
28296 @item evaluated-by
28297 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28298 @samp{target}.
28299
28300 @item thread
28301 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28302 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28303
28304 @item task
28305 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28306 field will hold the task identifier.
28307
28308 @item cond
28309 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28310
28311 @item ignore
28312 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28313
28314 @item enable
28315 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28316
28317 @item traceframe-usage
28318 FIXME.
28319
28320 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28321 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28322
28323 @item mask
28324 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28325
28326 @item pass
28327 A tracepoint's pass count.
28328
28329 @item original-location
28330 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28331 This field is optional.
28332
28333 @item times
28334 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28335
28336 @item installed
28337 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28338 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28339 is not.
28340
28341 @item what
28342 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28343
28344 @item locations
28345 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
28346 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
28347 location.
28348
28349 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
28350
28351 @end table
28352
28353 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
28354 following fields:
28355
28356 @table @code
28357
28358 @item number
28359 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
28360 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
28361 location within that breakpoint.
28362
28363 @item enabled
28364 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
28365 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28366 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28367
28368 @item addr
28369 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
28370
28371 @item func
28372 If known, the function in which the location appears.
28373 If not known, this field is not present.
28374
28375 @item file
28376 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
28377 If not known, this field is not present.
28378
28379 @item fullname
28380 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
28381 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28382
28383 @item line
28384 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
28385 If not known, this field is not present.
28386
28387 @item thread-groups
28388 The thread groups this location is in.
28389
28390 @end table
28391
28392 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28393 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28394
28395 @smallexample
28396 -> -break-insert main
28397 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28398 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28399 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28400 times="0"@}
28401 <- (gdb)
28402 @end smallexample
28403
28404 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28405 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28406
28407 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28408 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28409 fields:
28410
28411 @table @code
28412 @item level
28413 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28414 zero. This field is always present.
28415
28416 @item func
28417 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28418 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28419
28420 @item addr
28421 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28422
28423 @item file
28424 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28425 address. This field may be absent.
28426
28427 @item line
28428 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28429 may be absent.
28430
28431 @item from
28432 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28433 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28434
28435 @end table
28436
28437 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28438 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28439
28440 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28441 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28442 stated otherwise.
28443
28444 @table @code
28445 @item id
28446 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28447
28448 @item target-id
28449 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28450
28451 @item details
28452 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28453 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28454 frontend. This field is optional.
28455
28456 @item name
28457 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28458 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28459 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28460 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28461 field is omitted.
28462
28463 @item state
28464 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28465 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28466
28467 @item frame
28468 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28469 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28470 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28471
28472 @item core
28473 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28474 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28475 @end table
28476
28477 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28478 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28479
28480 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28481 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28482 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28483 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28484 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28485 the @code{exception-message} field.
28486
28487 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28488 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28489 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28490 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28491
28492 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28493 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28494 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28495 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28496
28497 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28498 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28499
28500 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28501
28502 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28503 information of the breakpoint.
28504
28505 @smallexample
28506 -> -break-insert main
28507 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28508 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28509 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28510 times="0"@}
28511 <- (gdb)
28512 @end smallexample
28513
28514 @subheading Program Execution
28515
28516 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28517 reason that execution stopped.
28518
28519 @smallexample
28520 -> -exec-run
28521 <- ^running
28522 <- (gdb)
28523 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28524 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28525 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28526 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28527 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28528 <- (gdb)
28529 -> -exec-continue
28530 <- ^running
28531 <- (gdb)
28532 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28533 <- (gdb)
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28537
28538 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28539
28540 @smallexample
28541 -> (gdb)
28542 <- -gdb-exit
28543 <- ^exit
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28547 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28548 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28549 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28550 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28551 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28552
28553 @subheading A Bad Command
28554
28555 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28556
28557 @smallexample
28558 -> -rubbish
28559 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28560 <- (gdb)
28561 @end smallexample
28562
28563
28564 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28565 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28566 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28567
28568 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28569 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28570
28571 @subheading Motivation
28572
28573 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28574
28575 @subheading Introduction
28576
28577 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28578
28579 @subheading Commands
28580
28581 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28582
28583 @subsubheading Synopsis
28584
28585 @smallexample
28586 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589 @subsubheading Result
28590
28591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28592
28593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28594
28595 @subsubheading Example
28596
28597 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28598 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28599
28600
28601 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28602 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28603 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28604
28605 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28606 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28607 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28608 breakpoints.
28609
28610 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28611 @findex -break-after
28612
28613 @subsubheading Synopsis
28614
28615 @smallexample
28616 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28617 @end smallexample
28618
28619 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28620 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28621 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28622 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28623
28624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28625
28626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28627
28628 @subsubheading Example
28629
28630 @smallexample
28631 (gdb)
28632 -break-insert main
28633 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28634 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28635 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28636 times="0"@}
28637 (gdb)
28638 -break-after 1 3
28639 ~
28640 ^done
28641 (gdb)
28642 -break-list
28643 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28644 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28645 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28646 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28647 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28648 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28649 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28650 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28651 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28652 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28653 (gdb)
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656 @ignore
28657 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28658 @findex -break-catch
28659 @end ignore
28660
28661 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28662 @findex -break-commands
28663
28664 @subsubheading Synopsis
28665
28666 @smallexample
28667 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28668 @end smallexample
28669
28670 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28671 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28672 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28673 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28674 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28675 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28676
28677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28678
28679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28680
28681 @subsubheading Example
28682
28683 @smallexample
28684 (gdb)
28685 -break-insert main
28686 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28687 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28688 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28689 times="0"@}
28690 (gdb)
28691 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28692 ^done
28693 (gdb)
28694 @end smallexample
28695
28696 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28697 @findex -break-condition
28698
28699 @subsubheading Synopsis
28700
28701 @smallexample
28702 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28706 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28707 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28708 command below).
28709
28710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28711
28712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28713
28714 @subsubheading Example
28715
28716 @smallexample
28717 (gdb)
28718 -break-condition 1 1
28719 ^done
28720 (gdb)
28721 -break-list
28722 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28723 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28724 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28725 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28726 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28727 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28728 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28729 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28730 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28731 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28732 (gdb)
28733 @end smallexample
28734
28735 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28736 @findex -break-delete
28737
28738 @subsubheading Synopsis
28739
28740 @smallexample
28741 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28742 @end smallexample
28743
28744 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28745 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28746
28747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28748
28749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28750
28751 @subsubheading Example
28752
28753 @smallexample
28754 (gdb)
28755 -break-delete 1
28756 ^done
28757 (gdb)
28758 -break-list
28759 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28760 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28761 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28762 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28763 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28764 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28765 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28766 body=[]@}
28767 (gdb)
28768 @end smallexample
28769
28770 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28771 @findex -break-disable
28772
28773 @subsubheading Synopsis
28774
28775 @smallexample
28776 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28777 @end smallexample
28778
28779 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28780 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28781
28782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28783
28784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28785
28786 @subsubheading Example
28787
28788 @smallexample
28789 (gdb)
28790 -break-disable 2
28791 ^done
28792 (gdb)
28793 -break-list
28794 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28795 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28796 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28797 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28798 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28799 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28800 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28801 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28802 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28803 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28804 (gdb)
28805 @end smallexample
28806
28807 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28808 @findex -break-enable
28809
28810 @subsubheading Synopsis
28811
28812 @smallexample
28813 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28814 @end smallexample
28815
28816 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28817
28818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28819
28820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28821
28822 @subsubheading Example
28823
28824 @smallexample
28825 (gdb)
28826 -break-enable 2
28827 ^done
28828 (gdb)
28829 -break-list
28830 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28831 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28832 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28833 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28834 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28835 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28836 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28837 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28838 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28839 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28840 (gdb)
28841 @end smallexample
28842
28843 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28844 @findex -break-info
28845
28846 @subsubheading Synopsis
28847
28848 @smallexample
28849 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28850 @end smallexample
28851
28852 @c REDUNDANT???
28853 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28854
28855 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28856 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28857 table.
28858
28859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28860
28861 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28862
28863 @subsubheading Example
28864 N.A.
28865
28866 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28867 @findex -break-insert
28868 @anchor{-break-insert}
28869
28870 @subsubheading Synopsis
28871
28872 @smallexample
28873 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28874 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28875 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28876 @end smallexample
28877
28878 @noindent
28879 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28880
28881 @table @var
28882 @item linespec location
28883 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28884
28885 @item explicit location
28886 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28887 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28888 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28889
28890 @table @samp
28891 @item --source @var{filename}
28892 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28893 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28894
28895 @item --function @var{function}
28896 The name of a function or method.
28897
28898 @item --label @var{label}
28899 The name of a label.
28900
28901 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28902 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28903 @end table
28904
28905 @item address location
28906 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28907 @end table
28908
28909 @noindent
28910 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28911
28912 @table @samp
28913 @item -t
28914 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28915 @item -h
28916 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28917 @item -f
28918 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28919 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28920 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28921 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28922 cannot be parsed.
28923 @item -d
28924 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28925 @item -a
28926 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28927 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28928 @item -c @var{condition}
28929 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28930 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28931 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28932 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28933 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28934 @var{thread-id}.
28935 @end table
28936
28937 @subsubheading Result
28938
28939 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28940 resulting breakpoint.
28941
28942 Note: this format is open to change.
28943 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28944
28945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28946
28947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28948 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28949
28950 @subsubheading Example
28951
28952 @smallexample
28953 (gdb)
28954 -break-insert main
28955 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28956 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28957 times="0"@}
28958 (gdb)
28959 -break-insert -t foo
28960 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28961 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28962 times="0"@}
28963 (gdb)
28964 -break-list
28965 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28966 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28967 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28968 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28969 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28970 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28971 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28972 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28973 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28974 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28975 times="0"@},
28976 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28977 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28978 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28979 times="0"@}]@}
28980 (gdb)
28981 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28982 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28983 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28984 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28985 @c times="0"@}
28986 @c (gdb)
28987 @end smallexample
28988
28989 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28990 @findex -dprintf-insert
28991
28992 @subsubheading Synopsis
28993
28994 @smallexample
28995 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28996 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28997 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28998 [ @var{argument} ]
28999 @end smallexample
29000
29001 @noindent
29002 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
29003 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
29004
29005 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29006
29007 @table @samp
29008 @item -t
29009 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29010 @item -f
29011 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29012 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29013 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29014 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29015 cannot be parsed.
29016 @item -d
29017 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29018 @item -c @var{condition}
29019 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29020 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29021 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29022 to @var{ignore-count}.
29023 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29024 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29025 @var{thread-id}.
29026 @end table
29027
29028 @subsubheading Result
29029
29030 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29031 resulting breakpoint.
29032
29033 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29034
29035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29036
29037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29038
29039 @subsubheading Example
29040
29041 @smallexample
29042 (gdb)
29043 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29044 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29045 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29046 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29047 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29048 original-location="foo"@}
29049 (gdb)
29050 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29051 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29052 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29053 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29054 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29055 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29056 (gdb)
29057 @end smallexample
29058
29059 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29060 @findex -break-list
29061
29062 @subsubheading Synopsis
29063
29064 @smallexample
29065 -break-list
29066 @end smallexample
29067
29068 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29069
29070 @table @samp
29071 @item Number
29072 number of the breakpoint
29073 @item Type
29074 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29075 @item Disposition
29076 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29077 or @samp{nokeep}
29078 @item Enabled
29079 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29080 @item Address
29081 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29082 @item What
29083 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29084 name, line number
29085 @item Thread-groups
29086 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29087 @item Times
29088 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29089 @end table
29090
29091 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29092 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29093
29094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29095
29096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29097
29098 @subsubheading Example
29099
29100 @smallexample
29101 (gdb)
29102 -break-list
29103 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29104 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29105 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29106 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29107 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29108 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29109 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29110 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29111 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29112 times="0"@},
29113 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29114 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29115 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29116 (gdb)
29117 @end smallexample
29118
29119 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29120
29121 @smallexample
29122 (gdb)
29123 -break-list
29124 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29125 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29126 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29127 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29128 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29129 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29130 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29131 body=[]@}
29132 (gdb)
29133 @end smallexample
29134
29135 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29136 @findex -break-passcount
29137
29138 @subsubheading Synopsis
29139
29140 @smallexample
29141 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29142 @end smallexample
29143
29144 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29145 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29146 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29147 command @samp{passcount}.
29148
29149 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29150 @findex -break-watch
29151
29152 @subsubheading Synopsis
29153
29154 @smallexample
29155 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29156 @end smallexample
29157
29158 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29159 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29160 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29161 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29162 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29163 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29164 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29165 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29166
29167 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29168 breakpoints inserted.
29169
29170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29171
29172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29173 @samp{rwatch}.
29174
29175 @subsubheading Example
29176
29177 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29178
29179 @smallexample
29180 (gdb)
29181 -break-watch x
29182 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29183 (gdb)
29184 -exec-continue
29185 ^running
29186 (gdb)
29187 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29188 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29189 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29190 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29191 (gdb)
29192 @end smallexample
29193
29194 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29195 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29196 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29197
29198 @smallexample
29199 (gdb)
29200 -break-watch C
29201 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29202 (gdb)
29203 -exec-continue
29204 ^running
29205 (gdb)
29206 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29207 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29208 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29209 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29210 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29211 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29212 (gdb)
29213 -exec-continue
29214 ^running
29215 (gdb)
29216 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29217 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29218 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29219 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29220 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29221 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29222 (gdb)
29223 @end smallexample
29224
29225 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29226 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29227 deleted.
29228
29229 @smallexample
29230 (gdb)
29231 -break-watch C
29232 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29233 (gdb)
29234 -break-list
29235 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29236 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29237 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29238 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29239 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29240 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29241 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29242 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29243 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29244 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29245 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29246 times="1"@},
29247 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29248 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29249 (gdb)
29250 -exec-continue
29251 ^running
29252 (gdb)
29253 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29254 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29255 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29256 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29257 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29258 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29259 (gdb)
29260 -break-list
29261 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29262 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29263 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29264 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29265 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29266 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29267 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29268 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29269 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29270 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29271 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29272 times="1"@},
29273 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29274 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29275 (gdb)
29276 -exec-continue
29277 ^running
29278 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29279 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29280 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29281 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29282 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29283 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29284 (gdb)
29285 -break-list
29286 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29287 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29288 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29289 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29290 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29291 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29292 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29293 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29294 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29295 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29296 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29297 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29298 (gdb)
29299 @end smallexample
29300
29301
29302 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29303 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29304 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29305
29306 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29307 catchpoints.
29308
29309 @menu
29310 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29311 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29312 @end menu
29313
29314 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29315 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29316
29317 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29318 @findex -catch-load
29319
29320 @subsubheading Synopsis
29321
29322 @smallexample
29323 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29324 @end smallexample
29325
29326 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29327 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29328 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29329 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29330 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29331
29332
29333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29334
29335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29336
29337 @subsubheading Example
29338
29339 @smallexample
29340 -catch-load -t foo.so
29341 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29342 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29343 (gdb)
29344 @end smallexample
29345
29346
29347 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29348 @findex -catch-unload
29349
29350 @subsubheading Synopsis
29351
29352 @smallexample
29353 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29354 @end smallexample
29355
29356 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29357 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29358 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29359 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29360 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29361
29362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29363
29364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29365
29366 @subsubheading Example
29367
29368 @smallexample
29369 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29370 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29371 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29372 (gdb)
29373 @end smallexample
29374
29375 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29376 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29377
29378 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29379 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29380
29381 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29382 @findex -catch-assert
29383
29384 @subsubheading Synopsis
29385
29386 @smallexample
29387 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29388 @end smallexample
29389
29390 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29391
29392 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29393
29394 @table @samp
29395 @item -c @var{condition}
29396 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29397 @item -d
29398 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29399 @item -t
29400 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29401 @end table
29402
29403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29404
29405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29406
29407 @subsubheading Example
29408
29409 @smallexample
29410 -catch-assert
29411 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29412 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29413 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29414 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29415 (gdb)
29416 @end smallexample
29417
29418 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29419 @findex -catch-exception
29420
29421 @subsubheading Synopsis
29422
29423 @smallexample
29424 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29425 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29426 @end smallexample
29427
29428 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29429 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29430 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29431 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29432 catchpoints.
29433
29434 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29435
29436 @table @samp
29437 @item -c @var{condition}
29438 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29439 @item -d
29440 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29441 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29442 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29443 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29444 @item -t
29445 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29446 @item -u
29447 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29448 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29449 @end table
29450
29451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29452
29453 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29454 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29455
29456 @subsubheading Example
29457
29458 @smallexample
29459 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29460 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29461 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29462 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29463 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29464 (gdb)
29465 @end smallexample
29466
29467 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29468 @findex -catch-handlers
29469
29470 @subsubheading Synopsis
29471
29472 @smallexample
29473 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29474 [ -t ]
29475 @end smallexample
29476
29477 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29478 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29479 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29480 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29481 catchpoints.
29482
29483 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29484
29485 @table @samp
29486 @item -c @var{condition}
29487 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29488 @item -d
29489 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29490 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29491 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29492 @item -t
29493 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29494 @end table
29495
29496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29497
29498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29499
29500 @subsubheading Example
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29504 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29505 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29506 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29507 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29508 (gdb)
29509 @end smallexample
29510
29511 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29512 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29513 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29514
29515 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29516 @findex -exec-arguments
29517
29518
29519 @subsubheading Synopsis
29520
29521 @smallexample
29522 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29523 @end smallexample
29524
29525 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29526 @samp{-exec-run}.
29527
29528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29529
29530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29531
29532 @subsubheading Example
29533
29534 @smallexample
29535 (gdb)
29536 -exec-arguments -v word
29537 ^done
29538 (gdb)
29539 @end smallexample
29540
29541
29542 @ignore
29543 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29544 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29545
29546 @subsubheading Synopsis
29547
29548 @smallexample
29549 -exec-show-arguments
29550 @end smallexample
29551
29552 Print the arguments of the program.
29553
29554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29555
29556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29557
29558 @subsubheading Example
29559 N.A.
29560 @end ignore
29561
29562
29563 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29564 @findex -environment-cd
29565
29566 @subsubheading Synopsis
29567
29568 @smallexample
29569 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29573
29574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29575
29576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29577
29578 @subsubheading Example
29579
29580 @smallexample
29581 (gdb)
29582 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29583 ^done
29584 (gdb)
29585 @end smallexample
29586
29587
29588 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29589 @findex -environment-directory
29590
29591 @subsubheading Synopsis
29592
29593 @smallexample
29594 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29595 @end smallexample
29596
29597 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29598 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29599 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29600 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29601 occurs as normal.
29602 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29603 multiple directories in a single command
29604 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29605 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29606 If blanks are needed as
29607 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29608 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29609 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29610 character must not be used
29611 in any directory name.
29612 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29613
29614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29615
29616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29617
29618 @subsubheading Example
29619
29620 @smallexample
29621 (gdb)
29622 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29623 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29624 (gdb)
29625 -environment-directory ""
29626 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29627 (gdb)
29628 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29629 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29630 (gdb)
29631 -environment-directory -r
29632 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29633 (gdb)
29634 @end smallexample
29635
29636
29637 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29638 @findex -environment-path
29639
29640 @subsubheading Synopsis
29641
29642 @smallexample
29643 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29644 @end smallexample
29645
29646 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29647 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29648 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29649 supplied in addition to the
29650 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29651 occurs as normal.
29652 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29653 multiple directories in a single command
29654 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29655 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29656 If blanks are needed as
29657 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29658 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29659 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29660 character must not be used
29661 in any directory name.
29662 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29663
29664
29665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29666
29667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29668
29669 @subsubheading Example
29670
29671 @smallexample
29672 (gdb)
29673 -environment-path
29674 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29675 (gdb)
29676 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29677 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29678 (gdb)
29679 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29680 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29681 (gdb)
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684
29685 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29686 @findex -environment-pwd
29687
29688 @subsubheading Synopsis
29689
29690 @smallexample
29691 -environment-pwd
29692 @end smallexample
29693
29694 Show the current working directory.
29695
29696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29697
29698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29699
29700 @subsubheading Example
29701
29702 @smallexample
29703 (gdb)
29704 -environment-pwd
29705 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29706 (gdb)
29707 @end smallexample
29708
29709 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29710 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29711 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29712
29713
29714 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29715 @findex -thread-info
29716
29717 @subsubheading Synopsis
29718
29719 @smallexample
29720 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29724 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29725 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29726 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29727 current thread.
29728
29729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29730
29731 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29732 about all threads.
29733
29734 @subsubheading Result
29735
29736 The result contains the following attributes:
29737
29738 @table @samp
29739 @item threads
29740 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29741 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29742
29743 @item current-thread-id
29744 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29745 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29746 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29747 the command.
29748
29749 @end table
29750
29751 @subsubheading Example
29752
29753 @smallexample
29754 -thread-info
29755 ^done,threads=[
29756 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29757 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29758 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29759 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29760 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29761 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29762 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29763 state="running"@}],
29764 current-thread-id="1"
29765 (gdb)
29766 @end smallexample
29767
29768 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29769 @findex -thread-list-ids
29770
29771 @subsubheading Synopsis
29772
29773 @smallexample
29774 -thread-list-ids
29775 @end smallexample
29776
29777 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29778 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29779 threads.
29780
29781 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29782 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29783
29784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29785
29786 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29787
29788 @subsubheading Example
29789
29790 @smallexample
29791 (gdb)
29792 -thread-list-ids
29793 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29794 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29795 (gdb)
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798
29799 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29800 @findex -thread-select
29801
29802 @subsubheading Synopsis
29803
29804 @smallexample
29805 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29806 @end smallexample
29807
29808 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29809 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29810 topmost frame for that thread.
29811
29812 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29813 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29814
29815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29816
29817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29818
29819 @subsubheading Example
29820
29821 @smallexample
29822 (gdb)
29823 -exec-next
29824 ^running
29825 (gdb)
29826 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29827 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29828 (gdb)
29829 -thread-list-ids
29830 ^done,
29831 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29832 number-of-threads="3"
29833 (gdb)
29834 -thread-select 3
29835 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29836 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29837 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29838 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29839 (gdb)
29840 @end smallexample
29841
29842 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29843 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29844 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29845
29846 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29847 @findex -ada-task-info
29848
29849 @subsubheading Synopsis
29850
29851 @smallexample
29852 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29853 @end smallexample
29854
29855 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29856 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29857
29858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29859
29860 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29861 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29862
29863 @subsubheading Result
29864
29865 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29866 defined for each Ada task:
29867
29868 @table @samp
29869 @item current
29870 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29871
29872 @item id
29873 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29874
29875 @item task-id
29876 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29877
29878 @item thread-id
29879 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29880 task.
29881
29882 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29883 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29884 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29885
29886 @item parent-id
29887 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29888 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29889
29890 @item priority
29891 The base priority of the task.
29892
29893 @item state
29894 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29895 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29896
29897 @item name
29898 The name of the task.
29899
29900 @end table
29901
29902 @subsubheading Example
29903
29904 @smallexample
29905 -ada-task-info
29906 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29907 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29908 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29909 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29910 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29911 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29912 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29913 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29914 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29915 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29916 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29917 (gdb)
29918 @end smallexample
29919
29920 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29921 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29922 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29923
29924 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29925 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29926 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29927 other cases.
29928
29929 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29930 @findex -exec-continue
29931
29932 @subsubheading Synopsis
29933
29934 @smallexample
29935 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29936 @end smallexample
29937
29938 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29939 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29940 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29941 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29942 @itemize @bullet
29943 @item
29944 breakpoints or watchpoints
29945 @item
29946 signals or exceptions
29947 @item
29948 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29949 @item
29950 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29951 @end itemize
29952 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29953 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29954 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29955 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29956 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29957 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29958
29959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29960
29961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29962
29963 @subsubheading Example
29964
29965 @smallexample
29966 -exec-continue
29967 ^running
29968 (gdb)
29969 @@Hello world
29970 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29971 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29972 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29973 (gdb)
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976
29977 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29978 @findex -exec-finish
29979
29980 @subsubheading Synopsis
29981
29982 @smallexample
29983 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29984 @end smallexample
29985
29986 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29987 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29988 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29989 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29990 function was called.
29991
29992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29993
29994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29995
29996 @subsubheading Example
29997
29998 Function returning @code{void}.
29999
30000 @smallexample
30001 -exec-finish
30002 ^running
30003 (gdb)
30004 @@hello from foo
30005 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30006 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30007 (gdb)
30008 @end smallexample
30009
30010 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30011 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30012 value itself.
30013
30014 @smallexample
30015 -exec-finish
30016 ^running
30017 (gdb)
30018 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30019 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30020 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30021 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30022 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30023 (gdb)
30024 @end smallexample
30025
30026
30027 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30028 @findex -exec-interrupt
30029
30030 @subsubheading Synopsis
30031
30032 @smallexample
30033 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30034 @end smallexample
30035
30036 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30037 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30038 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30039 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30040 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30041
30042 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30043 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30044 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30045 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30046
30047 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30048 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30049 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30050 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30051
30052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30053
30054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30055
30056 @subsubheading Example
30057
30058 @smallexample
30059 (gdb)
30060 111-exec-continue
30061 111^running
30062
30063 (gdb)
30064 222-exec-interrupt
30065 222^done
30066 (gdb)
30067 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30068 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30069 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30070 (gdb)
30071
30072 (gdb)
30073 -exec-interrupt
30074 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30075 (gdb)
30076 @end smallexample
30077
30078 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30079 @findex -exec-jump
30080
30081 @subsubheading Synopsis
30082
30083 @smallexample
30084 -exec-jump @var{location}
30085 @end smallexample
30086
30087 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30088 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30089 different forms of @var{location}.
30090
30091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30092
30093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30094
30095 @subsubheading Example
30096
30097 @smallexample
30098 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30099 *running,thread-id="all"
30100 ^running
30101 @end smallexample
30102
30103
30104 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30105 @findex -exec-next
30106
30107 @subsubheading Synopsis
30108
30109 @smallexample
30110 -exec-next [--reverse]
30111 @end smallexample
30112
30113 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30114 of the next source line is reached.
30115
30116 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30117 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30118 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30119 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30120 source line where the function was called.
30121
30122
30123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30124
30125 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30126
30127 @subsubheading Example
30128
30129 @smallexample
30130 -exec-next
30131 ^running
30132 (gdb)
30133 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30134 (gdb)
30135 @end smallexample
30136
30137
30138 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30139 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30140
30141 @subsubheading Synopsis
30142
30143 @smallexample
30144 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30145 @end smallexample
30146
30147 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30148 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30149 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30150 printed as well.
30151
30152 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30153 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30154 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30155 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30156 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30157
30158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30159
30160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30161
30162 @subsubheading Example
30163
30164 @smallexample
30165 (gdb)
30166 -exec-next-instruction
30167 ^running
30168
30169 (gdb)
30170 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30171 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30172 (gdb)
30173 @end smallexample
30174
30175
30176 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30177 @findex -exec-return
30178
30179 @subsubheading Synopsis
30180
30181 @smallexample
30182 -exec-return
30183 @end smallexample
30184
30185 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30186 Displays the new current frame.
30187
30188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30189
30190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30191
30192 @subsubheading Example
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 (gdb)
30196 200-break-insert callee4
30197 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30198 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30199 (gdb)
30200 000-exec-run
30201 000^running
30202 (gdb)
30203 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30204 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30205 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30206 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30207 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30208 (gdb)
30209 205-break-delete
30210 205^done
30211 (gdb)
30212 111-exec-return
30213 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30214 args=[@{name="strarg",
30215 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30216 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30217 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30218 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30219 (gdb)
30220 @end smallexample
30221
30222
30223 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30224 @findex -exec-run
30225
30226 @subsubheading Synopsis
30227
30228 @smallexample
30229 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
30230 @end smallexample
30231
30232 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30233 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30234 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30235 the program has exited exceptionally.
30236
30237 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
30238 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30239 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30240 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30241 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30242
30243 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
30244 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
30245 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
30246 (@pxref{Starting}).
30247
30248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30249
30250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30251
30252 @subsubheading Examples
30253
30254 @smallexample
30255 (gdb)
30256 -break-insert main
30257 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30258 (gdb)
30259 -exec-run
30260 ^running
30261 (gdb)
30262 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30263 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30264 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30265 (gdb)
30266 @end smallexample
30267
30268 @noindent
30269 Program exited normally:
30270
30271 @smallexample
30272 (gdb)
30273 -exec-run
30274 ^running
30275 (gdb)
30276 x = 55
30277 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30278 (gdb)
30279 @end smallexample
30280
30281 @noindent
30282 Program exited exceptionally:
30283
30284 @smallexample
30285 (gdb)
30286 -exec-run
30287 ^running
30288 (gdb)
30289 x = 55
30290 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30291 (gdb)
30292 @end smallexample
30293
30294 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30295 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30296
30297 @smallexample
30298 (gdb)
30299 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30300 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30301 @end smallexample
30302
30303
30304 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30305
30306
30307 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30308 @findex -exec-step
30309
30310 @subsubheading Synopsis
30311
30312 @smallexample
30313 -exec-step [--reverse]
30314 @end smallexample
30315
30316 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30317 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30318 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30319 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30320 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30321 previously executed source line.
30322
30323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30324
30325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30326
30327 @subsubheading Example
30328
30329 Stepping into a function:
30330
30331 @smallexample
30332 -exec-step
30333 ^running
30334 (gdb)
30335 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30336 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30337 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30338 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30339 (gdb)
30340 @end smallexample
30341
30342 Regular stepping:
30343
30344 @smallexample
30345 -exec-step
30346 ^running
30347 (gdb)
30348 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30349 (gdb)
30350 @end smallexample
30351
30352
30353 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30354 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30355
30356 @subsubheading Synopsis
30357
30358 @smallexample
30359 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30360 @end smallexample
30361
30362 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30363 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30364 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30365 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30366 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30367 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30368 as well.
30369
30370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30371
30372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30373
30374 @subsubheading Example
30375
30376 @smallexample
30377 (gdb)
30378 -exec-step-instruction
30379 ^running
30380
30381 (gdb)
30382 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30383 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30384 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30385 (gdb)
30386 -exec-step-instruction
30387 ^running
30388
30389 (gdb)
30390 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30391 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30392 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30393 (gdb)
30394 @end smallexample
30395
30396
30397 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30398 @findex -exec-until
30399
30400 @subsubheading Synopsis
30401
30402 @smallexample
30403 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30404 @end smallexample
30405
30406 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30407 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30408 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30409 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30410
30411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30412
30413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30414
30415 @subsubheading Example
30416
30417 @smallexample
30418 (gdb)
30419 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30420 ^running
30421 (gdb)
30422 x = 55
30423 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30424 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30425 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30426 (gdb)
30427 @end smallexample
30428
30429 @ignore
30430 @subheading -file-clear
30431 Is this going away????
30432 @end ignore
30433
30434 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30435 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30436 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30437
30438 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30439 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30440
30441 @smallexample
30442 -enable-frame-filters
30443 @end smallexample
30444
30445 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30446 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30447 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30448 request that this functionality be enabled.
30449
30450 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30451
30452 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30453 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30454
30455 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30456 @findex -stack-info-frame
30457
30458 @subsubheading Synopsis
30459
30460 @smallexample
30461 -stack-info-frame
30462 @end smallexample
30463
30464 Get info on the selected frame.
30465
30466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30467
30468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30469 (without arguments).
30470
30471 @subsubheading Example
30472
30473 @smallexample
30474 (gdb)
30475 -stack-info-frame
30476 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30477 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30478 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30479 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30480 (gdb)
30481 @end smallexample
30482
30483 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30484 @findex -stack-info-depth
30485
30486 @subsubheading Synopsis
30487
30488 @smallexample
30489 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30490 @end smallexample
30491
30492 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30493 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30494
30495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30496
30497 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30498
30499 @subsubheading Example
30500
30501 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30502
30503 @smallexample
30504 (gdb)
30505 -stack-info-depth
30506 ^done,depth="12"
30507 (gdb)
30508 -stack-info-depth 4
30509 ^done,depth="4"
30510 (gdb)
30511 -stack-info-depth 12
30512 ^done,depth="12"
30513 (gdb)
30514 -stack-info-depth 11
30515 ^done,depth="11"
30516 (gdb)
30517 -stack-info-depth 13
30518 ^done,depth="12"
30519 (gdb)
30520 @end smallexample
30521
30522 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30523 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30524 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30525
30526 @subsubheading Synopsis
30527
30528 @smallexample
30529 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30530 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30531 @end smallexample
30532
30533 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30534 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30535 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30536 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30537 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30538 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30539 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30540 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30541
30542 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30543 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30544 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30545 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30546 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30547 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30548
30549 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30550 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30551 are still displayed, however.
30552
30553 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30554 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30555
30556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30557
30558 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30559 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30560 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30561
30562 @subsubheading Example
30563
30564 @smallexample
30565 (gdb)
30566 -stack-list-frames
30567 ^done,
30568 stack=[
30569 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30570 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30571 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30572 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30573 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30574 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30575 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30576 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30577 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30578 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30579 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30580 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30581 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30582 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30583 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30584 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30585 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30586 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30587 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30588 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30589 (gdb)
30590 -stack-list-arguments 0
30591 ^done,
30592 stack-args=[
30593 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30594 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30595 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30596 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30597 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30598 (gdb)
30599 -stack-list-arguments 1
30600 ^done,
30601 stack-args=[
30602 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30603 frame=@{level="1",
30604 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30605 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30606 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30607 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30608 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30609 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30610 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30611 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30612 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30613 (gdb)
30614 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30615 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30616 (gdb)
30617 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30618 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30619 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30620 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30621 (gdb)
30622 @end smallexample
30623
30624 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30625
30626
30627 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30628 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30629 @findex -stack-list-frames
30630
30631 @subsubheading Synopsis
30632
30633 @smallexample
30634 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30635 @end smallexample
30636
30637 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30638 following info:
30639
30640 @table @samp
30641 @item @var{level}
30642 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30643 @item @var{addr}
30644 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30645 @item @var{func}
30646 Function name.
30647 @item @var{file}
30648 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30649 @item @var{fullname}
30650 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30651 @item @var{line}
30652 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30653 @item @var{from}
30654 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30655 if the frame's function is not known.
30656 @item @var{arch}
30657 Frame's architecture.
30658 @end table
30659
30660 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30661 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30662 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30663 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30664 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30665 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30666 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30667 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30668 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30669
30670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30671
30672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30673
30674 @subsubheading Example
30675
30676 Full stack backtrace:
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 (gdb)
30680 -stack-list-frames
30681 ^done,stack=
30682 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30683 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30684 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30685 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30686 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30687 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30688 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30689 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30690 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30691 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30692 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30693 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30694 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30695 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30696 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30697 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30698 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30699 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30700 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30701 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30702 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30703 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30704 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30705 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30706 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30707 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30708 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30709 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30710 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30711 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30712 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30713 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30714 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30715 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30716 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30717 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30718 (gdb)
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30722
30723 @smallexample
30724 (gdb)
30725 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30726 ^done,stack=
30727 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30728 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30729 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30730 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30731 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30732 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30733 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30734 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30735 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30736 (gdb)
30737 @end smallexample
30738
30739 Show a single frame:
30740
30741 @smallexample
30742 (gdb)
30743 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30744 ^done,stack=
30745 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30746 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30747 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30748 (gdb)
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751
30752 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30753 @findex -stack-list-locals
30754 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30755
30756 @subsubheading Synopsis
30757
30758 @smallexample
30759 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30760 @end smallexample
30761
30762 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30763 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30764 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30765 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30766 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30767 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30768 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30769 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30770 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30771 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30772
30773 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30774 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30775 variables are still displayed, however.
30776
30777 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30778 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30779
30780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30781
30782 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30783
30784 @subsubheading Example
30785
30786 @smallexample
30787 (gdb)
30788 -stack-list-locals 0
30789 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30790 (gdb)
30791 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30792 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30793 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30794 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30795 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30796 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30797 (gdb)
30798 @end smallexample
30799
30800 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30801 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30802 @findex -stack-list-variables
30803
30804 @subsubheading Synopsis
30805
30806 @smallexample
30807 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30808 @end smallexample
30809
30810 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30811 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30812 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30813 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30814 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30815 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30816 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30817
30818 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30819 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30820 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30821
30822 @subsubheading Example
30823
30824 @smallexample
30825 (gdb)
30826 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30827 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30828 (gdb)
30829 @end smallexample
30830
30831
30832 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30833 @findex -stack-select-frame
30834
30835 @subsubheading Synopsis
30836
30837 @smallexample
30838 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30839 @end smallexample
30840
30841 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30842 the stack.
30843
30844 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30845 option to every command.
30846
30847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30848
30849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30850 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30851
30852 @subsubheading Example
30853
30854 @smallexample
30855 (gdb)
30856 -stack-select-frame 2
30857 ^done
30858 (gdb)
30859 @end smallexample
30860
30861 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30862 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30863 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30864
30865 @ignore
30866
30867 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30868
30869 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30870 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30871 used by @code{Insight}.
30872
30873 The two main reasons for that are:
30874
30875 @enumerate 1
30876 @item
30877 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30878
30879 @item
30880 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30881 now).
30882 @end enumerate
30883
30884 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30885 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30886 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30887 hints about their use.
30888
30889 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30890 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30891 least, the following operations:
30892
30893 @itemize @bullet
30894 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30895 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30896 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30897 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30898 @end itemize
30899
30900 @end ignore
30901
30902 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30903
30904 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30905
30906 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30907 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30908 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30909 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30910 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30911 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30912 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30913 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30914 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30915 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30916 object, or to change display format.
30917
30918 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30919 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30920 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30921 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30922 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30923 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30924 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30925 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30926 child will be created.
30927
30928 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30929 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30930 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30931 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30932 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30933
30934 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30935 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30936 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30937 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30938 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30939 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30940 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30941 variables that frontend has created.
30942
30943 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30944 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30945 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30946 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30947 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30948 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30949 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30950 implicitly updated.
30951
30952 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30953 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30954 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30955 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30956 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30957 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30958 frame. Consider this example:
30959
30960 @smallexample
30961 void do_work(...)
30962 @{
30963 struct work_state state;
30964
30965 if (...)
30966 do_work(...);
30967 @}
30968 @end smallexample
30969
30970 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30971 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30972 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30973 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30974 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30975
30976 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30977 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30978 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30979 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30980 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30981 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30982
30983 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30984 access this functionality:
30985
30986 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30987 @item @strong{Operation}
30988 @tab @strong{Description}
30989
30990 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30991 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30992 @item @code{-var-create}
30993 @tab create a variable object
30994 @item @code{-var-delete}
30995 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30996 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30997 @tab set the display format of this variable
30998 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30999 @tab show the display format of this variable
31000 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31001 @tab tells how many children this object has
31002 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31003 @tab return a list of the object's children
31004 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31005 @tab show the type of this variable object
31006 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31007 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31008 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31009 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31010 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31011 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31012 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31013 @tab get the value of this variable
31014 @item @code{-var-assign}
31015 @tab set the value of this variable
31016 @item @code{-var-update}
31017 @tab update the variable and its children
31018 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31019 @tab set frozeness attribute
31020 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31021 @tab set range of children to display on update
31022 @end multitable
31023
31024 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31025 how it can be used.
31026
31027 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31028
31029 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31030 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31031
31032 @smallexample
31033 -enable-pretty-printing
31034 @end smallexample
31035
31036 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31037 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31038 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31039 request that this functionality be enabled.
31040
31041 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31042
31043 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31044 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31045
31046 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31047 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31048
31049 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31050 @findex -var-create
31051
31052 @subsubheading Synopsis
31053
31054 @smallexample
31055 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31056 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31057 @end smallexample
31058
31059 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31060 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31061 register.
31062
31063 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31064 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31065 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31066 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31067 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31068
31069 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31070 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31071 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31072 object must be created.
31073
31074 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31075 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31076
31077 @itemize @bullet
31078 @item
31079 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31080
31081 @item
31082 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31083
31084 @item
31085 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31086 @end itemize
31087
31088 @cindex dynamic varobj
31089 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31090 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31091 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31092 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31093 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31094 compatibility for existing clients.
31095
31096 @subsubheading Result
31097
31098 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31099 are:
31100
31101 @table @samp
31102 @item name
31103 The name of the varobj.
31104
31105 @item numchild
31106 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31107 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31108 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31109
31110 @item value
31111 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31112 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31113 will not be interesting.
31114
31115 @item type
31116 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31117 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31118 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31119 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31120 @emph{declared} one.
31121
31122 @item thread-id
31123 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31124 thread's global identifier.
31125
31126 @item has_more
31127 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31128 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31129
31130 @item dynamic
31131 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31132 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31133 then this attribute will not be present.
31134
31135 @item displayhint
31136 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31137 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31138 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31139 @end table
31140
31141 Typical output will look like this:
31142
31143 @smallexample
31144 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31145 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31146 @end smallexample
31147
31148
31149 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31150 @findex -var-delete
31151
31152 @subsubheading Synopsis
31153
31154 @smallexample
31155 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31159 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31160
31161 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31162
31163
31164 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31165 @findex -var-set-format
31166
31167 @subsubheading Synopsis
31168
31169 @smallexample
31170 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31171 @end smallexample
31172
31173 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31174 @var{format-spec}.
31175
31176 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31177 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31181 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
31182 @end smallexample
31183
31184 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31185 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31186 for pointers, etc.).
31187
31188 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
31189 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
31190 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
31191 zero-hexadecimal format.
31192
31193 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31194 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31195
31196 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31197 @findex -var-show-format
31198
31199 @subsubheading Synopsis
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 -var-show-format @var{name}
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 @var{format} @expansion{}
31209 @var{format-spec}
31210 @end smallexample
31211
31212
31213 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31214 @findex -var-info-num-children
31215
31216 @subsubheading Synopsis
31217
31218 @smallexample
31219 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31220 @end smallexample
31221
31222 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31223
31224 @smallexample
31225 numchild=@var{n}
31226 @end smallexample
31227
31228 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31229 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31230 be available.
31231
31232
31233 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31234 @findex -var-list-children
31235
31236 @subsubheading Synopsis
31237
31238 @smallexample
31239 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31240 @end smallexample
31241 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31242
31243 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31244 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31245 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31246 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31247 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31248 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31249 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31250 and unions.
31251
31252 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31253 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31254 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31255 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31256 reported.
31257
31258 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31259 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31260 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31261 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31262 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31263 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31264 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31265 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31266 the visible items.
31267
31268 For each child the following results are returned:
31269
31270 @table @var
31271
31272 @item name
31273 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31274
31275 @item exp
31276 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31277 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31278
31279 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31280 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31281
31282 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31283 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31284 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31285 type and value are not present.
31286
31287 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31288 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31289 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31290
31291 @item numchild
31292 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31293 0.
31294
31295 @item type
31296 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31297 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31298 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31299 @emph{declared} one.
31300
31301 @item value
31302 If values were requested, this is the value.
31303
31304 @item thread-id
31305 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31306 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31307
31308 @item frozen
31309 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31310
31311 @item displayhint
31312 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31313 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31314 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31315
31316 @item dynamic
31317 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31318 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31319 then this attribute will not be present.
31320
31321 @end table
31322
31323 The result may have its own attributes:
31324
31325 @table @samp
31326 @item displayhint
31327 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31328 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31329 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31330
31331 @item has_more
31332 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31333 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31334 @end table
31335
31336 @subsubheading Example
31337
31338 @smallexample
31339 (gdb)
31340 -var-list-children n
31341 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31342 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31343 (gdb)
31344 -var-list-children --all-values n
31345 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31346 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31347 @end smallexample
31348
31349
31350 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31351 @findex -var-info-type
31352
31353 @subsubheading Synopsis
31354
31355 @smallexample
31356 -var-info-type @var{name}
31357 @end smallexample
31358
31359 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31360 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31361 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31362
31363 @smallexample
31364 type=@var{typename}
31365 @end smallexample
31366
31367
31368 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31369 @findex -var-info-expression
31370
31371 @subsubheading Synopsis
31372
31373 @smallexample
31374 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31375 @end smallexample
31376
31377 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31378 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31379 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31380
31381 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31382 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31383
31384 @smallexample
31385 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31386 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31387 @end smallexample
31388
31389 @noindent
31390 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31391 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31392
31393 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31394 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31395 is of limited use.
31396
31397 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31398 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31399
31400 @subsubheading Synopsis
31401
31402 @smallexample
31403 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31404 @end smallexample
31405
31406 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31407 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31408 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31409 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31410 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31411 watchpoint from a variable object.
31412
31413 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31414 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31415
31416 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31417 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31418 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31419 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31420 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31421 @smallexample
31422 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31423 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31424 @end smallexample
31425
31426 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31427 @findex -var-show-attributes
31428
31429 @subsubheading Synopsis
31430
31431 @smallexample
31432 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31433 @end smallexample
31434
31435 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31436
31437 @smallexample
31438 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31439 @end smallexample
31440
31441 @noindent
31442 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31443
31444 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31445 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31446
31447 @subsubheading Synopsis
31448
31449 @smallexample
31450 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31451 @end smallexample
31452
31453 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31454 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31455 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31456 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31457 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31458 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31459 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 value=@var{value}
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31466 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31467
31468 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31469 @findex -var-assign
31470
31471 @subsubheading Synopsis
31472
31473 @smallexample
31474 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31475 @end smallexample
31476
31477 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31478 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31479 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31480 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31481
31482 @subsubheading Example
31483
31484 @smallexample
31485 (gdb)
31486 -var-assign var1 3
31487 ^done,value="3"
31488 (gdb)
31489 -var-update *
31490 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31491 (gdb)
31492 @end smallexample
31493
31494 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31495 @findex -var-update
31496
31497 @subsubheading Synopsis
31498
31499 @smallexample
31500 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31501 @end smallexample
31502
31503 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31504 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31505 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31506 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31507 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31508 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31509 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31510 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31511 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31512 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31513 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31514 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31515 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31516
31517 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31518 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31519 diagnostic.
31520
31521 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31522 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31523
31524 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31525 @samp{changelist}.
31526
31527 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31528
31529 @table @samp
31530 @item name
31531 The name of the varobj.
31532
31533 @item value
31534 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31535 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31536
31537 @item in_scope
31538 @anchor{-var-update}
31539 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31540
31541 @table @code
31542 @item "true"
31543 The variable object's current value is valid.
31544
31545 @item "false"
31546 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31547 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31548 scope.
31549
31550 @item "invalid"
31551 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31552 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31553 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31554 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31555 objects.
31556 @end table
31557
31558 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31559 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31560
31561 @item type_changed
31562 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31563 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31564 be @samp{false}.
31565
31566 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31567 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31568 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31569 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31570 unset.
31571
31572 @item new_type
31573 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31574 hold the new type.
31575
31576 @item new_num_children
31577 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31578 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31579
31580 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31581 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31582 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31583 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31584 children which may be available.
31585
31586 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31587 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31588 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31589 only happen at the end of the update range).
31590
31591 @item displayhint
31592 The display hint, if any.
31593
31594 @item has_more
31595 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31596 available outside the varobj's update range.
31597
31598 @item dynamic
31599 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31600 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31601 then this attribute will not be present.
31602
31603 @item new_children
31604 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31605 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31606 be listed in this attribute.
31607 @end table
31608
31609 @subsubheading Example
31610
31611 @smallexample
31612 (gdb)
31613 -var-assign var1 3
31614 ^done,value="3"
31615 (gdb)
31616 -var-update --all-values var1
31617 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31618 type_changed="false"@}]
31619 (gdb)
31620 @end smallexample
31621
31622 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31623 @findex -var-set-frozen
31624 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31625
31626 @subsubheading Synopsis
31627
31628 @smallexample
31629 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31630 @end smallexample
31631
31632 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31633 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31634 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31635 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31636 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31637 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31638 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31639 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31640 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31641 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31642 @code{-var-update} does.
31643
31644 @subsubheading Example
31645
31646 @smallexample
31647 (gdb)
31648 -var-set-frozen V 1
31649 ^done
31650 (gdb)
31651 @end smallexample
31652
31653 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31654 @findex -var-set-update-range
31655 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31656
31657 @subsubheading Synopsis
31658
31659 @smallexample
31660 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31661 @end smallexample
31662
31663 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31664 @code{-var-update}.
31665
31666 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31667 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31668 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31669 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31670
31671 @subsubheading Example
31672
31673 @smallexample
31674 (gdb)
31675 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31676 ^done
31677 @end smallexample
31678
31679 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31680 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31681 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31682
31683 @subsubheading Synopsis
31684
31685 @smallexample
31686 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31690
31691 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31692 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31693
31694 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31695 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31696 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31697 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31698 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31699 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31700 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31701
31702 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31703 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31704 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31705 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31706
31707 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31708 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31709 can be used to check this.
31710
31711 @subsubheading Example
31712
31713 Resetting the visualizer:
31714
31715 @smallexample
31716 (gdb)
31717 -var-set-visualizer V None
31718 ^done
31719 @end smallexample
31720
31721 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 (gdb)
31725 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31726 ^done
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31730 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31731
31732 @smallexample
31733 (gdb)
31734 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31735 ^done
31736 @end smallexample
31737
31738 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31739 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31740 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31741
31742 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31743 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31744 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31745 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31746
31747 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31748 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31749
31750 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31751 @c @subheading -data-assign
31752 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31753 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31754 @c set variable
31755 @c @subsubheading Example
31756 @c N.A.
31757
31758 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31759 @findex -data-disassemble
31760
31761 @subsubheading Synopsis
31762
31763 @smallexample
31764 -data-disassemble
31765 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31766 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31767 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31768 -- @var{mode}
31769 @end smallexample
31770
31771 @noindent
31772 Where:
31773
31774 @table @samp
31775 @item @var{start-addr}
31776 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31777 @item @var{end-addr}
31778 is the end address
31779 @item @var{addr}
31780 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31781 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31782 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31783 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31784 @item @var{filename}
31785 is the name of the file to disassemble
31786 @item @var{linenum}
31787 is the line number to disassemble around
31788 @item @var{lines}
31789 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31790 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31791 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31792 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31793 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31794 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31795 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31796 are displayed.
31797 @item @var{mode}
31798 is one of:
31799 @itemize @bullet
31800 @item 0 disassembly only
31801 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31802 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31803 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31804 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31805 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31806 @end itemize
31807
31808 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31809 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31810 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31811 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31812 @end table
31813
31814 @subsubheading Result
31815
31816 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31817 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31818 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31819
31820 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31821 following fields:
31822
31823 @table @code
31824 @item address
31825 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31826
31827 @item func-name
31828 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31829
31830 @item offset
31831 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31832
31833 @item inst
31834 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31835
31836 @item opcodes
31837 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31838 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31839
31840 @end table
31841
31842 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31843 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31844
31845 @table @code
31846 @item line
31847 The line number within @samp{file}.
31848
31849 @item file
31850 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31851 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31852 used.
31853
31854 @item fullname
31855 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31856 using the source file search path
31857 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31858 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31859
31860 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31861 present in the debug information.
31862
31863 @item line_asm_insn
31864 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31865 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31866 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31867 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31868 @samp{opcodes}.
31869
31870 @end table
31871
31872 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31873 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31874 adjust its format.
31875
31876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31877
31878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31879
31880 @subsubheading Example
31881
31882 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31883
31884 @smallexample
31885 (gdb)
31886 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31887 ^done,
31888 asm_insns=[
31889 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31890 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31891 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31892 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31893 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31894 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31895 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31896 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31897 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31898 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31899 (gdb)
31900 @end smallexample
31901
31902 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31903 @code{main}.
31904
31905 @smallexample
31906 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31907 ^done,asm_insns=[
31908 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31909 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31910 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31911 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31912 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31913 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31914 [@dots{}]
31915 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31916 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31917 (gdb)
31918 @end smallexample
31919
31920 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31921
31922 @smallexample
31923 (gdb)
31924 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31925 ^done,asm_insns=[
31926 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31927 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31928 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31929 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31930 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31931 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31932 (gdb)
31933 @end smallexample
31934
31935 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31936
31937 @smallexample
31938 (gdb)
31939 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31940 ^done,asm_insns=[
31941 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31942 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31943 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31944 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31945 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31946 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31947 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31948 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31949 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31950 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31951 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31952 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31953 (gdb)
31954 @end smallexample
31955
31956
31957 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31958 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31959
31960 @subsubheading Synopsis
31961
31962 @smallexample
31963 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31964 @end smallexample
31965
31966 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31967 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31968 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31969
31970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31971
31972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31973 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31974 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31975
31976 @subsubheading Example
31977
31978 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31979 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31980 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31981 output.
31982
31983 @smallexample
31984 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31985 211^done,value="1"
31986 (gdb)
31987 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31988 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31989 (gdb)
31990 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31991 411^done,value="4"
31992 (gdb)
31993 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31994 511^done,value="4"
31995 (gdb)
31996 @end smallexample
31997
31998
31999 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32000 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32001
32002 @subsubheading Synopsis
32003
32004 @smallexample
32005 -data-list-changed-registers
32006 @end smallexample
32007
32008 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32009
32010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32011
32012 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32013 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32014
32015 @subsubheading Example
32016
32017 On a PPC MBX board:
32018
32019 @smallexample
32020 (gdb)
32021 -exec-continue
32022 ^running
32023
32024 (gdb)
32025 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32026 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32027 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32028 (gdb)
32029 -data-list-changed-registers
32030 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32031 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32032 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32033 (gdb)
32034 @end smallexample
32035
32036
32037 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32038 @findex -data-list-register-names
32039
32040 @subsubheading Synopsis
32041
32042 @smallexample
32043 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32044 @end smallexample
32045
32046 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32047 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32048 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32049 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32050 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32051 include empty register names.
32052
32053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32054
32055 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32056 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32057 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32058
32059 @subsubheading Example
32060
32061 For the PPC MBX board:
32062 @smallexample
32063 (gdb)
32064 -data-list-register-names
32065 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32066 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32067 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32068 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32069 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32070 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32071 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32072 (gdb)
32073 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32074 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32075 (gdb)
32076 @end smallexample
32077
32078 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32079 @findex -data-list-register-values
32080
32081 @subsubheading Synopsis
32082
32083 @smallexample
32084 -data-list-register-values
32085 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32086 @end smallexample
32087
32088 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32089 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32090 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32091 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32092 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32093 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32094
32095 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32096
32097 @table @code
32098 @item x
32099 Hexadecimal
32100 @item o
32101 Octal
32102 @item t
32103 Binary
32104 @item d
32105 Decimal
32106 @item r
32107 Raw
32108 @item N
32109 Natural
32110 @end table
32111
32112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32113
32114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32115 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32116
32117 @subsubheading Example
32118
32119 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32120 don't appear in the actual output):
32121
32122 @smallexample
32123 (gdb)
32124 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32125 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32126 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32127 (gdb)
32128 -data-list-register-values x
32129 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32130 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32131 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32132 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32133 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32134 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32135 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32136 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32137 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32138 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32139 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32140 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32141 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32142 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32143 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32144 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32145 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32146 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32147 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32148 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32149 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32150 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32151 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32152 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32153 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32154 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32155 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32156 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32157 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32158 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32159 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32160 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32161 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32162 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32163 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32164 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32165 (gdb)
32166 @end smallexample
32167
32168
32169 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32170 @findex -data-read-memory
32171
32172 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32173
32174 @subsubheading Synopsis
32175
32176 @smallexample
32177 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32178 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32179 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32180 @end smallexample
32181
32182 @noindent
32183 where:
32184
32185 @table @samp
32186 @item @var{address}
32187 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32188 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32189 quoted using the C convention.
32190
32191 @item @var{word-format}
32192 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32193 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32194 ,Output Formats}).
32195
32196 @item @var{word-size}
32197 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32198
32199 @item @var{nr-rows}
32200 The number of rows in the output table.
32201
32202 @item @var{nr-cols}
32203 The number of columns in the output table.
32204
32205 @item @var{aschar}
32206 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32207 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32208 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32209 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32210
32211 @item @var{byte-offset}
32212 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32213 @end table
32214
32215 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32216 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32217 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32218 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32219 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32220 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32221 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32222 @samp{addr}.
32223
32224 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32225 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32226 @samp{prev-page}.
32227
32228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32229
32230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32231 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32232
32233 @subsubheading Example
32234
32235 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32236 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32237 word. Display each word in hex.
32238
32239 @smallexample
32240 (gdb)
32241 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32242 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32243 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32244 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32245 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32246 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32247 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32248 (gdb)
32249 @end smallexample
32250
32251 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32252 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 (gdb)
32256 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32257 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32258 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32259 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32260 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32261 (gdb)
32262 @end smallexample
32263
32264 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32265 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32266 used as the non-printable character.
32267
32268 @smallexample
32269 (gdb)
32270 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32271 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32272 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32273 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32274 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32275 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32276 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32277 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32278 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32279 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32280 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32281 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32282 (gdb)
32283 @end smallexample
32284
32285 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32286 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32287
32288 @subsubheading Synopsis
32289
32290 @smallexample
32291 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32292 @var{address} @var{count}
32293 @end smallexample
32294
32295 @noindent
32296 where:
32297
32298 @table @samp
32299 @item @var{address}
32300 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32301 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32302 quoted using the C convention.
32303
32304 @item @var{count}
32305 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32306 literal.
32307
32308 @item @var{offset}
32309 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32310 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32311 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32312 arithmetics itself.
32313
32314 @end table
32315
32316 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32317 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32318 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32319 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32320 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32321 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32322
32323 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32324 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32325 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32326 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32327 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32328 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32329 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32330 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32331
32332 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32333 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32334 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32335 and has the following fields:
32336
32337 @table @code
32338 @item begin
32339 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32340
32341 @item end
32342 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32343
32344 @item offset
32345 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32346 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32347
32348 @item contents
32349 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32350
32351 @end table
32352
32353
32354
32355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32356
32357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32358
32359 @subsubheading Example
32360
32361 @smallexample
32362 (gdb)
32363 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32364 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32365 end="0xbffff15e",
32366 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32367 (gdb)
32368 @end smallexample
32369
32370
32371 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32372 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32373
32374 @subsubheading Synopsis
32375
32376 @smallexample
32377 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32378 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32379 @end smallexample
32380
32381 @noindent
32382 where:
32383
32384 @table @samp
32385 @item @var{address}
32386 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32387 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32388 be quoted using the C convention.
32389
32390 @item @var{contents}
32391 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32392 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32393
32394 @item @var{count}
32395 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32396 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32397 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32398 @var{count} memory units.
32399
32400 @end table
32401
32402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32403
32404 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32405
32406 @subsubheading Example
32407
32408 @smallexample
32409 (gdb)
32410 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32411 ^done
32412 (gdb)
32413 @end smallexample
32414
32415 @smallexample
32416 (gdb)
32417 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32418 ^done
32419 (gdb)
32420 @end smallexample
32421
32422 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32423 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32424 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32425
32426 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32427 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32428
32429 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32430 @findex -trace-find
32431
32432 @subsubheading Synopsis
32433
32434 @smallexample
32435 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32436 @end smallexample
32437
32438 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32439 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32440 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32441
32442 @table @samp
32443
32444 @item none
32445 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32446
32447 @item frame-number
32448 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32449 that index.
32450
32451 @item tracepoint-number
32452 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32453 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32454
32455 @item pc
32456 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32457 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32458 address.
32459
32460 @item pc-inside-range
32461 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32462 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32463 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32464
32465 @item pc-outside-range
32466 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32467 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32468 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32469
32470 @item line
32471 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32472 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32473 the specified location.
32474
32475 @end table
32476
32477 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32478 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32479
32480 @table @samp
32481 @item found
32482 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32483 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32484
32485 @item traceframe
32486 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32487 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32488
32489 @item tracepoint
32490 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32491 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32492
32493 @item frame
32494 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32495 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32496 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32497
32498 @end table
32499
32500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32501
32502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32503
32504 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32505 @findex -trace-define-variable
32506
32507 @subsubheading Synopsis
32508
32509 @smallexample
32510 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32511 @end smallexample
32512
32513 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32514 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32515 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32516 with the @samp{$} character.
32517
32518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32519
32520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32521
32522 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32523 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32524
32525 @subsubheading Synopsis
32526
32527 @smallexample
32528 -trace-frame-collected
32529 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32530 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32531 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32532 [--memory-contents]
32533 @end smallexample
32534
32535 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32536 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32537 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32538 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32539 See the output description table below for more details.
32540
32541 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32542 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32543 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32544 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32545 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32546
32547 For instance, if the actions were
32548 @smallexample
32549 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32550 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32551 @end smallexample
32552
32553 @noindent
32554 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32555 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32556 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32557 objects would be computed expressions.
32558
32559 An example output would be:
32560
32561 @smallexample
32562 (gdb)
32563 -trace-frame-collected
32564 ^done,
32565 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32566 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32567 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32568 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32569 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32570 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32571 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32572 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32573 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32574 ...
32575 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32576 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32577 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32578 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32579 (gdb)
32580 @end smallexample
32581
32582 Where:
32583
32584 @table @code
32585 @item explicit-variables
32586 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32587 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32588 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32589 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32590 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32591 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32592 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32593 arrays, structures and unions.
32594
32595 @item computed-expressions
32596 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32597 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32598 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32599 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32600
32601 @item registers
32602 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32603 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32604 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32605 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32606 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32607
32608 @item tvars
32609 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32610 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32611 current value are returned.
32612
32613 @item memory
32614 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32615 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32616 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32617
32618 @table @code
32619 @item address
32620 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32621
32622 @item length
32623 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32624
32625 @item contents
32626 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32627 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32628
32629 @end table
32630
32631 @end table
32632
32633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32634
32635 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32636
32637 @subsubheading Example
32638
32639 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32640 @findex -trace-list-variables
32641
32642 @subsubheading Synopsis
32643
32644 @smallexample
32645 -trace-list-variables
32646 @end smallexample
32647
32648 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32649 table has the following fields:
32650
32651 @table @samp
32652 @item name
32653 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32654
32655 @item initial
32656 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32657 field is always present.
32658
32659 @item current
32660 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32661 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32662 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32663 presently running.
32664
32665 @end table
32666
32667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32668
32669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32670
32671 @subsubheading Example
32672
32673 @smallexample
32674 (gdb)
32675 -trace-list-variables
32676 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32677 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32678 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32679 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32680 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32681 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32682 (gdb)
32683 @end smallexample
32684
32685 @subheading -trace-save
32686 @findex -trace-save
32687
32688 @subsubheading Synopsis
32689
32690 @smallexample
32691 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32692 @end smallexample
32693
32694 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32695 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32696 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32697 to perform the save.
32698
32699 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32700 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32701 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32702
32703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32704
32705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32706
32707
32708 @subheading -trace-start
32709 @findex -trace-start
32710
32711 @subsubheading Synopsis
32712
32713 @smallexample
32714 -trace-start
32715 @end smallexample
32716
32717 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32718 have any fields.
32719
32720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32721
32722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32723
32724 @subheading -trace-status
32725 @findex -trace-status
32726
32727 @subsubheading Synopsis
32728
32729 @smallexample
32730 -trace-status
32731 @end smallexample
32732
32733 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32734 the following fields:
32735
32736 @table @samp
32737
32738 @item supported
32739 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32740 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32741 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32742 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32743 started. This field is always present.
32744
32745 @item running
32746 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32747 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32748 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32749
32750 @item stop-reason
32751 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32752 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32753 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32754 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32755 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32756 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32757 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32758 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32759 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32760
32761 @item stopping-tracepoint
32762 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32763 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32764 @samp{passcount}.
32765
32766 @item frames
32767 @itemx frames-created
32768 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32769 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32770 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32771 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32772
32773 @item buffer-size
32774 @itemx buffer-free
32775 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32776 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32777
32778 @item circular
32779 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32780 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32781 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32782 and may fill up.
32783
32784 @item disconnected
32785 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32786 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32787 that the trace run will stop.
32788
32789 @item trace-file
32790 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32791 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32792
32793 @end table
32794
32795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32796
32797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32798
32799 @subheading -trace-stop
32800 @findex -trace-stop
32801
32802 @subsubheading Synopsis
32803
32804 @smallexample
32805 -trace-stop
32806 @end smallexample
32807
32808 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32809 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32810 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32811
32812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32813
32814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32815
32816
32817 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32818 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32819 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32820
32821
32822 @ignore
32823 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32824 @findex -symbol-info-address
32825
32826 @subsubheading Synopsis
32827
32828 @smallexample
32829 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32830 @end smallexample
32831
32832 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32833
32834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32835
32836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32837
32838 @subsubheading Example
32839 N.A.
32840
32841
32842 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32843 @findex -symbol-info-file
32844
32845 @subsubheading Synopsis
32846
32847 @smallexample
32848 -symbol-info-file
32849 @end smallexample
32850
32851 Show the file for the symbol.
32852
32853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32854
32855 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32856 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32857
32858 @subsubheading Example
32859 N.A.
32860
32861
32862 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32863 @findex -symbol-info-function
32864
32865 @subsubheading Synopsis
32866
32867 @smallexample
32868 -symbol-info-function
32869 @end smallexample
32870
32871 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32872
32873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32874
32875 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32876
32877 @subsubheading Example
32878 N.A.
32879
32880
32881 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32882 @findex -symbol-info-line
32883
32884 @subsubheading Synopsis
32885
32886 @smallexample
32887 -symbol-info-line
32888 @end smallexample
32889
32890 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32891
32892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32893
32894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32895 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32896
32897 @subsubheading Example
32898 N.A.
32899
32900
32901 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32902 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32903
32904 @subsubheading Synopsis
32905
32906 @smallexample
32907 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32908 @end smallexample
32909
32910 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32911
32912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32913
32914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32915
32916 @subsubheading Example
32917 N.A.
32918
32919
32920 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32921 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32922
32923 @subsubheading Synopsis
32924
32925 @smallexample
32926 -symbol-list-functions
32927 @end smallexample
32928
32929 List the functions in the executable.
32930
32931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32932
32933 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32934 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32935
32936 @subsubheading Example
32937 N.A.
32938 @end ignore
32939
32940
32941 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32942 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32943
32944 @subsubheading Synopsis
32945
32946 @smallexample
32947 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32948 @end smallexample
32949
32950 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32951 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32952 ascending PC order.
32953
32954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32955
32956 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32957
32958 @subsubheading Example
32959 @smallexample
32960 (gdb)
32961 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32962 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32963 (gdb)
32964 @end smallexample
32965
32966
32967 @ignore
32968 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32969 @findex -symbol-list-types
32970
32971 @subsubheading Synopsis
32972
32973 @smallexample
32974 -symbol-list-types
32975 @end smallexample
32976
32977 List all the type names.
32978
32979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32980
32981 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32982 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32983
32984 @subsubheading Example
32985 N.A.
32986
32987
32988 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32989 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32990
32991 @subsubheading Synopsis
32992
32993 @smallexample
32994 -symbol-list-variables
32995 @end smallexample
32996
32997 List all the global and static variable names.
32998
32999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33000
33001 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33002
33003 @subsubheading Example
33004 N.A.
33005
33006
33007 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33008 @findex -symbol-locate
33009
33010 @subsubheading Synopsis
33011
33012 @smallexample
33013 -symbol-locate
33014 @end smallexample
33015
33016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33017
33018 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33019
33020 @subsubheading Example
33021 N.A.
33022
33023
33024 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33025 @findex -symbol-type
33026
33027 @subsubheading Synopsis
33028
33029 @smallexample
33030 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33031 @end smallexample
33032
33033 Show type of @var{variable}.
33034
33035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33036
33037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33038 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33039
33040 @subsubheading Example
33041 N.A.
33042 @end ignore
33043
33044
33045 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33046 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33047 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33048
33049 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33050 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33051
33052 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33053 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33054
33055 @subsubheading Synopsis
33056
33057 @smallexample
33058 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33059 @end smallexample
33060
33061 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33062 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33063 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33064 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33065 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33066 notification.
33067
33068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33069
33070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33071
33072 @subsubheading Example
33073
33074 @smallexample
33075 (gdb)
33076 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33077 ^done
33078 (gdb)
33079 @end smallexample
33080
33081
33082 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33083 @findex -file-exec-file
33084
33085 @subsubheading Synopsis
33086
33087 @smallexample
33088 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33089 @end smallexample
33090
33091 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33092 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33093 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33094 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33095 notification.
33096
33097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33098
33099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33100
33101 @subsubheading Example
33102
33103 @smallexample
33104 (gdb)
33105 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33106 ^done
33107 (gdb)
33108 @end smallexample
33109
33110
33111 @ignore
33112 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33113 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33114
33115 @subsubheading Synopsis
33116
33117 @smallexample
33118 -file-list-exec-sections
33119 @end smallexample
33120
33121 List the sections of the current executable file.
33122
33123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33124
33125 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33126 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33127 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33128
33129 @subsubheading Example
33130 N.A.
33131 @end ignore
33132
33133
33134 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33135 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33136
33137 @subsubheading Synopsis
33138
33139 @smallexample
33140 -file-list-exec-source-file
33141 @end smallexample
33142
33143 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33144 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33145 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33146 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33147
33148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33149
33150 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33151
33152 @subsubheading Example
33153
33154 @smallexample
33155 (gdb)
33156 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33157 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33158 (gdb)
33159 @end smallexample
33160
33161
33162 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33163 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33164
33165 @subsubheading Synopsis
33166
33167 @smallexample
33168 -file-list-exec-source-files
33169 @end smallexample
33170
33171 List the source files for the current executable.
33172
33173 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33174 name) of a source file.
33175
33176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33177
33178 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33179 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33180
33181 @subsubheading Example
33182 @smallexample
33183 (gdb)
33184 -file-list-exec-source-files
33185 ^done,files=[
33186 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33187 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33188 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33189 (gdb)
33190 @end smallexample
33191
33192 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33193 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33194
33195 @subsubheading Synopsis
33196
33197 @smallexample
33198 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
33199 @end smallexample
33200
33201 List the shared libraries in the program.
33202 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
33203 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33204
33205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33206
33207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
33208 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
33209 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
33210 library. Each range has the following fields:
33211
33212 @table @samp
33213 @item from
33214 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
33215 @item to
33216 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
33217 @end table
33218
33219 @subsubheading Example
33220 @smallexample
33221 (gdb)
33222 -file-list-exec-source-files
33223 ^done,shared-libraries=[
33224 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
33225 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
33226 (gdb)
33227 @end smallexample
33228
33229
33230 @ignore
33231 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33232 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33233
33234 @subsubheading Synopsis
33235
33236 @smallexample
33237 -file-list-symbol-files
33238 @end smallexample
33239
33240 List symbol files.
33241
33242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33243
33244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33245
33246 @subsubheading Example
33247 N.A.
33248 @end ignore
33249
33250
33251 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33252 @findex -file-symbol-file
33253
33254 @subsubheading Synopsis
33255
33256 @smallexample
33257 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33258 @end smallexample
33259
33260 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33261 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33262 produced, except for a completion notification.
33263
33264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33265
33266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33267
33268 @subsubheading Example
33269
33270 @smallexample
33271 (gdb)
33272 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33273 ^done
33274 (gdb)
33275 @end smallexample
33276
33277 @ignore
33278 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33279 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33280 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33281
33282 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33283
33284 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33285
33286 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33287
33288 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33289
33290 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33291
33292 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33293
33294 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33295
33296 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33297
33298 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33299 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33300 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33301
33302 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33303
33304 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33305
33306 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33307
33308 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33309 @end ignore
33310
33311
33312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33313 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33315
33316
33317 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33318 @findex -target-attach
33319
33320 @subsubheading Synopsis
33321
33322 @smallexample
33323 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33324 @end smallexample
33325
33326 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33327 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33328 group, the id previously returned by
33329 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33330
33331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33332
33333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33334
33335 @subsubheading Example
33336 @smallexample
33337 (gdb)
33338 -target-attach 34
33339 =thread-created,id="1"
33340 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33341 ^done
33342 (gdb)
33343 @end smallexample
33344
33345 @ignore
33346 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33347 @findex -target-compare-sections
33348
33349 @subsubheading Synopsis
33350
33351 @smallexample
33352 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33353 @end smallexample
33354
33355 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33356 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33357
33358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33359
33360 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33361
33362 @subsubheading Example
33363 N.A.
33364 @end ignore
33365
33366
33367 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33368 @findex -target-detach
33369
33370 @subsubheading Synopsis
33371
33372 @smallexample
33373 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33374 @end smallexample
33375
33376 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33377 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33378 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33379
33380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33381
33382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33383
33384 @subsubheading Example
33385
33386 @smallexample
33387 (gdb)
33388 -target-detach
33389 ^done
33390 (gdb)
33391 @end smallexample
33392
33393
33394 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33395 @findex -target-disconnect
33396
33397 @subsubheading Synopsis
33398
33399 @smallexample
33400 -target-disconnect
33401 @end smallexample
33402
33403 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33404 generally not resumed.
33405
33406 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33407
33408 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33409
33410 @subsubheading Example
33411
33412 @smallexample
33413 (gdb)
33414 -target-disconnect
33415 ^done
33416 (gdb)
33417 @end smallexample
33418
33419
33420 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33421 @findex -target-download
33422
33423 @subsubheading Synopsis
33424
33425 @smallexample
33426 -target-download
33427 @end smallexample
33428
33429 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33430 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33431
33432 @table @samp
33433 @item section
33434 The name of the section.
33435 @item section-sent
33436 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33437 @item section-size
33438 The size of the section.
33439 @item total-sent
33440 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33441 @item total-size
33442 The size of the overall executable to download.
33443 @end table
33444
33445 @noindent
33446 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33447 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33448
33449 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33450 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33451
33452 @table @samp
33453 @item section
33454 The name of the section.
33455 @item section-size
33456 The size of the section.
33457 @item total-size
33458 The size of the overall executable to download.
33459 @end table
33460
33461 @noindent
33462 At the end, a summary is printed.
33463
33464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33465
33466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33467
33468 @subsubheading Example
33469
33470 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33471 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33472
33473 @smallexample
33474 (gdb)
33475 -target-download
33476 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33477 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33478 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33479 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33480 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33481 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33482 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33483 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33484 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33485 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33486 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33487 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33488 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33489 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33490 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33491 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33492 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33493 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33494 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33496 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33497 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33498 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33499 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33500 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33501 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33502 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33503 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33504 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33505 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33506 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33507 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33508 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33509 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33510 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33511 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33512 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33513 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33514 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33515 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33516 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33517 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33518 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33519 write-rate="429"
33520 (gdb)
33521 @end smallexample
33522
33523
33524 @ignore
33525 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33526 @findex -target-exec-status
33527
33528 @subsubheading Synopsis
33529
33530 @smallexample
33531 -target-exec-status
33532 @end smallexample
33533
33534 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33535 not, for instance).
33536
33537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33538
33539 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33540
33541 @subsubheading Example
33542 N.A.
33543
33544
33545 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33546 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33547
33548 @subsubheading Synopsis
33549
33550 @smallexample
33551 -target-list-available-targets
33552 @end smallexample
33553
33554 List the possible targets to connect to.
33555
33556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33557
33558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33559
33560 @subsubheading Example
33561 N.A.
33562
33563
33564 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33565 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33566
33567 @subsubheading Synopsis
33568
33569 @smallexample
33570 -target-list-current-targets
33571 @end smallexample
33572
33573 Describe the current target.
33574
33575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33576
33577 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33578 other things).
33579
33580 @subsubheading Example
33581 N.A.
33582
33583
33584 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33585 @findex -target-list-parameters
33586
33587 @subsubheading Synopsis
33588
33589 @smallexample
33590 -target-list-parameters
33591 @end smallexample
33592
33593 @c ????
33594 @end ignore
33595
33596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33597
33598 No equivalent.
33599
33600 @subsubheading Example
33601 N.A.
33602
33603 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33604 @findex -target-flash-erase
33605
33606 @subsubheading Synopsis
33607
33608 @smallexample
33609 -target-flash-erase
33610 @end smallexample
33611
33612 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33613
33614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33615
33616 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33617 addresses and memory region sizes.
33618
33619 @smallexample
33620 (gdb)
33621 -target-flash-erase
33622 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33623 (gdb)
33624 @end smallexample
33625
33626 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33627 @findex -target-select
33628
33629 @subsubheading Synopsis
33630
33631 @smallexample
33632 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33633 @end smallexample
33634
33635 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33636
33637 @table @samp
33638 @item @var{type}
33639 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33640 @item @var{parameters}
33641 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33642 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33643 @end table
33644
33645 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33646 which the target program is, in the following form:
33647
33648 @smallexample
33649 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33650 args=[@var{arg list}]
33651 @end smallexample
33652
33653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33654
33655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33656
33657 @subsubheading Example
33658
33659 @smallexample
33660 (gdb)
33661 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33662 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33663 (gdb)
33664 @end smallexample
33665
33666 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33667 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33668 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33669
33670
33671 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33672 @findex -target-file-put
33673
33674 @subsubheading Synopsis
33675
33676 @smallexample
33677 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33678 @end smallexample
33679
33680 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33681 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33682
33683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33684
33685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33686
33687 @subsubheading Example
33688
33689 @smallexample
33690 (gdb)
33691 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33692 ^done
33693 (gdb)
33694 @end smallexample
33695
33696
33697 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33698 @findex -target-file-get
33699
33700 @subsubheading Synopsis
33701
33702 @smallexample
33703 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33704 @end smallexample
33705
33706 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33707 on the host system.
33708
33709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33710
33711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33712
33713 @subsubheading Example
33714
33715 @smallexample
33716 (gdb)
33717 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33718 ^done
33719 (gdb)
33720 @end smallexample
33721
33722
33723 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33724 @findex -target-file-delete
33725
33726 @subsubheading Synopsis
33727
33728 @smallexample
33729 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33730 @end smallexample
33731
33732 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33733
33734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33735
33736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33737
33738 @subsubheading Example
33739
33740 @smallexample
33741 (gdb)
33742 -target-file-delete remotefile
33743 ^done
33744 (gdb)
33745 @end smallexample
33746
33747
33748 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33749 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33750 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33751
33752 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33753 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33754
33755 @subsubheading Synopsis
33756
33757 @smallexample
33758 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33759 @end smallexample
33760
33761 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33762 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33763 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33764
33765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33766
33767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33768
33769 @subsubheading Result
33770
33771 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33772 defined for each exception:
33773
33774 @table @samp
33775 @item name
33776 The name of the exception.
33777
33778 @item address
33779 The address of the exception.
33780
33781 @end table
33782
33783 @subsubheading Example
33784
33785 @smallexample
33786 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33787 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33788 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33789 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33790 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33791 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33792 @end smallexample
33793
33794 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33795
33796 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33797 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33798 Catchpoint Commands}.
33799
33800
33801 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33802 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33803 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33804
33805 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33806 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33807 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33808 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33809
33810 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33811 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33812 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33813
33814 @subsubheading Synopsis
33815
33816 @smallexample
33817 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33818 @end smallexample
33819
33820 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33821
33822 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33823 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33824 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33825 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33826 dash.
33827
33828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33829
33830 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33831
33832 @subsubheading Result
33833
33834 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33835
33836 @table @samp
33837 @item exists
33838 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33839 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33840
33841 @end table
33842
33843 @subsubheading Example
33844
33845 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33846
33847 @smallexample
33848 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33849 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33850 @end smallexample
33851
33852 @noindent
33853 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33854 to the debugger:
33855
33856 @smallexample
33857 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33858 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33859 @end smallexample
33860
33861 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33862 @findex -list-features
33863 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33864
33865 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33866 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33867 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33868 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33869 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33870 startup.
33871
33872 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33873 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33874 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33875 is given below.
33876
33877 Example output:
33878
33879 @smallexample
33880 (gdb) -list-features
33881 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33882 @end smallexample
33883
33884 The current list of features is:
33885
33886 @ftable @samp
33887 @item frozen-varobjs
33888 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33889 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33890 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33891 @item pending-breakpoints
33892 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33893 command.
33894 @item python
33895 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33896 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33897 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33898 @item thread-info
33899 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33900 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33901 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33902 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33903 @item breakpoint-notifications
33904 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33905 CLI will be announced via async records.
33906 @item ada-task-info
33907 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33908 @item language-option
33909 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33910 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33911 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33912 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33913 @item undefined-command-error-code
33914 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33915 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33916 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33917 @item exec-run-start-option
33918 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33919 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33920 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33921 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33922 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33923 @end ftable
33924
33925 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33926 @findex -list-target-features
33927
33928 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33929 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33930 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33931 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33932 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33933 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33934 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33935 Example output:
33936
33937 @smallexample
33938 (gdb) -list-target-features
33939 ^done,result=["async"]
33940 @end smallexample
33941
33942 The current list of features is:
33943
33944 @table @samp
33945 @item async
33946 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33947 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33948 while the target is running.
33949
33950 @item reverse
33951 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33952 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33953
33954 @end table
33955
33956 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33957 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33958 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33959
33960 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33961
33962 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33963 @findex -gdb-exit
33964
33965 @subsubheading Synopsis
33966
33967 @smallexample
33968 -gdb-exit
33969 @end smallexample
33970
33971 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33972
33973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33974
33975 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33976
33977 @subsubheading Example
33978
33979 @smallexample
33980 (gdb)
33981 -gdb-exit
33982 ^exit
33983 @end smallexample
33984
33985
33986 @ignore
33987 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33988 @findex -exec-abort
33989
33990 @subsubheading Synopsis
33991
33992 @smallexample
33993 -exec-abort
33994 @end smallexample
33995
33996 Kill the inferior running program.
33997
33998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33999
34000 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34001
34002 @subsubheading Example
34003 N.A.
34004 @end ignore
34005
34006
34007 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34008 @findex -gdb-set
34009
34010 @subsubheading Synopsis
34011
34012 @smallexample
34013 -gdb-set
34014 @end smallexample
34015
34016 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34017 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34018
34019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34020
34021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34022
34023 @subsubheading Example
34024
34025 @smallexample
34026 (gdb)
34027 -gdb-set $foo=3
34028 ^done
34029 (gdb)
34030 @end smallexample
34031
34032
34033 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34034 @findex -gdb-show
34035
34036 @subsubheading Synopsis
34037
34038 @smallexample
34039 -gdb-show
34040 @end smallexample
34041
34042 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34043
34044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34045
34046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34047
34048 @subsubheading Example
34049
34050 @smallexample
34051 (gdb)
34052 -gdb-show annotate
34053 ^done,value="0"
34054 (gdb)
34055 @end smallexample
34056
34057 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34058
34059
34060 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34061 @findex -gdb-version
34062
34063 @subsubheading Synopsis
34064
34065 @smallexample
34066 -gdb-version
34067 @end smallexample
34068
34069 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34070
34071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34072
34073 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34074 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34075
34076 @subsubheading Example
34077
34078 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34079 @c box in TeX.
34080 @smallexample
34081 (gdb)
34082 -gdb-version
34083 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34084 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34085 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34086 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34087 ~ certain conditions.
34088 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34089 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34090 ~ details.
34091 ~This GDB was configured as
34092 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34093 ^done
34094 (gdb)
34095 @end smallexample
34096
34097 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34098 @findex -list-thread-groups
34099
34100 @subheading Synopsis
34101
34102 @smallexample
34103 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34104 @end smallexample
34105
34106 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34107 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34108 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34109 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34110 top-level thread groups.
34111
34112 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34113 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34114 available on the target.
34115
34116 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34117 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34118 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34119 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34120 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34121 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34122 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34123 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34124
34125 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34126 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34127 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34128 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34129 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34130 @samp{threads} field.
34131
34132 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34133 the following caveats:
34134
34135 @itemize @bullet
34136 @item
34137 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34138 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34139 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34140
34141 @item
34142 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34143 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34144 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34145 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34146 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34147 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34148
34149 @end itemize
34150
34151 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34152 have the following fields:
34153
34154 @table @code
34155 @item id
34156 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34157 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34158 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34159
34160 @item type
34161 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34162 valid type.
34163
34164 @item pid
34165 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34166 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34167
34168 @item exit-code
34169 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34170 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34171 only if the process is not running.
34172
34173 @item num_children
34174 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34175 absent for an available thread group.
34176
34177 @item threads
34178 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34179 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34180 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34181
34182 @item cores
34183 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34184 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34185 such information is not available.
34186
34187 @item executable
34188 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34189 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34190 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34191
34192 @end table
34193
34194 @subheading Example
34195
34196 @smallexample
34197 @value{GDBP}
34198 -list-thread-groups
34199 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34200 -list-thread-groups 17
34201 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34202 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34203 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34204 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34205 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
34206 -list-thread-groups --available
34207 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34208 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34209 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34210 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34211 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34212 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34213 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34214 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34215 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34216 @end smallexample
34217
34218 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34219 @findex -info-os
34220
34221 @subsubheading Synopsis
34222
34223 @smallexample
34224 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34225 @end smallexample
34226
34227 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34228 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34229 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34230 of data of that type.
34231
34232 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34233 system.
34234
34235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34236
34237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34238
34239 @subsubheading Example
34240
34241 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34242 like this:
34243
34244 @smallexample
34245 @value{GDBP}
34246 -info-os
34247 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
34248 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34249 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34250 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34251 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
34252 col2="CPUs"@},
34253 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34254 col2="File descriptors"@},
34255 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34256 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34257 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34258 col2="Message queues"@},
34259 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34260 col2="Processes"@},
34261 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34262 col2="Process groups"@},
34263 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34264 col2="Semaphores"@},
34265 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34266 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34267 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34268 col2="Sockets"@},
34269 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34270 col2="Threads"@}]
34271 @value{GDBP}
34272 -info-os processes
34273 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34274 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34275 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34276 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34277 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34278 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34279 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34280 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34281 ...
34282 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34283 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34284 (gdb)
34285 @end smallexample
34286
34287 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34288 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34289 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34290 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34291 @code{info os} omits it.)
34292
34293 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34294 @findex -add-inferior
34295
34296 @subheading Synopsis
34297
34298 @smallexample
34299 -add-inferior
34300 @end smallexample
34301
34302 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34303 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34304 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34305 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34306 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34307 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34308
34309 @subheading Example
34310
34311 @smallexample
34312 @value{GDBP}
34313 -add-inferior
34314 ^done,inferior="i3"
34315 @end smallexample
34316
34317 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34318 @findex -interpreter-exec
34319
34320 @subheading Synopsis
34321
34322 @smallexample
34323 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34324 @end smallexample
34325 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34326
34327 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34328
34329 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34330
34331 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34332
34333 @subheading Example
34334
34335 @smallexample
34336 (gdb)
34337 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34338 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34339 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34340 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34341 ^done
34342 (gdb)
34343 @end smallexample
34344
34345 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34346 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34347
34348 @subheading Synopsis
34349
34350 @smallexample
34351 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34352 @end smallexample
34353
34354 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34355
34356 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34357
34358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34359
34360 @subheading Example
34361
34362 @smallexample
34363 (gdb)
34364 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34365 ^done
34366 (gdb)
34367 @end smallexample
34368
34369 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34370 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34371
34372 @subheading Synopsis
34373
34374 @smallexample
34375 -inferior-tty-show
34376 @end smallexample
34377
34378 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34379
34380 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34381
34382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34383
34384 @subheading Example
34385
34386 @smallexample
34387 (gdb)
34388 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34389 ^done
34390 (gdb)
34391 -inferior-tty-show
34392 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34393 (gdb)
34394 @end smallexample
34395
34396 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34397 @findex -enable-timings
34398
34399 @subheading Synopsis
34400
34401 @smallexample
34402 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34403 @end smallexample
34404
34405 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34406 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34407 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34408 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34409
34410 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34411
34412 No equivalent.
34413
34414 @subheading Example
34415
34416 @smallexample
34417 (gdb)
34418 -enable-timings
34419 ^done
34420 (gdb)
34421 -break-insert main
34422 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34423 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34424 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34425 times="0"@},
34426 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34427 (gdb)
34428 -enable-timings no
34429 ^done
34430 (gdb)
34431 -exec-run
34432 ^running
34433 (gdb)
34434 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34435 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34436 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34437 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34438 (gdb)
34439 @end smallexample
34440
34441 @node Annotations
34442 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34443
34444 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34445 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34446 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34447 relatively high level.
34448
34449 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34450 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34451
34452 @ignore
34453 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34454 @end ignore
34455
34456 @menu
34457 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34458 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34459 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34460 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34461 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34462 * Annotations for Running::
34463 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34464 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34465 @end menu
34466
34467 @node Annotations Overview
34468 @section What is an Annotation?
34469 @cindex annotations
34470
34471 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34472 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34473 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34474 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34475 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34476 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34477 cannot contain newline characters.
34478
34479 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34480 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34481 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34482 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34483 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34484 means those three characters as output.
34485
34486 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34487 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34488 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34489 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34490 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34491 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34492 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34493 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34494 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34495
34496 @table @code
34497 @kindex set annotate
34498 @item set annotate @var{level}
34499 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34500 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34501
34502 @item show annotate
34503 @kindex show annotate
34504 Show the current annotation level.
34505 @end table
34506
34507 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34508
34509 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34510
34511 @smallexample
34512 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34513 GNU gdb 6.0
34514 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34515 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34516 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34517 under certain conditions.
34518 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34519 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34520 for details.
34521 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34522
34523 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34524 (@value{GDBP})
34525 ^Z^Zprompt
34526 @kbd{quit}
34527
34528 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34529 $
34530 @end smallexample
34531
34532 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34533 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34534 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34535 output from @value{GDBN}.
34536
34537 @node Server Prefix
34538 @section The Server Prefix
34539 @cindex server prefix
34540
34541 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34542 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34543 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34544 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34545 a transparent manner.
34546
34547 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34548 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34549 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34550 @code{print} command.
34551
34552 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34553 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34554
34555 @node Prompting
34556 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34557
34558 @cindex annotations for prompts
34559 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34560 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34561 over, etc.
34562
34563 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34564 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34565 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34566 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34567 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34568 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34569 features the following annotations:
34570
34571 @smallexample
34572 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34573 ^Z^Zprompt
34574 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34575 @end smallexample
34576
34577 The input types are
34578
34579 @table @code
34580 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34581 @findex prompt annotation
34582 @findex post-prompt annotation
34583 @item prompt
34584 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34585
34586 @findex pre-commands annotation
34587 @findex commands annotation
34588 @findex post-commands annotation
34589 @item commands
34590 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34591 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34592
34593 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34594 @findex overload-choice annotation
34595 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34596 @item overload-choice
34597 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34598
34599 @findex pre-query annotation
34600 @findex query annotation
34601 @findex post-query annotation
34602 @item query
34603 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34604
34605 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34606 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34607 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34608 @item prompt-for-continue
34609 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34610 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34611 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34612 presence of annotations.
34613 @end table
34614
34615 @node Errors
34616 @section Errors
34617 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34618
34619 @findex quit annotation
34620 @smallexample
34621 ^Z^Zquit
34622 @end smallexample
34623
34624 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34625
34626 @findex error annotation
34627 @smallexample
34628 ^Z^Zerror
34629 @end smallexample
34630
34631 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34632
34633 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34634 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34635 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34636 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34637 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34638 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34639 to the top level.
34640
34641 @findex error-begin annotation
34642 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34643
34644 @smallexample
34645 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34646 @end smallexample
34647
34648 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34649 message.
34650
34651 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34652 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34653 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34654
34655 @node Invalidation
34656 @section Invalidation Notices
34657
34658 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34659 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34660 changed.
34661
34662 @table @code
34663 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34664 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34665
34666 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34667 have changed.
34668
34669 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34670 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34671
34672 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34673 deleted a breakpoint.
34674 @end table
34675
34676 @node Annotations for Running
34677 @section Running the Program
34678 @cindex annotations for running programs
34679
34680 @findex starting annotation
34681 @findex stopping annotation
34682 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34683 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34684
34685 @smallexample
34686 ^Z^Zstarting
34687 @end smallexample
34688
34689 is output. When the program stops,
34690
34691 @smallexample
34692 ^Z^Zstopped
34693 @end smallexample
34694
34695 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34696 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34697
34698 @table @code
34699 @findex exited annotation
34700 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34701 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34702 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34703
34704 @findex signalled annotation
34705 @findex signal-name annotation
34706 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34707 @findex signal-string annotation
34708 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34709 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34710 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34711 annotation continues:
34712
34713 @smallexample
34714 @var{intro-text}
34715 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34716 @var{name}
34717 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34718 @var{middle-text}
34719 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34720 @var{string}
34721 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34722 @var{end-text}
34723 @end smallexample
34724
34725 @noindent
34726 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34727 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34728 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34729 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34730 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34731
34732 @findex signal annotation
34733 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34734 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34735 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34736 terminated with it.
34737
34738 @findex breakpoint annotation
34739 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34740 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34741
34742 @findex watchpoint annotation
34743 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34744 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34745 @end table
34746
34747 @node Source Annotations
34748 @section Displaying Source
34749 @cindex annotations for source display
34750
34751 @findex source annotation
34752 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34753
34754 @smallexample
34755 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34756 @end smallexample
34757
34758 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34759 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34760 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34761 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34762 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34763 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34764 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34765 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34766 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34767 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34768 depend on the language).
34769
34770 @node JIT Interface
34771 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34772 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34773 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34774
34775 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34776 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34777 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34778 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34779
34780 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34781 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34782 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34783 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34784 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34785 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34786
34787 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34788 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34789 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34790 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34791 LLVM JIT.
34792
34793 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34794 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34795 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34796 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34797 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34798 out about additional code.
34799
34800 @menu
34801 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34802 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34803 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34804 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34805 @end menu
34806
34807 @node Declarations
34808 @section JIT Declarations
34809
34810 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34811 implement the interface:
34812
34813 @smallexample
34814 typedef enum
34815 @{
34816 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34817 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34818 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34819 @} jit_actions_t;
34820
34821 struct jit_code_entry
34822 @{
34823 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34824 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34825 const char *symfile_addr;
34826 uint64_t symfile_size;
34827 @};
34828
34829 struct jit_descriptor
34830 @{
34831 uint32_t version;
34832 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34833 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34834 uint32_t action_flag;
34835 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34836 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34837 @};
34838
34839 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34840 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34841
34842 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34843 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34844 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34845 @end smallexample
34846
34847 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34848 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34849 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34850
34851 @node Registering Code
34852 @section Registering Code
34853
34854 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34855
34856 @itemize @bullet
34857 @item
34858 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34859 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34860
34861 @item
34862 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34863 file.
34864
34865 @item
34866 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34867
34868 @item
34869 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34870
34871 @item
34872 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34873 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34874 @end itemize
34875
34876 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34877 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34878 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34879 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34880
34881 @node Unregistering Code
34882 @section Unregistering Code
34883
34884 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34885
34886 @itemize @bullet
34887 @item
34888 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34889
34890 @item
34891 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34892
34893 @item
34894 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34895 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34896 @end itemize
34897
34898 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34899 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34900
34901 @node Custom Debug Info
34902 @section Custom Debug Info
34903 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34904 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34905
34906 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34907 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34908 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34909 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34910 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34911 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34912 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34913 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34914 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34915
34916 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34917 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34918 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34919 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34920 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34921 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34922 compiler.
34923
34924 @menu
34925 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34926 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34927 @end menu
34928
34929 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34930 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34931 @kindex jit-reader-load
34932 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34933
34934 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34935 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34936
34937 @table @code
34938 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34939 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34940 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34941 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34942 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34943 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34944 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34945
34946 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34947 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34948 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34949 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34950 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34951
34952 @item jit-reader-unload
34953 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34954
34955 @end table
34956
34957 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34958 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34959 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34960
34961 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34962 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34963
34964 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34965 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34966 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34967 the system include directory.
34968
34969 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34970 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34971 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34972
34973 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34974 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34975
34976 @findex gdb_init_reader
34977 @smallexample
34978 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34979 @end smallexample
34980
34981 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34982
34983 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34984 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34985 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34986 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34987 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34988 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34989
34990 @smallexample
34991 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34992 @{
34993 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34994 int reader_version;
34995
34996 /* For use by the reader. */
34997 void *priv_data;
34998
34999 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35000 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35001 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35002 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35003 @};
35004 @end smallexample
35005
35006 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35007 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35008
35009 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35010 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35011 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35012 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35013 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35014 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35015 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35016 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35017 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35018 target's address space.
35019
35020 @node In-Process Agent
35021 @chapter In-Process Agent
35022 @cindex debugging agent
35023 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35024 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35025 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35026 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35027 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35028 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35029 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35030 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35031 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35032 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35033 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35034 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35035 behavior without interrupting it.
35036
35037 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35038 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35039 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35040 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35041 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35042 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35043 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35044 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35045 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35046
35047 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35048 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35049 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35050 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35051
35052 @anchor{Control Agent}
35053 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35054 debugging with the following commands:
35055
35056 @table @code
35057 @kindex set agent on
35058 @item set agent on
35059 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35060 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35061 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35062 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35063 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35064 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35065
35066 @kindex set agent off
35067 @item set agent off
35068 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35069 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35070
35071 @kindex show agent
35072 @item show agent
35073 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35074 the in-process agent.
35075 @end table
35076
35077 @menu
35078 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35079 @end menu
35080
35081 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35082 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35083 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35084
35085 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35086 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35087 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35088 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35089 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35090 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35091 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35092 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35093 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35094
35095 @menu
35096 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35097 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35098 @end menu
35099
35100 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35101 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35102 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35103
35104 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35105 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35106
35107 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35108 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35109 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35110 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35111
35112 @enumerate
35113 @item
35114 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
35115 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
35116 @item
35117 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
35118 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
35119 the other one.
35120 @end enumerate
35121
35122 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
35123
35124 @enumerate
35125 @item
35126 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
35127 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
35128 @anchor{agent expression object}
35129 @item
35130 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
35131 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
35132 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
35133 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
35134 @item
35135 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35136 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35137
35138 @end enumerate
35139
35140 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35141 object:
35142
35143 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35144 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35145 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35146 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35147 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35148 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35149 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35150 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35151 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35152 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35153 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35154 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35155 memory address for collecting.
35156 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35157 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35158 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35159 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35160 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35161 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35162 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35163 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35164 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35165 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35166 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35167 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35168 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35169 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35170 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35171 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35172 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35173 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35174 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35175 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35176 @ref{agent expression object}
35177 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35178 @ref{agent expression object}
35179 @item actions @tab variable
35180 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35181 @end multitable
35182
35183 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35184 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35185 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35186
35187 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35188 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35189
35190 @table @samp
35191
35192 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35193 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35194 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35195 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35196 in IPA finally.
35197
35198 Replies:
35199 @table @samp
35200 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35201 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35202 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35203 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35204 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35205 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35206 @item E @var{NN}
35207 for an error
35208
35209 @end table
35210
35211 @item close
35212 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35213 is about to kill inferiors.
35214
35215 @item qTfSTM
35216 @xref{qTfSTM}.
35217 @item qTsSTM
35218 @xref{qTsSTM}.
35219 @item qTSTMat
35220 @xref{qTSTMat}.
35221 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35222 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35223
35224 Replies:
35225 @table @samp
35226 @item E @var{NN}
35227 for an error
35228 @end table
35229 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35230 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35231 @end table
35232
35233 @node GDB Bugs
35234 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35235 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35236 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35237
35238 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35239
35240 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35241 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35242 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35243 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35244
35245 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35246 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35247
35248 @menu
35249 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35250 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35251 @end menu
35252
35253 @node Bug Criteria
35254 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35255 @cindex bug criteria
35256
35257 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35258
35259 @itemize @bullet
35260 @cindex fatal signal
35261 @cindex debugger crash
35262 @cindex crash of debugger
35263 @item
35264 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35265 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35266
35267 @cindex error on valid input
35268 @item
35269 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35270 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35271 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35272
35273 @cindex invalid input
35274 @item
35275 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35276 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35277 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35278 for traditional practice''.
35279
35280 @item
35281 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35282 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35283 @end itemize
35284
35285 @node Bug Reporting
35286 @section How to Report Bugs
35287 @cindex bug reports
35288 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35289
35290 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35291 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35292 contact that organization first.
35293
35294 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35295 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35296 distribution.
35297 @c should add a web page ref...
35298
35299 @ifset BUGURL
35300 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35301 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35302 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35303 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35304 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35305 be used.
35306
35307 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35308 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35309 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35310 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35311
35312 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35313 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35314 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35315 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35316 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35317 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35318 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35319 bug reports to the mailing list.
35320 @end ifset
35321 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35322 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35323 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35324 @end ifclear
35325 @end ifset
35326
35327 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35328 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35329 fact or leave it out, state it!
35330
35331 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35332 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35333 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35334 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35335 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35336 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35337 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35338 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35339 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35340
35341 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35342 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35343 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35344 self-contained.
35345
35346 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35347 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35348 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35349 bugs properly.
35350
35351 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35352
35353 @itemize @bullet
35354 @item
35355 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35356 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35357 version}.
35358
35359 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35360 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35361
35362 @item
35363 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35364 version number.
35365
35366 @item
35367 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35368 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35369 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35370 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35371
35372 @item
35373 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35374 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35375
35376 @item
35377 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35378 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35379 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35380 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35381 those compilers.
35382
35383 @item
35384 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35385 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35386 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35387 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35388
35389 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35390 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35391
35392 @item
35393 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35394 reproduce the bug.
35395
35396 @item
35397 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35398 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35399
35400 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35401 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35402 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35403 a chance to make a mistake.
35404
35405 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35406 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35407 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35408 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35409 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35410 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35411 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35412 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35413
35414 @pindex script
35415 @cindex recording a session script
35416 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35417 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35418 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35419 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35420
35421 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35422 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35423
35424 @item
35425 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35426 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35427 it by context, not by line number.
35428
35429 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35430 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35431
35432 @end itemize
35433
35434 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35435
35436 @itemize @bullet
35437 @item
35438 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35439
35440 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35441 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35442 changes will not affect it.
35443
35444 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35445 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35446 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35447 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35448
35449 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35450 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35451 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35452 less time, and so on.
35453
35454 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35455 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35456
35457 @item
35458 A patch for the bug.
35459
35460 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35461 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35462 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35463 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35464
35465 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35466 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35467 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35468 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35469
35470 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35471 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35472 help us to understand.
35473
35474 @item
35475 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35476
35477 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35478 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35479 @end itemize
35480
35481 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35482 @c and consists of the two following files:
35483 @c rluser.texi
35484 @c hsuser.texi
35485 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35486 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35487 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35488 @include rluser.texi
35489 @include hsuser.texi
35490 @end ifclear
35491
35492 @node In Memoriam
35493 @appendix In Memoriam
35494
35495 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35496 contributors:
35497
35498 @table @code
35499 @item Fred Fish
35500 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35501 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35502 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35503
35504 @item Michael Snyder
35505 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35506 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35507 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35508 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35509 @end table
35510
35511 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35512 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35513
35514 @node Formatting Documentation
35515 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35516
35517 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35518 @cindex reference card
35519 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35520 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35521 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35522 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35523 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35524 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35525
35526 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35527 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35528
35529 @smallexample
35530 make refcard.dvi
35531 @end smallexample
35532
35533 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35534 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35535 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35536 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35537 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35538
35539 @cindex documentation
35540
35541 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35542 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35543 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35544 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35545 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35546 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35547
35548 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35549 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35550 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35551 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35552 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35553 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35554 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35555 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35556
35557 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35558 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35559 @code{makeinfo}.
35560
35561 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35562 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35563 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35564
35565 @smallexample
35566 cd gdb
35567 make gdb.info
35568 @end smallexample
35569
35570 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35571 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35572 Texinfo definitions file.
35573
35574 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35575 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35576 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35577 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35578 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35579 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35580 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35581
35582 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35583 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35584 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35585 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35586 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35587 directory.
35588
35589 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35590 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35591 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35592 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35593
35594 @smallexample
35595 make gdb.dvi
35596 @end smallexample
35597
35598 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35599
35600 @node Installing GDB
35601 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35602 @cindex installation
35603
35604 @menu
35605 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35606 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35607 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35608 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35609 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35610 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35611 @end menu
35612
35613 @node Requirements
35614 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35615 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35616
35617 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35618 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35619
35620 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35621 @table @asis
35622 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35623 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35624 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35625
35626 @item GNU make
35627 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35628 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35629 @end table
35630
35631 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35632 @table @asis
35633 @item Expat
35634 @anchor{Expat}
35635 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35636 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35637 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35638 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35639 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35640 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35641
35642 Expat is used for:
35643
35644 @itemize @bullet
35645 @item
35646 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35647 @item
35648 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35649 @item
35650 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35651 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35652 @item
35653 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35654 @item
35655 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35656 @item
35657 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35658 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35659 @end itemize
35660
35661 @item Guile
35662 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35663 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35664 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35665 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35666 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35667 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35668
35669 @item iconv
35670 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35671 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35672 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35673 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35674
35675 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35676 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35677 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35678 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35679 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35680
35681 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35682 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35683 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35684 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35685 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35686
35687 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35688 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35689 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35690 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35691 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35692 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35693 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35694 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35695 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35696
35697 @item lzma
35698 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35699 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35700 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35701 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35702 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35703 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35704 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35705
35706 @item MPFR
35707 @anchor{MPFR}
35708 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35709 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35710 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35711 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35712 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35713 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35714 option to specify its location.
35715
35716 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35717 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35718 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35719 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35720
35721 @item Python
35722 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35723 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35724 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35725 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35726 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35727 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35728 installation of Python.
35729
35730 @item zlib
35731 @cindex compressed debug sections
35732 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35733 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35734 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35735 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35736 information in such binaries.
35737
35738 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35739 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35740 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35741 @end table
35742
35743 @node Running Configure
35744 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35745 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35746 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35747 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35748 build the @code{gdb} program.
35749 @iftex
35750 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35751 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35752 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35753 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35754 @end iftex
35755
35756 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35757 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35758 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35759
35760 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35761 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35762
35763 @table @code
35764 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35765 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35766
35767 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35768 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35769
35770 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35771 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35772
35773 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35774 @sc{gnu} include files
35775
35776 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35777 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35778
35779 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35780 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35781
35782 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35783 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35784 @end table
35785
35786 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35787
35788 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35789 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35790 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35791
35792 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35793 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35794 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35795 argument.
35796
35797 For example:
35798
35799 @smallexample
35800 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35801 ./configure
35802 make
35803 @end smallexample
35804
35805 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35806 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35807 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35808 directories.
35809
35810 @need 750
35811 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35812 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35813 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35814
35815 @smallexample
35816 sh configure
35817 @end smallexample
35818
35819 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35820 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35821 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35822 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35823 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35824 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35825 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35826 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35827 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35828
35829 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35830 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35831 install it with @code{make install}.
35832
35833 @node Separate Objdir
35834 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35835
35836 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35837 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35838 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35839 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35840 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35841 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35842 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35843 program specified there.
35844
35845 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35846 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35847 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35848 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35849 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35850 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35851
35852 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35853 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35854
35855 @smallexample
35856 @group
35857 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35858 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35859 cd ../gdb-sun4
35860 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35861 make
35862 @end group
35863 @end smallexample
35864
35865 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35866 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35867 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35868 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35869 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35870 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35871
35872 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35873 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35874 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35875 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35876 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35877
35878 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35879 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35880 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35881 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35882 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35883 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35884
35885 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35886 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35887 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35888
35889 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35890 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35891 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35892 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35893 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35894
35895 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35896 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35897 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35898 with each other.
35899
35900 @node Config Names
35901 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35902
35903 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35904 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35905 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35906 of information in the following pattern:
35907
35908 @smallexample
35909 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35910 @end smallexample
35911
35912 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35913 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35914 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35915
35916 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35917 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35918 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35919 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35920 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35921 abbreviations---for example:
35922
35923 @smallexample
35924 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35925 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35926 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35927 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35928 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35929 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35930 % sh config.sub sun4
35931 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35932 % sh config.sub sun3
35933 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35934 % sh config.sub i986v
35935 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35936 @end smallexample
35937
35938 @noindent
35939 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35940 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35941
35942 @node Configure Options
35943 @section @file{configure} Options
35944
35945 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35946 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35947 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35948 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35949 explanation of @file{configure}.
35950
35951 @smallexample
35952 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35953 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35954 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35955 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35956 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35957 @end smallexample
35958
35959 @noindent
35960 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35961 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35962 @samp{--}.
35963
35964 @table @code
35965 @item --help
35966 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35967
35968 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35969 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35970 @file{@var{dir}}.
35971
35972 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35973 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35974 @file{@var{dir}}.
35975
35976 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35977 @need 2000
35978 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35979 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35980 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35981 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35982 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35983 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35984 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35985 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35986 @var{dirname}.
35987
35988 @item --target=@var{target}
35989 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35990 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35991 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35992
35993 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35994 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35995 @end table
35996
35997 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35998 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35999 options not described here.
36000
36001 @table @code
36002 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
36003 @itemx --enable-targets=all
36004 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
36005 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
36006 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
36007
36008 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
36009 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
36010 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
36011 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
36012 @code{--datadir}).
36013
36014 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
36015 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
36016 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
36017 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
36018 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36019 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36020 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36021 after it is built.
36022
36023 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36024 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36025
36026 @item --disable-gdbmi
36027 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36028 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36029
36030 @item --enable-tui
36031 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36032 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36033 supported).
36034
36035 @item --with-curses
36036 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
36037 terminal operations.
36038
36039 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36040 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36041 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36042 details.
36043
36044 @item --with-system-readline
36045 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36046 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36047
36048 @item --with-system-zlib
36049 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36050 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36051
36052 @item --with-expat
36053 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36054 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36055 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36056 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36057 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36058 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36059 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36060 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36061
36062 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36063
36064 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36065 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36066 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36067 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36068 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36069
36070 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36071 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36072
36073 @item --with-lzma
36074 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36075 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36076 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
36077 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
36078 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
36079 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
36080
36081 @item --with-mpfr
36082 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
36083 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
36084 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
36085 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
36086 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
36087 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
36088 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
36089 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
36090 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
36091
36092 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
36093 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
36094 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
36095 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
36096 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
36097 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
36098 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
36099 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
36100 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
36101 Python is installed.
36102
36103 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
36104 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
36105 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
36106 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
36107 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
36108 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
36109 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
36110 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
36111 compile and link against Guile.
36112
36113 @item --without-included-regex
36114 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
36115 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
36116 the GNU C library.
36117
36118 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
36119 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
36120 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
36121 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
36122 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
36123 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
36124 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
36125 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
36126
36127 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36128 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
36129 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
36130 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
36131 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
36132 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
36133
36134 @item --enable-build-warnings
36135 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
36136 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
36137 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
36138 compiler you are using.
36139
36140 @item --enable-werror
36141 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
36142 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
36143 outputs any warning messages.
36144
36145 @item --enable-ubsan
36146 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
36147 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
36148 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
36149 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
36150 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
36151 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
36152 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
36153 @end table
36154
36155 @node System-wide configuration
36156 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36157 @cindex system-wide init file
36158
36159 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36160 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36161 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36162
36163 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36164
36165 @table @code
36166 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36167 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36168 @var{file}.
36169 @end table
36170
36171 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36172 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36173
36174 @itemize @bullet
36175 @item
36176 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36177 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36178 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36179 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36180 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36181 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36182
36183 @item
36184 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36185 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36186 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36187 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36188 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36189 @end itemize
36190
36191 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36192 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36193 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36194 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36195 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36196 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36197 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36198 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36199 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36200 reread.
36201
36202 @menu
36203 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36204 @end menu
36205
36206 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
36207 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36208 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36209
36210 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36211 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36212 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36213 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36214 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36215 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36216
36217 The following scripts are currently available:
36218 @itemize @bullet
36219
36220 @item @file{elinos.py}
36221 @pindex elinos.py
36222 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36223 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36224 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36225 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36226 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36227 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36228
36229 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36230 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36231 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36232 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36233 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36234 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36235
36236 @end itemize
36237
36238 @node Maintenance Commands
36239 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36240 @cindex maintenance commands
36241 @cindex internal commands
36242
36243 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36244 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36245 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36246 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36247 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36248
36249 @table @code
36250 @kindex maint agent
36251 @kindex maint agent-eval
36252 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36253 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36254 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36255 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36256 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36257 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36258 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36259 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36260 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36261 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36262 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36263 addition and return the sum.
36264 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36265 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36266
36267 @kindex maint agent-printf
36268 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36269 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36270 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36271 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36272 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36273
36274 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36275 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36276 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36277 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36278 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36279 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36280 is shown:
36281
36282 @table @code
36283 @item breakpoint
36284 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36285
36286 @item watchpoint
36287 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36288
36289 @item longjmp
36290 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36291 @code{longjmp} calls.
36292
36293 @item longjmp resume
36294 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36295
36296 @item until
36297 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36298
36299 @item finish
36300 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36301
36302 @item shlib events
36303 Shared library events.
36304
36305 @end table
36306
36307 @kindex maint info btrace
36308 @item maint info btrace
36309 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36310
36311 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36312 @item maint btrace packet-history
36313 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36314 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36315 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36316 recording format.
36317
36318 @table @code
36319 @item bts
36320 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36321 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36322
36323 @table @asis
36324 @item Block number
36325 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36326 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36327 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36328 @end table
36329
36330 @item pt
36331 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36332 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36333 information is printed:
36334
36335 @table @asis
36336 @item Packet number
36337 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36338 @item Trace offset
36339 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36340 @item Packet opcode and payload
36341 @end table
36342 @end table
36343
36344 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36345 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36346 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36347 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36348 needed.
36349
36350 @kindex maint btrace clear
36351 @item maint btrace clear
36352 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36353 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36354
36355 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36356 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36357 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36358 buffer.
36359
36360 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36361 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36362 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36363 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36364 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36365 packet history.
36366
36367 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36368 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36369 @cindex displaced stepping support
36370 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36371 @item set displaced-stepping
36372 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36373 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36374 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36375 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36376 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36377 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36378
36379 @table @code
36380 @item set displaced-stepping on
36381 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36382 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36383
36384 @item set displaced-stepping off
36385 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36386 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36387
36388 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36389 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36390 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36391 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36392 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36393 @end table
36394
36395 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36396 @item maint check-psymtabs
36397 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36398 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36399
36400 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36401 @item maint check-symtabs
36402 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36403
36404 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36405 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36406 Expand symbol tables.
36407 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36408 names matching @var{regexp}.
36409
36410 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36411 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36412 @cindex demangler crashes
36413 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36414 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36415 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36416 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36417 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36418 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36419 option to terminate the current session.
36420
36421 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36422 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36423 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36424
36425 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36426 @item maint cplus namespace
36427 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36428
36429 @kindex maint deprecate
36430 @kindex maint undeprecate
36431 @cindex deprecated commands
36432 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36433 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36434 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36435 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36436 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36437 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36438 the replacement as part of the warning.
36439
36440 @kindex maint dump-me
36441 @item maint dump-me
36442 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36443 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36444 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36445 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36446
36447 @kindex maint internal-error
36448 @kindex maint internal-warning
36449 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36450 @cindex demangler crashes
36451 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36452 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36453 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36454
36455 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36456 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36457 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36458 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36459 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36460 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36461 @value{GDBN} session.
36462
36463 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36464 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36465
36466 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36467
36468 @smallexample
36469 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36470 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36471 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36472 debugging may prove unreliable.
36473 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36474 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36475 (@value{GDBP})
36476 @end smallexample
36477
36478 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36479 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36480 @cindex demangler crashes
36481
36482 @kindex maint set internal-error
36483 @kindex maint show internal-error
36484 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36485 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36486 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36487 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36488 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36489 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36490 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36491 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36492 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36493 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36494 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36495 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36496 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36497 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36498 described in the table below.
36499
36500 @table @samp
36501 @item quit
36502 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36503 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36504
36505 @item corefile
36506 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36507 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36508 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36509 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36510 disabled.
36511 @end table
36512
36513 @kindex maint packet
36514 @item maint packet @var{text}
36515 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36516 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36517 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36518 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36519 checksum.
36520
36521 @kindex maint print architecture
36522 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36523 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36524 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36525
36526 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36527 @item maint print c-tdesc
36528 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36529 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36530 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36531 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36532 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36533 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36534 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36535 modify XML target descriptions.
36536
36537 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36538 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36539 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36540 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36541
36542 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36543 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36544 @item maint check libthread-db
36545 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36546 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36547 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36548 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36549 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36550 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36551
36552 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36553 @item maint print dummy-frames
36554 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36555
36556 @smallexample
36557 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36558 @dots{}
36559 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36560 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36561 58 return (a + b);
36562 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36563 @dots{}
36564 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36565 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36566 (@value{GDBP})
36567 @end smallexample
36568
36569 Takes an optional file parameter.
36570
36571 @kindex maint print registers
36572 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36573 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36574 @kindex maint print register-groups
36575 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36576 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36577 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36578 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36579 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36580 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36581 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36582
36583 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36584 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36585 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36586 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36587 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36588 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36589 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36590 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36591
36592 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36593 write the information.
36594
36595 @kindex maint print reggroups
36596 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36597 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36598 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36599 information.
36600
36601 The register groups info looks like this:
36602
36603 @smallexample
36604 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36605 Group Type
36606 general user
36607 float user
36608 all user
36609 vector user
36610 system user
36611 save internal
36612 restore internal
36613 @end smallexample
36614
36615 @kindex flushregs
36616 @item flushregs
36617 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36618
36619 @kindex maint print objfiles
36620 @cindex info for known object files
36621 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36622 Print a dump of all known object files.
36623 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36624 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36625 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36626
36627 @kindex maint print user-registers
36628 @cindex user registers
36629 @item maint print user-registers
36630 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36631 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36632 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36633 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36634 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36635 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36636 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36637
36638 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36639 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36640 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36641 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36642 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36643 matching @var{regexp}.
36644 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36645 and the full path if known.
36646 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36647
36648 @kindex maint print statistics
36649 @cindex bcache statistics
36650 @item maint print statistics
36651 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36652 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36653 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36654 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36655 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36656 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36657 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36658 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36659 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36660 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36661 lengths.
36662
36663 @kindex maint print target-stack
36664 @cindex target stack description
36665 @item maint print target-stack
36666 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36667 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36668 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36669 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36670 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36671 address.
36672
36673 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36674 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36675
36676 @kindex maint print type
36677 @cindex type chain of a data type
36678 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36679 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36680 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36681 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36682 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36683 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36684
36685 @kindex maint selftest
36686 @cindex self tests
36687 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36688 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36689 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36690 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36691 name will by ran.
36692
36693 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36694 @cindex self tests
36695 @item maint info selftests
36696 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36697
36698 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36699 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36700 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36701 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36702 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36703 information.
36704
36705 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36706 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36707 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36708 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36709 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36710 always see the disassembly form.
36711
36712 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36713
36714 @smallexample
36715 (gdb) info addr argc
36716 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36717 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36718 @end smallexample
36719
36720 For more information on these expressions, see
36721 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36722
36723 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36724 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36725 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36726 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36727 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36728
36729 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36730 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36731 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36732 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36733 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36734 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36735 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36736 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36737 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36738
36739 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36740 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36741 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36742 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36743 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36744
36745 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36746 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36747 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36748 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36749 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36750 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36751
36752 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36753 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36754 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36755
36756 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36757 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36758 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36759 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36760
36761 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36762 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36763 @kindex maint set profile
36764 @kindex maint show profile
36765 @cindex profiling GDB
36766 @item maint set profile
36767 @itemx maint show profile
36768 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36769
36770 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36771 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36772 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36773 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36774 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36775 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36776 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36777
36778 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36779 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36780
36781 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36782 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36783 @cindex hardware debug registers
36784 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36785 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36786 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36787 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36788 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36789 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36790 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36791
36792 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36793 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36794 @item maint set show-all-tib
36795 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36796 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36797 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36798 command.
36799
36800 @kindex maint set target-async
36801 @kindex maint show target-async
36802 @item maint set target-async
36803 @itemx maint show target-async
36804 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36805 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36806 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36807 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36808
36809 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36810 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36811 @item maint set target-non-stop
36812 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36813
36814 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36815 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36816 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36817 if supported by the target.
36818
36819 @table @code
36820 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36821 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36822 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36823
36824 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36825 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36826 does not indicate support.
36827
36828 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36829 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36830 target supports it.
36831 @end table
36832
36833 @kindex maint set per-command
36834 @kindex maint show per-command
36835 @item maint set per-command
36836 @itemx maint show per-command
36837 @cindex resources used by commands
36838
36839 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36840 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36841
36842 @table @code
36843 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36844 @itemx maint show per-command space
36845 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36846 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36847 took, following the command's own output.
36848 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36849 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36850
36851 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36852 @itemx maint show per-command time
36853 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36854 for each command.
36855 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36856 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36857 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36858 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36859 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36860 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36861 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36862 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36863 spent by the program been debugged.
36864 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36865 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36866
36867 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36868 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36869 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36870 for each command.
36871 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36872
36873 @enumerate a
36874 @item
36875 number of symbol tables
36876 @item
36877 number of primary symbol tables
36878 @item
36879 number of blocks in the blockvector
36880 @end enumerate
36881 @end table
36882
36883 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36884 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36885 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36886 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36887 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36888 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36889 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36890 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36891 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36892 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36893
36894 @kindex maint space
36895 @cindex memory used by commands
36896 @item maint space @var{value}
36897 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36898 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36899
36900 @kindex maint time
36901 @cindex time of command execution
36902 @item maint time @var{value}
36903 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36904 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36905
36906 @kindex maint translate-address
36907 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36908 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36909 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36910 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36911 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36912 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36913 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36914
36915 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36916 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36917 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36918
36919 @end table
36920
36921 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36922 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36923
36924 @table @code
36925 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36926 @kindex set watchdog
36927 @cindex watchdog timer
36928 @cindex timeout for commands
36929 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36930 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36931 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36932
36933 @item show watchdog
36934 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36935 @end table
36936
36937 @node Remote Protocol
36938 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36939
36940 @menu
36941 * Overview::
36942 * Packets::
36943 * Stop Reply Packets::
36944 * General Query Packets::
36945 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36946 * Tracepoint Packets::
36947 * Host I/O Packets::
36948 * Interrupts::
36949 * Notification Packets::
36950 * Remote Non-Stop::
36951 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36952 * Examples::
36953 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36954 * Library List Format::
36955 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36956 * Memory Map Format::
36957 * Thread List Format::
36958 * Traceframe Info Format::
36959 * Branch Trace Format::
36960 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36961 @end menu
36962
36963 @node Overview
36964 @section Overview
36965
36966 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36967 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36968 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36969 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36970
36971 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36972 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36973
36974 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36975 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36976 @cindex remote serial protocol
36977 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36978 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36979 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36980 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36981 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36982
36983 @smallexample
36984 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36985 @end smallexample
36986 @noindent
36987
36988 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36989 @noindent
36990 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36991 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36992 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36993
36994 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36995 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36996
36997 @smallexample
36998 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36999 @end smallexample
37000
37001 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
37002 @noindent
37003 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
37004 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
37005 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
37006
37007 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
37008 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37009 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
37010 retransmission):
37011
37012 @smallexample
37013 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37014 <- @code{+}
37015 @end smallexample
37016 @noindent
37017
37018 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37019 once a connection is established.
37020 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37021
37022 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37023 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37024 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37025 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37026 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37027 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37028 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37029
37030 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37031 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37032 exceptions).
37033
37034 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37035 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37036 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37037 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37038
37039 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37040 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37041 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37042
37043 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37044 @anchor{Binary Data}
37045 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37046 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37047 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37048 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37049 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37050 binary data.
37051
37052 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37053 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37054 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37055 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37056 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37057 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37058 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37059 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37060 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37061 (described next).
37062
37063 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37064 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37065 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37066 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37067 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37068 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37069 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37070 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37071 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37072 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37073 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37074 3}} more times.
37075
37076 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37077 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37078 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37079 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37080 @samp{0*"00}.
37081
37082 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37083 error number. That number is not well defined.
37084
37085 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37086 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37087 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37088 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37089 on that response.
37090
37091 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
37092 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
37093 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
37094 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
37095 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
37096 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
37097
37098 @node Packets
37099 @section Packets
37100
37101 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
37102 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
37103 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
37104 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
37105
37106 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
37107 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
37108 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
37109 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
37110 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
37111 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
37112 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
37113 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
37114 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
37115 @var{baz}.
37116
37117 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
37118 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
37119 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
37120 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
37121 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
37122 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
37123 pick any thread.
37124
37125 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
37126 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
37127 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
37128 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
37129 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
37130 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
37131 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
37132 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
37133 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
37134 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
37135 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
37136 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37137 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37138
37139 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37140 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37141 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37142 more information.
37143
37144 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37145 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37146
37147 Here are the packet descriptions.
37148
37149 @table @samp
37150
37151 @item !
37152 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37153 @anchor{extended mode}
37154 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37155 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37156 debugged.
37157
37158 Reply:
37159 @table @samp
37160 @item OK
37161 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37162 @end table
37163
37164 @item ?
37165 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37166 @anchor{? packet}
37167 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37168 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37169 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37170
37171 Reply:
37172 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37173
37174 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37175 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37176 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37177 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37178 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37179
37180 Reply:
37181 @table @samp
37182 @item OK
37183 The arguments were set.
37184 @item E @var{NN}
37185 An error occurred.
37186 @end table
37187
37188 @item b @var{baud}
37189 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37190 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37191 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37192
37193 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37194 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37195 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37196
37197 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37198 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37199 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37200 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37201 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37202
37203 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37204 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37205 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37206 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37207
37208 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37209 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37210
37211 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37212 @anchor{bc}
37213 @item bc
37214 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37215 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37216
37217 Reply:
37218 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37219
37220 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37221 @anchor{bs}
37222 @item bs
37223 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37224 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37225
37226 Reply:
37227 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37228
37229 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37230 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37231 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
37232 is omitted, resume at current address.
37233
37234 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37235 packet}.
37236
37237 Reply:
37238 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37239
37240 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37241 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37242 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37243 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37244
37245 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37246 packet}.
37247
37248 Reply:
37249 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37250
37251 @item d
37252 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37253 Toggle debug flag.
37254
37255 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37256 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37257
37258 @item D
37259 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37260 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37261 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37262 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37263 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37264
37265 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37266 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37267 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37268 big-endian hex string.
37269
37270 Reply:
37271 @table @samp
37272 @item OK
37273 for success
37274 @item E @var{NN}
37275 for an error
37276 @end table
37277
37278 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37279 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37280 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37281 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37282 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37283
37284 @item g
37285 @anchor{read registers packet}
37286 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37287 Read general registers.
37288
37289 Reply:
37290 @table @samp
37291 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37292 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37293 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37294 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37295 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37296 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37297
37298 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37299 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37300 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37301 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37302 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37303 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37304 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37305 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37306
37307 @smallexample
37308 -> @code{g}
37309 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37310 @end smallexample
37311
37312 @item E @var{NN}
37313 for an error.
37314 @end table
37315
37316 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37317 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37318 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37319 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37320
37321 Reply:
37322 @table @samp
37323 @item OK
37324 for success
37325 @item E @var{NN}
37326 for an error
37327 @end table
37328
37329 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37330 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37331 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37332 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37333 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37334 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37335 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37336 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37337 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37338
37339 Reply:
37340 @table @samp
37341 @item OK
37342 for success
37343 @item E @var{NN}
37344 for an error
37345 @end table
37346
37347 @c FIXME: JTC:
37348 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37349 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37350 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37351 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37352 @c described. For example:
37353 @c
37354 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37355 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37356 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37357 @c
37358 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37359 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37360 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37361
37362 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37363 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37364 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37365 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37366 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37367 step starting at that address.
37368
37369 @item I
37370 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37371 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37372 step packet}.
37373
37374 @item k
37375 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37376 Kill request.
37377
37378 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37379
37380 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37381 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37382
37383 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37384
37385 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37386 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37387 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37388
37389 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37390 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37391 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37392
37393 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37394 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37395 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37396 (@pxref{? packet}).
37397
37398 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37399 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37400 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37401 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37402 any particular boundary.
37403
37404 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37405 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37406 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37407 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37408 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37409 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37410 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37411 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37412
37413 Reply:
37414 @table @samp
37415 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37416 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37417 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37418 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37419 @item E @var{NN}
37420 @var{NN} is errno
37421 @end table
37422
37423 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37424 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37425 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37426 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37427 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37428
37429 Reply:
37430 @table @samp
37431 @item OK
37432 for success
37433 @item E @var{NN}
37434 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37435 written).
37436 @end table
37437
37438 @item p @var{n}
37439 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37440 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37441 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37442 register value is encoded.
37443
37444 Reply:
37445 @table @samp
37446 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37447 the register's value
37448 @item E @var{NN}
37449 for an error
37450 @item @w{}
37451 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37452 @end table
37453
37454 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37455 @anchor{write register packet}
37456 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37457 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37458 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37459 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37460
37461 Reply:
37462 @table @samp
37463 @item OK
37464 for success
37465 @item E @var{NN}
37466 for an error
37467 @end table
37468
37469 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37470 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37471 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37472 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37473 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37474 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37475
37476 @item r
37477 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37478 Reset the entire system.
37479
37480 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37481
37482 @item R @var{XX}
37483 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37484 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37485 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37486
37487 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37488
37489 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37490 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37491 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37492 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37493
37494 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37495 packet}.
37496
37497 Reply:
37498 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37499
37500 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37501 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37502 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37503 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37504 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37505
37506 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37507 packet}.
37508
37509 Reply:
37510 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37511
37512 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37513 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37514 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37515 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37516 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37517
37518 @item T @var{thread-id}
37519 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37520 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37521
37522 Reply:
37523 @table @samp
37524 @item OK
37525 thread is still alive
37526 @item E @var{NN}
37527 thread is dead
37528 @end table
37529
37530 @item v
37531 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37532 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37533
37534 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37535 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37536 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37537 The process ID is a
37538 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37539 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37540 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37541
37542 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37543 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37544 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37545 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37546 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37547 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37548 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37549 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37550
37551 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37552
37553 Reply:
37554 @table @samp
37555 @item E @var{nn}
37556 for an error
37557 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37558 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37559 @item OK
37560 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37561 @end table
37562
37563 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37564 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37565 @anchor{vCont packet}
37566 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37567
37568 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37569 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37570 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37571 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37572 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37573 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37574 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37575 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37576 error.
37577
37578 Currently supported actions are:
37579
37580 @table @samp
37581 @item c
37582 Continue.
37583 @item C @var{sig}
37584 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37585 @item s
37586 Step.
37587 @item S @var{sig}
37588 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37589 @item t
37590 Stop.
37591 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37592 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37593 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37594 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37595 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37596 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37597
37598 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37599 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37600 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37601 jumps to @var{start}).
37602
37603 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37604 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37605 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37606
37607 @end table
37608
37609 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37610 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37611 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37612
37613 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37614 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37615 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37616 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37617 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37618 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37619 as an implementation detail.
37620
37621 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37622 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37623 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37624 stopped.
37625
37626 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37627 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37628 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37629
37630 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37631 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37632
37633 Reply:
37634 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37635
37636 @item vCont?
37637 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37638 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37639
37640 Reply:
37641 @table @samp
37642 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37643 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37644 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37645 @item @w{}
37646 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37647 @end table
37648
37649 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37650 @item vCtrlC
37651 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37652 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37653 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37654 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37655 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37656 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37657 variant.
37658
37659 Reply:
37660 @table @samp
37661 @item E @var{nn}
37662 for an error
37663 @item OK
37664 for success
37665 @end table
37666
37667 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37668 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37669 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37670 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37671
37672 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37673 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37674 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37675 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37676 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37677 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37678 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37679 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37680 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37681 packet is received.
37682
37683 Reply:
37684 @table @samp
37685 @item OK
37686 for success
37687 @item E @var{NN}
37688 for an error
37689 @end table
37690
37691 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37692 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37693 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37694 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37695 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37696 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37697 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37698 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37699 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37700 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37701 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37702 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37703
37704
37705 Reply:
37706 @table @samp
37707 @item OK
37708 for success
37709 @item E.memtype
37710 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37711 @item E @var{NN}
37712 for an error
37713 @end table
37714
37715 @item vFlashDone
37716 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37717 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37718 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37719 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37720 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37721 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37722 request is completed.
37723
37724 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37725 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37726 @anchor{vKill packet}
37727 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37728 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37729 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37730 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37731
37732 Reply:
37733 @table @samp
37734 @item E @var{nn}
37735 for an error
37736 @item OK
37737 for success
37738 @end table
37739
37740 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37741 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37742 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37743 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37744 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37745
37746 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37747 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37748 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37749 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37750 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37751 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37752
37753 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37754 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37755 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37756 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37757 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37758 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37759 state.
37760
37761 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37762
37763 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37764
37765 Reply:
37766 @table @samp
37767 @item E @var{nn}
37768 for an error
37769 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37770 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37771 @end table
37772
37773 @item vStopped
37774 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37775 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37776
37777 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37778 @anchor{X packet}
37779 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37780 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37781 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37782 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37783 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37784
37785 Reply:
37786 @table @samp
37787 @item OK
37788 for success
37789 @item E @var{NN}
37790 for an error
37791 @end table
37792
37793 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37794 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37795 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37796 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37797 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37798 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37799 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37800
37801 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37802 separately.
37803
37804 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37805 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37806 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37807 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37808 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37809 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37810
37811 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37812 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37813 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37814 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37815 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37816 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37817
37818 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37819 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37820 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37821 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37822 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37823 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37824 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37825 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37826 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37827 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37828 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37829 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37830 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37831
37832 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37833 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37834
37835 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37836 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37837
37838 @table @samp
37839
37840 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37841 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37842 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37843
37844 @end table
37845
37846 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37847 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37848 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37849 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37850 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37851 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37852 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37853
37854 @table @samp
37855
37856 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37857 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37858 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37859
37860 @end table
37861
37862 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37863 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37864 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37865 target, is not defined.}
37866
37867 Reply:
37868 @table @samp
37869 @item OK
37870 success
37871 @item @w{}
37872 not supported
37873 @item E @var{NN}
37874 for an error
37875 @end table
37876
37877 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37878 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37879 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37880 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37881 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37882 address @var{addr}.
37883
37884 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37885 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37886 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37887 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37888
37889 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37890 movement.}
37891
37892 Reply:
37893 @table @samp
37894 @item OK
37895 success
37896 @item @w{}
37897 not supported
37898 @item E @var{NN}
37899 for an error
37900 @end table
37901
37902 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37903 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37904 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37905 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37906 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37907 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37908
37909 Reply:
37910 @table @samp
37911 @item OK
37912 success
37913 @item @w{}
37914 not supported
37915 @item E @var{NN}
37916 for an error
37917 @end table
37918
37919 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37920 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37921 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37922 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37923 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37924 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37925
37926 Reply:
37927 @table @samp
37928 @item OK
37929 success
37930 @item @w{}
37931 not supported
37932 @item E @var{NN}
37933 for an error
37934 @end table
37935
37936 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37937 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37938 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37939 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37940 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37941 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37942
37943 Reply:
37944 @table @samp
37945 @item OK
37946 success
37947 @item @w{}
37948 not supported
37949 @item E @var{NN}
37950 for an error
37951 @end table
37952
37953 @end table
37954
37955 @node Stop Reply Packets
37956 @section Stop Reply Packets
37957 @cindex stop reply packets
37958
37959 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37960 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37961 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37962 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37963 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37964 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37965 @value{GDBN} source code.
37966
37967 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37968 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37969 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37970
37971 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37972 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37973 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37974 components.
37975
37976 @table @samp
37977
37978 @item S @var{AA}
37979 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37980 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37981 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37982
37983 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37984 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37985 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37986 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37987 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37988 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37989 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37990 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37991
37992 @itemize @bullet
37993 @item
37994 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37995 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37996 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37997 two-digit hex number.
37998
37999 @item
38000 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
38001 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38002
38003 @item
38004 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
38005 the core on which the stop event was detected.
38006
38007 @item
38008 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
38009 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
38010 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
38011 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
38012
38013 @item
38014 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
38015 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
38016 future.
38017 @end itemize
38018
38019 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38020
38021 @table @samp
38022 @item watch
38023 @itemx rwatch
38024 @itemx awatch
38025 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38026 hex.
38027
38028 @item syscall_entry
38029 @itemx syscall_return
38030 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
38031 syscall number, in hex.
38032
38033 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38034 @item library
38035 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38036 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38037 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
38038
38039 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38040 @item replaylog
38041 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38042 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38043 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38044 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38045 for more information.
38046
38047 @item swbreak
38048 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
38049 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
38050 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
38051 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
38052 part must be left empty.
38053
38054 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
38055 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
38056 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
38057 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
38058 address.
38059
38060 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38061 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38062 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38063 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38064 indicating support.
38065
38066 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
38067
38068 @item hwbreak
38069 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
38070 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
38071
38072 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
38073 apply.
38074
38075 @cindex fork events, remote reply
38076 @item fork
38077 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
38078 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38079 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38080 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38081 fork events.
38082
38083 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38084 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38085 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38086 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38087 indicating support.
38088
38089 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
38090 @item vfork
38091 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
38092 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38093 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38094 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38095 vfork events.
38096
38097 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38098 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38099 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38100 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38101 indicating support.
38102
38103 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
38104 @item vforkdone
38105 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
38106 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
38107 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
38108 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
38109 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
38110
38111 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38112 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38113 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38114 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38115 indicating support.
38116
38117 @cindex exec events, remote reply
38118 @item exec
38119 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
38120 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
38121 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
38122
38123 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38124 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38125 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38126 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38127 indicating support.
38128
38129 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
38130 @anchor{thread create event}
38131 @item create
38132 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
38133 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
38134 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
38135 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
38136 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
38137 @var{r} part is ignored.
38138
38139 @end table
38140
38141 @item W @var{AA}
38142 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38143 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38144 applicable to certain targets.
38145
38146 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38147 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38148 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38149 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38150 hex strings.
38151
38152 @item X @var{AA}
38153 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38154 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38155
38156 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38157 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38158 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38159 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38160 hex strings.
38161
38162 @anchor{thread exit event}
38163 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
38164 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
38165
38166 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
38167 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
38168 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
38169 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38170
38171 @item N
38172 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
38173 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
38174 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
38175 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
38176 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
38177 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
38178 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
38179 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
38180 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
38181 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
38182 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
38183 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
38184 support.
38185
38186 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38187 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38188 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38189 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38190 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38191
38192 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38193 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38194 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38195 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38196 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38197 system calls.
38198
38199 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38200 this very system call.
38201
38202 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38203 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38204 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38205 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38206 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38207 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38208
38209 @end table
38210
38211 @node General Query Packets
38212 @section General Query Packets
38213 @cindex remote query requests
38214
38215 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38216 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38217 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38218 sending information to and from the stub.
38219
38220 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38221 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38222 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38223 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38224 conventions:
38225
38226 @itemize @bullet
38227 @item
38228 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38229 @item
38230 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38231 letter.
38232 @item
38233 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38234 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38235 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38236 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38237 @end itemize
38238
38239 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38240 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38241 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38242 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38243 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38244 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38245 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38246 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38247 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38248 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38249 packet.}.
38250
38251 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38252 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38253 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38254 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38255 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38256
38257 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38258
38259 @table @samp
38260
38261 @item QAgent:1
38262 @itemx QAgent:0
38263 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38264 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38265
38266 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38267 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38268 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38269 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38270 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38271 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38272 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38273 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38274 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38275 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38276 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38277
38278 @item qC
38279 @cindex current thread, remote request
38280 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38281 Return the current thread ID.
38282
38283 Reply:
38284 @table @samp
38285 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38286 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38287 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38288 @item @r{(anything else)}
38289 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38290 @end table
38291
38292 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38293 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38294 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38295 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38296 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38297 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38298 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38299 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38300
38301 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38302 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38303 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38304 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38305 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38306 detect trailing zeros.
38307
38308 Reply:
38309 @table @samp
38310 @item E @var{NN}
38311 An error (such as memory fault)
38312 @item C @var{crc32}
38313 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38314 @end table
38315
38316 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38317 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38318 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38319 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38320 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38321 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38322 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38323 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38324 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38325 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38326 randomization.
38327
38328 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38329
38330 Reply:
38331 @table @samp
38332 @item OK
38333 The request succeeded.
38334
38335 @item E @var{nn}
38336 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38337
38338 @item @w{}
38339 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38340 by the stub.
38341 @end table
38342
38343 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38344 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38345 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38346 address space randomization.
38347
38348 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38349 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38350 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38351 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38352 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38353 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38354 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38355 inferior using a shell or not.
38356
38357 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38358 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38359 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38360 values are considered an error.
38361
38362 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38363 mode}).
38364
38365 Reply:
38366 @table @samp
38367 @item OK
38368 The request succeeded.
38369
38370 @item E @var{nn}
38371 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38372 @end table
38373
38374 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38375 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38376 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38377 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38378
38379 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38380 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38381
38382 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38383 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38384 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38385 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38386 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38387 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38388 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38389 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38390 environment}).
38391
38392 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38393 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38394 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38395 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38396 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38397 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38398 not be present.
38399
38400 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38401 mode}).
38402
38403 Reply:
38404 @table @samp
38405 @item OK
38406 The request succeeded.
38407 @end table
38408
38409 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38410 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38411 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38412 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38413 inferior.
38414
38415 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38416 @pxref{set environment}.
38417
38418 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38419 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38420 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38421 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38422 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38423 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38424 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38425 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38426
38427 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38428 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38429
38430 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38431 mode}).
38432
38433 Reply:
38434 @table @samp
38435 @item OK
38436 The request succeeded.
38437 @end table
38438
38439 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38440 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38441 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38442 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38443 inferior.
38444
38445 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38446 @pxref{unset environment}.
38447
38448 @item QEnvironmentReset
38449 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38450 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38451 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38452 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38453 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38454 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38455 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38456 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38457 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38458 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38459 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38460
38461 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38462 mode}).
38463
38464 Reply:
38465 @table @samp
38466 @item OK
38467 The request succeeded.
38468 @end table
38469
38470 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38471 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38472 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38473 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38474 inferior.
38475
38476 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38477 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38478 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38479 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38480 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38481 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38482
38483 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38484 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38485 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38486 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38487 directory to its original, empty value.
38488
38489 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38490 mode}).
38491
38492 Reply:
38493 @table @samp
38494 @item OK
38495 The request succeeded.
38496 @end table
38497
38498 @item qfThreadInfo
38499 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38500 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38501 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38502 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38503 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38504 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38505 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38506 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38507 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38508 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38509
38510 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38511
38512 Reply:
38513 @table @samp
38514 @item m @var{thread-id}
38515 A single thread ID
38516 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38517 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38518 @item l
38519 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38520 @end table
38521
38522 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38523 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38524 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38525 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38526 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38527 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38528 fields.
38529
38530 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38531 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38532 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38533 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38534 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38535
38536 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38537 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38538 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38539 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38540 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38541
38542 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38543 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38544
38545 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38546 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38547 information associated with the variable.)
38548
38549 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38550 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38551 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38552 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38553 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38554 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38555
38556 Reply:
38557 @table @samp
38558 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38559 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38560 local storage requested.
38561
38562 @item E @var{nn}
38563 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38564
38565 @item @w{}
38566 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38567 @end table
38568
38569 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38570 @cindex get thread information block address
38571 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38572 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38573
38574 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38575
38576 Reply:
38577 @table @samp
38578 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38579 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38580 thread information block.
38581
38582 @item E @var{nn}
38583 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38584 address could not be retrieved.
38585
38586 @item @w{}
38587 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38588 @end table
38589
38590 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38591 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38592 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38593 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38594 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38595 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38596 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38597
38598 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38599
38600 Reply:
38601 @table @samp
38602 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38603 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38604 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38605 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38606 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38607 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38608 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38609 @end table
38610
38611 @item qOffsets
38612 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38613 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38614 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38615 image.
38616
38617 Reply:
38618 @table @samp
38619 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38620 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38621 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38622 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38623 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38624 segments by the supplied offsets.
38625
38626 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38627 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38628 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38629
38630 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38631 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38632 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38633 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38634 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38635 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38636 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38637 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38638 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38639 @end table
38640
38641 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38642 @cindex thread information, remote request
38643 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38644 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38645 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38646 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38647
38648 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38649 (see below).
38650
38651 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38652
38653 @item QNonStop:1
38654 @itemx QNonStop:0
38655 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38656 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38657 @anchor{QNonStop}
38658 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38659 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38660
38661 Reply:
38662 @table @samp
38663 @item OK
38664 The request succeeded.
38665
38666 @item E @var{nn}
38667 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38668
38669 @item @w{}
38670 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38671 the stub.
38672 @end table
38673
38674 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38675 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38676 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38677 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38678
38679 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38680 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38681 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38682 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38683 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38684 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38685 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38686
38687 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38688 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38689 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38690
38691 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38692 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38693 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38694 report the requested syscalls.
38695
38696 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38697 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38698
38699 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38700 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38701 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38702 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38703
38704 Reply:
38705 @table @samp
38706 @item OK
38707 The request succeeded.
38708
38709 @item E @var{nn}
38710 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38711
38712 @item @w{}
38713 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38714 the stub.
38715 @end table
38716
38717 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38718 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38719 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38720 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38721
38722 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38723 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38724 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38725 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38726 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38727 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38728 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38729 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38730 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38731 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38732 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38733 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38734 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38735
38736 Reply:
38737 @table @samp
38738 @item OK
38739 The request succeeded.
38740
38741 @item E @var{nn}
38742 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38743
38744 @item @w{}
38745 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38746 the stub.
38747 @end table
38748
38749 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38750 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38751 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38752 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38753
38754 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38755 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38756 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38757 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38758 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38759 Others should be silently discarded.
38760
38761 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38762 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38763 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38764 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38765 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38766 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38767 signals.
38768
38769 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38770 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38771
38772 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38773 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38774 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38775 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38776 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38777
38778 Reply:
38779 @table @samp
38780 @item OK
38781 The request succeeded.
38782
38783 @item E @var{nn}
38784 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38785
38786 @item @w{}
38787 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38788 by the stub.
38789 @end table
38790
38791 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38792 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38793 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38794 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38795
38796 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38797 @item QThreadEvents:1
38798 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38799 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38800 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38801
38802 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38803 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38804 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38805 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38806 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38807 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38808 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38809 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38810 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38811 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38812
38813 Reply:
38814 @table @samp
38815 @item OK
38816 The request succeeded.
38817
38818 @item E @var{nn}
38819 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38820
38821 @item @w{}
38822 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38823 the stub.
38824 @end table
38825
38826 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38827 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38828
38829 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38830 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38831 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38832 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38833 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38834 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38835 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38836 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38837 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38838
38839 Reply:
38840 @table @samp
38841 @item OK
38842 A command response with no output.
38843 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38844 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38845 @item E @var{NN}
38846 Indicate a badly formed request.
38847 @item @w{}
38848 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38849 @end table
38850
38851 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38852 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38853 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38854 packets.)
38855
38856 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38857 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38858 @ifnotinfo
38859 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38860 @end ifnotinfo
38861 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38862 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38863 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38864 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38865 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38866
38867 Reply:
38868 @table @samp
38869 @item 0
38870 The pattern was not found.
38871 @item 1,address
38872 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38873 @item E @var{NN}
38874 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38875 @item @w{}
38876 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38877 @end table
38878
38879 @item QStartNoAckMode
38880 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38881 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38882 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38883 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38884
38885 Reply:
38886 @table @samp
38887 @item OK
38888 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38889 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38890 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38891 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38892 @item @w{}
38893 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38894 @end table
38895
38896 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38897 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38898 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38899 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38900 @anchor{qSupported}
38901 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38902 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38903 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38904 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38905 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38906 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38907 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38908 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38909 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38910 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38911 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38912 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38913 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38914 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38915
38916 Reply:
38917 @table @samp
38918 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38919 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38920 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38921 possible forms).
38922 @item @w{}
38923 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38924 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38925 @end table
38926
38927 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38928 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38929 are:
38930
38931 @table @samp
38932 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38933 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38934 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38935 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38936 @item @var{name}+
38937 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38938 need an associated value.
38939 @item @var{name}-
38940 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38941 @item @var{name}?
38942 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38943 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38944 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38945 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38946 @end table
38947
38948 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38949 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38950 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38951 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38952 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38953
38954 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38955 are defined:
38956
38957 @table @samp
38958 @item multiprocess
38959 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38960 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38961 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38962 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38963 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38964
38965 @item xmlRegisters
38966 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38967 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38968 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38969 description.
38970
38971 @item qRelocInsn
38972 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38973 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38974 instruction reply packet}).
38975
38976 @item swbreak
38977 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38978 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38979
38980 @item hwbreak
38981 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38982 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38983
38984 @item fork-events
38985 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38986 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38987 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38988 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38989
38990 @item vfork-events
38991 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38992 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38993 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38994 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38995
38996 @item exec-events
38997 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38998 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38999 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39000 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39001
39002 @item vContSupported
39003 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
39004 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
39005 @end table
39006
39007 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
39008 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
39009 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
39010 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
39011 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
39012 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
39013 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
39014 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
39015 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
39016 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
39017 all the features it supports.
39018
39019 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39020 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39021
39022 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39023 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39024 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39025 form response.
39026
39027 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39028 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39029 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39030 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39031
39032 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39033 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39034 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39035 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39036 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39037
39038 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39039
39040 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39041 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39042 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39043 @item Feature Name
39044 @tab Value Required
39045 @tab Default
39046 @tab Probe Allowed
39047
39048 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39049 @tab Yes
39050 @tab @samp{-}
39051 @tab No
39052
39053 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39054 @tab No
39055 @tab @samp{-}
39056 @tab Yes
39057
39058 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39059 @tab No
39060 @tab @samp{-}
39061 @tab Yes
39062
39063 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39064 @tab No
39065 @tab @samp{-}
39066 @tab Yes
39067
39068 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
39069 @tab No
39070 @tab @samp{-}
39071 @tab Yes
39072
39073 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39074 @tab No
39075 @tab @samp{-}
39076 @tab Yes
39077
39078 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39079 @tab No
39080 @tab @samp{-}
39081 @tab Yes
39082
39083 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
39084 @tab No
39085 @tab @samp{-}
39086 @tab Yes
39087
39088 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
39089 @tab No
39090 @tab @samp{-}
39091 @tab No
39092
39093 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39094 @tab No
39095 @tab @samp{-}
39096 @tab Yes
39097
39098 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
39099 @tab No
39100 @tab @samp{-}
39101 @tab Yes
39102
39103 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
39104 @tab No
39105 @tab @samp{-}
39106 @tab Yes
39107
39108 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
39109 @tab No
39110 @tab @samp{-}
39111 @tab Yes
39112
39113 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
39114 @tab No
39115 @tab @samp{-}
39116 @tab Yes
39117
39118 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
39119 @tab No
39120 @tab @samp{-}
39121 @tab Yes
39122
39123 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
39124 @tab No
39125 @tab @samp{-}
39126 @tab Yes
39127
39128 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39129 @tab No
39130 @tab @samp{-}
39131 @tab Yes
39132
39133 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39134 @tab No
39135 @tab @samp{-}
39136 @tab Yes
39137
39138 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39139 @tab No
39140 @tab @samp{-}
39141 @tab Yes
39142
39143 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39144 @tab Yes
39145 @tab @samp{-}
39146 @tab Yes
39147
39148 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39149 @tab Yes
39150 @tab @samp{-}
39151 @tab Yes
39152
39153 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
39154 @tab Yes
39155 @tab @samp{-}
39156 @tab Yes
39157
39158 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
39159 @tab Yes
39160 @tab @samp{-}
39161 @tab Yes
39162
39163 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
39164 @tab Yes
39165 @tab @samp{-}
39166 @tab Yes
39167
39168 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39169 @tab No
39170 @tab @samp{-}
39171 @tab Yes
39172
39173 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
39174 @tab No
39175 @tab @samp{-}
39176 @tab Yes
39177
39178 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39179 @tab No
39180 @tab @samp{-}
39181 @tab Yes
39182
39183 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39184 @tab No
39185 @tab @samp{-}
39186 @tab Yes
39187
39188 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39189 @tab No
39190 @tab @samp{-}
39191 @tab No
39192
39193 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39194 @tab No
39195 @tab @samp{-}
39196 @tab No
39197
39198 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39199 @tab No
39200 @tab @samp{-}
39201 @tab No
39202
39203 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39204 @tab No
39205 @tab @samp{-}
39206 @tab No
39207
39208 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39209 @tab No
39210 @tab @samp{-}
39211 @tab No
39212
39213 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39214 @tab No
39215 @tab @samp{-}
39216 @tab No
39217
39218 @item @samp{QAgent}
39219 @tab No
39220 @tab @samp{-}
39221 @tab No
39222
39223 @item @samp{QAllow}
39224 @tab No
39225 @tab @samp{-}
39226 @tab No
39227
39228 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39229 @tab No
39230 @tab @samp{-}
39231 @tab No
39232
39233 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39234 @tab No
39235 @tab @samp{-}
39236 @tab No
39237
39238 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39239 @tab No
39240 @tab @samp{-}
39241 @tab No
39242
39243 @item @samp{tracenz}
39244 @tab No
39245 @tab @samp{-}
39246 @tab No
39247
39248 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39249 @tab No
39250 @tab @samp{-}
39251 @tab No
39252
39253 @item @samp{swbreak}
39254 @tab No
39255 @tab @samp{-}
39256 @tab No
39257
39258 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39259 @tab No
39260 @tab @samp{-}
39261 @tab No
39262
39263 @item @samp{fork-events}
39264 @tab No
39265 @tab @samp{-}
39266 @tab No
39267
39268 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39269 @tab No
39270 @tab @samp{-}
39271 @tab No
39272
39273 @item @samp{exec-events}
39274 @tab No
39275 @tab @samp{-}
39276 @tab No
39277
39278 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39279 @tab No
39280 @tab @samp{-}
39281 @tab No
39282
39283 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39284 @tab No
39285 @tab @samp{-}
39286 @tab No
39287
39288 @end multitable
39289
39290 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39291
39292 @table @samp
39293 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39294 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39295 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39296 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39297 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39298 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39299 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39300 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39301 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39302 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39303
39304 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39305 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39306 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39307
39308 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39309 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39310 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39311
39312 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39313 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39314 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39315
39316 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39317 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39318 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39319
39320 @item qXfer:features:read
39321 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39322 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39323
39324 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39325 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39326 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39327
39328 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39329 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39330 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39331
39332 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39333 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39334 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39335 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39336
39337 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39338 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39339 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39340
39341 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39342 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39343 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39344
39345 @item qXfer:spu:read
39346 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39347 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39348
39349 @item qXfer:spu:write
39350 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39351 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39352
39353 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39354 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39355 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39356
39357 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39358 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39359 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39360
39361 @item qXfer:threads:read
39362 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39363 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39364
39365 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39366 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39367 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39368
39369 @item qXfer:uib:read
39370 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39371 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39372
39373 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39374 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39375 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39376
39377 @item QNonStop
39378 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39379 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39380
39381 @item QCatchSyscalls
39382 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39383 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39384
39385 @item QPassSignals
39386 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39387 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39388
39389 @item QStartNoAckMode
39390 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39391 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39392
39393 @item multiprocess
39394 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39395 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39396 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39397 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39398 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39399 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39400 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39401 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39402 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39403 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39404 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39405
39406 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39407 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39408 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39409
39410 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39411 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39412 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39413 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39414
39415 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39416 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39417 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39418
39419 @item ReverseContinue
39420 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39421 (@pxref{bc}).
39422
39423 @item ReverseStep
39424 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39425 (@pxref{bs}).
39426
39427 @item TracepointSource
39428 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39429 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39430
39431 @item QAgent
39432 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39433
39434 @item QAllow
39435 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39436
39437 @item QDisableRandomization
39438 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39439
39440 @item StaticTracepoint
39441 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39442 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39443
39444 @item InstallInTrace
39445 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39446 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39447
39448 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39449 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39450 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39451 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39452
39453 @item QTBuffer:size
39454 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39455 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39456
39457 @item tracenz
39458 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39459 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39460 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39461
39462 @item BreakpointCommands
39463 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39464 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39465 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39466
39467 @item Qbtrace:off
39468 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39469
39470 @item Qbtrace:bts
39471 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39472
39473 @item Qbtrace:pt
39474 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39475
39476 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39477 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39478
39479 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39480 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39481
39482 @item swbreak
39483 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39484 breakpoints.
39485
39486 @item hwbreak
39487 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39488 breakpoints.
39489
39490 @item fork-events
39491 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39492
39493 @item vfork-events
39494 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39495 and vforkdone events.
39496
39497 @item exec-events
39498 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39499
39500 @item vContSupported
39501 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39502 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39503
39504 @item QThreadEvents
39505 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39506
39507 @item no-resumed
39508 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39509
39510 @end table
39511
39512 @item qSymbol::
39513 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39514 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39515 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39516 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39517
39518 Reply:
39519 @table @samp
39520 @item OK
39521 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39522 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39523 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39524 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39525 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39526 below.
39527 @end table
39528
39529 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39530 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39531
39532 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39533 target has previously requested.
39534
39535 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39536 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39537 will be empty.
39538
39539 Reply:
39540 @table @samp
39541 @item OK
39542 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39543 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39544 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39545 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39546 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39547 @end table
39548
39549 @item qTBuffer
39550 @itemx QTBuffer
39551 @itemx QTDisconnected
39552 @itemx QTDP
39553 @itemx QTDPsrc
39554 @itemx QTDV
39555 @itemx qTfP
39556 @itemx qTfV
39557 @itemx QTFrame
39558 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39559
39560 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39561
39562 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39563 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39564 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39565 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39566 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39567 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39568 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39569 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39570 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39571 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39572 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39573
39574 Reply:
39575 @table @samp
39576 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39577 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39578 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39579 the thread's attributes.
39580 @end table
39581
39582 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39583 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39584 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39585 packets.)
39586
39587 @item QTNotes
39588 @itemx qTP
39589 @itemx QTSave
39590 @itemx qTsP
39591 @itemx qTsV
39592 @itemx QTStart
39593 @itemx QTStop
39594 @itemx QTEnable
39595 @itemx QTDisable
39596 @itemx QTinit
39597 @itemx QTro
39598 @itemx qTStatus
39599 @itemx qTV
39600 @itemx qTfSTM
39601 @itemx qTsSTM
39602 @itemx qTSTMat
39603 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39604
39605 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39606 @cindex read special object, remote request
39607 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39608 @anchor{qXfer read}
39609 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39610 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39611 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39612 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39613 additional details about what data to access.
39614
39615 Reply:
39616 @table @samp
39617 @item m @var{data}
39618 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39619 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39620 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39621 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39622 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39623 request.
39624
39625 @item l @var{data}
39626 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39627 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39628 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39629
39630 @item l
39631 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39632 There is no more data to be read.
39633
39634 @item E00
39635 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39636
39637 @item E @var{nn}
39638 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39639 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39640
39641 @item @w{}
39642 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39643 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39644 @end table
39645
39646 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39647 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39648 formats, listed above.
39649
39650 @table @samp
39651 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39652 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39653 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39654 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39655
39656 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39657 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39658
39659 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39660 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39661
39662 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39663 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39664 packet may have one of the following values:
39665
39666 @table @code
39667 @item all
39668 Returns all available branch trace.
39669
39670 @item new
39671 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39672 the last read request.
39673
39674 @item delta
39675 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39676 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39677 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39678 used to stitch traces together.
39679
39680 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39681 @end table
39682
39683 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39684 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39685
39686 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39687 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39688
39689 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39690 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39691
39692 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39693 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39694
39695 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39696 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39697 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39698 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39699 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39700 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39701 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39702
39703 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39704 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39705
39706 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39707 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39708 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39709 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39710 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39711
39712 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39713 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39714
39715 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39716 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39717 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39718 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39719 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39720
39721 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39722 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39723 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39724
39725 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39726 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39727
39728 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39729 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39730 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39731 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39732 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39733 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39734 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39735 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39736
39737 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39738 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39739
39740 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39741 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39742
39743 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39744 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39745 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39746 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39747
39748 @table @code
39749 @item start=@var{address}
39750 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39751 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39752 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39753 chosen as the starting point.
39754
39755 @item prev=@var{address}
39756 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39757 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39758 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39759 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39760 exists prior to the starting point.
39761
39762 @end table
39763
39764 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39765 ignored.
39766
39767 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39768 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39769 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39770 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39771 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39772
39773 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39774 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39775
39776 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39777 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39778
39779 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39780 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39781 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39782 Action Lists}.
39783
39784 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39785 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39786 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39787
39788 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39789 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39790 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39791 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39792 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39793
39794 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39795 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39796 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39797
39798 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39799 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39800 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39801 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39802 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39803 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39804 in that context to be accessed.
39805
39806 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39807 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39808 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39809
39810 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39811 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39812 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39813 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39814 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39815
39816 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39817 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39818
39819 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39820 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39821
39822 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39823 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39824 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39825
39826 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39827 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39828
39829 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39830 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39831
39832 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39833 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39834
39835 This packet is not probed by default.
39836
39837 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39838 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39839 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39840 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39841 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39842
39843 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39844 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39845
39846 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39847 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39848 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39849 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39850
39851 @end table
39852
39853 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39854 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39855 @anchor{qXfer write}
39856 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39857 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39858 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39859 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39860 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39861 to access.
39862
39863 Reply:
39864 @table @samp
39865 @item @var{nn}
39866 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39867 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39868
39869 @item E00
39870 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39871
39872 @item E @var{nn}
39873 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39874 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39875
39876 @item @w{}
39877 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39878 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39879 @end table
39880
39881 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39882 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39883 formats, listed above.
39884
39885 @table @samp
39886 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39887 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39888 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39889 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39890 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39891
39892 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39893 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39894 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39895
39896 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39897 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39898 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39899 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39900 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39901 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39902 in that context to be accessed.
39903
39904 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39905 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39906 @end table
39907
39908 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39909 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39910 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39911 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39912 must respond with an empty packet.
39913
39914 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39915 @cindex query attached, remote request
39916 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39917 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39918 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39919 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39920 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39921 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39922 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39923
39924 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39925 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39926 the @code{quit} command.
39927
39928 Reply:
39929 @table @samp
39930 @item 1
39931 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39932 @item 0
39933 The remote server created a new process.
39934 @item E @var{NN}
39935 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39936 @end table
39937
39938 @item Qbtrace:bts
39939 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39940
39941 Reply:
39942 @table @samp
39943 @item OK
39944 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39945 @item E.errtext
39946 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39947 @end table
39948
39949 @item Qbtrace:pt
39950 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39951
39952 Reply:
39953 @table @samp
39954 @item OK
39955 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39956 @item E.errtext
39957 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39958 @end table
39959
39960 @item Qbtrace:off
39961 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39962
39963 Reply:
39964 @table @samp
39965 @item OK
39966 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39967 @item E.errtext
39968 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39969 @end table
39970
39971 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39972 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39973 btrace recording method in bts format.
39974
39975 Reply:
39976 @table @samp
39977 @item OK
39978 The ring buffer size has been set.
39979 @item E.errtext
39980 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39981 @end table
39982
39983 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39984 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39985 btrace recording method in pt format.
39986
39987 Reply:
39988 @table @samp
39989 @item OK
39990 The ring buffer size has been set.
39991 @item E.errtext
39992 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39993 @end table
39994
39995 @end table
39996
39997 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39998 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39999
40000 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
40001 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
40002 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
40003
40004 @menu
40005 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
40006 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
40007 @end menu
40008
40009 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
40010 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
40011
40012 @menu
40013 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
40014 @end menu
40015
40016 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
40017 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
40018 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40019
40020 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40021
40022 @table @r
40023
40024 @item 2
40025 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40026
40027 @item 3
40028 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40029
40030 @item 4
40031 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40032
40033 @end table
40034
40035 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40036 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40037
40038 @menu
40039 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40040 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40041 @end menu
40042
40043 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40044 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40045 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40046
40047 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40048 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40049 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40050 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40051 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40052 most-significant -- least-significant.
40053
40054 @table @r
40055
40056 @item MIPS32
40057 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40058 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40059 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40060
40061 @item MIPS64
40062 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40063 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40064 as @code{MIPS32}.
40065
40066 @end table
40067
40068 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40069 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40070 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40071
40072 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40073
40074 @table @r
40075
40076 @item 2
40077 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40078
40079 @item 3
40080 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40081
40082 @item 4
40083 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
40084
40085 @item 5
40086 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40087
40088 @end table
40089
40090 @node Tracepoint Packets
40091 @section Tracepoint Packets
40092 @cindex tracepoint packets
40093 @cindex packets, tracepoint
40094
40095 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
40096 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
40097
40098 @table @samp
40099
40100 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
40101 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
40102 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
40103 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
40104 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
40105 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
40106 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
40107 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
40108 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
40109 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
40110 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
40111 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
40112 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
40113 actions.
40114
40115 Replies:
40116 @table @samp
40117 @item OK
40118 The packet was understood and carried out.
40119 @item qRelocInsn
40120 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40121 @item @w{}
40122 The packet was not recognized.
40123 @end table
40124
40125 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
40126 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
40127 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
40128 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
40129 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
40130 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
40131 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
40132
40133 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
40134 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
40135 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
40136 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40137 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40138 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40139 tracepoint actions.
40140
40141 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40142 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40143 following forms:
40144
40145 @table @samp
40146
40147 @item R @var{mask}
40148 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
40149 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40150 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40151 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40152 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40153
40154 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40155 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40156 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40157 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40158 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40159 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40160 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40161
40162 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40163 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40164 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
40165 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40166 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40167 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40168 packet).
40169
40170 @end table
40171
40172 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40173 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40174 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40175 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40176 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40177 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40178 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40179 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40180
40181 Replies:
40182 @table @samp
40183 @item OK
40184 The packet was understood and carried out.
40185 @item qRelocInsn
40186 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40187 @item @w{}
40188 The packet was not recognized.
40189 @end table
40190
40191 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40192 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40193 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40194 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40195 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
40196 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40197 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40198 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40199
40200 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40201 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40202 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40203 fit in a single packet.
40204 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40205 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40206
40207 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40208 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40209 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40210 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40211
40212 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40213 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40214 query packets.
40215
40216 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40217 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40218 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40219 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40220 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40221 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40222 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40223 be found.
40224
40225 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
40226 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40227 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40228 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40229 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40230 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40231 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40232 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40233 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
40234 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
40235 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
40236 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
40237 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
40238 variable.
40239
40240 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40241 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40242 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40243 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40244 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40245
40246 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40247 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40248 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40249 one of the following forms:
40250
40251 @table @samp
40252 @item F @var{f}
40253 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40254 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40255 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40256
40257 @item T @var{t}
40258 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40259 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40260
40261 @end table
40262
40263 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40264 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40265 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40266 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40267
40268 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40269 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40270 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40271 is a hexadecimal number.
40272
40273 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40274 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40275 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40276 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40277 numbers.
40278
40279 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40280 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40281 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40282
40283 @item qTMinFTPILen
40284 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40285 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40286 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40287 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40288 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40289 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40290 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40291 arrange for that.
40292
40293 Replies:
40294
40295 @table @samp
40296 @item 0
40297 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40298 @item @var{length}
40299 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40300 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40301 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40302 regardless of size.
40303 @item E
40304 An error has occurred.
40305 @item @w{}
40306 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40307 @end table
40308
40309 @item QTStart
40310 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40311 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40312 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40313 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40314 instruction reply packet}).
40315
40316 @item QTStop
40317 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40318 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40319
40320 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40321 @anchor{QTEnable}
40322 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40323 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40324 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40325 of data from it will resume.
40326
40327 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40328 @anchor{QTDisable}
40329 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40330 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40331 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40332 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40333
40334 @item QTinit
40335 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40336 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40337
40338 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40339 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40340 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40341 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40342 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40343
40344 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40345 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40346 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40347 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40348
40349 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40350 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40351 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40352 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40353 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40354 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40355
40356 @item qTStatus
40357 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40358 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40359
40360 The reply has the form:
40361
40362 @table @samp
40363
40364 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40365 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40366 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40367 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40368
40369 @end table
40370
40371 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40372 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40373
40374 @table @samp
40375
40376 @item tnotrun:0
40377 No trace has been run yet.
40378
40379 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40380 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40381 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40382 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40383 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40384
40385 @item tfull:0
40386 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40387
40388 @item tdisconnected:0
40389 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40390
40391 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40392 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40393
40394 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40395 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40396 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40397 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40398 is hex encoded.
40399
40400 @item tunknown:0
40401 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40402
40403 @end table
40404
40405 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40406 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40407 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40408 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40409 trace.
40410
40411 @table @samp
40412
40413 @item tframes:@var{n}
40414 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40415
40416 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40417 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40418 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40419
40420 @item tsize:@var{n}
40421 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40422
40423 @item tfree:@var{n}
40424 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40425
40426 @item circular:@var{n}
40427 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40428 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40429 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40430 and may fill up.
40431
40432 @item disconn:@var{n}
40433 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40434 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40435 that the trace run will stop.
40436
40437 @end table
40438
40439 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40440 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40441 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40442 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40443 address @var{addr}.
40444
40445 Replies:
40446 @table @samp
40447 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40448 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40449 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40450 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40451 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40452
40453 @end table
40454
40455 @item qTV:@var{var}
40456 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40457 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40458 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40459
40460 Replies:
40461 @table @samp
40462 @item V@var{value}
40463 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40464 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40465 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40466 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40467 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40468 program is running.
40469
40470 @item U
40471 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40472 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40473 was not collected.
40474 @end table
40475
40476 @item qTfP
40477 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40478 @itemx qTsP
40479 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40480 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40481 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40482 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40483 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40484 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40485
40486 @item qTfV
40487 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40488 @itemx qTsV
40489 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40490 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40491 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40492 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40493 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40494 trace state variables.
40495
40496 @item qTfSTM
40497 @itemx qTsSTM
40498 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40499 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40500 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40501 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40502 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40503 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40504 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40505 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40506
40507 Reply:
40508 @table @samp
40509 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40510 A single marker
40511 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40512 a comma-separated list of markers
40513 @item l
40514 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40515 @item E @var{nn}
40516 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40517 @item @w{}
40518 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40519 stub.
40520 @end table
40521
40522 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40523 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40524
40525 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40526 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40527 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40528 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40529 @dfn{last}).
40530
40531 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40532 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40533 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40534 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40535 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40536 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40537 tracepoint markers.
40538
40539 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40540 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40541 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40542 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40543 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40544 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40545
40546 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40547 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40548 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40549 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40550 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40551 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40552 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40553 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40554 available.
40555
40556 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40557 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40558 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40559
40560 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40561 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40562 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40563 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40564 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40565 use whatever size it prefers.
40566
40567 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40568 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40569 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40570 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40571 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40572
40573 @end table
40574
40575 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40576 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40577 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40578 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40579 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40580 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40581 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40582 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40583 it had executed in the original location.
40584
40585 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40586 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40587 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40588 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40589 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40590 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40591 format of the request is:
40592
40593 @table @samp
40594 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40595
40596 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40597 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40598 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40599 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40600 memory starting at @var{to}.
40601 @end table
40602
40603 Replies:
40604 @table @samp
40605 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40606 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40607 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40608 @item E @var{NN}
40609 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40610 relocating the instruction.
40611 @end table
40612
40613 @node Host I/O Packets
40614 @section Host I/O Packets
40615 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40616 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40617
40618 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40619 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40620 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40621 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40622 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40623 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40624 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40625 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40626 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40627 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40628
40629 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40630 its arguments. They have this format:
40631
40632 @table @samp
40633
40634 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40635 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40636 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40637 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40638 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40639 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40640 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40641 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40642 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40643
40644 @end table
40645
40646 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40647
40648 @table @samp
40649
40650 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40651 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40652 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40653 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40654 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40655 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40656 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40657 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40658 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40659 @var{attachment}.
40660
40661 @item @w{}
40662 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40663
40664 @end table
40665
40666 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40667
40668 @table @samp
40669 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40670 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40671 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40672 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40673 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40674 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40675 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40676
40677 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40678 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40679 -1 if an error occurs.
40680
40681 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40682 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40683 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40684 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40685 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40686 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40687 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40688 @var{count} was zero.
40689
40690 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40691 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40692 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40693 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40694 some characters were escaped.
40695
40696 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40697 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40698 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40699 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40700 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40701 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40702 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40703 error occurred.
40704
40705 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40706 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40707 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40708 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40709 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40710 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40711
40712 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40713 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40714 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40715
40716 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40717 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40718 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40719
40720 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40721 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40722 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40723 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40724 some characters were escaped.
40725
40726 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40727 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40728 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40729 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40730 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40731 inferior(s).
40732
40733 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40734 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40735 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40736 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40737 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40738 operation.
40739
40740 @end table
40741
40742 @node Interrupts
40743 @section Interrupts
40744 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40745 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40746
40747 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40748 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40749 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40750 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40751
40752 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40753 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40754 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40755 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40756 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40757
40758 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40759 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40760 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40761 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40762 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40763 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40764 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40765 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40766
40767 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40768 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40769 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40770
40771 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40772 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40773 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40774 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40775 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40776 @code{0x03}.
40777
40778 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40779 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40780 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40781 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40782 currently-executing threads and processes.
40783 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40784 running program, it should send one of the stop
40785 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40786 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40787 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40788 Interrupts received while the
40789 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40790 it is resumed next time.
40791
40792 @node Notification Packets
40793 @section Notification Packets
40794 @cindex notification packets
40795 @cindex packets, notification
40796
40797 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40798 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40799 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40800 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40801 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40802 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40803 is not a problem.
40804
40805 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40806 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40807 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40808 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40809 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40810 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40811 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40812
40813 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40814 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40815
40816 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40817 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40818 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40819 not they understand it.
40820
40821 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40822 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40823 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40824 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40825 recipients.
40826
40827 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40828 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40829 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40830 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40831 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40832
40833 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40834 @table @samp
40835 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40836 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40837 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40838 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40839 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40840 @item @var{ack}
40841 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40842 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40843 @end table
40844
40845 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40846 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40847
40848 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40849 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40850 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40851 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40852 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40853 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40854 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40855 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40856 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40857 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40858
40859 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40860 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40861 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40862 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40863 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40864 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40865
40866 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40867 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40868 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40869 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40870 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40871
40872 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40873 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40874 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40875 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40876 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40877 normally.
40878
40879 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40880 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40881 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40882 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40883 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40884 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40885 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40886 the process shall be repeated.
40887
40888 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40889 following example:
40890 @smallexample
40891 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40892 @code{...}
40893 -> @code{vStopped}
40894 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40895 -> @code{vStopped}
40896 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40897 -> @code{vStopped}
40898 <- @code{OK}
40899 @end smallexample
40900
40901 The following notifications are defined:
40902 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40903
40904 @item Notification
40905 @tab Ack
40906 @tab Event
40907 @tab Description
40908
40909 @item Stop
40910 @tab vStopped
40911 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40912 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40913 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40914 @value{GDBN}.
40915 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40916
40917 @end multitable
40918
40919 @node Remote Non-Stop
40920 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40921
40922 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40923 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40924 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40925 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40926
40927 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40928 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40929 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40930 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40931 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40932 probe the target state after a mode change.
40933
40934 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40935 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40936 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40937 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40938 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40939 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40940 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40941 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40942 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40943 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40944 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40945
40946 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40947 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40948 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40949 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40950 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40951 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40952 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40953 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40954 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40955 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40956 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40957 @samp{OK}.
40958
40959 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40960 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40961 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40962 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40963 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40964 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40965 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40966 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40967 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40968 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40969 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40970 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40971 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40972
40973 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40974 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40975
40976 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40977 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40978 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40979 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40980 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40981 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40982 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40983
40984 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40985 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40986 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40987 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40988 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40989
40990 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40991 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40992 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40993 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40994
40995 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40996 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40997 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40998 @pxref{qSupported}.
40999 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
41000 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
41001 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
41002 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
41003 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
41004 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
41005 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
41006
41007 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
41008 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
41009 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
41010 connection.
41011 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
41012 new connection is established,
41013 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
41014 for the current connection, once disabled.
41015
41016 @node Examples
41017 @section Examples
41018
41019 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41020 does not get any direct output:
41021
41022 @smallexample
41023 -> @code{R00}
41024 <- @code{+}
41025 @emph{target restarts}
41026 -> @code{?}
41027 <- @code{+}
41028 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41029 -> @code{+}
41030 @end smallexample
41031
41032 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41033
41034 @smallexample
41035 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41036 <- @code{+}
41037 -> @code{s}
41038 <- @code{+}
41039 @emph{time passes}
41040 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41041 -> @code{+}
41042 -> @code{g}
41043 <- @code{+}
41044 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41045 -> @code{+}
41046 @end smallexample
41047
41048 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41049 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41050 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41051
41052 @menu
41053 * File-I/O Overview::
41054 * Protocol Basics::
41055 * The F Request Packet::
41056 * The F Reply Packet::
41057 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41058 * Console I/O::
41059 * List of Supported Calls::
41060 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41061 * Constants::
41062 * File-I/O Examples::
41063 @end menu
41064
41065 @node File-I/O Overview
41066 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41067 @cindex file-i/o overview
41068
41069 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41070 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41071 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41072 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41073 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41074 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41075
41076 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41077 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41078 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41079 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41080 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41081
41082 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
41083 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
41084 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
41085 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
41086 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
41087 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
41088 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
41089
41090 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
41091 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
41092 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
41093 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
41094 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
41095
41096 @smallexample
41097 (@value{GDBP}) continue
41098 <- target requests 'system call X'
41099 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
41100 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
41101 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
41102 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
41103 @end smallexample
41104
41105 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
41106 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
41107 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
41108 system are not supported by this protocol.
41109
41110 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
41111
41112 @node Protocol Basics
41113 @subsection Protocol Basics
41114 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
41115
41116 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
41117 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
41118 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
41119 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
41120 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
41121 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
41122 to call the appropriate host system call:
41123
41124 @itemize @bullet
41125 @item
41126 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
41127
41128 @item
41129 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
41130 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
41131 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
41132 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
41133
41134 @end itemize
41135
41136 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41137
41138 @itemize @bullet
41139 @item
41140 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41141 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41142 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41143 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41144 packet.
41145
41146 @item
41147 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41148 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41149
41150 @item
41151 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41152
41153 @item
41154 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41155
41156 @item
41157 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41158 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41159 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41160 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41161 packet.
41162
41163 @end itemize
41164
41165 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41166 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41167
41168 @itemize @bullet
41169 @item
41170 Return value.
41171
41172 @item
41173 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41174
41175 @item
41176 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41177
41178 @end itemize
41179
41180 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41181 the latest continue or step action.
41182
41183 @node The F Request Packet
41184 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41185 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41186 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41187
41188 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41189
41190 @table @samp
41191 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41192
41193 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41194 This is just the name of the function.
41195
41196 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41197 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41198 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41199 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41200 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41201 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41202 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41203
41204 @end table
41205
41206
41207
41208 @node The F Reply Packet
41209 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41210 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41211 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41212
41213 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41214
41215 @table @samp
41216
41217 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41218
41219 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41220
41221 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41222 representation.
41223 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41224
41225 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41226 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41227 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41228
41229 @smallexample
41230 F0,0,C
41231 @end smallexample
41232
41233 @noindent
41234 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41235
41236 @smallexample
41237 F-1,4,C
41238 @end smallexample
41239
41240 @noindent
41241 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41242
41243 @end table
41244
41245
41246 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41247 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41248 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41249
41250 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41251 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41252 the target should behave as if it had
41253 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41254 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41255 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41256 packet.
41257
41258 It's important for the target to know in which
41259 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41260
41261 @itemize @bullet
41262 @item
41263 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41264
41265 @item
41266 The system call on the host has been finished.
41267
41268 @end itemize
41269
41270 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41271 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41272 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41273 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41274 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41275 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41276
41277 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41278 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41279 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41280 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41281 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41282 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41283 or the full action has been completed.
41284
41285 @node Console I/O
41286 @subsection Console I/O
41287 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41288
41289 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41290 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41291 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41292 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41293 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41294 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41295 conditions is met:
41296
41297 @itemize @bullet
41298 @item
41299 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41300 @code{read}
41301 system call is treated as finished.
41302
41303 @item
41304 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41305 newline.
41306
41307 @item
41308 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41309 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41310
41311 @end itemize
41312
41313 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41314 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41315 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41316 is stopped at the user's request.
41317
41318
41319 @node List of Supported Calls
41320 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41321 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41322
41323 @menu
41324 * open::
41325 * close::
41326 * read::
41327 * write::
41328 * lseek::
41329 * rename::
41330 * unlink::
41331 * stat/fstat::
41332 * gettimeofday::
41333 * isatty::
41334 * system::
41335 @end menu
41336
41337 @node open
41338 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41339 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41340
41341 @table @asis
41342 @item Synopsis:
41343 @smallexample
41344 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41345 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41346 @end smallexample
41347
41348 @item Request:
41349 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41350
41351 @noindent
41352 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41353
41354 @table @code
41355 @item O_CREAT
41356 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41357 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41358 are concerned.
41359
41360 @item O_EXCL
41361 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41362 an error and open() fails.
41363
41364 @item O_TRUNC
41365 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41366 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41367 truncated to zero length.
41368
41369 @item O_APPEND
41370 The file is opened in append mode.
41371
41372 @item O_RDONLY
41373 The file is opened for reading only.
41374
41375 @item O_WRONLY
41376 The file is opened for writing only.
41377
41378 @item O_RDWR
41379 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41380 @end table
41381
41382 @noindent
41383 Other bits are silently ignored.
41384
41385
41386 @noindent
41387 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41388
41389 @table @code
41390 @item S_IRUSR
41391 User has read permission.
41392
41393 @item S_IWUSR
41394 User has write permission.
41395
41396 @item S_IRGRP
41397 Group has read permission.
41398
41399 @item S_IWGRP
41400 Group has write permission.
41401
41402 @item S_IROTH
41403 Others have read permission.
41404
41405 @item S_IWOTH
41406 Others have write permission.
41407 @end table
41408
41409 @noindent
41410 Other bits are silently ignored.
41411
41412
41413 @item Return value:
41414 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41415 occurred.
41416
41417 @item Errors:
41418
41419 @table @code
41420 @item EEXIST
41421 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41422
41423 @item EISDIR
41424 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41425
41426 @item EACCES
41427 The requested access is not allowed.
41428
41429 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41430 @var{pathname} was too long.
41431
41432 @item ENOENT
41433 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41434
41435 @item ENODEV
41436 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41437
41438 @item EROFS
41439 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41440 write access was requested.
41441
41442 @item EFAULT
41443 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41444
41445 @item ENOSPC
41446 No space on device to create the file.
41447
41448 @item EMFILE
41449 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41450
41451 @item ENFILE
41452 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41453 has been reached.
41454
41455 @item EINTR
41456 The call was interrupted by the user.
41457 @end table
41458
41459 @end table
41460
41461 @node close
41462 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41463 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41464
41465 @table @asis
41466 @item Synopsis:
41467 @smallexample
41468 int close(int fd);
41469 @end smallexample
41470
41471 @item Request:
41472 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41473
41474 @item Return value:
41475 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41476
41477 @item Errors:
41478
41479 @table @code
41480 @item EBADF
41481 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41482
41483 @item EINTR
41484 The call was interrupted by the user.
41485 @end table
41486
41487 @end table
41488
41489 @node read
41490 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41491 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41492
41493 @table @asis
41494 @item Synopsis:
41495 @smallexample
41496 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41497 @end smallexample
41498
41499 @item Request:
41500 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41501
41502 @item Return value:
41503 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41504 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41505 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41506
41507 @item Errors:
41508
41509 @table @code
41510 @item EBADF
41511 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41512 reading.
41513
41514 @item EFAULT
41515 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41516
41517 @item EINTR
41518 The call was interrupted by the user.
41519 @end table
41520
41521 @end table
41522
41523 @node write
41524 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41525 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41526
41527 @table @asis
41528 @item Synopsis:
41529 @smallexample
41530 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41531 @end smallexample
41532
41533 @item Request:
41534 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41535
41536 @item Return value:
41537 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41538 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41539 is returned.
41540
41541 @item Errors:
41542
41543 @table @code
41544 @item EBADF
41545 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41546 writing.
41547
41548 @item EFAULT
41549 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41550
41551 @item EFBIG
41552 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41553 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41554
41555 @item ENOSPC
41556 No space on device to write the data.
41557
41558 @item EINTR
41559 The call was interrupted by the user.
41560 @end table
41561
41562 @end table
41563
41564 @node lseek
41565 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41566 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41567
41568 @table @asis
41569 @item Synopsis:
41570 @smallexample
41571 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41572 @end smallexample
41573
41574 @item Request:
41575 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41576
41577 @var{flag} is one of:
41578
41579 @table @code
41580 @item SEEK_SET
41581 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41582
41583 @item SEEK_CUR
41584 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41585 bytes.
41586
41587 @item SEEK_END
41588 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41589 bytes.
41590 @end table
41591
41592 @item Return value:
41593 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41594 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41595 value of -1 is returned.
41596
41597 @item Errors:
41598
41599 @table @code
41600 @item EBADF
41601 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41602
41603 @item ESPIPE
41604 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41605
41606 @item EINVAL
41607 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41608
41609 @item EINTR
41610 The call was interrupted by the user.
41611 @end table
41612
41613 @end table
41614
41615 @node rename
41616 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41617 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41618
41619 @table @asis
41620 @item Synopsis:
41621 @smallexample
41622 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41623 @end smallexample
41624
41625 @item Request:
41626 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41627
41628 @item Return value:
41629 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41630
41631 @item Errors:
41632
41633 @table @code
41634 @item EISDIR
41635 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41636 directory.
41637
41638 @item EEXIST
41639 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41640
41641 @item EBUSY
41642 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41643 process.
41644
41645 @item EINVAL
41646 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41647 of itself.
41648
41649 @item ENOTDIR
41650 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41651 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41652 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41653
41654 @item EFAULT
41655 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41656
41657 @item EACCES
41658 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41659
41660 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41661
41662 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41663
41664 @item ENOENT
41665 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41666
41667 @item EROFS
41668 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41669
41670 @item ENOSPC
41671 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41672 directory entry.
41673
41674 @item EINTR
41675 The call was interrupted by the user.
41676 @end table
41677
41678 @end table
41679
41680 @node unlink
41681 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41682 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41683
41684 @table @asis
41685 @item Synopsis:
41686 @smallexample
41687 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41688 @end smallexample
41689
41690 @item Request:
41691 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41692
41693 @item Return value:
41694 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41695
41696 @item Errors:
41697
41698 @table @code
41699 @item EACCES
41700 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41701
41702 @item EPERM
41703 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41704
41705 @item EBUSY
41706 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41707 being used by another process.
41708
41709 @item EFAULT
41710 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41711
41712 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41713 @var{pathname} was too long.
41714
41715 @item ENOENT
41716 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41717
41718 @item ENOTDIR
41719 A component of the path is not a directory.
41720
41721 @item EROFS
41722 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41723
41724 @item EINTR
41725 The call was interrupted by the user.
41726 @end table
41727
41728 @end table
41729
41730 @node stat/fstat
41731 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41732 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41733 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41734
41735 @table @asis
41736 @item Synopsis:
41737 @smallexample
41738 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41739 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41740 @end smallexample
41741
41742 @item Request:
41743 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41744 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41745
41746 @item Return value:
41747 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41748
41749 @item Errors:
41750
41751 @table @code
41752 @item EBADF
41753 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41754
41755 @item ENOENT
41756 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41757 path is an empty string.
41758
41759 @item ENOTDIR
41760 A component of the path is not a directory.
41761
41762 @item EFAULT
41763 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41764
41765 @item EACCES
41766 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41767
41768 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41769 @var{pathname} was too long.
41770
41771 @item EINTR
41772 The call was interrupted by the user.
41773 @end table
41774
41775 @end table
41776
41777 @node gettimeofday
41778 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41779 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41780
41781 @table @asis
41782 @item Synopsis:
41783 @smallexample
41784 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41785 @end smallexample
41786
41787 @item Request:
41788 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41789
41790 @item Return value:
41791 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41792
41793 @item Errors:
41794
41795 @table @code
41796 @item EINVAL
41797 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41798
41799 @item EFAULT
41800 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41801 @end table
41802
41803 @end table
41804
41805 @node isatty
41806 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41807 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41808
41809 @table @asis
41810 @item Synopsis:
41811 @smallexample
41812 int isatty(int fd);
41813 @end smallexample
41814
41815 @item Request:
41816 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41817
41818 @item Return value:
41819 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41820
41821 @item Errors:
41822
41823 @table @code
41824 @item EINTR
41825 The call was interrupted by the user.
41826 @end table
41827
41828 @end table
41829
41830 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41831 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41832 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41833 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41834 needed.
41835
41836
41837 @node system
41838 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41839 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41840
41841 @table @asis
41842 @item Synopsis:
41843 @smallexample
41844 int system(const char *command);
41845 @end smallexample
41846
41847 @item Request:
41848 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41849
41850 @item Return value:
41851 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41852 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41853 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41854 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41855 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41856 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41857 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41858
41859 @item Errors:
41860
41861 @table @code
41862 @item EINTR
41863 The call was interrupted by the user.
41864 @end table
41865
41866 @end table
41867
41868 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41869 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41870 the host is simplified before it's returned
41871 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41872 is discarded, and the return value consists
41873 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41874
41875 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41876 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41877 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41878
41879 @table @code
41880 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41881 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41882 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41883 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41884
41885 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41886 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41887 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41888 protocol.
41889 @end table
41890
41891 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41892 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41893 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41894
41895 @menu
41896 * Integral Datatypes::
41897 * Pointer Values::
41898 * Memory Transfer::
41899 * struct stat::
41900 * struct timeval::
41901 @end menu
41902
41903 @node Integral Datatypes
41904 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41905 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41906
41907 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41908 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41909 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41910
41911 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41912 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41913
41914 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41915
41916 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41917 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41918
41919 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41920
41921 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41922 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41923 byte order.
41924
41925 @node Pointer Values
41926 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41927 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41928
41929 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41930 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41931 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41932 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41933
41934 @smallexample
41935 @code{1aaf/12}
41936 @end smallexample
41937
41938 @noindent
41939 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41940 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41941 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41942 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41943
41944 @smallexample
41945 @code{123456/d}
41946 @end smallexample
41947
41948 @node Memory Transfer
41949 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41950 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41951
41952 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41953 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41954 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41955 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41956 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41957 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41958 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41959
41960
41961 @node struct stat
41962 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41963 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41964
41965 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41966 is defined as follows:
41967
41968 @smallexample
41969 struct stat @{
41970 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41971 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41972 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41973 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41974 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41975 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41976 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41977 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41978 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41979 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41980 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41981 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41982 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41983 @};
41984 @end smallexample
41985
41986 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41987 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41988 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41989
41990 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41991 range of values.
41992
41993 @table @code
41994
41995 @item st_dev
41996 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41997
41998 @item st_ino
41999 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42000
42001 @item st_mode
42002 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
42003 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
42004
42005 @item st_uid
42006 @itemx st_gid
42007 @itemx st_rdev
42008 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42009
42010 @item st_atime
42011 @itemx st_mtime
42012 @itemx st_ctime
42013 These values have a host and file system dependent
42014 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
42015 support exact timing values.
42016 @end table
42017
42018 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42019 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42020 continuing.
42021
42022 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42023 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42024 get truncated on the target.
42025
42026 @node struct timeval
42027 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42028 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42029
42030 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42031 is defined as follows:
42032
42033 @smallexample
42034 struct timeval @{
42035 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42036 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42037 @};
42038 @end smallexample
42039
42040 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42041 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42042 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42043
42044 @node Constants
42045 @subsection Constants
42046 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42047
42048 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42049 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42050 values before and after the call as needed.
42051
42052 @menu
42053 * Open Flags::
42054 * mode_t Values::
42055 * Errno Values::
42056 * Lseek Flags::
42057 * Limits::
42058 @end menu
42059
42060 @node Open Flags
42061 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42062 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42063
42064 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42065
42066 @smallexample
42067 O_RDONLY 0x0
42068 O_WRONLY 0x1
42069 O_RDWR 0x2
42070 O_APPEND 0x8
42071 O_CREAT 0x200
42072 O_TRUNC 0x400
42073 O_EXCL 0x800
42074 @end smallexample
42075
42076 @node mode_t Values
42077 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42078 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42079
42080 All values are given in octal representation.
42081
42082 @smallexample
42083 S_IFREG 0100000
42084 S_IFDIR 040000
42085 S_IRUSR 0400
42086 S_IWUSR 0200
42087 S_IXUSR 0100
42088 S_IRGRP 040
42089 S_IWGRP 020
42090 S_IXGRP 010
42091 S_IROTH 04
42092 S_IWOTH 02
42093 S_IXOTH 01
42094 @end smallexample
42095
42096 @node Errno Values
42097 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
42098 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
42099
42100 All values are given in decimal representation.
42101
42102 @smallexample
42103 EPERM 1
42104 ENOENT 2
42105 EINTR 4
42106 EBADF 9
42107 EACCES 13
42108 EFAULT 14
42109 EBUSY 16
42110 EEXIST 17
42111 ENODEV 19
42112 ENOTDIR 20
42113 EISDIR 21
42114 EINVAL 22
42115 ENFILE 23
42116 EMFILE 24
42117 EFBIG 27
42118 ENOSPC 28
42119 ESPIPE 29
42120 EROFS 30
42121 ENAMETOOLONG 91
42122 EUNKNOWN 9999
42123 @end smallexample
42124
42125 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
42126 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
42127
42128 @node Lseek Flags
42129 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
42130 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
42131
42132 @smallexample
42133 SEEK_SET 0
42134 SEEK_CUR 1
42135 SEEK_END 2
42136 @end smallexample
42137
42138 @node Limits
42139 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42140 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42141
42142 All values are given in decimal representation.
42143
42144 @smallexample
42145 INT_MIN -2147483648
42146 INT_MAX 2147483647
42147 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42148 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42149 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42150 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42151 @end smallexample
42152
42153 @node File-I/O Examples
42154 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42155 @cindex file-i/o examples
42156
42157 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42158 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42159
42160 @smallexample
42161 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42162 @emph{request memory read from target}
42163 -> @code{m1234,6}
42164 <- XXXXXX
42165 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42166 -> @code{F6}
42167 @end smallexample
42168
42169 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42170 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42171
42172 @smallexample
42173 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42174 @emph{request memory write to target}
42175 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42176 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42177 -> @code{F6}
42178 @end smallexample
42179
42180 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42181 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42182
42183 @smallexample
42184 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42185 -> @code{F-1,9}
42186 @end smallexample
42187
42188 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42189 host is called:
42190
42191 @smallexample
42192 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42193 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42194 <- @code{T02}
42195 @end smallexample
42196
42197 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42198 host is called:
42199
42200 @smallexample
42201 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42202 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42203 <- @code{T02}
42204 @end smallexample
42205
42206 @node Library List Format
42207 @section Library List Format
42208 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42209
42210 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42211 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42212 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42213 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42214 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42215 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42216 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42217 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42218 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42219 are loaded.
42220
42221 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42222 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42223 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42224 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42225
42226 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42227 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42228 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42229 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42230 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42231 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42232
42233 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42234 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42235
42236 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42237 offset, looks like this:
42238
42239 @smallexample
42240 <library-list>
42241 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42242 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42243 </library>
42244 </library-list>
42245 @end smallexample
42246
42247 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42248 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42249
42250 @smallexample
42251 <library-list>
42252 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42253 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42254 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42255 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42256 </library>
42257 </library-list>
42258 @end smallexample
42259
42260 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42261
42262 @smallexample
42263 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42264 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42265 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42266 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42267 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42268 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42269 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42270 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42271 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42272 @end smallexample
42273
42274 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42275 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42276 section for each library.
42277
42278 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42279 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42280 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42281
42282 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42283 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42284 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42285 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42286
42287 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42288 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42289 target, the following parameters are reported:
42290
42291 @itemize @minus
42292 @item
42293 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42294 @code{struct link_map}.
42295 @item
42296 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42297 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42298 @item
42299 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42300 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42301 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42302 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42303 @item
42304 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42305 @end itemize
42306
42307 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42308 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42309 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42310
42311 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42312 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42313
42314 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42315 looks like this:
42316
42317 @smallexample
42318 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42319 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42320 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42321 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42322 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42323 </library-list-svr>
42324 @end smallexample
42325
42326 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42327
42328 @smallexample
42329 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42330 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42331 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42332 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42333 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42334 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42335 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42336 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42337 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42338 @end smallexample
42339
42340 @node Memory Map Format
42341 @section Memory Map Format
42342 @cindex memory map format
42343
42344 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42345 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42346 memory map.
42347
42348 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42349 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42350 lists memory regions.
42351
42352 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42353 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42354
42355 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42356
42357 @smallexample
42358 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42359 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42360 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42361 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42362 <memory-map>
42363 region...
42364 </memory-map>
42365 @end smallexample
42366
42367 Each region can be either:
42368
42369 @itemize
42370
42371 @item
42372 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42373 bytes from there:
42374
42375 @smallexample
42376 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42377 @end smallexample
42378
42379
42380 @item
42381 A region of read-only memory:
42382
42383 @smallexample
42384 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42385 @end smallexample
42386
42387
42388 @item
42389 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42390 bytes in length:
42391
42392 @smallexample
42393 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42394 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42395 </memory>
42396 @end smallexample
42397
42398 @end itemize
42399
42400 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42401 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42402 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42403
42404 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42405
42406 @smallexample
42407 <!-- ................................................... -->
42408 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42409 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42410 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42411 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42412 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42413 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42414 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42415 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42416 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42417 and its type, or device. -->
42418 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42419 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42420 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42421 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42422 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42423 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42424 @end smallexample
42425
42426 @node Thread List Format
42427 @section Thread List Format
42428 @cindex thread list format
42429
42430 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42431 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42432 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42433 the following structure:
42434
42435 @smallexample
42436 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42437 <threads>
42438 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42439 ... description ...
42440 </thread>
42441 </threads>
42442 @end smallexample
42443
42444 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42445 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42446 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42447 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42448 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42449 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42450 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42451 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42452
42453
42454 @node Traceframe Info Format
42455 @section Traceframe Info Format
42456 @cindex traceframe info format
42457
42458 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42459 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42460 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42461 collected in a traceframe.
42462
42463 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42464 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42465
42466 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42467 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42468
42469 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42470
42471 @smallexample
42472 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42473 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42474 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42475 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42476 <traceframe-info>
42477 block...
42478 </traceframe-info>
42479 @end smallexample
42480
42481 Each traceframe block can be either:
42482
42483 @itemize
42484
42485 @item
42486 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42487 @var{length} bytes from there:
42488
42489 @smallexample
42490 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42491 @end smallexample
42492
42493 @item
42494 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42495 collected:
42496
42497 @smallexample
42498 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42499 @end smallexample
42500
42501 @end itemize
42502
42503 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42504
42505 @smallexample
42506 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42507 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42508
42509 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42510 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42511 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42512 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42513 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42514 @end smallexample
42515
42516 @node Branch Trace Format
42517 @section Branch Trace Format
42518 @cindex branch trace format
42519
42520 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42521 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42522 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42523 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42524
42525 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42526 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42527
42528 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42529 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42530
42531 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42532
42533 @smallexample
42534 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42535 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42536 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42537 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42538 <btrace>
42539 block...
42540 </btrace>
42541 @end smallexample
42542
42543 @itemize
42544
42545 @item
42546 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42547 and ending at @var{end}:
42548
42549 @smallexample
42550 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42551 @end smallexample
42552
42553 @end itemize
42554
42555 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42556
42557 @smallexample
42558 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42559 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42560
42561 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42562 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42563 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42564
42565 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42566
42567 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42568
42569 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42570 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42571 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42572 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42573 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42574
42575 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42576 @end smallexample
42577
42578 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42579 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42580 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42581
42582 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42583 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42584 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42585
42586 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42587 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42588
42589 @table @code
42590 @item bts
42591 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42592 @table @code
42593 @item size
42594 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42595 @end table
42596 @item pt
42597 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42598 PT}) format.
42599 @table @code
42600 @item size
42601 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42602 @end table
42603 @end table
42604
42605 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42606 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42607
42608 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42609
42610 @smallexample
42611 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42612 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42613
42614 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42615 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42616
42617 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42618 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42619 @end smallexample
42620
42621 @include agentexpr.texi
42622
42623 @node Target Descriptions
42624 @appendix Target Descriptions
42625 @cindex target descriptions
42626
42627 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42628 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42629 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42630 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42631 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42632 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42633 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42634
42635 @itemize @bullet
42636 @item
42637 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42638 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42639 @item
42640 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42641 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42642 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42643 @item
42644 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42645 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42646 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42647 @end itemize
42648
42649 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42650 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42651 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42652 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42653 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42654
42655 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42656 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42657
42658 @menu
42659 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42660 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42661 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42662 descriptions.
42663 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42664 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42665 @end menu
42666
42667 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42668 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42669
42670 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42671 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42672 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42673 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42674 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42675 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42676 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42677 Format}.
42678
42679 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42680 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42681 specify a file are:
42682
42683 @table @code
42684 @cindex set tdesc filename
42685 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42686 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42687
42688 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42689 @item unset tdesc filename
42690 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42691 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42692
42693 @cindex show tdesc filename
42694 @item show tdesc filename
42695 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42696 @end table
42697
42698
42699 @node Target Description Format
42700 @section Target Description Format
42701 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42702
42703 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42704 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42705 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42706 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42707 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42708 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42709 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42710
42711 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42712 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42713 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42714 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42715 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42716
42717 Here is a simple target description:
42718
42719 @smallexample
42720 <target version="1.0">
42721 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42722 </target>
42723 @end smallexample
42724
42725 @noindent
42726 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42727 the x86-64 architecture.
42728
42729 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42730 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42731 are explained further below.
42732
42733 @smallexample
42734 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42735 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42736 <target version="1.0">
42737 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42738 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42739 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42740 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42741 </target>
42742 @end smallexample
42743
42744 @noindent
42745 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42746 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42747 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42748 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42749 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42750 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42751 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42752 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42753 the version mismatch.
42754
42755 @subsection Inclusion
42756 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42757 @cindex XInclude
42758 @ifnotinfo
42759 @cindex <xi:include>
42760 @end ifnotinfo
42761
42762 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42763 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42764 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42765 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42766 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42767
42768 @smallexample
42769 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42770 @end smallexample
42771
42772 @noindent
42773 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42774 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42775 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42776 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42777 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42778 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42779 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42780 original description.
42781
42782 @subsection Architecture
42783 @cindex <architecture>
42784
42785 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42786
42787 @smallexample
42788 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42789 @end smallexample
42790
42791 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42792 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42793
42794 @subsection OS ABI
42795 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42796
42797 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42798 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42799
42800 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42801
42802 @smallexample
42803 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42804 @end smallexample
42805
42806 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42807 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42808
42809 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42810 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42811
42812 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42813 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42814
42815 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42816
42817 @smallexample
42818 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42819 @end smallexample
42820
42821 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42822 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42823
42824 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42825 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42826 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42827 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42828 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42829 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42830 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42831
42832 @smallexample
42833 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42834 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42835 @end smallexample
42836
42837 @subsection Features
42838 @cindex <feature>
42839
42840 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42841 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42842 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42843 has this form:
42844
42845 @smallexample
42846 <feature name="@var{name}">
42847 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42848 @var{reg}@dots{}
42849 </feature>
42850 @end smallexample
42851
42852 @noindent
42853 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42854 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42855 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42856 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42857
42858 @subsection Types
42859
42860 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42861 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42862 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42863 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42864 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42865 and enum types.
42866
42867 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42868 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42869 Types must be defined before they are used.
42870
42871 @cindex <vector>
42872 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42873 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42874 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42875 @var{count}:
42876
42877 @smallexample
42878 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42879 @end smallexample
42880
42881 @cindex <union>
42882 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42883 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42884 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42885 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42886
42887 @smallexample
42888 <union id="@var{id}">
42889 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42890 @dots{}
42891 </union>
42892 @end smallexample
42893
42894 @cindex <struct>
42895 @cindex <flags>
42896 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42897 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42898 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42899 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42900 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42901 specified.
42902
42903 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42904
42905 @smallexample
42906 <struct id="@var{id}">
42907 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42908 @dots{}
42909 </struct>
42910 @end smallexample
42911
42912 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42913 No implicit padding is added.
42914
42915 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42916
42917 @smallexample
42918 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42919 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42920 @dots{}
42921 </struct>
42922 @end smallexample
42923
42924 @smallexample
42925 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42926 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42927 @dots{}
42928 </flags>
42929 @end smallexample
42930
42931 The @var{name} value is required.
42932 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42933 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42934 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42935
42936 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42937 is optional.
42938 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42939 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42940
42941 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42942 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42943
42944 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42945
42946 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42947 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42948
42949 @itemize @bullet
42950 @item
42951 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42952 @item
42953 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42954 @end itemize
42955
42956 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42957 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42958
42959 @itemize @bullet
42960 @item
42961 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42962
42963 @smallexample
42964 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42965 $1 = 42
42966 @end smallexample
42967
42968 @end itemize
42969
42970 @subsection Registers
42971 @cindex <reg>
42972
42973 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42974
42975 @smallexample
42976 <reg name="@var{name}"
42977 bitsize="@var{size}"
42978 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42979 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42980 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42981 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42982 @end smallexample
42983
42984 @noindent
42985 The components are as follows:
42986
42987 @table @var
42988
42989 @item name
42990 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42991
42992 @item bitsize
42993 The register's size, in bits.
42994
42995 @item regnum
42996 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42997 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42998 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42999 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
43000 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
43001 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
43002 in order of increasing register number.
43003
43004 @item save-restore
43005 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
43006 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
43007 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
43008 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
43009 ABI.
43010
43011 @item type
43012 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
43013 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
43014 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
43015 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
43016 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
43017 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
43018
43019 @item group
43020 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
43021 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
43022 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
43023 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
43024 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
43025 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
43026 @code{info registers}.
43027
43028 @end table
43029
43030 @node Predefined Target Types
43031 @section Predefined Target Types
43032 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43033
43034 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43035 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43036 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43037 types. The currently supported types are:
43038
43039 @table @code
43040
43041 @item bool
43042 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43043
43044 @item int8
43045 @itemx int16
43046 @itemx int24
43047 @itemx int32
43048 @itemx int64
43049 @itemx int128
43050 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43051
43052 @item uint8
43053 @itemx uint16
43054 @itemx uint24
43055 @itemx uint32
43056 @itemx uint64
43057 @itemx uint128
43058 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43059
43060 @item code_ptr
43061 @itemx data_ptr
43062 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43063 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43064 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43065 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43066 may be marked as data pointers.
43067
43068 @item ieee_single
43069 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43070
43071 @item ieee_double
43072 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43073
43074 @item arm_fpa_ext
43075 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43076
43077 @item i387_ext
43078 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43079
43080 @item i386_eflags
43081 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43082
43083 @item i386_mxcsr
43084 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
43085
43086 @end table
43087
43088 @node Enum Target Types
43089 @section Enum Target Types
43090 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
43091
43092 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
43093 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
43094
43095 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
43096
43097 @smallexample
43098 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43099 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
43100 @dots{}
43101 </enum>
43102 @end smallexample
43103
43104 Enums must be defined before they are used.
43105
43106 @smallexample
43107 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
43108 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
43109 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
43110 </enum>
43111 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
43112 <field name="X" start="0"/>
43113 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
43114 </flags>
43115 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
43116 @end smallexample
43117
43118 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
43119 would be printed as:
43120
43121 @smallexample
43122 (gdb) info register flags
43123 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
43124 @end smallexample
43125
43126 @node Standard Target Features
43127 @section Standard Target Features
43128 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
43129
43130 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
43131 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
43132 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
43133 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
43134 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
43135 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
43136 can recognize them.
43137
43138 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43139 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43140 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43141 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43142 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43143 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43144 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43145 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43146
43147 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43148 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43149 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43150
43151 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43152 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43153 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43154 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43155
43156 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43157 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43158 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43159
43160 @menu
43161 * AArch64 Features::
43162 * ARC Features::
43163 * ARM Features::
43164 * i386 Features::
43165 * MicroBlaze Features::
43166 * MIPS Features::
43167 * M68K Features::
43168 * NDS32 Features::
43169 * Nios II Features::
43170 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
43171 * PowerPC Features::
43172 * RISC-V Features::
43173 * S/390 and System z Features::
43174 * Sparc Features::
43175 * TIC6x Features::
43176 @end menu
43177
43178
43179 @node AArch64 Features
43180 @subsection AArch64 Features
43181 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43182
43183 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43184 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43185 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43186
43187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43188 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43189 and @samp{fpcr}.
43190
43191 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
43192 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
43193 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
43194
43195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
43196 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
43197
43198 @node ARC Features
43199 @subsection ARC Features
43200 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
43201
43202 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
43203 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
43204 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
43205 that one of the core registers features is present.
43206 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
43207
43208 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
43209 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43210 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43211 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
43212 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43213 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
43214 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
43215
43216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
43217 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
43218 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
43219 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
43220 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
43221 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43222
43223 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
43224 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43225 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43226 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
43227 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
43228 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
43229 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
43230 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
43231 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
43232 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
43233
43234 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
43235 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
43236
43237 @node ARM Features
43238 @subsection ARM Features
43239 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43240
43241 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43242 ARM targets.
43243 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43244 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43245
43246 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43247 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43248 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43249 and @samp{xpsr}.
43250
43251 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43252 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43253
43254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43255 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43256 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43257 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43258
43259 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43260 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43261 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43262 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43263 halves of the double-precision registers.
43264
43265 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43266 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43267 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43268 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43269 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43270 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43271
43272 @node i386 Features
43273 @subsection i386 Features
43274 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43275
43276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43277 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43278
43279 @itemize @minus
43280 @item
43281 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43282 @item
43283 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43284 @item
43285 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43286 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43287 @item
43288 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43289 @item
43290 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43291 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43292 @end itemize
43293
43294 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43295
43296 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43297 describe registers:
43298
43299 @itemize @minus
43300 @item
43301 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43302 @item
43303 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43304 @item
43305 @samp{mxcsr}
43306 @end itemize
43307
43308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43309 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43310 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43311
43312 @itemize @minus
43313 @item
43314 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43315 @item
43316 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43317 @end itemize
43318
43319 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43320 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43321
43322 @itemize @minus
43323 @item
43324 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43325 @item
43326 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43327 @end itemize
43328
43329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43330 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43331
43332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43333 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43334
43335 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43336 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43337 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43338
43339 @itemize @minus
43340 @item
43341 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43342 @end itemize
43343
43344 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43345
43346 @itemize @minus
43347 @item
43348 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43349 @end itemize
43350
43351 It should
43352 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43353
43354 @itemize @minus
43355 @item
43356 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43357 @item
43358 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43359 @end itemize
43360
43361 It should
43362 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43363
43364 @itemize @minus
43365 @item
43366 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43367 @end itemize
43368
43369 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43370 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43371 valid for i386 and amd64.
43372
43373 @node MicroBlaze Features
43374 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43375 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43376
43377 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43378 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43379 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43380 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43381 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43382
43383 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43384 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43385
43386 @node MIPS Features
43387 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43388 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43389
43390 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43391 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43392 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43393 on the target.
43394
43395 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43396 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43397 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43398
43399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43400 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43401 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43402 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43403
43404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43405 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43406 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43407 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43408
43409 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43410 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43411 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43412
43413 @node M68K Features
43414 @subsection M68K Features
43415 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43416
43417 @table @code
43418 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43419 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43420 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43421 One of those features must be always present.
43422 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43423 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43424 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43425 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43426
43427 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43428 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43429 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43430 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43431 @end table
43432
43433 @node NDS32 Features
43434 @subsection NDS32 Features
43435 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43436
43437 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43438 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43439 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43440 and @samp{pc}.
43441
43442 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43443 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43444 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43445 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43446
43447 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43448 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43449 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43450 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43451 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43452 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43453 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43454
43455 @node Nios II Features
43456 @subsection Nios II Features
43457 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43458
43459 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43460 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43461 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43462 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43463 @samp{mpuacc}).
43464
43465 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43466 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43467 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43468
43469 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43470 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43471 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43472
43473 @node PowerPC Features
43474 @subsection PowerPC Features
43475 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43476
43477 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43478 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43479 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43480 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43481
43482 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43483 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43484
43485 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43486 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
43487 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
43488 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
43489 registers.
43490
43491 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43492 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43493 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43494 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43495 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43496 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43497 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43498 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43499
43500 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43501 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43502 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43503 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43504 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43505 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43506 user.
43507
43508 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43509 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43510
43511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43512 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43513
43514 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43515 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43516
43517 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43518 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43519 64-bit wide.
43520
43521 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43522 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43523 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43524 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43525
43526 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43527 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43528 64-bit wide.
43529
43530 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43531 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43532 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43533 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43534 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43535 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43536 wide.
43537
43538 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43539 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43540 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43541 @samp{cfpscr}.
43542
43543 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43544 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43545 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43546 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43547 wide.
43548
43549 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43550 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43551 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43552 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43553 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43554 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43555 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43556 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43557 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43558
43559 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43560 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43561
43562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43563 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43564
43565 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43566 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43567
43568
43569 @node RISC-V Features
43570 @subsection RISC-V Features
43571 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
43572
43573 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
43574 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
43575 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
43576 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
43577 etc).
43578
43579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
43580 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
43581 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
43582 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
43583
43584 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
43585 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
43586 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
43587 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
43588 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
43589 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
43590 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
43591 least significant two bits.
43592
43593 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
43594 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
43595 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
43596 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
43597 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
43598 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
43599 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
43600 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
43601 other floating point hardware.
43602
43603 @node S/390 and System z Features
43604 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43605 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43606 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43607
43608 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43609 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43610 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43611 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43612 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43613 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43614 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43615 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43616 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43617
43618 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43619 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43620 @samp{fpc}.
43621
43622 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43623 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43624
43625 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43626 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43627 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43628 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43629 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43630 32-bit wide.
43631
43632 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43633 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43634 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43635
43636 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43637 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43638 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43639 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43640 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43641 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43642 @samp{v31}.
43643
43644 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43645 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43646 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43647
43648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43649 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43650 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43651
43652 @node Sparc Features
43653 @subsection Sparc Features
43654 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43655 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43656 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43657 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43658
43659 @itemize @minus
43660 @item
43661 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43662 @item
43663 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43664 @item
43665 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43666 @item
43667 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43668 @end itemize
43669
43670 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43671
43672 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43673 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43674
43675 @itemize @minus
43676 @item
43677 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43678 @item
43679 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43680 @end itemize
43681
43682 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43683 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43684
43685 @itemize @minus
43686 @item
43687 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43688 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43689 @item
43690 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43691 for sparc64
43692 @end itemize
43693
43694 @node TIC6x Features
43695 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43696 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43697 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43698 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43699 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43700 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43701
43702 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43703 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43704 through @samp{B31}.
43705
43706 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43707 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43708
43709 @node Operating System Information
43710 @appendix Operating System Information
43711 @cindex operating system information
43712
43713 @menu
43714 * Process list::
43715 @end menu
43716
43717 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43718 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43719 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43720 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43721 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43722 on a different aspect of target.
43723
43724 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43725 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43726 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43727 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43728
43729 @node Process list
43730 @appendixsection Process list
43731 @cindex operating system information, process list
43732
43733 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43734 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43735 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43736 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43737
43738 An example document is:
43739
43740 @smallexample
43741 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43742 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43743 <osdata type="processes">
43744 <item>
43745 <column name="pid">1</column>
43746 <column name="user">root</column>
43747 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43748 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43749 </item>
43750 </osdata>
43751 @end smallexample
43752
43753 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43754 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43755 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43756 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43757 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43758 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43759 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43760
43761 @node Trace File Format
43762 @appendix Trace File Format
43763 @cindex trace file format
43764
43765 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43766 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43767
43768 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43769 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43770 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43771 in the future.
43772
43773 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43774 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43775 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43776 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43777 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43778 of this section.
43779
43780 @table @code
43781 @item R @var{size}
43782 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43783 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43784 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43785 a single trace file.
43786
43787 @item status @var{status}
43788 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43789 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43790 file.
43791
43792 @item tp @var{payload}
43793 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43794 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43795 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43796 reply packets.
43797
43798 @item tsv @var{payload}
43799 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43800 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43801 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43802 reply packets.
43803
43804 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43805 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43806 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43807 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43808 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43809 file. Includes are not allowed.
43810
43811 @end table
43812
43813 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43814 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43815 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43816 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43817 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43818 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43819 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43820 endianness.
43821
43822 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43823
43824 @table @code
43825 @item R @var{bytes}
43826 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43827 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43828 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43829
43830 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43831 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43832 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43833 @var{length} bytes.
43834
43835 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43836 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43837 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43838
43839 @end table
43840
43841 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43842 of blocks.
43843
43844 @node Index Section Format
43845 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43846 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43847 @cindex index section format
43848
43849 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43850 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43851 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43852 description.
43853
43854 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43855 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43856 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43857 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43858 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43859 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43860
43861 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43862
43863 @enumerate
43864 @item
43865 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43866 unless otherwise noted:
43867
43868 @enumerate
43869 @item
43870 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43871 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43872 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43873 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43874 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43875 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43876 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43877
43878 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43879 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43880 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43881 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43882
43883 @item
43884 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43885
43886 @item
43887 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43888 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43889 to the next offset.
43890
43891 @item
43892 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43893
43894 @item
43895 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43896
43897 @item
43898 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43899 @end enumerate
43900
43901 @item
43902 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43903 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43904 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43905 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43906 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43907 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43908 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43909 CU indices.
43910
43911 @item
43912 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43913 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43914 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43915 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43916
43917 @item
43918 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43919 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43920
43921 @enumerate
43922 @item
43923 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43924
43925 @item
43926 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43927 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43928
43929 @item
43930 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43931 @end enumerate
43932
43933 @item
43934 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43935 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43936
43937 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43938 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43939 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43940 constant pool.
43941
43942 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43943 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43944 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43945
43946 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43947 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43948 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43949 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43950 index version:
43951
43952 @table @asis
43953 @item Version 4
43954 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43955
43956 @item Versions 5 to 7
43957 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43958 @end table
43959
43960 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43961
43962 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43963 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43964 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43965 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43966 collision.
43967
43968 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43969 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43970 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43971 the code.
43972
43973 @item
43974 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43975 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43976 strings.
43977
43978 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43979 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43980 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43981 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43982 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43983 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43984
43985 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43986 @end enumerate
43987
43988 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43989 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43990 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43991
43992 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43993 (bit 0 = LSB):
43994
43995 @table @asis
43996
43997 @item Bits 0-23
43998 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43999 @item Bits 24-27
44000 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
44001 @item Bits 28-30
44002 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
44003
44004 @table @asis
44005 @item 0
44006 This value is reserved and should not be used.
44007 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
44008 with previous versions of the index.
44009 @item 1
44010 The symbol is a type.
44011 @item 2
44012 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
44013 @item 3
44014 The symbol is a function.
44015 @item 4
44016 Any other kind of symbol.
44017 @item 5,6,7
44018 These values are reserved.
44019 @end table
44020
44021 @item Bit 31
44022 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
44023
44024 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
44025 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
44026 @value{GDBN} sources.
44027
44028 @end table
44029
44030 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
44031 global/static attributes in the index.
44032
44033 @smallexample
44034 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
44035 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
44036 switch (die->tag)
44037 @{
44038 case DW_TAG_typedef:
44039 case DW_TAG_base_type:
44040 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
44041 kind = TYPE;
44042 is_static = 1;
44043 break;
44044 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44045 kind = VARIABLE;
44046 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44047 break;
44048 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44049 kind = FUNCTION;
44050 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44051 break;
44052 case DW_TAG_constant:
44053 kind = VARIABLE;
44054 is_static = ! is_external;
44055 break;
44056 case DW_TAG_variable:
44057 kind = VARIABLE;
44058 is_static = ! is_external;
44059 break;
44060 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44061 kind = TYPE;
44062 is_static = 0;
44063 break;
44064 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44065 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44066 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44067 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44068 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
44069 kind = TYPE;
44070 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44071 break;
44072 default:
44073 assert (0);
44074 @}
44075 @end smallexample
44076
44077 @node Man Pages
44078 @appendix Manual pages
44079 @cindex Man pages
44080
44081 @menu
44082 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
44083 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
44084 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
44085 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
44086 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
44087 @end menu
44088
44089 @node gdb man
44090 @heading gdb man
44091
44092 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
44093
44094 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
44095 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
44096 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
44097 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
44098 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
44099 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
44100 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
44101 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
44102 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
44103 @c man end
44104
44105 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
44106 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
44107 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
44108 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
44109
44110 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
44111 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
44112
44113 @itemize @bullet
44114 @item
44115 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
44116
44117 @item
44118 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
44119
44120 @item
44121 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
44122
44123 @item
44124 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
44125 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
44126 @end itemize
44127
44128 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
44129 Modula-2.
44130
44131 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
44132 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
44133 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
44134 by using the command @code{help}.
44135
44136 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
44137 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
44138 executable program as the argument:
44139
44140 @smallexample
44141 gdb program
44142 @end smallexample
44143
44144 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
44145
44146 @smallexample
44147 gdb program core
44148 @end smallexample
44149
44150 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
44151 to debug a running process:
44152
44153 @smallexample
44154 gdb program 1234
44155 gdb -p 1234
44156 @end smallexample
44157
44158 @noindent
44159 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
44160 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
44161 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
44162
44163 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
44164
44165 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
44166 @table @env
44167 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44168 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
44169
44170 @item run [@var{arglist}]
44171 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
44172
44173 @item bt
44174 Backtrace: display the program stack.
44175
44176 @item print @var{expr}
44177 Display the value of an expression.
44178
44179 @item c
44180 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
44181
44182 @item next
44183 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
44184 function calls in the line.
44185
44186 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44187 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
44188
44189 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44190 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
44191
44192 @item step
44193 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
44194 function calls in the line.
44195
44196 @item help [@var{name}]
44197 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
44198 about using @value{GDBN}.
44199
44200 @item quit
44201 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
44202 @end table
44203
44204 @ifset man
44205 For full details on @value{GDBN},
44206 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44207 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
44208 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
44209 @end ifset
44210 @c man end
44211
44212 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
44213 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
44214 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
44215 encountered with no
44216 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
44217 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
44218 Many options have
44219 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
44220 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
44221 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
44222 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
44223 more usual convention.)
44224
44225 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
44226 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
44227 option is used.
44228
44229 @table @env
44230 @item -help
44231 @itemx -h
44232 List all options, with brief explanations.
44233
44234 @item -symbols=@var{file}
44235 @itemx -s @var{file}
44236 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
44237
44238 @item -write
44239 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44240
44241 @item -exec=@var{file}
44242 @itemx -e @var{file}
44243 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44244 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44245 dump.
44246
44247 @item -se=@var{file}
44248 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44249 file.
44250
44251 @item -core=@var{file}
44252 @itemx -c @var{file}
44253 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44254
44255 @item -command=@var{file}
44256 @itemx -x @var{file}
44257 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44258
44259 @item -ex @var{command}
44260 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44261
44262 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44263 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44264 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44265
44266 @item -nh
44267 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44268
44269 @item -nx
44270 @itemx -n
44271 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44272
44273 @item -quiet
44274 @itemx -q
44275 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44276 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44277
44278 @item -batch
44279 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44280 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44281 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44282 commands in the command files.
44283
44284 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44285 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44286 more useful, the message
44287
44288 @smallexample
44289 Program exited normally.
44290 @end smallexample
44291
44292 @noindent
44293 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44294 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44295
44296 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44297 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44298 instead of the current directory.
44299
44300 @item -fullname
44301 @itemx -f
44302 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44303 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44304 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44305 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44306 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44307 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44308 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44309 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44310
44311 @item -b @var{bps}
44312 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44313 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44314
44315 @item -tty=@var{device}
44316 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44317 @end table
44318 @c man end
44319
44320 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44321 @ifset man
44322 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44323 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44324 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44325
44326 @smallexample
44327 info gdb
44328 @end smallexample
44329
44330 @noindent
44331 should give you access to the complete manual.
44332
44333 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44334 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44335 @end ifset
44336 @c man end
44337
44338 @node gdbserver man
44339 @heading gdbserver man
44340
44341 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44342 @format
44343 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44344 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44345
44346 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44347
44348 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44349 @c man end
44350 @end format
44351
44352 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44353 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44354 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44355
44356 @ifclear man
44357 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44358 @end ifclear
44359 @ifset man
44360 Usage (server (target) side):
44361 @end ifset
44362
44363 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44364 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44365 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44366 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44367
44368 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44369 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44370 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44371
44372 @smallexample
44373 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44374 @end smallexample
44375
44376 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44377
44378 @smallexample
44379 @ifset man
44380 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44381 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44382 @end ifset
44383 @ifclear man
44384 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44385 @end ifclear
44386 @end smallexample
44387
44388 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44389 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44390 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44391
44392 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44393
44394 @smallexample
44395 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44396 @end smallexample
44397
44398 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44399 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44400 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44401 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44402 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44403 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44404 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44405 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44406 print an error message and exit.
44407
44408 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44409 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44410
44411 @smallexample
44412 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44413 @end smallexample
44414
44415 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44416 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44417
44418 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44419 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44420 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44421 the program you want to debug.
44422
44423 @smallexample
44424 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44425 @end smallexample
44426
44427 @ifclear man
44428 @subheading Usage (host side)
44429 @end ifclear
44430 @ifset man
44431 Usage (host side):
44432 @end ifset
44433
44434 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44435 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44436 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44437 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44438 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44439 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44440 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44441 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44442 descriptor. For example:
44443
44444 @smallexample
44445 @ifset man
44446 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44447 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44448 @end ifset
44449 @ifclear man
44450 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44451 @end ifclear
44452 @end smallexample
44453
44454 @noindent
44455 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44456
44457 @smallexample
44458 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44459 @end smallexample
44460
44461 @noindent
44462 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44463 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44464 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44465 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44466 `Connection refused'.
44467
44468 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44469 described in
44470 @ifset man
44471 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44472 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44473 @end ifset
44474 @ifclear man
44475 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44476 @end ifclear
44477 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44478
44479 @smallexample
44480 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44481 @end smallexample
44482
44483 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44484 case.
44485 @c man end
44486
44487 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44488 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44489
44490 @itemize @bullet
44491
44492 @item
44493 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44494
44495 @smallexample
44496 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44497 @end smallexample
44498
44499 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44500 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44501 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44502 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44503 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44504 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44505 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44506
44507 @item
44508 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44509 program:
44510
44511 @smallexample
44512 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44513 @end smallexample
44514
44515 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44516 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44517 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44518 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44519
44520 @item
44521 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44522
44523 @smallexample
44524 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44525 @end smallexample
44526
44527 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44528 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44529 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44530 debug several processes in the same session.
44531 @end itemize
44532
44533 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44534
44535 @table @env
44536
44537 @item --help
44538 List all options, with brief explanations.
44539
44540 @item --version
44541 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44542
44543 @item --attach
44544 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44545
44546 @smallexample
44547 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44548 @end smallexample
44549
44550 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44551 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44552
44553 @item --multi
44554 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44555 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44556 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44557 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44558
44559 @smallexample
44560 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44561 @end smallexample
44562
44563 @item --debug
44564 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44565 process.
44566 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44567 the developers.
44568
44569 @item --remote-debug
44570 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44571 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44572 the developers.
44573
44574 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
44575 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
44576 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44577 the developers.
44578
44579 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44580 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44581 of debugging output.
44582 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44583
44584 @item --wrapper
44585 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44586 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44587 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44588 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44589
44590 @item --once
44591 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44592 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44593 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44594 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44595
44596 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44597
44598 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44599 @c QDisableRandomization.
44600
44601 @end table
44602 @c man end
44603
44604 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44605 @ifset man
44606 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44607 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44608 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44609
44610 @smallexample
44611 info gdb
44612 @end smallexample
44613
44614 should give you access to the complete manual.
44615
44616 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44617 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44618 @end ifset
44619 @c man end
44620
44621 @node gcore man
44622 @heading gcore
44623
44624 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44625
44626 @format
44627 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44628 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44629 @c man end
44630 @end format
44631
44632 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44633 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44634 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44635 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44636 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44637 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44638 its job the program remains running without any change.
44639 @c man end
44640
44641 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44642 @table @env
44643 @item -a
44644 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44645 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44646 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44647 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44648 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44649
44650 @item -o @var{prefix}
44651 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44652 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44653 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44654 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44655 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44656 @end table
44657 @c man end
44658
44659 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44660 @ifset man
44661 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44662 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44663 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44664
44665 @smallexample
44666 info gdb
44667 @end smallexample
44668
44669 @noindent
44670 should give you access to the complete manual.
44671
44672 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44673 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44674 @end ifset
44675 @c man end
44676
44677 @node gdbinit man
44678 @heading gdbinit
44679
44680 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44681
44682 @format
44683 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44684 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44685 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44686 @end ifset
44687
44688 ~/.gdbinit
44689
44690 ./.gdbinit
44691 @c man end
44692 @end format
44693
44694 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44695 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44696 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44697 described in
44698 @ifset man
44699 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44700 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44701 @end ifset
44702 @ifclear man
44703 @ref{Sequences}.
44704 @end ifclear
44705
44706 Please read more in
44707 @ifset man
44708 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44709 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44710 @end ifset
44711 @ifclear man
44712 @ref{Startup}.
44713 @end ifclear
44714
44715 @table @env
44716 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44717 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44718 @end ifset
44719 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44720 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44721 @end ifclear
44722 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44723 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44724 See more in
44725 @ifset man
44726 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44727 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44728 @end ifset
44729 @ifclear man
44730 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44731 @end ifclear
44732
44733 @item ~/.gdbinit
44734 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44735 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44736
44737 @item ./.gdbinit
44738 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44739 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44740 See more in
44741 @ifset man
44742 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44743 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44744 @end ifset
44745 @ifclear man
44746 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44747 @end ifclear
44748 @end table
44749 @c man end
44750
44751 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44752 @ifset man
44753 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44754
44755 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44756 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44757 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44758
44759 @smallexample
44760 info gdb
44761 @end smallexample
44762
44763 should give you access to the complete manual.
44764
44765 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44766 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44767 @end ifset
44768 @c man end
44769
44770 @node gdb-add-index man
44771 @heading gdb-add-index
44772 @pindex gdb-add-index
44773 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44774
44775 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44776
44777 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44778 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44779 @c man end
44780
44781 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44782 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44783 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44784 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44785 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44786 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44787
44788 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44789 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44790 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44791 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44792 named @code{.debug_*}).
44793
44794 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44795 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44796 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44797 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44798
44799 See more in
44800 @ifset man
44801 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44802 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44803 @end ifset
44804 @ifclear man
44805 @ref{Index Files}.
44806 @end ifclear
44807 @c man end
44808
44809 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44810 @ifset man
44811 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44812 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44813 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44814
44815 @smallexample
44816 info gdb
44817 @end smallexample
44818
44819 should give you access to the complete manual.
44820
44821 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44822 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44823 @end ifset
44824 @c man end
44825
44826 @include gpl.texi
44827
44828 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44829 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44830 @include fdl.texi
44831
44832 @node Concept Index
44833 @unnumbered Concept Index
44834
44835 @printindex cp
44836
44837 @node Command and Variable Index
44838 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44839
44840 @printindex fn
44841
44842 @tex
44843 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44844 % meantime:
44845 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44846 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44847 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44848 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44849 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44850 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44851 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44852 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44853 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44854 \page\colophon
44855 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44856 @end tex
44857
44858 @bye
This page took 1.147356 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.